sv1
As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on
May 7, 2010
Registration
No. 333-
UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C.
20549
Form S-1
REGISTRATION
STATEMENT
UNDER
THE SECURITIES ACT OF
1933
HCA Inc.
(Exact name of registrant as
specified in its charter)
|
|
|
|
|
Delaware
(State or other jurisdiction
of
incorporation or organization)
|
|
8062
(Primary Standard
Industrial
Classification Code Number)
|
|
75-2497104
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)
|
One Park Plaza
Nashville, Tennessee
37203
(615) 344-9551
(Address, including zip code,
and telephone number, including area code, of registrants
principal executive offices)
John M. Franck
II, Esq.
HCA Inc.
Vice President and Corporate
Secretary
One Park Plaza
Nashville, Tennessee
37203
(615) 344-9551
(Name, address, including zip
code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for
service)
With copies to:
|
|
|
|
|
Joseph H. Kaufman, Esq.
|
|
J. Page Davidson, Esq.
|
|
James J. Clark, Esq.
|
John C. Ericson, Esq.
|
|
Ryan D. Thomas, Esq.
|
|
Jonathan A. Schaffzin, Esq.
|
Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP
|
|
Bass, Berry & Sims PLC
|
|
William J. Miller, Esq.
|
425 Lexington Avenue
|
|
150 Third Avenue South, Suite 2800
|
|
Cahill Gordon & Reindel
llp
|
New York, New York
10017-3954
|
|
Nashville, Tennessee 37201-2017
|
|
Eighty Pine Street
|
(212) 455-2000
|
|
(615) 742-6200
|
|
New York, New York
10005-1702
|
|
|
|
|
(212) 701-3000
|
Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the
public: As soon as practicable after this
Registration Statement is declared effective.
If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be
offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to
Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the
following
box. o
If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an
offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act,
please check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective
registration statement for the same
offering. o
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to
Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following
box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of
the earlier effective registration statement for the same
offering. o
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to
Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following
box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of
the earlier effective registration statement for the same
offering. o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large
accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated
filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of
large accelerated filer, accelerated
filer and smaller reporting company in
Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
|
|
|
|
Large
accelerated
filer o
|
Accelerated
filer o
|
Non-accelerated
filer þ
|
Smaller reporting
company o
|
(Do not check if a smaller
reporting company)
CALCULATION
OF REGISTRATION FEE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Proposed Maximum
|
|
|
|
Title of Each Class of
|
|
|
Aggregate Offering
|
|
|
Amount of
|
Securities to be Registered
|
|
|
Price(1)(2)
|
|
|
Registration Fee
|
Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share
|
|
|
$
|
4,600,000,000
|
|
|
|
$
|
327,980
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
Includes shares to be sold upon
exercise of the underwriters option. See
Underwriting.
|
|
(2)
|
|
Estimated solely for the purpose of
calculating the amount of the registration fee pursuant to
Rule 457(o) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
|
The registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on
such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective
date until the registrant shall file a further amendment which
specifically states that this Registration Statement shall
thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a)
of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or until the
Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as
the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said
Section 8(a), may determine.
The
information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and
may be changed. We and the selling stockholders may not sell
these securities until the registration statement filed with the
Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This
preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities,
and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any
jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.
|
SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED
MAY 7, 2010
PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS
HCA Inc.
Shares
Common
Stock
$
per share
We are
offering shares
of our common stock, and the selling stockholders named in this
prospectus are
offering shares
of our common stock. We will not receive any proceeds from the
sale of the shares by the selling stockholders.
This is an initial public offering of our common stock. Since
November 2006 and prior to this offering, there has been no
public market for our common stock. We currently expect the
initial public offering price will be between
$ and
$ per share. We intend to apply to
list the common stock on the New York Stock Exchange under the
symbol HCA.
Investing in our common stock involves a high degree of risk.
See Risk Factors beginning on page 14 of this
prospectus to read about factors you should consider before
buying shares of our common stock.
Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state
securities commission has approved or disapproved of these
securities or passed upon the adequacy or accuracy of this
prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal
offense.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Per Share
|
|
Total
|
|
Initial price to public
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Underwriting discount
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Proceeds, before expenses, to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Proceeds, before expenses, to the selling stockholders
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
To the extent that the underwriters sell more
than shares
of common stock, the underwriters have the option to purchase up
to an
additional shares
from us and the selling stockholders at the initial price to the
public less the underwriting discount.
The underwriters expect to deliver the shares against payment in
New York, New York on or
about ,
2010.
Joint
Book-Running Managers
|
|
|
BofA
Merrill Lynch |
Citi |
J.P. Morgan |
Prospectus
dated ,
2010.
You should rely only on the information contained in this
prospectus or in any free writing prospectus that we authorize
be delivered to you. Neither we nor the underwriters have
authorized anyone to provide you with additional or different
information. If anyone provides you with additional, different
or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it. We and
the underwriters are not making an offer to sell these
securities in any jurisdiction where an offer or sale is not
permitted. You should assume that the information in this
prospectus is accurate only as of the date on the front cover,
regardless of the time of delivery of this prospectus or of any
sale of our common stock. Our business, prospects, financial
condition and results of operations may have changed since that
date.
TABLE OF
CONTENTS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
14
|
|
|
|
|
30
|
|
|
|
|
32
|
|
|
|
|
33
|
|
|
|
|
34
|
|
|
|
|
36
|
|
|
|
|
38
|
|
|
|
|
41
|
|
|
|
|
62
|
|
|
|
|
84
|
|
|
|
|
100
|
|
|
|
|
111
|
|
|
|
|
144
|
|
|
|
|
146
|
|
|
|
|
150
|
|
|
|
|
159
|
|
|
|
|
163
|
|
|
|
|
165
|
|
|
|
|
168
|
|
|
|
|
175
|
|
|
|
|
175
|
|
|
|
|
176
|
|
|
|
|
F-1
|
|
EX-23.2 |
MARKET,
RANKING AND OTHER INDUSTRY DATA
The data included in this prospectus regarding markets and
ranking, including the size of certain markets and our position
and the position of our competitors within these markets, are
based on reports of government agencies or published industry
sources and estimates based on our managements knowledge
and experience in the markets in which we operate. These
estimates have been based on information obtained from our trade
and business organizations and other contacts in the markets in
which we operate. We believe these estimates to be accurate as
of the date of this prospectus. However, this information may
prove to be inaccurate because of the method by which we
obtained some of the data for the estimates or because this
information cannot always be verified with complete certainty
due to the limits on the availability and reliability of raw
data, the voluntary nature of the data gathering process and
other limitations and uncertainties. As a result, you should be
aware that market, ranking and other similar industry data
included in this prospectus, and estimates and beliefs based on
that data, may not be reliable. We cannot guarantee the accuracy
or completeness of any such information contained in this
prospectus.
i
PROSPECTUS
SUMMARY
This summary highlights significant aspects of our business
and this offering, but it is not complete and does not contain
all of the information you should consider before making your
investment decision. You should carefully read the entire
prospectus, including the information presented under the
section entitled Risk Factors and the financial
statements and related notes, before making an investment
decision. This summary contains forward-looking statements that
involve risks and uncertainties. Our actual results may differ
significantly from the results discussed in the forward-looking
statements as a result of certain factors, including those set
forth in Risk Factors and Forward-Looking
Statements.
The terms Company, HCA,
we, our or us, as used
herein, refer to HCA Inc. and its affiliates unless otherwise
stated or indicated by context. The term affiliates
means direct and indirect subsidiaries of HCA Inc. and
partnerships and joint ventures in which such subsidiaries are
partners. The terms facilities or
hospitals refer to entities owned and operated by
affiliates of HCA and the term employees refers to
employees of affiliates of HCA.
Our
Company
We are the largest non-governmental hospital operator in the
U.S. and a leading comprehensive, integrated provider of
health care and related services. We provide these services
through a network of acute care hospitals, outpatient
facilities, clinics and other patient care delivery settings. As
of March 31, 2010, we operated a diversified portfolio of
162 hospitals (with approximately 41,000 beds) and 106
freestanding surgery centers across 20 states throughout
the U.S. and in England. As a result of our efforts to
establish significant market share in large and growing urban
markets with attractive demographic and economic profiles, we
currently have a substantial market presence in 14 of the top 25
fastest growing markets in the U.S. and currently maintain the
first or second position, based on inpatient admissions, in many
of our key markets. We believe our ability to successfully
position and grow our assets in attractive markets and execute
our operating plan has contributed to the strength of our
financial performance over the last several years. For the year
ended December 31, 2009, we generated revenues of
$30.052 billion, net income attributable to HCA Inc. of
$1.054 billion and Adjusted EBITDA of $5.472 billion.
For the three months ended March 31, 2010, we generated
revenues of $7.544 billion, net income attributable to HCA
Inc. of $388 million and Adjusted EBITDA of
$1.574 billion.
Our patient-first strategy is to provide high quality health
care services in a cost-efficient manner. We intend to build
upon our history of profitable growth by maintaining our
dedication to quality care, increasing our presence in key
markets through organic expansion and strategic acquisitions,
leveraging our scale and infrastructure, and further developing
our physician and employee relationships. We believe pursuing
these core elements of our strategy helps us develop a
faster-growing, more stable and more profitable business and
increases our relevance to patients, physicians, payers and
employers.
Using our scale, significant resources and over 40 years of
operating experience we have developed a significant management
and support infrastructure. Some of the key components of our
support infrastructure include a revenue cycle management
organization, a health care group purchasing organization, or
GPO, an information technology and services provider, a nurse
staffing agency and a medical malpractice insurance underwriter.
These shared services have helped us to maximize our cash
collection efficiency, achieve savings in purchasing through our
scale, more rapidly deploy information technology upgrades, more
effectively manage our labor pool and achieve greater stability
in malpractice insurance premiums. Collectively, these
components have helped us to further enhance our operating
effectiveness, cost efficiency and overall financial results.
Since the founding of our business in 1968 as a single-facility
hospital company, we have demonstrated an ability to
consistently innovate and sustain growth during varying economic
and regulatory climates. Under the leadership of an experienced
senior management team, whose tenure at HCA averages over
20 years, we have established an extensive record of
providing high quality care, profitably growing our business,
making and integrating strategic acquisitions and efficiently
and strategically allocating capital spending.
1
On November 17, 2006, we were acquired by a private
investor group comprised of affiliates of or funds sponsored by
Bain Capital Partners, LLC, Kohlberg Kravis Roberts &
Co., Merrill Lynch Global Private Equity, Citigroup Inc., Bank
of America Corporation and HCA founder Dr. Thomas F. Frist,
Jr., a group we collectively refer to as the
Investors, and by members of management and certain
other investors. We refer to the merger, the financing
transactions related to the merger and other related
transactions collectively as the Recapitalization.
Since the Recapitalization, we have achieved substantial
operational and financial progress. During this time, we have
made significant investments in expanding our service lines and
expanding our alignment with highly specialized and primary care
physicians. In addition, we have enhanced our operating
efficiencies through a number of corporate cost-saving
initiatives and an expansion of our support infrastructure. We
have made investments in information technology to optimize our
facilities and systems. We have also undertaken a number of
initiatives to improve clinical quality and patient
satisfaction. As a result of these initiatives, our financial
performance has improved significantly from the year ended
December 31, 2007, the first full year following the
Recapitalization, to the year ended December 31, 2009, with
revenues growing by $3.194 billion, net income attributable
to HCA Inc. increasing by $180 million and Adjusted EBITDA
increasing by $880 million. This represents compounded
annual growth rates on these key metrics of 5.8%, 9.8% and 9.2%,
respectively.
Our
Industry
We believe well-capitalized, comprehensive and integrated health
care delivery providers are well-positioned to benefit from the
current industry trends, some of which include:
Aging Population and Continued Growth in the Need for Health
Care Services. According to the U.S. Census
Bureau, the demographic age group of persons aged 65 and over is
expected to experience compounded annual growth of 3.0% over the
next 20 years, and constitute 19.3% of the total
U.S. population by 2030. The Centers for
Medicare & Medicaid Services, or CMS, projects
continued increases in hospital services based on the aging of
the U.S. population, advances in medical procedures,
expansion of health coverage, increasing consumer demand for
expanded medical services and increased prevalence of chronic
conditions such as diabetes, heart disease and obesity. We
believe these factors will continue to drive increased
utilization of health care services and the need for
comprehensive, integrated hospital networks that can provide a
wide array of essential and sophisticated health care.
Continued Evolution of Quality-Based Reimbursement Favors
Large-Scale, Comprehensive and Integrated
Providers. We believe the U.S. health care
system is continuing to evolve in ways that favor large-scale,
comprehensive and integrated providers that provide high levels
of quality care. Specifically, we believe there are a number of
initiatives that will continue to gain importance in the
foreseeable future, including: introduction of value-based
payment methodologies tied to performance, quality and
coordination of care, implementation of integrated electronic
health records and information, and an increasing ability for
patients and consumers to make choices about all aspects of
health care. We believe our company is well positioned to
respond to these emerging trends and has the resources,
expertise and flexibility necessary to adapt in a timely manner
to the changing health care regulatory and reimbursement
environment.
Impact of Health Reform Law. The recently
enacted Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act, as amended
by the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act of 2010
(collectively, the Health Reform Law), will change
how health care services are covered, delivered and reimbursed.
It will do so through expanded coverage of uninsured
individuals, significant reductions in the growth of Medicare
program payments, material decreases in Medicare and Medicaid
disproportionate share hospital (DSH) payments, and
the establishment of programs where reimbursement is tied in
part to quality and integration. The Health Reform Law is
expected to expand health insurance coverage to approximately 32
to 34 million additional individuals through a combination of
public program expansion and private sector health insurance
reforms. We believe the expansion of private sector and
Medicaid coverage will, over time, increase our reimbursement
related to providing services to individuals who were previously
uninsured. On the other hand, the reductions in the growth in
Medicare payments and the decreases in DSH payments will
adversely affect our government
2
reimbursement. Because of the many variables involved, we are
unable to predict the net impact of the Health Reform Law on us;
however, we believe our experienced management team, emphasis on
quality care and our diverse service offerings will enable us to
capitalize on the opportunities presented by the Health Reform
Law, as well as adapt in a timely manner to its challenges.
Our
Competitive Strengths
We believe our key competitive strengths include:
Largest Comprehensive, Integrated Health Care Delivery
System. We are the largest
non-governmental
hospital operator in the U.S., providing approximately 4% to 5%
of all U.S. hospital services through our national
footprint. The scope and scale of our operations, evidenced by
the types of facilities we operate, the diverse medical
specialties we offer and the numerous patient care access points
we provide enable us to provide a comprehensive range of health
care services in a cost-effective manner. As a result, we
believe the breadth of our platform is a competitive advantage
in the marketplace enabling us to attract patients, physicians
and clinical staff while also providing significant economies of
scale and increasing our relevance with commercial payers.
Reputation for High Quality Patient-Centered
Care. Since our founding, we have maintained an
unwavering focus on patients and clinical outcomes. We believe
clinical quality influences physician and patient choices about
health care delivery. We align our quality initiatives
throughout the organization by engaging corporate, local,
physician and nurse leaders to share best practices and develop
standards for delivering high quality care. We have invested
extensively in quality of care initiatives, with an emphasis on
implementing information technology and adopting industry-wide
best practices and clinical protocols. As a result of these
measures, we have achieved significant progress in clinical
quality, as measured by the CMS HQA Grand Composite Score (based
on publicly available data for the twelve months ended
June 30, 2009) wherein HCA hospitals achieved 97.3% of the
CMS core measures versus the national average of 94.1%, making
HCA the best performing non-governmental system in the U.S.
Similarly, 88% of the core measure sets performed by our
facilities ranked in the top quartile and 65% ranked in the top
decile based on publicly available data for the twelve months
ended June 30, 2009. In addition, the Health Reform Law
establishes a value-based purchasing system and adjusts hospital
payment rates based on
hospital-acquired
conditions and hospital readmissions. We also believe our
quality initiatives favorably position us in a payment
environment that is increasingly performance-based.
Leading Local Market Positions in Large, Growing, Urban
Markets. Over our history, we have sought to
selectively expand and upgrade our asset base to create a
premium portfolio of assets in attractive growing markets. As a
result, we have a strong market presence in 14 of the top 25
fastest growing markets in the U.S. We currently operate in
29 markets, 17 of which have populations of 1 million
or more, with all but one of these markets projecting growth
above the national average from 2009 to 2014. Our inpatient
market share places us first or second in many of our key
markets. In addition, we operate in markets that have
demonstrated relative economic stability, with the unemployment
rate in a majority of our markets below the national average as
of March 2010. We believe the strength and stability of these
market positions will create organic growth opportunities and
allow us to develop long-term relationships with patients,
physicians, large employers and third-party payers.
Diversified Revenue Base and Payer Mix. We
believe our broad geographic footprint, varied service lines and
diverse revenue base mitigate our risks in numerous ways. Our
diversification limits our exposure to competitive dynamics and
economic conditions in any single local market, reimbursement
changes in specific service lines and disruptions with respect
to payers such as state Medicaid programs or large commercial
insurers. We have a diverse portfolio of assets with no single
facility contributing more than 2.4% of our revenues and no
single metropolitan statistical area contributing more than 7.8%
of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2009. We have
also developed a highly diversified payer base, including
approximately 3,000 managed care contracts, with no single
commercial payer representing more than 8% of revenues for the
year ended December 31, 2009. In addition, we are one of
the countrys largest providers of outpatient services,
which accounted for approximately 38% of our revenues for the
year ended December 31, 2009. We
3
believe the geographic diversity of our markets and the scope of
our inpatient and outpatient operations help reduce volatility
in our operating results.
Scale and Infrastructure Drives Cost Savings and
Efficiencies. Our scale allows us to leverage our
support infrastructure to achieve significant cost savings and
operating efficiencies, thereby driving margin expansion. We
strategically manage our supply chain through centralized
purchasing and supply warehouses, as well as our revenue cycle
through centralized billing, collections and health information
management functions. We also manage the provision of
information technology through a combination of centralized
systems with regional service support as well as centralize many
other clinical and corporate functions, creating economies of
scale in managing expenses and business processes. In addition
to the cost savings and operating efficiencies, this support
infrastructure simultaneously generates revenue from third
parties that utilize our services.
Well-Capitalized Portfolio of High Quality
Assets. In order to expand the range and improve
the quality of services provided at our facilities, we invested
over $7.8 billion in our facilities and information
technology systems over the five-year period ended
December 31, 2009. We believe our significant capital
investments in these areas will continue to attract new and
returning patients, attract and retain high-quality physicians,
maximize cost efficiencies and address the health care needs of
our local communities. Furthermore, we believe our platform as
well as electronic health record infrastructure, national
research and physician management capabilities provide a
strategic advantage by enhancing our ability to capitalize on
anticipated incentives through the HITECH provisions of the
American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 and positions us
well in an environment that increasingly emphasizes quality,
transparency and coordination of care.
Strong Operating Results and Cash Flows. Our
leading scale, diversification, favorable market positions,
dedication to clinical quality and focus on operational
efficiency have enabled us to achieve attractive historical
financial performance even during the most recent economic
period. In the year ended December 31, 2009, we generated
net income attributable to HCA Inc. of $1.054 billion,
Adjusted EBITDA of $5.472 billion and cash flows from
operating activities of $2.747 billion, while for the three
months ended March 31, 2010, we generated net income
attributable to HCA Inc. of $388 million, Adjusted EBITDA
of $1.574 billion and cash flows from operating activities
of $901 million. Our ability to generate strong and
consistent cash flow from operations has enabled us to invest in
our operations, reduce our debt, enhance earnings per share and
continue to pursue attractive growth opportunities.
Proven and Experienced Management Team. We
believe the extensive experience and depth of our management
team are a distinct competitive advantage in the complicated and
evolving industry in which we compete. Our CEO and Chairman of
the Board of Directors, Richard M. Bracken, began his career
with our company over 28 years ago and has held various
executive positions with us over that period, including, most
recently, as our President and Chief Operating Officer. Our
Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Director,
R. Milton Johnson, joined our company over 27 years ago and
has held various positions in our financial operations since
that time. Our six Group Presidents average over 20 years
of experience with our company. Members of our senior management
hold significant equity interests in our company, further
aligning their long-term interests with those of our
stockholders.
Our
Growth Strategy
We are committed to providing the communities we serve with high
quality, cost-effective health care while growing our business,
increasing our profitability and creating long-term value for
our stockholders. To achieve these objectives, we align our
efforts around the following growth agenda:
Grow Our Presence in Existing Markets. We
believe we are well positioned in a number of large and growing
markets that will allow us the opportunity to generate
long-term, attractive growth through the expansion of our
presence in these markets. We plan to continue recruiting and
strategically collaborating with the physician community and
adding attractive service lines such as cardiology, emergency
services, oncology and womens services. Additional
components of our growth strategy include expanding our
footprint through developing various outpatient access points,
including surgery centers, rural outreach, freestanding
emergency
4
departments and walk-in clinics. Since our Recapitalization, we
have invested significant capital into these markets and expect
to continue to see the benefit of this investment.
Achieve Industry-Leading Performance in Clinical and
Satisfaction Measures. Achieving high levels of
patient safety, patient satisfaction and clinical quality are
central goals of our business model. To achieve these goals, we
have implemented a number of initiatives including infection
reduction initiatives, hospitalist programs, advanced health
information technology and evidence-based medicine programs. We
routinely analyze operational practices from our best-performing
hospitals to identify ways to implement organization-wide
performance improvements and reduce clinical variation. We
believe these initiatives will continue to improve patient care,
help us achieve cost efficiencies, grow our revenues and
favorably position us in an environment where our constituents
are increasingly focused on quality, efficacy and efficiency.
Recruit and Employ Physicians to Meet Need for High Quality
Health Services. We depend on the quality and
dedication of the health care providers and other team members
who serve at our facilities. We believe a critical component of
our growth strategy is our ability to successfully recruit and
strategically collaborate with physicians and other
professionals to provide high quality care. We attract and
retain physicians by providing high quality, convenient
facilities with advanced technology, by expanding our specialty
services and by building our outpatient operations. We believe
our continued investment in the employment, recruitment and
retention of physicians will improve the quality of care at our
facilities.
Continue to Leverage Our Scale and Market Positions to
Enhance Profitability. We believe there is
significant opportunity to continue to grow the profitability of
our company by fully leveraging the scale and scope of our
franchise. We are currently pursuing next generation performance
improvement initiatives such as contracting for services on a
multistate basis and expanding our support infrastructure for
additional clinical and support functions, such as physician
credentialing, medical transcription and electronic medical
recordkeeping. We believe our centrally managed business
processes and ability to leverage cost-saving practices across
our extensive network will enable us to continue to manage costs
effectively.
Selectively Pursue a Disciplined Development
Strategy. We continue to believe there are
significant growth opportunities in our markets. We will
continue to provide financial and operational resources to
successfully execute on our in-market opportunities. To
complement our in-market growth agenda, we intend to focus on
selectively developing and acquiring new hospitals, outpatient
facilities and other health care service providers. We believe
the challenges faced by the hospital industry may spur
consolidation and we believe our size, scale, national presence
and access to capital will position us well to participate in
any such consolidation. We have a strong record of successfully
acquiring and integrating hospitals and entering into joint
ventures and intend to continue leveraging this experience.
Recent
Developments
On April 6, 2010, we entered into an amendment of our
senior secured term loan B facility, extending the maturity date
for $2.0 billion of loans from November 17, 2013 to
March 31, 2017.
On May 5, 2010, our Board of Directors declared a
distribution to our existing stockholders and holders of vested
stock options of approximately $500 million in the
aggregate.
Risk
Factors
Investing in our common stock involves substantial risk, and our
ability to successfully operate our business is subject to
numerous risks, including those that are generally associated
with operating in the health care industry. Any of the factors
set forth under Risk Factors may limit our ability
to successfully execute our business strategy. You should
carefully consider all of the information set forth in this
prospectus and, in particular, should evaluate the specific
factors set forth under Risk Factors in deciding
whether to invest in our common stock. Among these important
risks are the following:
|
|
|
|
|
our substantial debt could limit our ability to pursue our
growth strategy;
|
|
|
|
our debt agreements contain restrictions that may limit our
flexibility in operating our business;
|
5
|
|
|
|
|
the current economic climate and general economic factors may
adversely affect our performance;
|
|
|
|
we face intense competition that could limit our growth
opportunities;
|
|
|
|
we are required to comply with extensive laws and regulations
that could impact our operations;
|
|
|
|
legal proceedings and governmental investigations could
negatively impact our business; and
|
|
|
|
uninsured and patient due accounts could adversely affect our
results of operations.
|
In addition, it is difficult to predict the impact on our
company of the Health Reform Law due to the laws
complexity, lack of implementing regulations or interpretive
guidance, gradual implementation and possible amendment, as well
as our inability to foresee how individuals and businesses will
respond to the choices afforded them by the law. Because of the
many variables involved, we are unable to predict the net effect
on the Company of the Health Reform Laws planned
reductions in the growth of Medicare payments, the expected
increases in our revenues from providing care to previously
uninsured individuals, and numerous other provisions in the law
that may affect us.
Through our predecessors, we commenced operations in 1968. HCA
Inc. was incorporated in Nevada in January 1990 and
reincorporated in Delaware in September 1993. Our principal
executive offices are located at One Park Plaza, Nashville,
Tennessee 37203, and our telephone number is
(615) 344-9551.
Our website address is www.hcahealthcare.com. The
information on our website is not part of this prospectus.
6
The
Offering
|
|
|
Common stock offered by HCA |
|
shares |
|
Common stock offered by selling stockholders |
|
shares |
|
Common stock to be outstanding after this offering |
|
shares
( shares
if the underwriters exercise their option in full) |
|
Use of Proceeds |
|
We estimate that the net proceeds to us from this offering,
after deducting underwriting discounts and estimated offering
expenses, will be approximately
$ billion, assuming the
shares are offered at $ per share,
which is the mid-point of the estimated offering price range set
forth on the cover page of this prospectus. |
|
|
|
We intend to use the anticipated net proceeds to repay certain
of our existing indebtedness, as will be determined prior to our
offering, and for general corporate purposes. |
|
|
|
We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of shares of our
common stock by the selling stockholders. |
|
Underwriters option |
|
We and the selling stockholders have granted the underwriters a
30-day
option to purchase up
to
additional shares of our common stock at the initial public
offering price. |
|
Dividend policy |
|
We do not intend to pay dividends on our common stock for the
foreseeable future following completion of the offering. |
|
Risk Factors |
|
You should carefully read and consider the information set forth
under Risk Factors beginning on page 14 of this
prospectus and all other information set forth in this
prospectus before investing in our common stock. |
|
Conflicts of Interest |
|
Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates
have, from time to time, performed, and may in the future
perform, various financial advisory, investment banking,
commercial banking and other services for us for which they
received or will receive customary fees and expenses. See
Underwriting. Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner &
Smith Incorporated and/or its affiliates indirectly own in
excess of 10% of our issued and outstanding common stock, and
may therefore be deemed to be one of our affiliates
and to have a conflict of interest with us within
the meaning of NASD Conduct Rule 2720
(Rule 2720) of the Financial Industry
Regulatory Authority, Inc. Therefore, this offering will be
conducted in accordance with Rule 2720, which requires that
a qualified independent underwriter as defined in Rule 2720
participate in the preparation of the registration statement of
which this prospectus forms a part and perform its usual
standard of due diligence with respect thereto. See
Underwriting Conflicts of Interest. |
|
Proposed NYSE ticker symbol |
|
HCA |
7
Unless we indicate otherwise or the context requires, all
information in this prospectus:
|
|
|
|
|
assumes (1) no exercise of the underwriters option to
purchase additional shares of our common stock; and (2) an
initial public offering price of $
per share, the midpoint of the initial public offering range
indicated on the cover of this prospectus;
|
|
|
|
reflects the to 1 stock split that we effected
on ,
2010; and
|
|
|
|
does not reflect
(1) shares
of our common stock issuable upon the exercise of outstanding
stock options at a weighted average exercise price of
$ per share as of March 31,
2010,
of
which
were then exercisable; and
(2) shares
of our common stock reserved for future grants under our stock
incentive plans.
|
8
Summary
Financial Data
The following table sets forth our summary financial data as of
and for the periods indicated. The financial data as of
December 31, 2009 and 2008 and for the years ended
December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 have been derived from our
consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this
prospectus, which have been audited by Ernst & Young
LLP. The financial data as of December 31, 2007 have been
derived from our consolidated financial statements audited by
Ernst & Young LLP that are not included herein.
The summary financial data as of March 31, 2010 and for the
three months ended March 31, 2010 and 2009 have been
derived from our unaudited condensed consolidated financial
statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary
financial data as of March 31, 2009 have been derived from
our unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements that
are not included in this prospectus. The unaudited financial
data presented have been prepared on a basis consistent with our
audited consolidated financial statements. In the opinion of
management, such unaudited financial data reflect all
adjustments, consisting only of normal and recurring
adjustments, necessary for a fair presentation of the results
for those periods. The results of operations for the interim
periods are not necessarily indicative of the results to be
expected for the full year or any future period.
The summary financial data should be read in conjunction with
Selected Financial Data, Managements
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations and our consolidated financial statements, our
unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements and
related notes thereto appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As of and for the
|
|
|
|
As of and for the
|
|
|
Three Months Ended
|
|
|
|
Years Ended December 31,
|
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(Unaudited)
|
|
|
|
(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)
|
|
|
Income Statement Data:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
30,052
|
|
|
$
|
28,374
|
|
|
$
|
26,858
|
|
|
$
|
7,544
|
|
|
$
|
7,431
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
11,958
|
|
|
|
11,440
|
|
|
|
10,714
|
|
|
|
3,072
|
|
|
|
2,923
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
4,868
|
|
|
|
4,620
|
|
|
|
4,395
|
|
|
|
1,200
|
|
|
|
1,210
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
4,724
|
|
|
|
4,554
|
|
|
|
4,233
|
|
|
|
1,202
|
|
|
|
1,102
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
3,276
|
|
|
|
3,409
|
|
|
|
3,130
|
|
|
|
564
|
|
|
|
807
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(246
|
)
|
|
|
(223
|
)
|
|
|
(206
|
)
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
1,425
|
|
|
|
1,416
|
|
|
|
1,426
|
|
|
|
355
|
|
|
|
353
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
1,987
|
|
|
|
2,021
|
|
|
|
2,215
|
|
|
|
516
|
|
|
|
471
|
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
(97
|
)
|
|
|
(471
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
28,050
|
|
|
|
27,204
|
|
|
|
25,460
|
|
|
|
6,859
|
|
|
|
6,812
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
2,002
|
|
|
|
1,170
|
|
|
|
1,398
|
|
|
|
685
|
|
|
|
619
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
627
|
|
|
|
268
|
|
|
|
316
|
|
|
|
209
|
|
|
|
187
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
1,375
|
|
|
|
902
|
|
|
|
1,082
|
|
|
|
476
|
|
|
|
432
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
321
|
|
|
|
229
|
|
|
|
208
|
|
|
|
88
|
|
|
|
72
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
1,054
|
|
|
$
|
673
|
|
|
$
|
874
|
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
360
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As of and for the
|
|
|
|
As of and for the
|
|
|
Three Months Ended
|
|
|
|
Years Ended December 31,
|
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(Unaudited)
|
|
|
|
(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)
|
|
|
Earnings per share:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Basic
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Diluted
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Weighted average shares (shares in thousands):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Basic
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Diluted
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Statement of Cash Flows Data:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows provided by operating activities
|
|
$
|
2,747
|
|
|
$
|
1,990
|
|
|
$
|
1,564
|
|
|
$
|
901
|
|
|
$
|
615
|
|
Cash flows used in investing activities
|
|
|
(1,035
|
)
|
|
|
(1,467
|
)
|
|
|
(479
|
)
|
|
|
(181
|
)
|
|
|
(288
|
)
|
Cash flows used in financing activities
|
|
|
(1,865
|
)
|
|
|
(451
|
)
|
|
|
(1,326
|
)
|
|
|
(644
|
)
|
|
|
(436
|
)
|
Other Financial Data:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
EBITDA(1)
|
|
$
|
5,093
|
|
|
$
|
4,378
|
|
|
$
|
4,831
|
|
|
$
|
1,468
|
|
|
$
|
1,371
|
|
Adjusted EBITDA(1)
|
|
|
5,472
|
|
|
|
4,574
|
|
|
|
4,592
|
|
|
|
1,574
|
|
|
|
1,457
|
|
Capital expenditures
|
|
|
1,317
|
|
|
|
1,600
|
|
|
|
1,444
|
|
|
|
214
|
|
|
|
337
|
|
Operating Data(2):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number of hospitals at end of period(3)
|
|
|
155
|
|
|
|
158
|
|
|
|
161
|
|
|
|
154
|
|
|
|
155
|
|
Number of freestanding outpatient surgical centers at end of
period(4)
|
|
|
97
|
|
|
|
97
|
|
|
|
99
|
|
|
|
98
|
|
|
|
97
|
|
Number of licensed beds at end of period(5)
|
|
|
38,839
|
|
|
|
38,504
|
|
|
|
38,405
|
|
|
|
38,719
|
|
|
|
38,763
|
|
Weighted average licensed beds(6)
|
|
|
38,825
|
|
|
|
38,422
|
|
|
|
39,065
|
|
|
|
38,687
|
|
|
|
38,811
|
|
Admissions(7)
|
|
|
1,556,500
|
|
|
|
1,541,800
|
|
|
|
1,552,700
|
|
|
|
398,900
|
|
|
|
396,200
|
|
Equivalent admissions(8)
|
|
|
2,439,000
|
|
|
|
2,363,600
|
|
|
|
2,352,400
|
|
|
|
615,500
|
|
|
|
610,200
|
|
Average length of stay (days)(9)
|
|
|
4.8
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
Average daily census(10)
|
|
|
20,650
|
|
|
|
20,795
|
|
|
|
21,049
|
|
|
|
21,696
|
|
|
|
21,701
|
|
Occupancy(11)
|
|
|
53
|
%
|
|
|
54
|
%
|
|
|
54
|
%
|
|
|
56
|
%
|
|
|
56
|
%
|
Emergency room visits(12)
|
|
|
5,593,500
|
|
|
|
5,246,400
|
|
|
|
5,116,100
|
|
|
|
1,367,100
|
|
|
|
1,359,700
|
|
Outpatient surgeries(13)
|
|
|
794,600
|
|
|
|
797,400
|
|
|
|
804,900
|
|
|
|
190,700
|
|
|
|
194,400
|
|
Inpatient surgeries(14)
|
|
|
494,500
|
|
|
|
493,100
|
|
|
|
516,500
|
|
|
|
122,500
|
|
|
|
122,600
|
|
Days revenues in accounts receivable(15)
|
|
|
45
|
|
|
|
49
|
|
|
|
53
|
|
|
|
46
|
|
|
|
47
|
|
Gross patient revenues(16)
|
|
$
|
115,682
|
|
|
$
|
102,843
|
|
|
$
|
92,429
|
|
|
$
|
31,054
|
|
|
$
|
28,742
|
|
Outpatient revenues as a percentage of patient revenues(17)
|
|
|
38
|
%
|
|
|
37
|
%
|
|
|
37
|
%
|
|
|
36
|
%
|
|
|
38
|
%
|
10
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As of and for the
|
|
|
|
As of and for the
|
|
|
Three Months Ended
|
|
|
|
Years Ended December 31,
|
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(Unaudited)
|
|
|
|
(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)
|
|
|
Balance Sheet Data:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Working capital(18)
|
|
$
|
2,264
|
|
|
$
|
2,391
|
|
|
$
|
2,356
|
|
|
$
|
2,167
|
|
|
$
|
2,592
|
|
Property, plant and equipment, net
|
|
|
11,427
|
|
|
|
11,529
|
|
|
|
11,442
|
|
|
|
11,252
|
|
|
|
11,455
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents
|
|
|
312
|
|
|
|
465
|
|
|
|
393
|
|
|
|
388
|
|
|
|
356
|
|
Total assets
|
|
|
24,131
|
|
|
|
24,280
|
|
|
|
24,025
|
|
|
|
24,091
|
|
|
|
24,284
|
|
Total debt
|
|
|
25,670
|
|
|
|
26,989
|
|
|
|
27,308
|
|
|
|
26,855
|
|
|
|
26,567
|
|
Equity securities with contingent redemption rights
|
|
|
147
|
|
|
|
155
|
|
|
|
164
|
|
|
|
144
|
|
|
|
154
|
|
Stockholders deficit attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
|
(8,986
|
)
|
|
|
(10,255
|
)
|
|
|
(10,538
|
)
|
|
|
(10,313
|
)
|
|
|
(9,888
|
)
|
Noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
1,008
|
|
|
|
995
|
|
|
|
938
|
|
|
|
1,015
|
|
|
|
1,019
|
|
Total stockholders deficit
|
|
|
(7,978
|
)
|
|
|
(9,260
|
)
|
|
|
(9,600
|
)
|
|
|
(9,298
|
)
|
|
|
(8,869
|
)
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
EBITDA, a measure used by management to evaluate operating
performance, is defined as net income attributable to HCA Inc.
plus (i) provision for income taxes, (ii) interest
expense and (iii) depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is
not a recognized term under GAAP and does not purport to be an
alternative to net income as a measure of operating performance
or to cash flows from operating activities as a measure of
liquidity. Additionally, EBITDA is not intended to be a measure
of free cash flow available for managements discretionary
use, as it does not consider certain cash requirements such as
interest payments, tax payments and other debt service
requirements. Management believes EBITDA is helpful to investors
and our management in highlighting trends because EBITDA
excludes the results of decisions outside the control of
operating management and that can differ significantly from
company to company depending on long-term strategic decisions
regarding capital structure, the tax jurisdictions in which
companies operate and capital investments. Management
compensates for the limitations of using non-GAAP financial
measures by using them to supplement GAAP results to provide a
more complete understanding of the factors and trends affecting
the business than GAAP results alone. Because not all companies
use identical calculations, our presentation of EBITDA may not
be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies. |
|
|
|
Adjusted EBITDA is defined as EBITDA, adjusted to exclude net
income attributable to noncontrolling interests, losses (gains)
on sales of facilities and impairments of long-lived assets. We
believe Adjusted EBITDA is an important measure that supplements
discussions and analysis of our results of operations. We
believe it is useful to investors to provide disclosures of our
results of operations on the same basis used by management.
Management relies upon Adjusted EBITDA as the primary measure to
review and assess operating performance of its hospital
facilities and their management teams. Adjusted EBITDA target
amounts are the performance measures utilized in our annual
incentive compensation programs and are vesting conditions for a
portion of our stock option grants. Management and investors
review both the overall performance (GAAP net income
attributable to HCA Inc.) and operating performance (Adjusted
EBITDA) of our health care facilities. Adjusted EBITDA and the
Adjusted EBITDA margin (Adjusted EBITDA divided by revenues) are
utilized by management and investors to compare our current
operating results with the corresponding periods during the
previous year and to compare our operating results with other
companies in the health care industry. It is reasonable to
expect that losses (gains) on sales of facilities and impairment
of long-lived assets will occur in future periods, but the
amounts recognized can vary significantly from period to period,
do not directly relate to the ongoing operations of our health
care facilities and complicate period comparisons of our results
of operations and operations comparisons with other health care
companies. Adjusted EBITDA is not a measure of financial
performance under accounting principles generally accepted in
the United States, and should not be considered an alternative |
11
|
|
|
|
|
to net income attributable to HCA Inc. as a measure of operating
performance or cash flows from operating, investing and
financing activities as a measure of liquidity. Because Adjusted
EBITDA is not a measurement determined in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles and is susceptible to
varying calculations, Adjusted EBITDA, as presented, may not be
comparable to other similarly titled measures presented by other
companies. |
|
|
|
|
|
EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA are calculated as follows: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Three Months
|
|
|
|
Years Ended December 31,
|
|
|
Ended March 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(Unaudited)
|
|
|
|
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
1,054
|
|
|
$
|
673
|
|
|
$
|
874
|
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
360
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
627
|
|
|
|
268
|
|
|
|
316
|
|
|
|
209
|
|
|
|
187
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
1,987
|
|
|
|
2,021
|
|
|
|
2,215
|
|
|
|
516
|
|
|
|
471
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
1,425
|
|
|
|
1,416
|
|
|
|
1,426
|
|
|
|
355
|
|
|
|
353
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
EBITDA
|
|
|
5,093
|
|
|
|
4,378
|
|
|
|
4,831
|
|
|
|
1,468
|
|
|
|
1,371
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests(i)
|
|
|
321
|
|
|
|
229
|
|
|
|
208
|
|
|
|
88
|
|
|
|
72
|
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities(ii)
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
(97
|
)
|
|
|
(471
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets(iii)
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Adjusted EBITDA
|
|
$
|
5,472
|
|
|
$
|
4,574
|
|
|
$
|
4,592
|
|
|
$
|
1,574
|
|
|
$
|
1,457
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(i) |
|
Represents the add-back of net income attributable to
noncontrolling interests. |
|
(ii) |
|
Represents the elimination of losses (gains) on sales of
facilities. |
|
(iii) |
|
Represents the add-back of impairments of long-lived assets. |
|
|
|
(2) |
|
The operating data set forth in this table includes only those
facilities that are consolidated for financial reporting
purposes. |
|
|
|
(3) |
|
Excludes eight facilities in 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 that are
not consolidated (accounted for using the equity method) for
financial reporting purposes. |
|
(4) |
|
Excludes eight facilities in 2010, 2009 and 2008 and nine
facilities in 2007 that are not consolidated (accounted for
using the equity method) for financial reporting purposes. |
|
(5) |
|
Licensed beds are those beds for which a facility has been
granted approval to operate from the applicable state licensing
agency. |
|
(6) |
|
Weighted average licensed beds represents the average number of
licensed beds, weighted based on periods owned. |
|
(7) |
|
Represents the total number of patients admitted to our
hospitals and is used by management and certain investors as a
general measure of inpatient volume. |
|
(8) |
|
Equivalent admissions are used by management and certain
investors as a general measure of combined inpatient and
outpatient volume. Equivalent admissions are computed by
multiplying admissions (inpatient volume) by the sum of gross
inpatient revenues and gross outpatient revenues and then
dividing the resulting amount by gross inpatient revenues. The
equivalent admissions computation equates outpatient
revenues to the volume measure (admissions) used to measure
inpatient volume, resulting in a general measure of combined
inpatient and outpatient volume. |
|
(9) |
|
Represents the average number of days admitted patients stay in
our hospitals. |
|
(10) |
|
Represents the average number of patients in our hospital beds
each day. |
|
(11) |
|
Represents the percentage of hospital licensed beds occupied by
patients. Both average daily census and occupancy rate provide
measures of the utilization of inpatient rooms. |
|
(12) |
|
Represents the number of patients treated in our emergency rooms. |
12
|
|
|
(13) |
|
Represents the number of surgeries performed on patients who
were not admitted to our hospitals. Pain management and
endoscopy procedures are not included in outpatient surgeries. |
|
(14) |
|
Represents the number of surgeries performed on patients who
have been admitted to our hospitals. Pain management and
endoscopy procedures are not included in inpatient surgeries. |
|
(15) |
|
Revenues per day is calculated by dividing the revenues for the
period by the days in the period. Days revenues in accounts
receivable is then calculated as accounts receivable, net of the
allowance for doubtful accounts, at the end of the period
divided by revenues per day. |
|
(16) |
|
Gross patient revenues are based upon our standard charge
listing. Gross charges/revenues do not reflect what our hospital
facilities are paid. Gross charges/revenues are reduced by
contractual adjustments, discounts and charity care to determine
reported revenues. |
|
|
|
(17) |
|
Represents the percentage of patient revenues related to
patients who are not admitted to our hospitals. |
|
(18) |
|
We define working capital as current assets minus current
liabilities. |
13
RISK
FACTORS
An investment in our common stock involves risk. You should
carefully consider the following risks as well as the other
information included in this prospectus, including
Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations and our financial
statements and related notes, before investing in our common
stock. Any of the following risks could materially and adversely
affect our business, financial condition or results of
operations. However, the selected risks described below are not
the only risks facing us. Additional risks and uncertainties not
currently known to us or those we currently view to be
immaterial may also materially and adversely affect our
business, financial condition or results of operations. In such
a case, the trading price of the common stock could decline, and
you may lose all or part of your investment in our Company.
Risks
Related to Our Business
Our
hospitals face competition for patients from other hospitals and
health care providers.
The health care business is highly competitive, and competition
among hospitals and other health care providers for patients has
intensified in recent years. Generally, other hospitals in the
local communities we serve provide services similar to those
offered by our hospitals. In addition, the Centers for Medicare
& Medicaid Services (CMS) publicizes on its
Medicare website performance data related to quality measures
and data on patient satisfaction surveys hospitals submit in
connection with their Medicare reimbursement. Federal law
provides for the future expansion of the number of quality
measures that must be reported. Additional quality measures and
future trends toward clinical transparency may have an
unanticipated impact on our competitive position and patient
volumes. Further, the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act
as amended by the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act
of 2010 (collectively, the Health Reform Law)
requires all hospitals to annually establish, update and make
public a list of the hospitals standard charges for items
and services. If any of our hospitals achieve poor results (or
results that are lower than our competitors) on these quality
measures or on patient satisfaction surveys or if our standard
charges are higher than our competitors, our patient volumes
could decline.
In addition, the number of freestanding specialty hospitals,
surgery centers and diagnostic and imaging centers in the
geographic areas in which we operate has increased
significantly. As a result, most of our hospitals operate in a
highly competitive environment. Some of the facilities that
compete with our hospitals are owned by governmental agencies or
not-for-profit
corporations supported by endowments, charitable contributions
and/or tax
revenues and can finance capital expenditures and operations on
a tax-exempt basis. Our hospitals are facing increasing
competition from specialty hospitals, some of which are
physician-owned, and from both our own and unaffiliated
freestanding surgery centers for market share in high margin
services and for quality physicians and personnel. If ambulatory
surgery centers are better able to compete in this environment
than our hospitals, our hospitals may experience a decline in
patient volume, and we may experience a decrease in margin, even
if those patients use our ambulatory surgery centers. In states
that do not require a Certificate of Need (CON) for
the purchase, construction or expansion of health care
facilities or services, competition in the form of new services,
facilities and capital spending is more prevalent. Further, if
our competitors are better able to attract patients, recruit
physicians, expand services or obtain favorable managed care
contracts at their facilities than our hospitals and ambulatory
surgery centers, we may experience an overall decline in patient
volume. See Business Competition.
The
growth of uninsured and patient due accounts and a deterioration
in the collectibility of these accounts could adversely affect
our results of operations.
The primary collection risks of our accounts receivable relate
to the uninsured patient accounts and patient accounts for which
the primary insurance carrier has paid the amounts covered by
the applicable agreement, but patient responsibility amounts
(deductibles and copayments) remain outstanding. The provision
for doubtful accounts relates primarily to amounts due directly
from patients.
The amount of the provision for doubtful accounts is based upon
managements assessment of historical writeoffs and
expected net collections, business and economic conditions,
trends in federal and state
14
governmental and private employer health care coverage, the rate
of growth in uninsured patient admissions and other collection
indicators. At March 31, 2010, our allowance for doubtful
accounts represented approximately 94% of the
$4.833 billion patient due accounts receivable balance. The
sum of the provision for doubtful accounts, uninsured discounts
and charity care increased from $6.134 billion for 2007 to
$7.009 billion for 2008 and to $8.362 billion for 2009.
A continuation of the trends that have resulted in an increasing
proportion of accounts receivable being comprised of uninsured
accounts and a deterioration in the collectibility of these
accounts will adversely affect our collection of accounts
receivable, cash flows and results of operations. Prior to the
Health Reform Law being fully implemented, our facilities may
experience growth in bad debts, uninsured discounts and charity
care as a result of a number of factors, including the recent
economic downturn and increase in unemployment. The Health
Reform Law seeks to decrease over time the number of uninsured
individuals. Among other things, the Health Reform Law will,
effective January 1, 2014, expand Medicaid and incentivize
employers to offer, and require individuals to carry, health
insurance or be subject to penalties. However, it is difficult
to predict the full impact of the Health Reform Law due to the
laws complexity, lack of implementing regulations or
interpretive guidance, gradual implementation and possible
amendment, as well as our inability to foresee how individuals
and businesses will respond to the choices afforded them by the
law. In addition, even after implementation of the Health Reform
Law, we may continue to experience bad debts and have to provide
uninsured discounts and charity care for undocumented aliens who
are not permitted to enroll in a health insurance exchange or
government health care programs.
Changes
in governmental programs may reduce our revenues.
A significant portion of our patient volume is derived from
government health care programs, principally Medicare and
Medicaid. Specifically, we derived approximately 40% of our
revenues from the Medicare and Medicaid programs in 2009. In
recent years, legislative and regulatory changes have resulted
in limitations on and, in some cases, reductions in levels of
payments to health care providers for certain services under the
Medicare program. For example, CMS has recently completed a
two-year transition to full implementation of the Medicare
severity diagnosis-related group (MS-DRG) system,
which represents a refinement to the existing diagnosis-related
group system. Future realignments in the MS-DRG system could
impact the margins we receive for certain services. Further, the
Health Reform Law provides for material reductions in the growth
of Medicare program spending, including reductions in Medicare
market basket updates, and Medicare and Medicaid
disproportionate share hospital (DSH) funding.
Reductions to our reimbursement under the Medicare and Medicaid
programs by the Health Reform Law could adversely affect our
business and results of operations to the extent such reductions
are not offset by anticipated increases in revenues from
providing care to previously uninsured individuals.
Since most states must operate with balanced budgets and since
the Medicaid program is often a states largest program,
some states can be expected to enact or consider enacting
legislation designed to reduce their Medicaid expenditures. The
current economic downturn has increased the budgetary pressures
on many states, and these budgetary pressures have resulted, and
likely will continue to result, in decreased spending for
Medicaid programs and the Childrens Health Insurance
Program (CHIP) in many states. Further, many states
have also adopted, or are considering, legislation designed to
reduce coverage, enroll Medicaid recipients in managed care
programs
and/or
impose additional taxes on hospitals to help finance or expand
the states Medicaid systems. Effective March 23,
2010, the Health Reform Law requires states to at least maintain
Medicaid eligibility standards established prior to the
enactment of the law for adults until January 1, 2014 and
for children until October 1, 2019. However, states with
budget deficits may seek exceptions from this requirement to
address eligibility standards that apply to adults making more
than 133% of the federal poverty level. The Health Reform Law
also provides for significant expansions to the Medicaid
program, but these changes are not required until 2014. In
addition, the Health Reform Law will result in increased state
legislative and regulatory changes in order for states to comply
with new federal mandates, such as the requirement to establish
health insurance exchanges, and to participate in grants and
other incentive opportunities.
15
In some cases, commercial third-party payers rely on all or
portions of the MS-DRG system to determine payment rates, which
may result in decreased reimbursement from some commercial
third-party payers. Other changes to government health care
programs may negatively impact payments from commercial
third-party payers.
Current or future health care reform efforts, changes in laws or
regulations regarding government health programs, other changes
in the administration of government health programs and changes
to commercial third-party payers in response to health care
reform and other changes to government health programs could
have a material, adverse effect on our financial position and
results of operations.
We are
unable to predict the impact of the Health Reform Law, which
represents significant change to the health care
industry.
The Health Reform Law will change how health care services are
covered, delivered, and reimbursed through expanded coverage of
uninsured individuals, reduced growth in Medicare program
spending, reductions in Medicare and Medicaid DSH payments and
the establishment of programs where reimbursement is tied to
quality and integration. In addition, the new law reforms
certain aspects of health insurance, expands existing efforts to
tie Medicare and Medicaid payments to performance and quality,
and contains provisions intended to strengthen fraud and abuse
enforcement.
The expansion of health insurance coverage under the Health
Reform Law may result in a material increase in the number of
patients using our facilities who have either private or public
program coverage. In addition, a disproportionately large
percentage of the new Medicaid coverage is likely to be in
states that currently have relatively low income eligibility
requirements. Two such states are Texas and Florida, where about
one-half of the Companys licensed beds are located. The
Company also has a significant presence in other relatively low
income eligibility states, including Georgia, Kansas, Louisiana,
Missouri, Oklahoma and Virginia. Further, the Health Reform Law
provides for a value-based purchasing program, the establishment
of Accountable Care Organizations (ACOs) and bundled
payment pilot programs, which will create possible sources of
additional revenue.
However, it is difficult to predict the size of the potential
revenue gains to the Company as a result of these elements of
the Health Reform Law, because of uncertainty surrounding a
number of material factors, including the following:
|
|
|
|
|
how many previously uninsured individuals will obtain coverage
as a result of the Health Reform Law (while the Congressional
Budget Office (CBO) estimates 32 million, CMS
estimates almost 34 million; both agencies made a number of
assumptions to derive that figure, including how many
individuals will ignore substantial subsidies and decide to pay
the penalty rather than obtain health insurance and what
percentage of people in the future will meet the new Medicaid
income eligibility requirements);
|
|
|
|
what percentage of the newly insured patients will be covered
under the Medicaid program and what percentage will be covered
by private health insurers;
|
|
|
|
the extent to which states will enroll new Medicaid participants
in managed care programs;
|
|
|
|
the pace at which insurance coverage expands, including the pace
of different types of coverage expansion;
|
|
|
|
the change, if any, in the volume of inpatient and outpatient
hospital services that are sought by and provided to previously
uninsured individuals;
|
|
|
|
the rate paid to hospitals by private payers for newly covered
individuals, including those covered through the newly created
American Health Benefit Exchanges (Exchanges) and
those who might be covered under the Medicaid program under
contracts with the state;
|
|
|
|
the rate paid by state governments under the Medicaid program
for newly covered individuals;
|
|
|
|
how the value-based purchasing and other quality programs will
be implemented;
|
16
|
|
|
|
|
the percentage of individuals in the Exchanges who select the
high deductible plans, since health insurers offering those
kinds of products have traditionally sought to pay lower rates
to hospitals;
|
|
|
|
whether the net effect of the Health Reform Law, including the
prohibition on excluding individuals based on pre-existing
conditions, the requirement to keep medical costs lower than a
specified percentage of premium revenue, other health insurance
reforms and the annual fee applied to all health insurers, will
be to put pressure on the bottom line of health insurers, which
in turn might cause them to seek to reduce payments to hospitals
with respect to both newly insured individuals and their
existing business; and
|
|
|
|
the possibility that implementation of provisions expanding
health insurance coverage will be delayed or even blocked due to
court challenges or revised or eliminated as a result of efforts
to repeal or amend the new law.
|
On the other hand, the Health Reform Law provides for
significant reductions in the growth of Medicare spending,
reductions in Medicare and Medicaid DSH payments and the
establishment of programs where reimbursement is tied to quality
and integration. Since approximately 40% of our revenues in 2009
were from Medicare and Medicaid, reductions to these programs
may significantly impact the Company and could offset any
positive effects of the Health Reform Law. It is difficult to
predict the size of the revenue reductions to Medicare and
Medicaid spending, because of uncertainty regarding a number of
material factors, including the following:
|
|
|
|
|
the amount of overall revenues the Company will generate from
Medicare and Medicaid business when the reductions are
implemented;
|
|
|
|
whether reductions required by the Health Reform Law will be
changed by statute prior to becoming effective;
|
|
|
|
the size of the Health Reform Laws annual productivity
adjustment to the market basket beginning in 2012 payment years;
|
|
|
|
the amount of the Medicare DSH reductions that will be made,
commencing in federal fiscal year 2014;
|
|
|
|
the allocation to our hospitals of the Medicaid DSH reductions,
commencing in federal fiscal year 2014;
|
|
|
|
what the losses in revenues will be, if any, from the Health
Reform Laws quality initiatives;
|
|
|
|
how successful ACOs, in which we participate, will be at
coordinating care and reducing costs;
|
|
|
|
the scope and nature of potential changes to Medicare
reimbursement methods, such as an emphasis on bundling payments
or coordination of care programs;
|
|
|
|
whether the Companys revenues from upper payment limit
(UPL) programs will be adversely affected, because
there may be fewer indigent, non-Medicaid patients for whom the
Company provides services pursuant to UPL programs; and
|
|
|
|
reductions to Medicare payments CMS may impose for
excessive readmissions.
|
Because of the many variables involved, we are unable to predict
the net effect on the Company of the expected increases in
insured individuals using our facilities, the reductions in
Medicare spending, reductions in Medicare and Medicaid DSH
funding, and numerous other provisions in the Health Reform Law
that may affect the Company.
If we
are unable to retain and negotiate favorable contracts with
nongovernment payers, including managed care plans, our revenues
may be reduced.
Our ability to obtain favorable contracts with nongovernment
payers, including health maintenance organizations, preferred
provider organizations and other managed care plans
significantly affects the revenues and operating results of our
facilities. Revenues derived from these entities and other
insurers accounted for
17
53%, 52% and 53% of our patient revenues for the quarter ended
March 31, 2010 and the years ended December 31, 2009
and December 31, 2008, respectively. Nongovernment payers,
including managed care payers, continue to demand discounted fee
structures, and the trend toward consolidation among
nongovernment payers tends to increase their bargaining power
over fee structures. As various provisions of the Health Reform
Law are implemented, including the establishment of the
Exchanges, nongovernment payers increasingly may demand reduced
fees. Our future success will depend, in part, on our ability to
retain and renew our managed care contracts and enter into new
managed care contracts on terms favorable to us. Other health
care providers may impact our ability to enter into managed care
contracts or negotiate increases in our reimbursement and other
favorable terms and conditions. For example, some of our
competitors may negotiate exclusivity provisions with managed
care plans or otherwise restrict the ability of managed care
companies to contract with us. It is not clear what impact, if
any, the increased obligations on managed care payers and other
payers imposed by the Health Reform Law will have on our ability
to negotiate reimbursement increases. If we are unable to retain
and negotiate favorable contracts with managed care plans or
experience reductions in payment increases or amounts received
from nongovernment payers, our revenues may be reduced.
Our
performance depends on our ability to recruit and retain quality
physicians.
The success of our hospitals depends in part on the number and
quality of the physicians on the medical staffs of our
hospitals, the admitting practices of those physicians and
maintaining good relations with those physicians. Although we
employ some physicians, physicians are often not employees of
the hospitals at which they practice and, in many of the markets
we serve, most physicians have admitting privileges at other
hospitals in addition to our hospitals. Such physicians may
terminate their affiliation with our hospitals at any time. If
we are unable to provide adequate support personnel or
technologically advanced equipment and hospital facilities that
meet the needs of those physicians and their patients, they may
be discouraged from referring patients to our facilities,
admissions may decrease and our operating performance may
decline.
Our
hospitals face competition for staffing, which may increase
labor costs and reduce profitability.
Our operations are dependent on the efforts, abilities and
experience of our management and medical support personnel, such
as nurses, pharmacists and lab technicians, as well as our
physicians. We compete with other health care providers in
recruiting and retaining qualified management and support
personnel responsible for the daily operations of each of our
hospitals, including nurses and other nonphysician health care
professionals. In some markets, the availability of nurses and
other medical support personnel has been a significant operating
issue to health care providers. We may be required to continue
to enhance wages and benefits to recruit and retain nurses and
other medical support personnel or to hire more expensive
temporary or contract personnel. As a result, our labor costs
could increase. We also depend on the available labor pool of
semi-skilled and unskilled employees in each of the markets in
which we operate. Certain proposed changes in federal labor
laws, including the Employee Free Choice Act, could increase the
likelihood of employee unionization attempts. To the extent a
significant portion of our employee base unionizes, it is
possible our labor costs could increase materially. In addition,
the states in which we operate could adopt mandatory
nurse-staffing ratios or could reduce mandatory nurse staffing
ratios already in place. State-mandated nurse-staffing ratios
could significantly affect labor costs and have an adverse
impact on revenues if we are required to limit admissions in
order to meet the required ratios. If our labor costs increase,
we may not be able to raise rates to offset these increased
costs. Because a significant percentage of our revenues consists
of fixed, prospective payments, our ability to pass along
increased labor costs is constrained. Our failure to recruit and
retain qualified management, nurses and other medical support
personnel, or to control labor costs, could have a material,
adverse effect on our results of operations.
If we
fail to comply with extensive laws and government regulations,
we could suffer penalties or be required to make significant
changes to our operations.
The health care industry is required to comply with extensive
and complex laws and regulations at the federal, state and local
government levels relating to, among other things:
|
|
|
|
|
billing and coding for services and properly handling
overpayments;
|
18
|
|
|
|
|
relationships with physicians and other referral sources;
|
|
|
|
adequacy of medical care;
|
|
|
|
quality of medical equipment and services;
|
|
|
|
qualifications of medical and support personnel;
|
|
|
|
confidentiality, maintenance, data breach, identity theft and
security issues associated with health-related and personal
information and medical records;
|
|
|
|
the screening, stabilization and transfer of individuals who
have emergency medical conditions;
|
|
|
|
licensure and certification;
|
|
|
|
hospital rate or budget review;
|
|
|
|
preparing and filing of cost reports;
|
|
|
|
operating policies and procedures;
|
|
|
|
activities regarding competitors; and
|
|
|
|
addition of facilities and services.
|
Among these laws are the federal Anti-kickback Statute, the
federal physician self-referral law (commonly called the Stark
Law), the federal False Claims Act (FCA) and similar
state laws. We have a variety of financial relationships with
physicians and others who either refer or influence the referral
of patients to our hospitals and other health care facilities,
and these laws govern those relationships. The Office of
Inspector General of the Department of Health and Human Services
(OIG) has enacted safe harbor regulations that
outline practices deemed protected from prosecution under the
Anti-kickback Statute. While we endeavor to comply with the
applicable safe harbors, certain of our current arrangements,
including joint ventures and financial relationships with
physicians and other referral sources and persons and entities
to which we refer patients, do not qualify for safe harbor
protection. Failure to qualify for a safe harbor does not mean
the arrangement necessarily violates the Anti-kickback Statute,
but may subject the arrangement to greater scrutiny. However, we
cannot offer assurance that practices outside of a safe harbor
will not be found to violate the Anti-kickback Statute.
Allegations of violations of the Anti-kickback Statute may be
brought under the federal Civil Monetary Penalty Law, which
requires a lower burden of proof than other fraud and abuse
laws, including the Anti-kickback Statute.
Our financial relationships with referring physicians and their
immediate family members must comply with the Stark Law by
meeting an exception. We attempt to structure our relationships
to meet an exception to the Stark Law, but the regulations
implementing the exceptions are detailed and complex, and we
cannot provide assurance every relationship complies fully with
the Stark Law. Unlike the Anti-kickback Statute, failure to meet
an exception under the Stark Law results in a violation of the
Stark Law, even if such violation is technical in nature.
Additionally, if we violate the Anti-kickback Statute or Stark
Law, or if we improperly bill for our services, we may be found
to violate the FCA, either under a suit brought by the
government or by a private person under a qui tam, or
whistleblower, suit.
If we fail to comply with the Anti-kickback Statute, the Stark
Law, the FCA or other applicable laws and regulations, we could
be subjected to liabilities, including civil penalties
(including the loss of our licenses to operate one or more
facilities), exclusion of one or more facilities from
participation in the Medicare, Medicaid and other federal and
state health care programs and, for violations of certain laws
and regulations, criminal penalties. See Regulation and
Other Factors.
CMS published a proposal to collect information from 400
hospitals regarding their ownership, investment and compensation
arrangements with physicians. Called the Disclosure of Financial
Relationships Report (or DFRR), CMS intends to
use this data to monitor compliance with the Stark Law, and CMS
may share this information with other government agencies. Many
of these agencies have not previously analyzed this
19
information and have the authority to bring enforcement actions
against hospitals filing such reports. The DFRR and its
supporting documentation are currently under review by the
Office of Management and Budget, and it is unclear when, or if,
it will be finalized.
Because many of these laws and their implementing regulations
are relatively new, we do not always have the benefit of
significant regulatory or judicial interpretation of these laws
and regulations. In the future, different interpretations or
enforcement of these laws and regulations could subject our
current or past practices to allegations of impropriety or
illegality or could require us to make changes in our
facilities, equipment, personnel, services, capital expenditure
programs and operating expenses. A determination we have
violated these laws, or the public announcement that we are
being investigated for possible violations of these laws, could
have a material, adverse effect on our business, financial
condition, results of operations or prospects, and our business
reputation could suffer significantly. In addition, other
legislation or regulations at the federal or state level may be
adopted that adversely affect our business.
We
have been and could become the subject of governmental
investigations, claims and litigation.
Health care companies are subject to numerous investigations by
various governmental agencies. Further, under the FCA, private
parties have the right to bring qui tam, or
whistleblower, suits against companies that submit
false claims for payments to, or improperly retain overpayments
from, the government. Some states have adopted similar state
whistleblower and false claims provisions. Certain of our
individual facilities have received, and other facilities may
receive, government inquiries from federal and state agencies.
Depending on whether the underlying conduct in these or future
inquiries or investigations could be considered systemic, their
resolution could have a material, adverse effect on our
financial position, results of operations and liquidity.
Governmental agencies and their agents, such as the Medicare
Administrative Contractors, fiscal intermediaries and carriers,
as well as the OIG, CMS and state Medicaid programs, conduct
audits of our health care operations. Private payers may conduct
similar post-payment audits, and we also perform internal audits
and monitoring. Depending on the nature of the conduct found in
such audits and whether the underlying conduct could be
considered systemic, the resolution of these audits could have a
material, adverse effect on our financial position, results of
operations and liquidity.
As required by statute, CMS is in the process of implementing
the Recovery Audit Contractor (RAC) program on a
nationwide basis. Under the program, CMS contracts with RACs to
conduct post-payment reviews to detect and correct improper
payments in the
fee-for-service
Medicare program. The Health Reform Law expands the RAC
programs scope to include managed Medicare plans and to
include Medicaid claims by requiring all states to enter into
contracts with RACs by December 31, 2010. In addition, CMS
employs Medicaid Integrity Contractors (MICs) to
perform post-payment audits of Medicaid claims and identify
overpayments. Throughout 2010, MIC audits will continue to
expand. The Health Reform Law increases federal funding for the
MIC program for federal fiscal year 2011 and later years. In
addition to RACs and MICs, several other contractors, including
the state Medicaid agencies, have increased their review
activities.
Should we be found out of compliance with any of these laws,
regulations or programs, depending on the nature of the
findings, our business, our financial position and our results
of operations could be negatively impacted.
Controls
designed to reduce inpatient services may reduce our
revenues.
Controls imposed by Medicare, managed Medicare, Medicaid,
managed Medicaid and commercial third-party payers designed to
reduce admissions and lengths of stay, commonly referred to as
utilization review, have affected and are expected
to continue to affect our facilities. Utilization review entails
the review of the admission and course of treatment of a patient
by health plans. Inpatient utilization, average lengths of stay
and occupancy rates continue to be negatively affected by
payer-required preadmission authorization and utilization review
and by payer pressure to maximize outpatient and alternative
health care delivery services for less acutely ill patients.
Efforts to impose more stringent cost controls are expected to
continue. For example, the Health Reform Law potentially expands
the use of prepayment review by Medicare contractors
20
by eliminating statutory restrictions on their use. Although we
are unable to predict the effect these changes will have on our
operations, significant limits on the scope of services
reimbursed and on reimbursement rates and fees could have a
material, adverse effect on our business, financial position and
results of operations.
Our
overall business results may suffer from the recent economic
downturn.
During periods of high unemployment, governmental entities often
experience budget deficits as a result of increased costs and
lower than expected tax collections. These budget deficits at
federal, state and local government entities have decreased, and
may continue to decrease, spending for health and human service
programs, including Medicare, Medicaid and similar programs,
which represent significant payer sources for our hospitals.
Other risks we face during periods of high unemployment include
potential declines in the population covered under managed care
agreements, patient decisions to postpone or cancel elective and
non-emergency health care procedures, potential increases in the
uninsured and underinsured populations and further difficulties
in our collecting patient co-payment and deductible receivables.
The
industry trend towards value-based purchasing may negatively
impact our revenues.
There is a trend in the health care industry toward value-based
purchasing of health care services. These value-based purchasing
programs include both public reporting of quality data and
preventable adverse events tied to the quality and efficiency of
care provided by facilities. Governmental programs including
Medicare and Medicaid currently require hospitals to report
certain quality data to receive full reimbursement updates. In
addition, Medicare does not reimburse for care related to
certain preventable adverse events (also called never
events). Many large commercial payers currently require
hospitals to report quality data, and several commercial payers
do not reimburse hospitals for certain preventable adverse
events. Further, we have implemented a policy pursuant to which
we do not bill patients or third-party payers for fees or
expenses incurred due to certain preventable adverse events.
The Health Reform Law contains a number of provisions intended
to promote value-based purchasing. Effective July 1, 2011,
the Health Reform Law will prohibit the use of federal funds
under the Medicaid program to reimburse providers for medical
assistance provided to treat hospital acquired conditions
(HACs). Beginning in federal fiscal year 2015,
hospitals that fall into the top 25% of national risk-adjusted
HAC rates for all hospitals in the previous year will receive a
1% reduction in their total Medicare payments. Hospitals with
excessive readmissions for conditions designated by the
Department of Health and Human Services (HHS) will
receive reduced payments for all inpatient discharges, not just
discharges relating to the conditions subject to the excessive
readmission standard.
The Health Reform Law also requires HHS to implement a
value-based purchasing program for inpatient hospital services.
Beginning in federal fiscal year 2013, HHS will reduce inpatient
hospital payments for all discharges by a percentage specified
by statute ranging from 1% to 2% and pool the total amount
collected from these reductions to fund payments to reward
hospitals that meet or exceed certain quality performance
standards established by HHS. HHS will determine the amount each
hospital that meets or exceeds the quality performance standards
will receive from the pool of dollars created by these payment
reductions.
We expect value-based purchasing programs, including programs
that condition reimbursement on patient outcome measures, to
become more common and to involve a higher percentage of
reimbursement amounts. We are unable at this time to predict how
this trend will affect our results of operations, but it could
negatively impact our revenues.
Our
operations could be impaired by a failure of our information
systems.
Any system failure that causes an interruption in service or
availability of our systems could adversely affect operations or
delay the collection of revenues. Even though we have
implemented network security measures, our servers are
vulnerable to computer viruses, break-ins and similar
disruptions from unauthorized tampering. The occurrence of any
of these events could result in interruptions, delays, the loss
or corruption of data, cessations in the availability of systems
or liability under privacy and security laws, all of which could
21
have a material adverse effect on our financial position and
results of operations and harm our business reputation.
The performance of our information technology and systems is
critical to our business operations. In addition to our shared
services initiatives, our information systems are essential to a
number of critical areas of our operations, including:
|
|
|
|
|
accounting and financial reporting;
|
|
|
|
billing and collecting accounts;
|
|
|
|
coding and compliance;
|
|
|
|
clinical systems;
|
|
|
|
medical records and document storage;
|
|
|
|
inventory management;
|
|
|
|
negotiating, pricing and administering managed care contracts
and supply contracts; and
|
|
|
|
monitoring quality of care and collecting data on quality
measures necessary for full Medicare payment updates.
|
If we
fail to effectively and timely implement electronic health
record systems, our operations could be adversely
affected.
As required by the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of
2009, HHS is in the process of developing and implementing an
incentive payment program for eligible hospitals and health care
professionals that adopt and meaningfully use certified
electronic health record (EHR) technology. If our
hospitals and employed professionals are unable to meet the
requirements for participation in the incentive payment program,
we will not be eligible to receive incentive payments that could
offset some of the costs of implementing EHR systems. Further,
beginning in 2015, eligible hospitals and professionals that
fail to demonstrate meaningful use of certified EHR technology
will be subject to reduced payments from Medicare. Failure to
implement EHR systems effectively and in a timely manner could
have a material, adverse effect on our financial position and
results of operations.
State
efforts to regulate the construction or expansion of health care
facilities could impair our ability to operate and expand our
operations.
Some states, particularly in the eastern part of the country,
require health care providers to obtain prior approval, known as
a CON, for the purchase, construction or expansion of health
care facilities, to make certain capital expenditures or to make
changes in services or bed capacity. In giving approval, these
states consider the need for additional or expanded health care
facilities or services. We currently operate health care
facilities in a number of states with CON laws. The failure to
obtain any requested CON could impair our ability to operate or
expand operations. Any such failure could, in turn, adversely
affect our ability to attract patients to our facilities and
grow our revenues, which would have an adverse effect on our
results of operations.
Our
facilities are heavily concentrated in Florida and Texas, which
makes us sensitive to regulatory, economic, environmental and
competitive conditions and changes in those
states.
We operated 162 hospitals at March 31, 2010, and 73 of
those hospitals are located in Florida and Texas. Our Florida
and Texas facilities combined revenues represented
approximately 52% and 51%, respectively, of our consolidated
revenues for the quarter ended March 31, 2010 and year
ended December 31, 2009. This concentration makes us
particularly sensitive to regulatory, economic, environmental
and competitive conditions and changes in those states. Any
material change in the current payment programs or regulatory,
economic, environmental or competitive conditions in those
states could have a disproportionate effect on our overall
business results.
22
In addition, our hospitals in Florida and Texas and other areas
across the Gulf Coast are located in hurricane-prone areas. In
the recent past, hurricanes have had a disruptive effect on the
operations of our hospitals in Florida, Texas and other coastal
states, and the patient populations in those states. Our
business activities could be harmed by a particularly active
hurricane season or even a single storm, and the property
insurance we obtain may not be adequate to cover losses from
future hurricanes or other natural disasters.
We may
be subject to liabilities from claims by the Internal Revenue
Service.
At March 31, 2010, we were contesting before the Appeals
Division of the Internal Revenue Service (IRS)
certain claimed deficiencies and adjustments proposed by the IRS
in connection with its examination of the 2003 and 2004 federal
income tax returns for HCA and eight affiliates that are treated
as partnerships for federal income tax purposes
(affiliated partnerships). The disputed items
include the timing of recognition of certain patient service
revenues and our method for calculating the tax allowance for
doubtful accounts.
Six taxable periods of HCA and its predecessors ended in 1997
through 2002 and the 2002 taxable year of four affiliated
partnerships, for which the primary remaining issue is the
computation of the tax allowance for doubtful accounts, are
pending before the IRS Examination Division as of March 31,
2010.
The IRS completed its audit of HCAs 2005 and 2006 federal
income tax returns in April 2010. We will contest certain
claimed deficiencies and adjustments proposed by the IRS
Examination Division in connection with this audit, including
the timing of recognition of certain patient service revenues,
before the IRS Appeals Division. We anticipate the IRS will
begin an audit of the 2007, 2008 and 2009 federal income tax
returns for HCA and one or more affiliated partnerships during
2010.
Management believes HCA, its predecessors and affiliates
properly reported taxable income and paid taxes in accordance
with applicable laws and agreements established with the IRS and
final resolution of these disputes will not have a material,
adverse effect on our results of operations or financial
position. However, if payments due upon final resolution of
these issues exceed our recorded estimates, such resolutions
could have a material, adverse effect on our results of
operations or financial position.
We may
be subject to liabilities from claims brought against our
facilities.
We are subject to litigation relating to our business practices,
including claims and legal actions by patients and others in the
ordinary course of business alleging malpractice, product
liability or other legal theories. See
Business Legal Proceedings. Many of
these actions involve large claims and significant defense
costs. We insure a portion of our professional liability risks
through a wholly-owned subsidiary. Management believes our
reserves for self-insured retentions and insurance coverage are
sufficient to cover insured claims arising out of the operation
of our facilities. Our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary has
entered into certain reinsurance contracts, and the obligations
covered by the reinsurance contracts are included in its
reserves for professional liability risks, as the subsidiary
remains liable to the extent that the reinsurers do not meet
their obligations under the reinsurance contracts. If payments
for claims exceed actuarially determined estimates, are not
covered by insurance, or reinsurers, if any, fail to meet their
obligations, our results of operations and financial position
could be adversely affected.
We are
exposed to market risks related to changes in the market values
of securities and interest rate changes.
We are exposed to market risk related to changes in market
values of securities. The investments in debt and equity
securities of our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary were
$1.296 billion and $7 million, respectively, at
March 31, 2010. These investments are carried at fair
value, with changes in unrealized gains and losses being
recorded as adjustments to other comprehensive income. At
March 31, 2010, we had a net unrealized gain of
$22 million on the insurance subsidiarys investment
securities.
We are exposed to market risk related to market illiquidity.
Liquidity of the investments in debt and equity securities of
our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary could be impaired by the
inability to access the
23
capital markets. Should the wholly-owned insurance subsidiary
require significant amounts of cash in excess of normal cash
requirements to pay claims and other expenses on short notice,
we may have difficulty selling these investments in a timely
manner or be forced to sell them at a price less than what we
might otherwise have been able to in a normal market
environment. At March 31, 2010, our wholly-owned insurance
subsidiary had invested $333 million ($336 million par
value) in municipal, tax-exempt student loan auction rate
securities (ARS). Since February 2008, when multiple
failed auctions occurred due to a severe credit and liquidity
crisis in the capital markets, the ARS have experienced market
illiquidity. It is uncertain if auction-related market liquidity
will resume for these securities. We may be required to
recognize
other-than-temporary
impairments on these investments in future periods should
issuers default on interest payments or should the fair market
valuations of the securities deteriorate due to ratings
downgrades or other issue specific factors.
We are also exposed to market risk related to changes in
interest rates, and we periodically enter into interest rate
swap agreements to manage our exposure to these fluctuations.
Our interest rate swap agreements involve the exchange of fixed
and variable rate interest payments between two parties, based
on common notional principal amounts and maturity dates. The net
notional amounts of the swap agreements represent balances used
to calculate the exchange of cash flows and are not our assets
or liabilities. See Managements Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations Market Risk.
Risks
Related to Our Indebtedness
Our
substantial leverage could adversely affect our ability to raise
additional capital to fund our operations, limit our ability to
react to changes in the economy or our industry, expose us to
interest rate risk to the extent of our variable rate debt and
prevent us from meeting our obligations.
We are highly leveraged. As of March 31, 2010, our total
indebtedness is $26.855 billion. Our high degree of
leverage could have important consequences, including:
|
|
|
|
|
increasing our vulnerability to downturns or adverse changes in
general economic, industry or competitive conditions and adverse
changes in government regulations;
|
|
|
|
requiring a substantial portion of cash flow from operations to
be dedicated to the payment of principal and interest on our
indebtedness, therefore reducing our ability to use our cash
flow to fund our operations, capital expenditures and future
business opportunities;
|
|
|
|
exposing us to the risk of increased interest rates as certain
of our unhedged borrowings are at variable rates of interest;
|
|
|
|
limiting our ability to make strategic acquisitions or causing
us to make nonstrategic divestitures;
|
|
|
|
limiting our ability to obtain additional financing for working
capital, capital expenditures, product or service line
development, debt service requirements, acquisitions and general
corporate or other purposes; and
|
|
|
|
limiting our ability to adjust to changing market conditions and
placing us at a competitive disadvantage compared to our
competitors who are less highly leveraged.
|
We and our subsidiaries have the ability to incur additional
indebtedness in the future, subject to the restrictions
contained in our senior secured credit facilities and the
indentures governing our outstanding notes. If new indebtedness
is added to our current debt levels, the related risks that we
now face could intensify.
We may
not be able to generate sufficient cash to service all of our
indebtedness and may not be able to refinance our indebtedness
on favorable terms. If we are unable to do so, we may be forced
to take other actions to satisfy our obligations under our
indebtedness, which may not be successful.
Our ability to make scheduled payments on or to refinance our
debt obligations depends on our financial condition and
operating performance, which are subject to prevailing economic
and competitive conditions and to certain financial, business
and other factors beyond our control. We cannot assure you we
will maintain a
24
level of cash flows from operating activities sufficient to
permit us to pay the principal, premium, if any, and interest on
our indebtedness.
As of March 31, 2010, our substantial indebtedness included
$9.648 billion of indebtedness under our senior secured
credit facilities maturing in 2012 and 2013, $4.150 billion
aggregate principal amount of first lien notes maturing in 2019
and 2020, $6.088 billion aggregate principal amount of
second lien notes maturing in 2014, 2016 and 2017 and
$6.723 billion aggregate principal amount of unsecured
senior notes and debentures that mature on various dates from
2010 to 2095 (including $5.321 billion maturing through
2016). Because a significant portion of our indebtedness matures
in the next few years, we may find it necessary or prudent to
refinance that indebtedness with longer-maturity debt at a
higher interest rate. In February, April and August of 2009 and
in March of 2010, for example, we issued $310 million in
aggregate principal amount of
97/8%
second lien notes due 2017, $1.500 billion in aggregate
principal amount of
81/2%
first lien notes due 2019, $1.250 billion in aggregate
principal amount of
77/8%
first lien notes due 2020 and $1.400 billion in aggregate
principal amount of
71/4%
first lien notes due 2020, respectively. We used the net
proceeds of those offerings to prepay term loans under our cash
flow credit facility, which currently bears interest at a lower
floating rate. Our ability to refinance our indebtedness on
favorable terms, or at all, is directly affected by the current
global economic and financial conditions. In addition, our
ability to incur secured indebtedness (which would generally
enable us to achieve better pricing than the incurrence of
unsecured indebtedness) depends in part on the value of our
assets, which depends, in turn, on the strength of our cash
flows and results of operations, and on economic and market
conditions and other factors.
If our cash flows and capital resources are insufficient to fund
our debt service obligations or we are unable to refinance our
indebtedness, we may be forced to reduce or delay investments
and capital expenditures, or to sell assets, seek additional
capital or restructure our indebtedness. These alternative
measures may not be successful and may not permit us to meet our
scheduled debt service obligations. If our operating results and
available cash are insufficient to meet our debt service
obligations, we could face substantial liquidity problems and
might be required to dispose of material assets or operations to
meet our debt service and other obligations. We may not be able
to consummate those dispositions, or the proceeds from the
dispositions may not be adequate to meet any debt service
obligations then due.
Our
debt agreements contain restrictions that limit our flexibility
in operating our business.
Our senior secured credit facilities and the indentures
governing our outstanding notes contain various covenants that
limit our ability to engage in specified types of transactions.
These covenants limit our and certain of our subsidiaries
ability to, among other things:
|
|
|
|
|
incur additional indebtedness or issue certain preferred shares;
|
|
|
|
pay dividends on, repurchase or make distributions in respect of
our capital stock or make other restricted payments;
|
|
|
|
make certain investments;
|
|
|
|
sell or transfer assets;
|
|
|
|
create liens;
|
|
|
|
consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or
substantially all of our assets; and
|
|
|
|
enter into certain transactions with our affiliates.
|
Under our asset-based revolving credit facility, when (and for
as long as) the combined availability under our asset-based
revolving credit facility and our senior secured revolving
credit facility is less than a specified amount for a certain
period of time or, if a payment or bankruptcy event of default
has occurred and is continuing, funds deposited into any of our
depository accounts will be transferred on a daily basis into a
blocked account with the administrative agent and applied to
prepay loans under the asset-based revolving credit facility and
to cash collateralize letters of credit issued thereunder.
25
Under our senior secured credit facilities, we are required to
satisfy and maintain specified financial ratios. Our ability to
meet those financial ratios can be affected by events beyond our
control, and there can be no assurance we will continue to meet
those ratios. A breach of any of these covenants could result in
a default under both our cash flow credit facility and our
asset-based revolving credit facility. Upon the occurrence of an
event of default under our senior secured credit facilities, our
lenders could elect to declare all amounts outstanding under our
senior secured credit facilities to be immediately due and
payable and terminate all commitments to extend further credit.
If we were unable to repay those amounts, the lenders under our
senior secured credit facilities could proceed against the
collateral granted to them to secure such indebtedness. We have
pledged a significant portion of our assets as collateral under
our senior secured credit facilities, and that collateral (other
than certain European collateral securing our senior secured
European term loan facility) is also pledged as collateral under
our first lien notes. If any of the lenders under our senior
secured credit facilities accelerate the repayment of
borrowings, there can be no assurance we will have sufficient
assets to repay our senior secured credit facilities and the
first lien notes.
Risks
Related to this Offering and Ownership of Our Common
Stock
An
active, liquid trading market for our common stock may not
develop.
After our Recapitalization and prior to this offering, there has
not been a public market for our common stock. We cannot predict
the extent to which investor interest in our company will lead
to the development of a trading market on the New York Stock
Exchange or otherwise or how active and liquid that market may
become. If an active and liquid trading market does not develop,
you may have difficulty selling any of our common stock that you
purchase. The initial public offering price for the shares will
be determined by negotiations between us and the underwriters
and may not be indicative of prices that will prevail in the
open market following this offering. The market price of our
common stock may decline below the initial offering price, and
you may not be able to sell your shares of our common stock at
or above the price you paid in this offering, or at all.
You
will incur immediate and substantial dilution in the net
tangible book value of the shares you purchase in this
offering.
Prior investors have paid substantially less per share of our
common stock than the price in this offering. The initial public
offering price of our common stock is substantially higher than
the net tangible book value per share of outstanding common
stock prior to completion of the offering. Based on our net
tangible book value as of March 31, 2010 and upon the
issuance and sale
of shares
of common stock by us at an assumed initial public offering
price of $ per share (the midpoint
of the initial public offering price range indicated on the
cover of this prospectus), if you purchase our common stock in
this offering, you will pay more for your shares than the
amounts paid by our existing stockholders for their shares and
you will suffer immediate dilution of approximately
$ per share in net tangible book
value. We also have a large number of outstanding stock options
to purchase common stock with exercise prices that are below the
estimated initial public offering price of our common stock. To
the extent that these options are exercised, you will experience
further dilution. See Dilution.
Our
stock price may change significantly following the offering, and
you could lose all or part of your investment as a
result.
We and the underwriters will negotiate to determine the initial
public offering price. You may not be able to resell your shares
at or above the initial public offering price due to a number of
factors such as those listed in Risks Related
to Our Business and the following, some of which are
beyond our control:
|
|
|
|
|
quarterly variations in our results of operations;
|
|
|
|
results of operations that vary from the expectations of
securities analysts and investors;
|
|
|
|
results of operations that vary from those of our competitors;
|
|
|
|
changes in expectations as to our future financial performance,
including financial estimates by securities analysts and
investors;
|
26
|
|
|
|
|
announcements by us, our competitors or our vendors of
significant contracts, acquisitions, joint marketing
relationships, joint ventures or capital commitments;
|
|
|
|
announcements by third parties or governmental entities of
significant claims or proceedings against us;
|
|
|
|
new laws and governmental regulations applicable to the health
care industry, including the Health Reform Law;
|
|
|
|
a default under the agreements governing our indebtedness;
|
|
|
|
future sales of our common stock by us, directors, executives
and significant stockholders; and
|
|
|
|
changes in domestic and international economic and political
conditions and regionally in our markets.
|
Furthermore, the stock market has recently experienced extreme
volatility that, in some cases, has been unrelated or
disproportionate to the operating performance of particular
companies. These broad market and industry fluctuations may
adversely affect the market price of our common stock,
regardless of our actual operating performance.
In the past, following periods of market volatility,
stockholders have instituted securities class action litigation.
If we were involved in securities litigation, it could have a
substantial cost and divert resources and the attention of
executive management from our business regardless of the outcome
of such litigation.
If we
or our existing investors sell additional shares of our common
stock after this offering, the market price of our common stock
could decline.
The market price of our common stock could decline as a result
of sales of a large number of shares of common stock in the
market after this offering, or the perception that such sales
could occur. These sales, or the possibility that these sales
may occur, also might make it more difficult for us to sell
equity securities in the future at a time and at a price that we
deem appropriate. After the completion of this offering, we will
have million shares of common
stock outstanding ( million
shares if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase
additional shares in full). This number
includes million shares that
are being sold in this offering, which may be resold immediately
in the public market.
We and the selling stockholders, our executive officers and
directors and the Investors have agreed not to sell or transfer
any common stock or securities convertible into, exchangeable
for, exercisable for, or repayable with common stock, for
180 days after the date of this prospectus without first
obtaining the written consent of two of the representatives. In
addition, pursuant to stockholders agreements, we have granted
certain members of our management and other stockholders the
right to cause us, in certain instances, at our expense, to file
registration statements under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended (the Securities Act) covering resales of our
common stock held by them. These shares will represent
approximately % of our outstanding
common stock after this offering,
or % if the underwriters exercise
their option to purchase additional shares in full. These shares
also may be sold pursuant to Rule 144 under the Securities
Act, depending on their holding period and subject to
restrictions in the case of shares held by persons deemed to be
our affiliates. As restrictions on resale end or if these
stockholders exercise their registration rights, the market
price of our stock could decline if the holders of restricted
shares sell them or are perceived by the market as intending to
sell them. See Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions Stockholder Agreements
Management Stockholders Agreement, Certain
Relationships and Related Party Transactions
Registration Rights Agreement, Shares Eligible for
Future Sale and Underwriting.
As
of ,
2010, shares
of our common stock were
outstanding, shares
were issuable upon the exercise of outstanding vested stock
options under our stock incentive
plans, shares
were subject to outstanding unvested stock options under our
stock incentive plans,
and shares
were reserved for future grant under our stock incentive plans.
Shares acquired upon the exercise of vested options under our
stock incentive plan will first become eligible for
resale days after the date of
this prospectus. Sales of a substantial number of shares of our
common stock following the vesting of outstanding stock options
could cause the market price of our common stock to decline.
27
Because
we do not currently intend to pay cash dividends on our common
stock for the foreseeable future, you may not receive any return
on investment unless you sell your common stock for a price
greater than that which you paid for it.
We currently intend to retain future earnings, if any, for
future operation, expansion and debt repayment and do not intend
to pay any cash dividends for the foreseeable future. Any
decision to declare and pay dividends in the future will be made
at the discretion of our board of directors (the
Board or the Board of Directors) and
will depend on, among other things, our results of operations,
financial condition, cash requirements, contractual restrictions
and other factors that our Board of Directors may deem relevant.
In addition, our ability to pay dividends may be limited by
covenants of any existing and future outstanding indebtedness we
or our subsidiaries incur, including our senior secured credit
facilities and the indentures governing our notes. As a result,
you may not receive any return on an investment in our common
stock unless you sell our common stock for a price greater than
that which you paid for it.
Some
provisions of Delaware law and our governing documents could
discourage a takeover that stockholders may consider
favorable.
In addition to the Investors ownership of a controlling
percentage of our common stock, Delaware law and provisions
contained in our certificate of incorporation and bylaws could
make it difficult for a third party to acquire us, even if doing
so might be beneficial to our stockholders. For example, our
charter authorizes our Board of Directors to determine the
rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions of unissued
preferred stock, without any vote or action by our stockholders.
As a result, our Board could authorize and issue shares of
preferred stock with voting or conversion rights that could
adversely affect the voting or other rights of holders of our
common stock or with other terms that could impede the
completion of a merger, tender offer or other takeover attempt.
In addition, as described under Description of Capital
Stock Delaware Anti-Takeover Statutes
elsewhere in this prospectus, we are subject to certain
provisions of Delaware law that may discourage potential
acquisition proposals and may delay, deter or prevent a change
of control of our company, including through transactions, and,
in particular, unsolicited transactions, that some or all of our
stockholders might consider to be desirable. As a result,
efforts by our stockholders to change the direction or
management of our company may be unsuccessful.
The
Investors will continue to have significant influence over us
after this offering, including control over decisions that
require the approval of stockholders, which could limit your
ability to influence the outcome of key transactions, including
a change of control.
We are controlled, and after this offering is completed will
continue to be controlled, by the Investors. The Investors will
indirectly own through their investment in Hercules Holding II,
LLC (Hercules Holding)
approximately % of our common stock
(or % if the underwriters exercise
their option to purchase additional shares in full) after the
completion of this offering. In addition, representatives of the
Investors will have the right to designate a majority of the
seats on our Board of Directors. As a result, the Investors will
have control over our decisions to enter into any corporate
transaction (and the terms thereof) and the ability to prevent
any change in the composition of our Board of Directors and any
transaction that requires stockholder approval regardless of
whether others believe that such change or transaction is in our
best interests. So long as the Investors continue to indirectly
hold a majority of our outstanding common stock, they will have
the ability to control the vote in any election of directors,
amend our certificate of incorporation or bylaws or take other
actions requiring the vote of our stockholders. Even if such
amount is less than 50%, the Investors will continue to be able
to strongly influence or effectively control our decisions.
Additionally, Bain Capital Partners, LLC, Kohlberg Kravis
Roberts & Co., and BAML Capital Partners, the successor
organization to Merrill Lynch Global Private Equity (each a
Sponsor, collectively, the Sponsors),
are in the business of making investments in companies and may
acquire and hold interests in businesses that compete directly
or indirectly with us. One or more of the Sponsors may also
pursue acquisition opportunities that may be complementary to
our business and, as a result, those acquisition opportunities
may not be available to us.
28
We are
a controlled company within the meaning of the New
York Stock Exchange rules and, as a result, will qualify for,
and intend to rely on, exemptions from certain corporate
governance requirements. You will not have the same protections
afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to such
requirements.
After completion of this offering, the Investors will continue
to control a majority of the voting power of our outstanding
common stock. As a result, we are a controlled
company within the meaning of the corporate governance
standards of the New York Stock Exchange. Under these rules, a
company of which more than 50% of the voting power is held by an
individual, group or another company is a controlled
company and may elect not to comply with certain corporate
governance requirements, including:
|
|
|
|
|
the requirement that a majority of the Board of Directors
consist of independent directors;
|
|
|
|
the requirement that we have a nominating/corporate governance
committee that is composed entirely of independent directors
with a written charter addressing the committees purpose
and responsibilities;
|
|
|
|
the requirement that we have a compensation committee that is
composed entirely of independent directors with a written
charter addressing the committees purpose and
responsibilities; and
|
|
|
|
the requirement for an annual performance evaluation of the
nominating/corporate governance and compensation committees.
|
Following this offering, we intend to utilize these exemptions.
As a result, we will not have a majority of independent
directors, our nominating and corporate governance committee, if
any, and compensation committee will not consist entirely of
independent directors and such committees will not be subject to
annual performance evaluations. Accordingly, you will not have
the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that
are subject to all of the corporate governance requirements of
the New York Stock Exchange.
29
FORWARD-LOOKING
STATEMENTS
This prospectus contains forward-looking statements
within the meaning of the federal securities laws, which involve
risks and uncertainties. Forward-looking statements include all
statements that do not relate solely to historical or current
facts, and you can identify forward-looking statements because
they contain words such as believes,
expects, may, will,
should, seeks,
approximately, intends,
plans, estimates, projects,
continue, initiative or
anticipates or similar expressions that concern our
prospects, objectives, strategies, plans or intentions. All
statements made relating to our estimated and projected
earnings, margins, costs, expenditures, cash flows, growth
rates, operating and growth strategies, ability to repay or
refinance our substantial existing indebtedness and financial
results or to the impact of existing or proposed laws or
regulations (including the Health Reform Law) described in this
prospectus are forward-looking statements. These forward-looking
statements are subject to risks and uncertainties that may
change at any time, and, therefore, our actual results may
differ materially from those expected. We derive many of our
forward-looking statements from our operating budgets and
forecasts, which are based upon many detailed assumptions. While
we believe our assumptions are reasonable, it is very difficult
to predict the impact of known factors, and, of course, it is
impossible to anticipate all factors that could affect our
actual results. These factors include, but are not limited to:
|
|
|
|
|
the ability to recognize the benefits of the Recapitalization;
|
|
|
|
the impact of the substantial indebtedness incurred to finance
the Recapitalization and the ability to refinance such
indebtedness on acceptable terms;
|
|
|
|
the passage of the Health Reform Law and the enactment of
additional federal or state health care reform and changes in
federal, state or local laws or regulations affecting the health
care industry;
|
|
|
|
increases, particularly in the current economic downturn, in the
amount and risk of collectibility of uninsured accounts, and
deductibles and copayment amounts for insured accounts;
|
|
|
|
the ability to achieve operating and financial targets, attain
expected levels of patient volumes and control the costs of
providing services;
|
|
|
|
possible changes in the Medicare, Medicaid and other state
programs, including Medicaid supplemental payments pursuant to
UPL programs, that may impact reimbursements to health care
providers and insurers;
|
|
|
|
the highly competitive nature of the health care business;
|
|
|
|
changes in revenue mix, including potential declines in the
population covered under managed care agreements due to the
economic downturn, and the ability to enter into and renew
managed care provider agreements on acceptable terms;
|
|
|
|
the efforts of insurers, health care providers and others to
contain health care costs;
|
|
|
|
the outcome of our continuing efforts to monitor, maintain and
comply with appropriate laws, regulations, policies and
procedures;
|
|
|
|
increases in wages and the ability to attract and retain
qualified management and personnel, including affiliated
physicians, nurses and medical and technical support personnel;
|
|
|
|
the availability and terms of capital to fund the expansion of
our business and improvements to our existing facilities;
|
|
|
|
changes in accounting practices;
|
|
|
|
changes in general economic conditions nationally and regionally
in our markets;
|
|
|
|
future divestitures which may result in charges;
|
|
|
|
changes in business strategy or development plans;
|
|
|
|
delays in receiving payments for services provided;
|
30
|
|
|
|
|
the outcome of pending and any future tax audits, appeals and
litigation associated with our tax positions;
|
|
|
|
potential liabilities and other claims that may be asserted
against us; and
|
|
|
|
other risk factors described in this prospectus.
|
All subsequent written and oral forward-looking statements
attributable to us, or persons acting on our behalf, are
expressly qualified in their entirety by these cautionary
statements.
We caution you that the important factors discussed above may
not contain all of the material factors that are important to
you. The forward-looking statements included in this prospectus
are made only as of the date hereof. We undertake no obligation
to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statement as a
result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as
otherwise required by law.
31
USE OF
PROCEEDS
We estimate that the gross proceeds we will receive from the
sale of shares of our common stock sold by us in this offering,
excluding the underwriters option to purchase additional
shares, will be $2.5 billion. We estimate that the net
proceeds we will receive from the sale
of shares of our common stock
in this offering, after deducting underwriter discounts and
commissions and estimated expenses payable by us, will be
approximately $ billion (or
$ billion if the underwriters
exercise the option to purchase additional shares in full). This
estimate assumes an initial public offering price of
$ per share, the midpoint of the
range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus. A $1.00
increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price
of $ per share would increase
(decrease) the net proceeds to us from this offering by
$ million, assuming the
number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page
of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting the
estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated
expenses payable by us. We will not receive any proceeds from
the sale of shares of our common stock by the selling
stockholders.
We intend to use the anticipated net proceeds to repay certain
of our existing indebtedness, as will be determined prior to
this offering, and for general corporate purposes.
32
DIVIDEND
POLICY
Following completion of the offering, we do not intend to pay
any cash dividends on our common stock for the foreseeable
future and instead may retain earnings, if any, for future
operation and expansion and debt repayment. Any decision to
declare and pay dividends in the future will be made at the
discretion of our Board of Directors and will depend on, among
other things, our results of operations, cash requirements,
financial condition, contractual restrictions and other factors
that our Board of Directors may deem relevant. In addition, our
ability to pay dividends is limited by covenants in our senior
secured credit facilities and in the indentures governing
certain of our notes. See Description of
Indebtedness and Note 9 to our consolidated financial
statements for restrictions on our ability to pay dividends.
On January 27, 2010, our Board of Directors declared a
distribution to the Companys stockholders and holders of
vested stock options of $1.751 billion in the aggregate. On
May 5, 2010, our Board of Directors declared a distribution to
the Companys existing stockholders and holders of vested
stock options of approximately $500 million in the aggregate.
33
CAPITALIZATION
The following table sets forth our capitalization as of
March 31, 2010:
|
|
|
|
|
on an actual basis; and
|
|
|
|
on an as adjusted basis to give effect to (1) the issuance
of common stock in this offering and the application of proceeds
from the offering as described in Use of Proceeds as
if each had occurred on March 31, 2010, (2) the
payment of a distribution to our existing stockholders and
holders of vested stock options of approximately $500 million in
the aggregate as announced on May 5, 2010,
(3) the to 1
stock split that we effected on ,
2010 and (4) the payment of approximately
$ million in fees under our
management agreement with the Sponsors in connection with its
termination. See Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions Sponsor Management Agreement.
|
You should read this table in conjunction with Use of
Proceeds, Selected Financial Data, and
Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations and our financial
statements and notes thereto, included elsewhere in this
prospectus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 31, 2010
|
|
|
|
Actual
|
|
|
As Adjusted
|
|
|
|
(In millions)
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Long-term obligations:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Senior secured credit facilities(1)
|
|
$
|
9,648
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Senior secured first lien notes(2)
|
|
|
4,071
|
|
|
|
|
|
Senior secured second lien notes(3)
|
|
|
6,079
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other secured indebtedness
|
|
|
345
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unsecured indebtedness(4)
|
|
|
6,712
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total long-term obligations
|
|
|
26,855
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stockholders deficit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Common stock: $.01 par
value; authorized
shares; outstanding
shares
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
|
Capital in excess of par value
|
|
|
291
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
|
|
|
(479
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Retained deficit
|
|
|
(10,126
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stockholders deficit attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
|
(10,313
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
1,015
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total stockholders deficit
|
|
|
(9,298
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total capitalization(5)
|
|
$
|
17,557
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
In connection with the Recapitalization, we entered into
(i) a $2.000 billion asset-based revolving credit
facility with an original six-year maturity (the
asset-based revolving credit facility)
($1.825 billion outstanding at March 31, 2010);
(ii) a $2.000 billion senior secured revolving credit
facility with an original six-year maturity (the senior
secured revolving credit facility) ($229 million
outstanding at March 31, 2010, without giving effect to
outstanding letters of credit); (iii) a $2.750 billion
senior secured term loan A facility with an original six-year
maturity ($1.618 billion outstanding at March 31,
2010); (iv) an $8.800 billion senior secured term loan
B facility with an original seven-year maturity
($5.525 billion outstanding at March 31, 2010); and
(v) a 1.000 billion (334 million, or
$451 million-equivalent, outstanding at March 31,
2010), senior secured European term loan facility with an
original seven-year maturity. |
34
|
|
|
|
|
We refer to the facilities described under (ii) through
(v) above, collectively, as the cash flow credit
facility and, together with the asset-based revolving
credit facility, the senior secured credit
facilities. |
|
(2) |
|
In April 2009, we issued $1.500 billion aggregate principal
amount of first lien notes at a price of 96.755% of their face
value, resulting in $1.451 billion of gross proceeds, which
were used to repay obligations under our cash flow credit
facility after the payment of related fees and expenses. In
August 2009, we issued $1.250 billion aggregate principal
amount of first lien notes at a price of 98.254% of their face
value, resulting in $1.228 billion of gross proceeds, which
were used to repay obligations under our cash flow credit
facility after the payment of related fees and expenses. In
March 2010, we issued $1.400 billion aggregate principal
amount of first lien notes at a price of 99.095% of their face
value, resulting in approximately $1.387 billion of gross
proceeds, which were used to repay obligations under our cash
flow credit facility after the payment of related fees and
expenses. In each case, the discount will accrete and be
included in interest expense until the applicable first lien
notes mature. |
|
(3) |
|
Consists of $4.200 billion of second lien notes (comprised
of $1.000 billion of
91/8% notes
due 2014 and $3.200 billion of
91/4% notes
due 2016) and $1.578 billion of
95/8%/103/8%
second lien toggle notes (which allow us, at our option, to pay
interest in kind during the first five years at the higher
interest rate of
103/8%)
due 2016. In addition, in February 2009 we issued
$310 million aggregate principal amount of
97/8%
second lien notes due 2017 at a price of 96.673% of their face
value, resulting in $300 million of gross proceeds, which
were used to repay obligations under our cash flow credit
facility after payment of related fees and expenses. The
discount on the 2009 second lien notes will accrete and be
included in interest expense until those 2009 second lien notes
mature. |
|
(4) |
|
Consists of (i) an aggregate principal amount of
$246 million medium-term notes with maturities in 2014 and
2025 and a weighted average interest rate of 8.28%; (ii) an
aggregate principal amount of $886 million debentures with
maturities ranging from 2015 to 2095 and a weighted average
interest rate of 7.55%; (iii) an aggregate principal amount
of $5.407 billion senior notes with maturities ranging from
2010 to 2033 and a weighted average interest rate of 6.79%; (iv)
£121 million ($184 million-equivalent at
March 31, 2010) aggregate principal amount of
8.75% senior notes due 2010; and (v) $11 million
of unamortized debt discounts that reduce the existing
indebtedness. For more information regarding our unsecured and
other indebtedness, see Description of Indebtedness. |
|
(5) |
|
A $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public
offering price of $ per share
would increase (decrease) each of cash and cash equivalents,
equity and total capitalization by
$ ,
$ and
$ , respectively, assuming the
number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page
of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting the
estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated
expenses payable by us. |
The table set forth above is based on the number of shares of
our common stock outstanding as of March 31, 2010. This
table does not reflect:
|
|
|
|
|
shares of our common stock
issuable upon the exercise of outstanding stock options at a
weighted average exercise price of
$ per share as of March 31,
2010, of
which
were then exercisable; and
|
|
|
|
shares of our common stock
reserved for future grants under our stock incentive plans.
|
35
DILUTION
If you invest in our common stock, your interest will be diluted
to the extent of the difference between the initial public
offering price per share of our common stock and the net
tangible book value per share of our common stock after this
offering. Dilution results from the fact that the initial public
offering price per share of common stock is substantially in
excess of the net tangible book value per share of our common
stock attributable to the existing stockholders for our
presently outstanding shares of common stock. We calculate net
tangible book value per share of our common stock by dividing
the net tangible book value (total consolidated tangible assets
less total consolidated liabilities) by the number of
outstanding shares of our common stock.
Our net tangible book value as of March 31, 2010 was a
deficit of $(12.1) billion or
$ per share of our common stock,
based on shares of our common
stock outstanding. Dilution is determined by subtracting net
tangible book value per share of our common stock from the
assumed initial public offering price per share of our common
stock.
Without taking into account any other changes in such net
tangible book value after March 31, 2010, after giving
effect to the sale
of shares
of our common stock in this offering assuming an initial public
offering price of $ per share,
less the underwriting discounts and commissions and the
estimated offering expenses payable by us, our pro forma as
adjusted net tangible book value at March 31, 2010 would
have been $ , or
$ per share. This represents an
immediate increase in net tangible book value of
$ per share of our common stock to
the existing stockholders and an immediate dilution in net
tangible book value of $ per
share of our common stock, to investors purchasing shares of our
common stock in this offering. The following table illustrates
such dilution per share of our common stock:
|
|
|
|
|
Assumed initial public offering price per share of our common
stock
|
|
$
|
|
|
Net tangible book value per share of our common stock as of
March 31, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
Pro forma net tangible book value per share of our common stock
after giving effect to this offering
|
|
|
|
|
Amount of dilution in net tangible book value per share of our
common stock to new investors in this offering
|
|
|
|
|
If the underwriters exercise their overallotment option in full,
the adjusted net tangible book value per share of our common
stock after giving effect to the offering would be
$ per share of our common stock.
This represents an increase in adjusted net tangible book value
of $ per share of our common stock
to existing stockholders and dilution in adjusted net tangible
book value of $ per share of our
common stock to new investors.
A $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public
offering price of $ per share of
our common stock would increase (decrease) our net tangible book
value after giving to the offering by
$ million, or by
$ per share of our common stock,
assuming no change to the number of shares of our common stock
offered by us as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus,
and after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and
estimated expenses payable by us.
The following table summarizes, on a pro forma basis as of
March 31, 2010, the total number of shares of our common
stock purchased from us, the total cash consideration paid to us
and the average price per share of our common stock paid by
purchasers of such shares and by new investors purchasing shares
of our common stock in this offering.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shares of our
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Average Price Per
|
|
|
|
Common Stock Purchased
|
|
|
Total Consideration
|
|
|
Share of our
|
|
|
|
Number
|
|
|
Percent
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Percent
|
|
|
Common Stock
|
|
|
Prior purchasers
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
%
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
|
|
%
|
|
$
|
|
|
New investors
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
%
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
|
|
%
|
|
$
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
%
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
|
|
%
|
|
$
|
|
|
36
If the underwriters were to fully exercise their overallotment
option to
purchase additional
shares of our common stock from the selling stockholders, the
percentage of shares of our common stock held by existing
stockholders who are directors, officers or affiliated persons
would be %, and the percentage of shares of shares of
our common stock held by new investors would be %.
To the extent that we grant options to our employees or
directors in the future, and those options or existing options
are exercised or other issuances of shares of our common stock
are made, there will be further dilution to new investors.
37
SELECTED
FINANCIAL DATA
The following table sets forth selected financial data of HCA
Inc. as of the dates and for the periods indicated. The selected
financial data as of December 31, 2009 and 2008 and for
each of the three years in the period ended December 31,
2009 have been derived from our consolidated financial
statements appearing elsewhere in this prospectus, which have
been audited by Ernst & Young LLP. The selected financial
data as of December 31, 2007, 2006 and 2005 and for each of
the two years in the period ended December 31, 2006
presented in this table have been derived from our consolidated
financial statements audited by Ernst & Young LLP that are
not included in this prospectus.
The selected financial data as of March 31, 2010 and for
the three months ended March 31, 2010 and 2009 have been
derived from our unaudited condensed consolidated financial
statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The selected
financial data as of March 31, 2009 have been derived from
our unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements that
are not included in this prospectus. The unaudited financial
data presented have been prepared on a basis consistent with our
audited consolidated financial statements. In the opinion of
management, such unaudited financial data reflect all
adjustments, consisting only of normal and recurring
adjustments, necessary for a fair presentation of the results
for those periods. The results of operations for the interim
periods are not necessarily indicative of the results to be
expected for the full year or any future period.
The selected financial data set forth below should be read in
conjunction with, and are qualified by reference to,
Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations and our consolidated
financial statements, our unaudited condensed consolidated
financial statements and related notes thereto appearing
elsewhere in this prospectus.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As of and for the
|
|
|
|
|
Three Months Ended
|
|
|
As of and for the Years Ended December 31,
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
2009
|
|
2008
|
|
2007
|
|
2006
|
|
2005
|
|
2010
|
|
2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(Unaudited)
|
|
|
(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)
|
|
Summary of Operations:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
30,052
|
|
|
$
|
28,374
|
|
|
$
|
26,858
|
|
|
$
|
25,477
|
|
|
$
|
24,455
|
|
|
$
|
7,544
|
|
|
$
|
7,431
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
11,958
|
|
|
|
11,440
|
|
|
|
10,714
|
|
|
|
10,409
|
|
|
|
9,928
|
|
|
|
3,072
|
|
|
|
2,923
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
4,868
|
|
|
|
4,620
|
|
|
|
4,395
|
|
|
|
4,322
|
|
|
|
4,126
|
|
|
|
1,200
|
|
|
|
1,210
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
4,724
|
|
|
|
4,554
|
|
|
|
4,233
|
|
|
|
4,056
|
|
|
|
4,034
|
|
|
|
1,202
|
|
|
|
1,102
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
3,276
|
|
|
|
3,409
|
|
|
|
3,130
|
|
|
|
2,660
|
|
|
|
2,358
|
|
|
|
564
|
|
|
|
807
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(246
|
)
|
|
|
(223
|
)
|
|
|
(206
|
)
|
|
|
(197
|
)
|
|
|
(221
|
)
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
Gains on sales of investments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(243
|
)
|
|
|
(53
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
1,425
|
|
|
|
1,416
|
|
|
|
1,426
|
|
|
|
1,391
|
|
|
|
1,374
|
|
|
|
355
|
|
|
|
353
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
1,987
|
|
|
|
2,021
|
|
|
|
2,215
|
|
|
|
955
|
|
|
|
655
|
|
|
|
516
|
|
|
|
471
|
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
(97
|
)
|
|
|
(471
|
)
|
|
|
(205
|
)
|
|
|
(78
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
Transaction costs
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
442
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
28,050
|
|
|
|
27,204
|
|
|
|
25,460
|
|
|
|
23,614
|
|
|
|
22,123
|
|
|
|
6,859
|
|
|
|
6,812
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
2,002
|
|
|
|
1,170
|
|
|
|
1,398
|
|
|
|
1,863
|
|
|
|
2,332
|
|
|
|
685
|
|
|
|
619
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
627
|
|
|
|
268
|
|
|
|
316
|
|
|
|
626
|
|
|
|
730
|
|
|
|
209
|
|
|
|
187
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
1,375
|
|
|
|
902
|
|
|
|
1,082
|
|
|
|
1,237
|
|
|
|
1,602
|
|
|
|
476
|
|
|
|
432
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
321
|
|
|
|
229
|
|
|
|
208
|
|
|
|
201
|
|
|
|
178
|
|
|
|
88
|
|
|
|
72
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
1,054
|
|
|
$
|
673
|
|
|
$
|
874
|
|
|
$
|
1,036
|
|
|
$
|
1,424
|
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
360
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
38
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As of and for the
|
|
|
|
|
Three Months Ended
|
|
|
As of and for the Years Ended December 31,
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
2009
|
|
2008
|
|
2007
|
|
2006
|
|
2005
|
|
2010
|
|
2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(Unaudited)
|
|
|
(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)
|
|
Earnings per share:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Basic
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
|
(a
|
)
|
|
|
(a
|
)
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Diluted
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(a
|
)
|
|
|
(a
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Weighted average shares (shares in thousands):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Basic
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(a
|
)
|
|
|
(a
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Diluted
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(a
|
)
|
|
|
(a
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Financial Position:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Assets
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
$
|
24,280
|
|
|
$
|
24,025
|
|
|
$
|
23,675
|
|
|
$
|
22,225
|
|
|
$
|
24,091
|
|
|
$
|
24,284
|
|
Working capital
|
|
|
2,264
|
|
|
|
2,391
|
|
|
|
2,356
|
|
|
|
2,502
|
|
|
|
1,320
|
|
|
|
2,167
|
|
|
|
2,592
|
|
Long-term debt, including amounts due within one year
|
|
|
25,670
|
|
|
|
26,989
|
|
|
|
27,308
|
|
|
|
28,408
|
|
|
|
10,475
|
|
|
|
26,855
|
|
|
|
26,567
|
|
Equity securities with contingent redemption rights
|
|
|
147
|
|
|
|
155
|
|
|
|
164
|
|
|
|
125
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
144
|
|
|
|
154
|
|
Noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
1,008
|
|
|
|
995
|
|
|
|
938
|
|
|
|
907
|
|
|
|
828
|
|
|
|
1,015
|
|
|
|
1,019
|
|
Stockholders (deficit) equity
|
|
|
(7,978
|
)
|
|
|
(9,260
|
)
|
|
|
(9,600
|
)
|
|
|
(10,467
|
)
|
|
|
5,691
|
|
|
|
(9,298
|
)
|
|
|
(8,869
|
)
|
Cash Flow Data:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash provided by operating activities
|
|
$
|
2,747
|
|
|
$
|
1,990
|
|
|
$
|
1,564
|
|
|
$
|
1,988
|
|
|
$
|
3,162
|
|
|
$
|
901
|
|
|
$
|
615
|
|
Cash used in investing activities
|
|
|
(1,035
|
)
|
|
|
(1,467
|
)
|
|
|
(479
|
)
|
|
|
(1,307
|
)
|
|
|
(1,681
|
)
|
|
|
(181
|
)
|
|
|
(288
|
)
|
Capital expenditures
|
|
|
(1,317
|
)
|
|
|
(1,600
|
)
|
|
|
(1,444
|
)
|
|
|
(1,865
|
)
|
|
|
(1,592
|
)
|
|
|
(214
|
)
|
|
|
(337
|
)
|
Cash used in financing activities
|
|
|
(1,865
|
)
|
|
|
(451
|
)
|
|
|
(1,326
|
)
|
|
|
(383
|
)
|
|
|
(1,403
|
)
|
|
|
(644
|
)
|
|
|
(436
|
)
|
Operating Data:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number of hospitals at end of period(b)
|
|
|
155
|
|
|
|
158
|
|
|
|
161
|
|
|
|
166
|
|
|
|
175
|
|
|
|
154
|
|
|
|
155
|
|
Number of freestanding outpatient surgical centers at end of
period(c)
|
|
|
97
|
|
|
|
97
|
|
|
|
99
|
|
|
|
98
|
|
|
|
87
|
|
|
|
98
|
|
|
|
97
|
|
Number of licensed beds at end of period(d)
|
|
|
38,839
|
|
|
|
38,504
|
|
|
|
38,405
|
|
|
|
39,354
|
|
|
|
41,265
|
|
|
|
38,719
|
|
|
|
38,763
|
|
Weighted average licensed beds(e)
|
|
|
38,825
|
|
|
|
38,422
|
|
|
|
39,065
|
|
|
|
40,653
|
|
|
|
41,902
|
|
|
|
38,687
|
|
|
|
38,811
|
|
Admissions(f)
|
|
|
1,556,500
|
|
|
|
1,541,800
|
|
|
|
1,552,700
|
|
|
|
1,610,100
|
|
|
|
1,647,800
|
|
|
|
398,900
|
|
|
|
396,200
|
|
Equivalent admissions(g)
|
|
|
2,439,000
|
|
|
|
2,363,600
|
|
|
|
2,352,400
|
|
|
|
2,416,700
|
|
|
|
2,476,600
|
|
|
|
615,500
|
|
|
|
610,200
|
|
Average length of stay (days)(h)
|
|
|
4.8
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
Average daily census(i)
|
|
|
20,650
|
|
|
|
20,795
|
|
|
|
21,049
|
|
|
|
21,688
|
|
|
|
22,225
|
|
|
|
21,696
|
|
|
|
21,701
|
|
Occupancy(j)
|
|
|
53
|
%
|
|
|
54
|
%
|
|
|
54
|
%
|
|
|
53
|
%
|
|
|
53
|
%
|
|
|
56
|
%
|
|
|
56
|
%
|
Emergency room visits(k)
|
|
|
5,593,500
|
|
|
|
5,246,400
|
|
|
|
5,116,100
|
|
|
|
5,213,500
|
|
|
|
5,415,200
|
|
|
|
1,367,100
|
|
|
|
1,359,700
|
|
Outpatient surgeries(l)
|
|
|
794,600
|
|
|
|
797,400
|
|
|
|
804,900
|
|
|
|
820,900
|
|
|
|
836,600
|
|
|
|
190,700
|
|
|
|
194,400
|
|
Inpatient surgeries(m)
|
|
|
494,500
|
|
|
|
493,100
|
|
|
|
516,500
|
|
|
|
533,100
|
|
|
|
541,400
|
|
|
|
122,500
|
|
|
|
122,600
|
|
Days revenues in accounts receivable(n)
|
|
|
45
|
|
|
|
49
|
|
|
|
53
|
|
|
|
53
|
|
|
|
50
|
|
|
|
46
|
|
|
|
47
|
|
Gross patient revenues(o)
|
|
$
|
115,682
|
|
|
$
|
102,843
|
|
|
$
|
92,429
|
|
|
$
|
84,913
|
|
|
$
|
78,662
|
|
|
$
|
31,054
|
|
|
$
|
28,742
|
|
Outpatient revenues as a % of patient revenues(p)
|
|
|
38
|
%
|
|
|
37
|
%
|
|
|
37
|
%
|
|
|
36
|
%
|
|
|
36
|
%
|
|
|
36
|
%
|
|
|
38
|
%
|
|
|
|
(a) |
|
Due to our November 2006 merger and Recapitalization, our
capital structure and share-based compensation plans for periods
before and after the Recapitalization are not comparable,
therefore we are presenting earnings per share information only
for periods subsequent to the Recapitalization. |
39
|
|
|
(b) |
|
Excludes eight facilities in 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 and seven
facilities in 2006 and 2005 that are not consolidated (accounted
for using the equity method) for financial reporting purposes. |
|
(c) |
|
Excludes eight facilities in 2010, 2009 and 2008, nine
facilities in 2007 and 2006 and seven facilities in 2005 that
are not consolidated (accounted for using the equity method) for
financial reporting purposes. |
|
(d) |
|
Licensed beds are those beds for which a facility has been
granted approval to operate from the applicable state licensing
agency. |
|
(e) |
|
Weighted average licensed beds represents the average number of
licensed beds, weighted based on periods owned. |
|
(f) |
|
Represents the total number of patients admitted to our
hospitals and is used by management and certain investors as a
general measure of inpatient volume. |
|
(g) |
|
Equivalent admissions are used by management and certain
investors as a general measure of combined inpatient and
outpatient volume. Equivalent admissions are computed by
multiplying admissions (inpatient volume) by the sum of gross
inpatient revenue and gross outpatient revenue and then dividing
the resulting amount by gross inpatient revenue. The equivalent
admissions computation equates outpatient revenue to
the volume measure (admissions) used to measure inpatient
volume, resulting in a general measure of combined inpatient and
outpatient volume. |
|
(h) |
|
Represents the average number of days admitted patients stay in
our hospitals. |
|
(i) |
|
Represents the average number of patients in our hospital beds
each day. |
|
(j) |
|
Represents the percentage of hospital licensed beds occupied by
patients. Both average daily census and occupancy rate provide
measures of the utilization of inpatient rooms. |
|
(k) |
|
Represents the number of patients treated in our emergency rooms. |
|
(l) |
|
Represents the number of surgeries performed on patients who
were not admitted to our hospitals. Pain management and
endoscopy procedures are not included in outpatient surgeries. |
|
(m) |
|
Represents the number of surgeries performed on patients who
have been admitted to our hospitals. Pain management and
endoscopy procedures are not included in inpatient surgeries. |
|
(n) |
|
Revenues per day is calculated by dividing the revenues for the
period by the days in the period. Days revenues in accounts
receivable is then calculated as accounts receivable, net of the
allowance for doubtful accounts, at the end of the period
divided by revenues per day. |
|
(o) |
|
Gross patient revenues are based upon our standard charge
listing. Gross charges/revenues do not reflect what our hospital
facilities are paid. Gross charges/revenues are reduced by
contractual adjustments, discounts and charity care to determine
reported revenues. |
|
(p) |
|
Represents the percentage of patient revenues related to
patients who are not admitted to our hospitals. |
40
MANAGEMENTS
DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
You should read the following discussion of our results of
operations and financial condition with Selected Financial
Data and the consolidated financial statements and related
notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. This discussion
contains forward-looking statements and involves numerous risks
and uncertainties, including, but not limited to, those
described in the Risk Factors section of this
prospectus. Actual results may differ materially from those
contained in any forward-looking statements.
You also should read the following discussion of our results
of operations and financial condition with
Business Business Drivers and Measures
for a discussion of certain of our important financial policies
and objectives; performance measures and operational factors we
use to evaluate our financial condition and operating
performance; and our business segments.
Overview
We are one of the leading health care services companies in the
United States. At March 31, 2010, we operated 162
hospitals, comprised of 156 general, acute care hospitals; five
psychiatric hospitals; and one rehabilitation hospital. The 162
hospital total includes eight hospitals (seven general, acute
care hospitals and one rehabilitation hospital) owned by joint
ventures in which an affiliate of HCA is a partner, and these
joint ventures are accounted for using the equity method. In
addition, we operated 106 freestanding surgery centers, eight of
which are owned by joint ventures in which an affiliate of HCA
is a partner, and these joint ventures are accounted for using
the equity method. Our facilities are located in 20 states
and England. For the year ended December 31, 2009, we
generated revenues of $30.052 billion and net income
attributable to HCA Inc. of $1.054 billion, and for the
quarter ended March 31, 2010, we generated revenues of
$7.544 billion and net income attributable to HCA Inc. of
$388 million.
On November 17, 2006, we were acquired by a private
investor group comprised of affiliates of or funds sponsored by
Bain Capital Partners, LLC, Kohlberg Kravis Roberts &
Co., Merrill Lynch Global Private Equity (now BAML Capital
Partners), Citigroup Inc., Bank of America Corporation and HCA
founder Dr. Thomas F. Frist, Jr., and by members of
management and certain other investors. We refer to the merger,
the financing transactions related to the merger and other
related transactions collectively as the
Recapitalization.
First
Quarter 2010 Operations Summary
Net income attributable to HCA Inc. totaled $388 million
for the quarter ended March 31, 2010, compared to
$360 million for the quarter ended March 31, 2009.
Revenues increased to $7.544 billion in the first quarter
of 2010 from $7.431 billion in the first quarter of 2009.
First quarter 2010 results include impairments of long-lived
assets of $18 million. First quarter 2009 results include
losses on sales of facilities of $5 million and impairments
of long-lived assets of $9 million.
Revenues increased 1.5% on a consolidated basis and on a same
facility basis for the quarter ended March 31, 2010
compared to the quarter ended March 31, 2009. The increase
in consolidated revenues can be attributed to the combined
impact of a 0.6% increase in revenue per equivalent admission
and a 0.9% increase in equivalent admissions. The same facility
revenues increase resulted from the combined impact of a 0.4%
increase in same facility revenue per equivalent admission and a
1.1% increase in same facility equivalent admissions.
During the quarter ended March 31, 2010, consolidated
admissions and same facility admissions increased 0.7% and 0.9%,
respectively, compared to the quarter ended March 31, 2009.
Inpatient surgeries declined 0.1% on a consolidated basis and
declined 0.4% on a same facility basis during the quarter ended
March 31, 2010, compared to the quarter ended
March 31, 2009. Outpatient surgeries declined 1.9% on a
consolidated basis and declined 1.8% on a same facility basis
during the quarter ended March 31, 2010, compared to the
quarter ended March 31, 2009. Emergency department visits
increased 0.5% on a consolidated basis and
41
increased 1.0% on a same facility basis during the quarter ended
March 31, 2010, compared to the quarter ended
March 31, 2009.
For the quarter ended March 31, 2010, the provision for
doubtful accounts declined $243 million to 7.5% of
revenues, from 10.9% of revenues for the quarter ended
March 31, 2009. The self-pay revenue deductions for charity
care and uninsured discounts increased $55 million and
$418 million (we increased our uninsured discount
percentages during August 2009), respectively, during the
first quarter of 2010, compared to the first quarter of 2009.
The sum of the provision for doubtful accounts, uninsured
discounts and charity care, as a percentage of the sum of
revenues, uninsured discounts and charity care, was 23.5% for
the first quarter of 2010, compared to 22.4% for the first
quarter of 2009. Same facility uninsured admissions increased
6.8% and same facility uninsured emergency room visits decreased
1.6% for the quarter ended March 31, 2010, compared to the
quarter ended March 31, 2009.
The increases in the self-pay revenue deductions result in
reductions to both the provision for doubtful accounts and
revenues, and were the primary contributing factors to the lower
growth rates we experienced in revenues and revenue per
equivalent admission during the quarter ended March 31,
2010.
Interest expense increased $45 million to $516 million
for the quarter ended March 31, 2010, from
$471 million for the quarter ended March 31, 2009. The
additional interest expense was due primarily to an increase in
the average effective interest rate.
Cash flows from operating activities increased
$286 million, from $615 million for the first quarter
of 2009 to $901 million for the first quarter of 2010. The
increase related primarily to income tax payments, as we
received a net refund of $71 million in the first quarter
of 2010 and made net payments of $146 million in the first
quarter of 2009.
2009
Operations Summary
Net income attributable to HCA Inc. totaled $1.054 billion
for 2009, compared to $673 million for 2008. The 2009
results include losses on sales of facilities of
$15 million and impairments of long-lived assets of
$43 million. The 2008 results include gains on sales of
facilities of $97 million and impairments of long-lived
assets of $64 million.
Revenues increased to $30.052 billion for 2009 from
$28.374 billion for 2008. Revenues increased 5.9% on a
consolidated basis and 6.1% on a same facility basis for 2009,
compared to 2008. The consolidated revenues increase can be
attributed to the combined impact of a 2.6% increase in revenue
per equivalent admission and a 3.2% increase in equivalent
admissions. The same facility revenues increase resulted from a
2.6% increase in same facility revenue per equivalent admission
and a 3.4% increase in same facility equivalent admissions.
During 2009, consolidated admissions increased 1.0% and same
facility admissions increased 1.2%, compared to 2008. Inpatient
surgical volumes increased 0.3% on a consolidated basis and
increased 0.5% on a same facility basis during 2009, compared to
2008. Outpatient surgical volumes declined 0.4% on a
consolidated basis and declined 0.1% on a same facility basis
during 2009, compared to 2008. Emergency department visits
increased 6.6% on a consolidated basis and increased 7.0% on a
same facility basis during 2009, compared to 2008.
For 2009, the provision for doubtful accounts declined to 10.9%
of revenues from 12.0% of revenues for 2008. The combined
self-pay revenue deductions for charity care and uninsured
discounts increased $1.486 billion for 2009, compared to
2008. The sum of the provision for doubtful accounts, uninsured
discounts and charity care, as a percentage of the sum of net
revenues, uninsured discounts and charity care, was 23.8% for
2009, compared to 21.9% for 2008. Same facility uninsured
admissions increased 4.7% and same facility uninsured emergency
room visits increased 6.5% for 2009, compared to 2008.
Interest expense totaled $1.987 billion for 2009, compared
to $2.021 billion for 2008. The $34 million decline in
interest expense for 2009 was due to a reduction in the average
debt balance offsetting an increase in the average interest rate.
42
Critical
Accounting Policies and Estimates
The preparation of our consolidated financial statements
requires management to make estimates and assumptions that
affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, the
disclosure of contingent liabilities and the reported amounts of
revenues and expenses. Our estimates are based on historical
experience and various other assumptions we believe are
reasonable under the circumstances. We evaluate our estimates on
an ongoing basis and make changes to the estimates and related
disclosures as experience develops or new information becomes
known. Actual results may differ from these estimates.
We believe the following critical accounting policies affect our
more significant judgments and estimates used in the preparation
of our consolidated financial statements.
Revenues
Revenues are recorded during the period the health care services
are provided, based upon the estimated amounts due from payers.
Estimates of contractual allowances under managed care health
plans are based upon the payment terms specified in the related
contractual agreements. Laws and regulations governing the
Medicare and Medicaid programs are complex and subject to
interpretation. The estimated reimbursement amounts are made on
a payer-specific basis and are recorded based on the best
information available regarding managements interpretation
of the applicable laws, regulations and contract terms.
Management continually reviews the contractual estimation
process to consider and incorporate updates to laws and
regulations and the frequent changes in managed care contractual
terms resulting from contract renegotiations and renewals. We
have invested significant resources to refine and improve our
computerized billing systems and the information system data
used to make contractual allowance estimates. We have developed
standardized calculation processes and related training programs
to improve the utility of our patient accounting systems.
The Emergency Medical Treatment and Active Labor Act
(EMTALA) requires any hospital participating in the
Medicare program to conduct an appropriate medical screening
examination of every person who presents to the hospitals
emergency room for treatment and, if the individual is suffering
from an emergency medical condition, to either stabilize the
condition or make an appropriate transfer of the individual to a
facility able to handle the condition. The obligation to screen
and stabilize emergency medical conditions exists regardless of
an individuals ability to pay for treatment. Federal and
state laws and regulations, including but not limited to EMTALA,
require, and our commitment to providing quality patient care
encourages, the provision of services to patients who are
financially unable to pay for the health care services they
receive. The Health Reform Law requires health plans offered
through an Exchange to reimburse hospitals for emergency
services provided to enrollees without prior authorization and
without regard to whether a participating provider contract is
in place. Further, the Health Reform Law contains provisions
that seek to decrease the number of uninsured individuals,
including requirements or incentives, which do not become
effective until 2014, for individuals to obtain, and large
employers to provide, insurance coverage. These mandates may
reduce the financial impact of screening for and stabilizing
emergency medical conditions. However, many factors are unknown
regarding the impact of the Health Reform Law, including how
many previously uninsured individuals will obtain coverage as a
result of the new law or the change, if any, in the volume of
inpatient and outpatient hospital services that are sought by
and provided to previously uninsured individuals.
We do not pursue collection of amounts related to patients who
meet our guidelines to qualify as charity care; therefore, they
are not reported in revenues. Patients treated at our hospitals
for nonelective care, who have income at or below 200% of the
federal poverty level, are eligible for charity care. The
federal poverty level is established by the federal government
and is based on income and family size. We provide discounts
from our gross charges to uninsured patients who do not qualify
for Medicaid or charity care. These discounts are similar to
those provided to many local managed care plans.
Due to the complexities involved in the classification and
documentation of health care services authorized and provided,
the estimation of revenues earned and the related reimbursement
are often subject to interpretations that could result in
payments that are different from our estimates. Adjustments to
estimated Medicare and Medicaid reimbursement amounts and
disproportionate-share funds, which resulted in net
43
increases to revenues, related primarily to cost reports filed
during the respective year were $40 million,
$32 million and $47 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007,
respectively. The adjustments to estimated reimbursement
amounts, which resulted in net increases to revenues, related
primarily to cost reports filed during previous years were
$60 million, $35 million and $83 million in 2009,
2008 and 2007, respectively. We expect adjustments during the
next 12 months related to Medicare and Medicaid cost report
filings and settlements and disproportionate-share funds will
result in increases to revenues within generally similar ranges.
Provision
for Doubtful Accounts and the Allowance for Doubtful
Accounts
The collection of outstanding receivables from Medicare, managed
care payers, other third-party payers and patients is our
primary source of cash and is critical to our operating
performance. The primary collection risks relate to uninsured
patient accounts, including patient accounts for which the
primary insurance carrier has paid the amounts covered by the
applicable agreement, but patient responsibility amounts
(deductibles and copayments) remain outstanding. The provision
for doubtful accounts and the allowance for doubtful accounts
relate primarily to amounts due directly from patients. An
estimated allowance for doubtful accounts is recorded for all
uninsured accounts, regardless of the aging of those accounts.
Accounts are written off when all reasonable internal and
external collection efforts have been performed. Our collection
policies include a review of all accounts against certain
standard collection criteria, upon completion of our internal
collection efforts. Accounts determined to possess positive
collectibility attributes are forwarded to a secondary external
collection agency and the other accounts are written off. The
accounts that are not collected by the secondary external
collection agency are written off when they are returned to us
by the collection agency (usually within 12 months).
Writeoffs are based upon specific identification and the
writeoff process requires a writeoff adjustment entry to the
patient accounting system. We do not pursue collection of
amounts related to patients that meet our guidelines to qualify
as charity care.
The amount of the provision for doubtful accounts is based upon
managements assessment of historical writeoffs and
expected net collections, business and economic conditions,
trends in federal, state, and private employer health care
coverage and other collection indicators. Management relies on
the results of detailed reviews of historical writeoffs and
recoveries at facilities that represent a majority of our
revenues and accounts receivable (the hindsight
analysis) as a primary source of information in estimating
the collectibility of our accounts receivable. We perform the
hindsight analysis quarterly, utilizing rolling twelve-months
accounts receivable collection and writeoff data. We believe our
quarterly updates to the estimated allowance for doubtful
accounts at each of our hospital facilities provide reasonable
valuations of our accounts receivable. These routine, quarterly
changes in estimates have not resulted in material adjustments
to our allowance for doubtful accounts, provision for doubtful
accounts or
period-to-period
comparisons of our results of operations. At March 31, 2010
and 2009, the allowance for doubtful accounts represented
approximately 94% and 93%, respectively, of the
$4.833 billion and $5.266 billion, respectively,
patient due accounts receivable balance. At December 31,
2009 and 2008, the allowance for doubtful accounts represented
approximately 94% and 92%, respectively, of the
$5.176 billion and $5.148 billion, respectively,
patient due accounts receivable balance. The patient due
accounts receivable balance represents the estimated uninsured
portion of our accounts receivable. The estimated uninsured
portion of Medicaid pending and uninsured discount pending
accounts is included in our patient due accounts receivable
balance.
The revenue deductions related to uninsured accounts (charity
care and uninsured discounts) generally have the inverse effect
on the provision for doubtful accounts. To quantify the total
impact of and trends related to uninsured accounts, we believe
it is beneficial to view these revenue deductions and provision
for doubtful accounts in combination, rather than each
separately. A summary of these amounts for the years
44
ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 and for the
three months ended March 31, 2010 and 2009 follows
(dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Three Months
|
|
|
Years Ended December 31,
|
|
Ended March 31,
|
|
|
2009
|
|
2008
|
|
2007
|
|
2010
|
|
2009
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
$
|
3,276
|
|
|
$
|
3,409
|
|
|
$
|
3,130
|
|
|
$
|
564
|
|
|
$
|
807
|
|
Uninsured discounts
|
|
|
2,935
|
|
|
|
1,853
|
|
|
|
1,474
|
|
|
|
1,035
|
|
|
|
617
|
|
Charity care
|
|
|
2,151
|
|
|
|
1,747
|
|
|
|
1,530
|
|
|
|
546
|
|
|
|
491
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Totals
|
|
$
|
8,362
|
|
|
$
|
7,009
|
|
|
$
|
6,134
|
|
|
$
|
2,145
|
|
|
$
|
1,915
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The provision for doubtful accounts, as a percentage of
revenues, increased from 11.7% for 2007 to 12.0% for 2008 and
declined to 10.9% for 2009. However, the sum of the provision
for doubtful accounts, uninsured discounts and charity care, as
a percentage of the sum of net revenues, uninsured discounts and
charity care increased from 20.5% for 2007 to 21.9% for 2008 and
to 23.8% for 2009.
Days revenues in accounts receivable were 46 days and
47 days at March 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively, and
45 days, 49 days and 53 days at December 31,
2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Management expects a
continuation of the challenges related to the collection of the
patient due accounts. Adverse changes in the percentage of our
patients having adequate health care coverage, general economic
conditions, patient accounting service center operations, payer
mix, or trends in federal, state, and private employer health
care coverage could affect the collection of accounts
receivable, cash flows and results of operations.
The approximate breakdown of accounts receivable by payer
classification as of March 31, 2010, December 31, 2009
and 2008 is set forth in the following table:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
% of Accounts Receivable
|
|
|
|
Under 91 Days
|
|
|
91180 Days
|
|
|
Over 180 Days
|
|
|
Accounts receivable aging at March 31, 2010:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Medicare and Medicaid
|
|
|
14
|
%
|
|
|
1
|
%
|
|
|
1
|
%
|
Managed care and other insurers
|
|
|
19
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
Uninsured
|
|
|
14
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
37
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
47
|
%
|
|
|
11
|
%
|
|
|
42
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts receivable aging at December 31, 2009:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Medicare and Medicaid
|
|
|
12
|
%
|
|
|
1
|
%
|
|
|
1
|
%
|
Managed care and other insurers
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
Uninsured
|
|
|
13
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
39
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
43
|
%
|
|
|
13
|
%
|
|
|
44
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts receivable aging at December 31, 2008:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Medicare and Medicaid
|
|
|
10
|
%
|
|
|
1
|
%
|
|
|
2
|
%
|
Managed care and other insurers
|
|
|
17
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
3
|
|
Uninsured
|
|
|
21
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
33
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
48
|
%
|
|
|
14
|
%
|
|
|
38
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Professional
Liability Claims
We, along with virtually all health care providers, operate in
an environment with professional liability risks. Our facilities
are insured by our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary for losses
up to $50 million per occurrence, subject to a
$5 million per occurrence self-insured retention. We
purchase excess insurance on a claims-made basis for losses in
excess of $50 million per occurrence. Our professional
liability reserves, net of receivables under reinsurance
contracts, do not include amounts for any estimated losses
covered by our excess
45
insurance coverage. Provisions for losses related to
professional liability risks were $56 million and
$45 million for the three months ended March 31,
2010 and 2009, respectively, and $211 million,
$175 million and $163 million for the years ended
December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
Reserves for professional liability risks represent the
estimated ultimate cost of all reported and unreported losses
incurred through the respective consolidated balance sheet
dates. The estimated ultimate cost includes estimates of direct
expenses and fees paid to outside counsel and experts, but does
not include the general overhead costs of our insurance
subsidiary or corporate office. Individual case reserves are
established based upon the particular circumstances of each
reported claim and represent our estimates of the future costs
that will be paid on reported claims. Case reserves are reduced
as claim payments are made and are adjusted upward or downward
as our estimates regarding the amounts of future losses are
revised. Once the case reserves for known claims are determined,
information is stratified by loss layers and retentions,
accident years, reported years, and geographic location of our
hospitals. Several actuarial methods are employed to utilize
this data to produce estimates of ultimate losses and reserves
for incurred but not reported claims, including: paid and
incurred extrapolation methods utilizing paid and incurred loss
development to estimate ultimate losses; frequency and severity
methods utilizing paid and incurred claims development to
estimate ultimate average frequency (number of claims) and
ultimate average severity (cost per claim); and
Bornhuetter-Ferguson methods which add expected development to
actual paid or incurred experience to estimate ultimate losses.
These methods use our company-specific historical claims data
and other information. Company-specific claim reporting and
settlement data collected over an approximate
20-year
period is used in our reserve estimation process. This
company-specific data includes information regarding our
business, including historical paid losses and loss adjustment
expenses, historical and current case loss reserves, actual and
projected hospital statistical data, professional liability
retentions for each policy year, geographic information and
other data.
Reserves and provisions for professional liability risks are
based upon actuarially determined estimates. The estimated
reserve ranges, net of amounts receivable under reinsurance
contracts, were $1.024 billion to $1.270 billion at
December 31, 2009 and $1.102 billion to
$1.332 billion at December 31, 2008. Our estimated
reserves for professional liability claims may change
significantly if future claims differ from expected trends. We
perform sensitivity analyses which model the volatility of key
actuarial assumptions and monitor our reserves for adequacy
relative to all our assumptions in the aggregate. Based on our
analysis, we believe the estimated professional liability
reserve ranges represent the reasonably likely outcomes for
ultimate losses. We consider the number and severity of claims
to be the most significant assumptions in estimating reserves
for professional liabilities. A 2% change in the expected
frequency trend could be reasonable likely and would increase
the reserve estimate by $16 million or reduce the reserve
estimate by $15 million. A 2% change in the expected claim
severity trend could be reasonably likely and would increase the
reserve estimate by $69 million or reduce the reserve
estimate by $63 million. We believe adequate reserves have
been recorded for our professional liability claims; however,
due to the complexity of the claims, the extended period of time
to settle the claims and the wide range of potential outcomes,
our ultimate liability for professional liability claims could
change by more than the estimated sensitivity amounts and could
change materially from our current estimates.
The reserves for professional liability risks cover
approximately 2,600 and 2,800 individual claims at
December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and estimates for
unreported potential claims. The time period required to resolve
these claims can vary depending upon the jurisdiction and
whether the claim is settled or litigated. The average time
period between the occurrence and payment of final settlement
for our professional liability claims is approximately five
years, although the facts and circumstances of each individual
claim can result in an
occurrence-to-settlement
timeframe that varies from this average. The estimation of the
timing of payments beyond a year can vary significantly.
Reserves for professional liability risks were
$1.335 billion, $1.322 billion and $1.387 billion
at March 31, 2010, December 31, 2009 and 2008,
respectively. The current portion of these reserves,
$277 million, $265 million and $279 million at
March 31, 2010, December 31, 2009 and 2008,
respectively, is included in other accrued expenses.
Obligations covered by reinsurance contracts are included in the
reserves for professional liability risks, as the insurance
subsidiary remains liable to the extent reinsurers do not meet
their obligations. Reserves for professional liability risks
(net of $49 million, $53 million and $57 million
receivable
46
under reinsurance contracts at March 31, 2010,
December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively) were
$1.286 billion, $1.269 billion and $1.330 billion
at March 31, 2010, December 31, 2009 and 2008,
respectively. The estimated total net reserves for professional
liability risks at March 31, 2010, December 31, 2009
and 2008 are comprised of $736 million, $680 million
and $724 million, respectively, of case reserves for known
claims and $550 million, $589 million and
$606 million, respectively, of reserves for incurred but
not reported claims.
Changes in our professional liability reserves, net of
reinsurance recoverable, for the years ended December 31,
are summarized in the following table (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Net reserves for professional liability claims, January 1
|
|
$
|
1,330
|
|
|
$
|
1,469
|
|
|
$
|
1,542
|
|
Provision for current year claims
|
|
|
258
|
|
|
|
239
|
|
|
|
214
|
|
Favorable development related to prior years claims
|
|
|
(47
|
)
|
|
|
(64
|
)
|
|
|
(51
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total provision
|
|
|
211
|
|
|
|
175
|
|
|
|
163
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payments for current year claims
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
Payments for prior years claims
|
|
|
268
|
|
|
|
307
|
|
|
|
232
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total claim payments
|
|
|
272
|
|
|
|
314
|
|
|
|
236
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net reserves for professional liability claims, December 31
|
|
$
|
1,269
|
|
|
$
|
1,330
|
|
|
$
|
1,469
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The favorable development related to prior years claims
resulted from declining claim frequency and moderating claim
severity trends. We believe these favorable trends are primarily
attributable to tort reforms enacted in key states, particularly
Texas, and our risk management and patient safety initiatives,
particularly in the area of obstetrics.
Income
Taxes
We calculate our provision for income taxes using the asset and
liability method, under which deferred tax assets and
liabilities are recognized by identifying the temporary
differences that arise from the recognition of items in
different periods for tax and accounting purposes. Deferred tax
assets generally represent the tax effects of amounts expensed
in our income statement for which tax deductions will be claimed
in future periods.
Although we believe we have properly reported taxable income and
paid taxes in accordance with applicable laws, federal, state or
international taxing authorities may challenge our tax positions
upon audit. Significant judgment is required in determining and
assessing the impact of uncertain tax positions. We report a
liability for unrecognized tax benefits from uncertain tax
positions taken or expected to be taken in our income tax
return. During each reporting period, we assess the facts and
circumstances related to uncertain tax positions. If the
realization of unrecognized tax benefits is deemed probable
based upon new facts and circumstances, the estimated liability
and the provision for income taxes are reduced in the current
period. Final audit results may vary from our estimates.
Results
of Operations
Revenue/Volume
Trends
Our revenues depend upon inpatient occupancy levels, the
ancillary services and therapy programs ordered by physicians
and provided to patients, the volume of outpatient procedures
and the charge and negotiated payment rates for such services.
Gross charges typically do not reflect what our facilities are
actually paid. Our facilities have entered into agreements with
third-party payers, including government programs and managed
care health plans, under which the facilities are paid based
upon the cost of providing services, predetermined rates per
diagnosis, fixed per diem rates or discounts from gross charges.
We do not pursue collection of amounts related to patients who
meet our guidelines to qualify for charity care; therefore, they
are not reported in revenues. We provide discounts to uninsured
patients who do not qualify for Medicaid or charity care that
are similar to the discounts provided to many local managed care
plans.
47
Revenues increased 5.9% to $30.052 billion for 2009 from
$28.374 billion for 2008 and increased 5.6% for 2008 from
$26.858 billion for 2007. The increase in revenues in 2009
can be primarily attributed to the combined impact of a 2.6%
increase in revenue per equivalent admission and a 3.2% increase
in equivalent admissions compared to the prior year. The
increase in revenues in 2008 can be primarily attributed to the
combined impact of a 5.2% increase in revenue per equivalent
admission and a 0.5% increase in equivalent admissions compared
to 2007.
Consolidated admissions increased 1.0% in 2009 compared to 2008
and declined 0.7% in 2008 compared to 2007. Consolidated
inpatient surgeries increased 0.3% and consolidated outpatient
surgeries declined 0.4% during 2009 compared to 2008.
Consolidated inpatient surgeries declined 4.5% and consolidated
outpatient surgeries declined 0.9% during 2008 compared to 2007.
Consolidated emergency department visits increased 6.6% during
2009 compared to 2008 and increased 2.5% during 2008 compared to
2007.
Same facility revenues increased 6.1% for the year ended
December 31, 2009 compared to the year ended
December 31, 2008 and increased 7.0% for the year ended
December 31, 2008 compared to the year ended
December 31, 2007. The 6.1% increase for 2009 can be
primarily attributed to the combined impact of a 2.6% increase
in same facility revenue per equivalent admission and a 3.4%
increase in same facility equivalent admissions. The 7.0%
increase for 2008 can be primarily attributed to the combined
impact of a 5.1% increase in same facility revenue per
equivalent admission and a 1.9% increase in same facility
equivalent admissions.
Same facility admissions increased 1.2% in 2009 compared to 2008
and increased 0.9% in 2008 compared to 2007. Same facility
inpatient surgeries increased 0.5% and same facility outpatient
surgeries declined 0.1% during 2009 compared to 2008. Same
facility inpatient surgeries declined 0.5% and same facility
outpatient surgeries declined 0.2% during 2008 compared to 2007.
Same facility emergency department visits increased 7.0% during
2009 compared to 2008 and increased 3.6% during 2008 compared to
2007.
Same facility uninsured emergency room visits increased 6.5% and
same facility uninsured admissions increased 4.7% during 2009
compared to 2008. Same facility uninsured emergency room visits
increased 4.5% and same facility uninsured admissions increased
1.7% during 2008 compared to 2007. Management believes same
facility uninsured emergency department visits and same facility
uninsured admissions could continue to increase during 2010 if
the adverse general economic and unemployment trends continue.
Admissions related to Medicare, managed Medicare, Medicaid,
managed Medicaid, managed care and other insurers and the
uninsured for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and
2007 and for the three months ended March 31, 2010 and 2009
are set forth below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Three Months Ended
|
|
|
|
Years Ended December 31,
|
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Medicare
|
|
|
34
|
%
|
|
|
35
|
%
|
|
|
35
|
%
|
|
|
35
|
%
|
|
|
35
|
%
|
Managed Medicare
|
|
|
10
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
11
|
|
|
|
10
|
|
Medicaid
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
Managed Medicaid
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
Managed care and other insurers
|
|
|
34
|
|
|
|
35
|
|
|
|
37
|
|
|
|
32
|
|
|
|
33
|
|
Uninsured
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
48
The approximate percentages of our inpatient revenues related to
Medicare, managed Medicare, Medicaid, managed Medicaid, managed
care plans and other insurers and the uninsured for the years
ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 and for the three
months ended March 31, 2010 and 2009 are set forth below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Three Months Ended
|
|
|
|
Years Ended December 31,
|
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Medicare
|
|
|
31
|
%
|
|
|
31
|
%
|
|
|
32
|
%
|
|
|
32
|
%
|
|
|
33
|
%
|
Managed Medicare
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
Medicaid
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
Managed Medicaid
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
Managed care and other insurers
|
|
|
44
|
|
|
|
44
|
|
|
|
44
|
|
|
|
44
|
|
|
|
44
|
|
Uninsured
|
|
|
5
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At December 31, 2009, we owned and operated 38 hospitals
and 33 surgery centers in the state of Florida. Our Florida
facilities revenues totaled $7.343 billion and
$7.099 billion for the years ended December 31, 2009
and 2008, respectively. At December 31, 2009, we owned and
operated 35 hospitals and 23 surgery centers in the state of
Texas. Our Texas facilities revenues totaled
$8.042 billion and $7.351 billion for the years ended
December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. During 2009 and
2008, 57% and 55%, respectively, of our admissions and 51% of
our revenues were generated by our Florida and Texas facilities.
Uninsured admissions in Florida and Texas represented 64% and
63% of our uninsured admissions during 2009 and 2008,
respectively.
We provided $2.151 billion, $1.747 billion and
$1.530 billion of charity care (amounts are based upon our
gross charges) during the years ended December 31, 2009,
2008 and 2007, respectively. We provide discounts to uninsured
patients who do not qualify for Medicaid or charity care. These
discounts are similar to those provided to many local managed
care plans and totaled $2.935 billion, $1.853 billion
and $1.474 billion for the years ended December 31,
2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
We receive a significant portion of our revenues from government
health programs, principally Medicare and Medicaid, which are
highly regulated and subject to frequent and substantial
changes. We have increased the indigent care services we provide
in several communities in the state of Texas, in affiliation
with other hospitals. The state of Texas has been involved in
the effort to increase the indigent care provided by private
hospitals. As a result of this additional indigent care provided
by private hospitals, public hospital districts or counties in
Texas have available funds that were previously devoted to
indigent care. The public hospital districts or counties are
under no contractual or legal obligation to provide such
indigent care. The public hospital districts or counties have
elected to transfer some portion of these available funds to the
states Medicaid program. Such action is at the sole
discretion of the public hospital districts or counties. It is
anticipated that these contributions to the state will be
matched with federal Medicaid funds. The state then may make
supplemental payments to hospitals in the state for Medicaid
services rendered. Hospitals receiving Medicaid supplemental
payments may include those that are providing additional
indigent care services. Such payments must be within the federal
UPL established by federal regulation. Our Texas Medicaid
revenues included $169 million and $63 million for the
three months ended March 31, 2010 and 2009,
respectively, and $474 million, $262 million and
$232 million for the years ended December 31, 2009,
2008 and 2007, respectively, of Medicaid supplemental payments
pursuant to UPL programs.
49
Operating
Results Summary
The following are comparative summaries of operating results for
the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 and for
the three months ended March 31, 2010 and 2009 (dollars in
millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Years Ended December 31
|
|
|
Three Months Ended March 31
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Ratio
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Ratio
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Ratio
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Ratio
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Ratio
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(Unaudited)
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
30,052
|
|
|
|
100.0
|
|
|
$
|
28,374
|
|
|
|
100.0
|
|
|
$
|
26,858
|
|
|
|
100.0
|
|
|
$
|
7,544
|
|
|
|
100.0
|
|
|
$
|
7,431
|
|
|
|
100.0
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
11,958
|
|
|
|
39.8
|
|
|
|
11,440
|
|
|
|
40.3
|
|
|
|
10,714
|
|
|
|
39.9
|
|
|
|
3,072
|
|
|
|
40.7
|
|
|
|
2,923
|
|
|
|
39.3
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
4,868
|
|
|
|
16.2
|
|
|
|
4,620
|
|
|
|
16.3
|
|
|
|
4,395
|
|
|
|
16.4
|
|
|
|
1,200
|
|
|
|
15.9
|
|
|
|
1,210
|
|
|
|
16.3
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
4,724
|
|
|
|
15.7
|
|
|
|
4,554
|
|
|
|
16.1
|
|
|
|
4,233
|
|
|
|
15.7
|
|
|
|
1,202
|
|
|
|
15.9
|
|
|
|
1,102
|
|
|
|
14.8
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
3,276
|
|
|
|
10.9
|
|
|
|
3,409
|
|
|
|
12.0
|
|
|
|
3,130
|
|
|
|
11.7
|
|
|
|
564
|
|
|
|
7.5
|
|
|
|
807
|
|
|
|
10.9
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(246
|
)
|
|
|
(0.8
|
)
|
|
|
(223
|
)
|
|
|
(0.8
|
)
|
|
|
(206
|
)
|
|
|
(0.8
|
)
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
|
|
(0.9
|
)
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
|
|
(0.9
|
)
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
1,425
|
|
|
|
4.8
|
|
|
|
1,416
|
|
|
|
5.0
|
|
|
|
1,426
|
|
|
|
5.4
|
|
|
|
355
|
|
|
|
4.8
|
|
|
|
353
|
|
|
|
4.8
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
1,987
|
|
|
|
6.6
|
|
|
|
2,021
|
|
|
|
7.1
|
|
|
|
2,215
|
|
|
|
8.2
|
|
|
|
516
|
|
|
|
6.8
|
|
|
|
471
|
|
|
|
6.3
|
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(97
|
)
|
|
|
(0.3
|
)
|
|
|
(471
|
)
|
|
|
(1.8
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
|
|
0.1
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
0.1
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
|
|
0.2
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
0.1
|
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
0.2
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
0.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
28,050
|
|
|
|
93.3
|
|
|
|
27,204
|
|
|
|
95.9
|
|
|
|
25,460
|
|
|
|
94.8
|
|
|
|
6,859
|
|
|
|
90.9
|
|
|
|
6,812
|
|
|
|
91.7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
2,002
|
|
|
|
6.7
|
|
|
|
1,170
|
|
|
|
4.1
|
|
|
|
1,398
|
|
|
|
5.2
|
|
|
|
685
|
|
|
|
9.1
|
|
|
|
619
|
|
|
|
8.3
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
627
|
|
|
|
2.1
|
|
|
|
268
|
|
|
|
0.9
|
|
|
|
316
|
|
|
|
1.1
|
|
|
|
209
|
|
|
|
2.8
|
|
|
|
187
|
|
|
|
2.5
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
1,375
|
|
|
|
4.6
|
|
|
|
902
|
|
|
|
3.2
|
|
|
|
1,082
|
|
|
|
4.1
|
|
|
|
476
|
|
|
|
6.3
|
|
|
|
432
|
|
|
|
5.8
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
321
|
|
|
|
1.1
|
|
|
|
229
|
|
|
|
0.8
|
|
|
|
208
|
|
|
|
0.8
|
|
|
|
88
|
|
|
|
1.1
|
|
|
|
72
|
|
|
|
1.0
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
1,054
|
|
|
|
3.5
|
|
|
$
|
673
|
|
|
|
2.4
|
|
|
$
|
874
|
|
|
|
3.3
|
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
|
5.2
|
|
|
$
|
360
|
|
|
|
4.8
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
% changes from prior year:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
|
5.9
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5.6
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5.4
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.5
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.3
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
71.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(16.3
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(25.0
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
80.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
|
56.7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(23.0
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(15.7
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
111.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
Admissions(a)
|
|
|
1.0
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(0.7
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3.6
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
0.7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1.4
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Equivalent admissions(b)
|
|
|
3.2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
0.5
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2.7
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
0.9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.5
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue per equivalent admission
|
|
|
2.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5.2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8.3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
0.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.8
|
|
|
|
|
|
Same facility % changes from prior year(c):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
|
6.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7.0
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7.4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.5
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
Admissions(a)
|
|
|
1.2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
0.9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1.3
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
0.9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(0.9
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Equivalent admissions(b)
|
|
|
3.4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(0.7
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1.9
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue per equivalent admission
|
|
|
2.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8.1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
0.4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(a) |
|
Represents the total number of patients admitted to our
hospitals and is used by management and certain investors as a
general measure of inpatient volume. |
|
(b) |
|
Equivalent admissions are used by management and certain
investors as a general measure of combined inpatient and
outpatient volume. Equivalent admissions are computed by
multiplying admissions (inpatient volume) by the sum of gross
inpatient revenue and gross outpatient revenue and then dividing
the resulting amount by gross inpatient revenue. The equivalent
admissions computation equates outpatient revenue to
the volume measure (admissions) used to measure inpatient
volume, resulting in a general measure of combined inpatient and
outpatient volume. |
|
(c) |
|
Same facility information excludes the operations of hospitals
and their related facilities that were either acquired, divested
or removed from service during the current and prior year. |
50
Supplemental
Non-GAAP Disclosures
Operating Measures on a Cash Revenues Basis
(Dollars in millions)
The results from operations presented on a cash revenues basis
for the quarters ended March 31, 2010 and 2009 follow:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-GAAP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-GAAP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
% of Cash
|
|
|
GAAP % of
|
|
|
|
|
|
% of Cash
|
|
|
GAAP % of
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Ratios(b)
|
|
|
Ratios(b)
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Ratios(b)
|
|
|
Ratios(b)
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
7,544
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
100.0
|
|
|
$
|
7,431
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
100.0
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
564
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
807
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash revenues(a)
|
|
|
6,980
|
|
|
|
100.0
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,624
|
|
|
|
100.0
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
3,072
|
|
|
|
44.0
|
|
|
|
40.7
|
|
|
|
2,923
|
|
|
|
44.1
|
|
|
|
39.3
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
1,200
|
|
|
|
17.2
|
|
|
|
15.9
|
|
|
|
1,210
|
|
|
|
18.3
|
|
|
|
16.3
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
1,202
|
|
|
|
17.3
|
|
|
|
15.9
|
|
|
|
1,102
|
|
|
|
16.6
|
|
|
|
14.8
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
% changes from prior year:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
|
1.5
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash revenues
|
|
|
5.4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Revenue per equivalent admission
|
|
|
0.6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash revenue per equivalent admission
|
|
|
4.5
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(a) |
|
Cash revenues is defined as reported revenues less the provision
for doubtful accounts. We use cash revenues as an analytical
indicator for purposes of assessing the effect of uninsured
patient volumes, adjusted for the effect of both the revenue
deductions related to uninsured accounts (charity care and
uninsured discounts) and the provision for doubtful accounts
(which relates primarily to uninsured accounts), on our revenues
and certain operating expenses, as a percentage of cash
revenues. Variations in the revenue deductions related to
uninsured accounts generally have the inverse effect on the
provision for doubtful accounts. We increased our uninsured
discount percentages during August 2009 and the resulting
effects, for the first quarter of 2010, were an increase in
uninsured discounts of $418 million and a decline in the
provision for doubtful accounts of $243 million, compared
to the first quarter of 2009. Cash revenues is commonly used as
an analytical indicator within the health care industry. Cash
revenues should not be considered as a measure of financial
performance under generally accepted accounting principles.
Because cash revenues is not a measurement determined in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and is
thus susceptible to varying calculations, cash revenues, as
presented, may not be comparable to other similarly titled
measures of other health care companies. |
|
(b) |
|
Salaries and benefits, supplies and other operating expenses, as
a percentage of cash revenues (a non-GAAP financial measure),
present the impact on these ratios due to the adjustment of
deducting the provision for doubtful accounts from reported
revenues and results in these ratios being non-GAAP financial
measures. We believe these non-GAAP financial measures are
useful to investors to provide disclosures of our results of
operations on the same basis as that used by management.
Management uses this information to compare certain operating
expense categories as a percentage of cash revenues. Management
finds this information useful to evaluate certain expense
category trends without the influence of whether adjustments
related to revenues for uninsured accounts are recorded as
revenue adjustments (charity care and uninsured discounts) or
operating expenses (provision for doubtful accounts), and thus
the expense category trends are generally analyzed as a
percentage of cash revenues. These non-GAAP financial measures
should not be considered alternatives to GAAP financial
measures. We believe this supplemental information provides
management and the users of our financial statements with useful
information for
period-to-period
comparisons. Investors are encouraged to use GAAP measures when
evaluating our overall financial performance. |
51
Three
Months Ended March 31, 2010 and 2009
Net income attributable to HCA Inc. totaled $388 million
for the first quarter of 2010 compared to $360 million for
the first quarter of 2009. Revenues increased 1.5% due to the
combined impact of revenue per equivalent admission growth of
0.6% and an increase of 0.9% in equivalent admissions for the
first quarter of 2010 compared to the first quarter of 2009.
Cash revenues (reported revenues less the provision for doubtful
accounts) increased 5.4% for the first quarter of 2010 compared
to the first quarter of 2009.
For the first quarter of 2010, consolidated admissions and same
facility admissions increased 0.7% and 0.9%, respectively,
compared to the first quarter of 2009. Outpatient surgical
volumes declined 1.9% on a consolidated basis and declined 1.8%
on a same facility basis during the first quarter of 2010,
compared to the first quarter of 2009. Consolidated inpatient
surgeries declined 0.1% and same facility inpatient surgeries
declined 0.4% in the first quarter of 2010, compared to the
first quarter of 2009. Emergency department visits increased
0.5% on a consolidated basis and increased 1.0% on a same
facility basis during the quarter ended March 31, 2010,
compared to the quarter ended March 31, 2009.
Salaries and benefits, as a percentage of revenues, were 40.7%
in the first quarter of 2010 and 39.3% in the first quarter of
2009. Salaries and benefits, as a percentage of cash revenues,
were 44.0% in the first quarter of 2010 and 44.1% in the first
quarter of 2009. Salaries and benefits per equivalent admission
increased 4.2% in the first quarter of 2010 compared to the
first quarter of 2009. Same facility labor rate increases
averaged 2.7% for the first quarter of 2010 compared to the
first quarter of 2009.
Supplies, as a percentage of revenues, were 15.9% in the first
quarter of 2010 and 16.3% in the first quarter of 2009.
Supplies, as a percentage of cash revenues, were 17.2% in the
first quarter of 2010 and 18.3% in the first quarter of 2009.
Supply cost per equivalent admission declined 1.7% in the first
quarter of 2010 compared to the first quarter of 2009. Supply
costs per equivalent admission increased 3.0% for medical
devices, 4.3% for blood products and 4.8% for general medical
and surgical items and declined 7.2% for pharmacy supplies in
the first quarter of 2010 compared to the first quarter of 2009.
Other operating expenses, as a percentage of revenues, increased
to 15.9% in the first quarter of 2010 compared to 14.8% in the
first quarter of 2009. Other operating expenses, as a percentage
of cash revenues, increased to 17.3% in the first quarter of
2010 compared to 16.6% in the first quarter of 2009. Other
operating expenses is primarily comprised of contract services,
professional fees, repairs and maintenance, rents and leases,
utilities, insurance (including professional liability
insurance) and nonincome taxes. Other operating expenses include
$90 million and $39 million of indigent care costs in
certain Texas markets during the first quarters of 2010 and
2009, respectively, and this increase is the primary component
of the overall increase in other operating expenses. Provisions
for losses related to professional liability risks were
$56 million and $45 million for the first quarters of
2010 and 2009, respectively.
Provision for doubtful accounts declined $243 million, from
$807 million in the first quarter of 2009 to
$564 million in the first quarter of 2010, and as a
percentage of revenues, declined to 7.5% in the first quarter of
2010 compared to 10.9% in the first quarter of 2009. The
provision for doubtful accounts and the allowance for doubtful
accounts relate primarily to uninsured amounts due directly from
patients. The combined self-pay revenue deductions for charity
care and uninsured discounts increased $473 million during
the first quarter of 2010, compared to the first quarter of
2009. The sum of the provision for doubtful accounts, uninsured
discounts and charity care, as a percentage of the sum of
revenues, uninsured discounts and charity care, was 23.5% for
the first quarter of 2010, compared to 22.4% for the first
quarter of 2009. To quantify the total impact of and trends
related to uninsured accounts, we believe it is beneficial to
review the related revenue deductions and the provision for
doubtful accounts in combination, rather than separately. At
March 31, 2010, our allowance for doubtful accounts
represented approximately 94% of the $4.833 billion total
patient due accounts receivable balance. The patient due
accounts receivable balance represents the estimated uninsured
portion of our accounts receivable.
Equity in earnings of affiliates was $68 million in each of
the first quarters of 2010 and 2009. Equity in earnings of
affiliates relates primarily to our Denver, Colorado market
joint venture.
52
Depreciation and amortization increased $2 million, from
$353 million in the first quarter of 2009 to
$355 million in the first quarter of 2010.
Interest expense increased from $471 million in the first
quarter of 2009 to $516 million in the first quarter of
2010 primarily due to an increase in the average effective
interest rate. Our average debt balance was $26.314 billion
for the first quarter of 2010 compared to $26.794 billion
for the first quarter of 2009. The average effective interest
rate for our long term debt increased from 7.1% for the quarter
ended March 31, 2009 to 8.0% for the quarter ended
March 31, 2010.
During the first quarter of 2010, no gains or losses on sales of
facilities were recognized. During the first quarter of 2009, we
recorded a net loss on sales of facilities and other investments
of $5 million.
During the first quarter of 2010, we recorded asset impairment
charges of $18 million to adjust the values of real estate
and other investments to estimated fair value. During the first
quarter of 2009, we recorded an asset impairment charge of
$9 million to adjust the value of certain real estate
investments to estimated fair value.
The effective tax rate was 35.0% and 34.1% for the first
quarters of 2010 and 2009, respectively. The effective tax rate
computations exclude net income attributable to noncontrolling
interests as it relates to consolidated partnerships.
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests increased
from $72 million for the first quarter of 2009 to
$88 million for the first quarter of 2010. The increase in
net income attributable to noncontrolling interests related
primarily to growth in operating results of hospital joint
ventures in two Texas markets.
Years
Ended December 31, 2009 and 2008
Net income attributable to HCA Inc. totaled $1.054 billion
for the year ended December 31, 2009 compared to
$673 million for the year ended December 31, 2008.
Financial results for 2009 include losses on sales of facilities
of $15 million and asset impairment charges of
$43 million. Financial results for 2008 include gains on
sales of facilities of $97 million and asset impairment
charges of $64 million.
Revenues increased 5.9% to $30.052 billion for 2009 from
$28.374 billion for 2008. The increase in revenues was due
primarily to the combined impact of a 2.6% increase in revenue
per equivalent admission and a 3.2% increase in equivalent
admissions compared to 2008. Same facility revenues increased
6.1% due primarily to the combined impact of a 2.6% increase in
same facility revenue per equivalent admission and a 3.4%
increase in same facility equivalent admissions compared to 2008.
During 2009, consolidated admissions increased 1.0% and same
facility admissions increased 1.2% for 2009, compared to 2008.
Consolidated inpatient surgical volumes increased 0.3%, and same
facility inpatient surgeries increased 0.5% during 2009 compared
to 2008. Consolidated outpatient surgical volumes declined 0.4%,
and same facility outpatient surgeries declined 0.1% during 2009
compared to 2008. Emergency department visits increased 6.6% on
a consolidated basis and increased 7.0% on a same facility basis
during 2009 compared to 2008.
Salaries and benefits, as a percentage of revenues, were 39.8%
in 2009 and 40.3% in 2008. Salaries and benefits per equivalent
admission increased 1.3% in 2009 compared to 2008. Same facility
labor rate increases averaged 3.7% for 2009 compared to 2008.
Supplies, as a percentage of revenues, were 16.2% in 2009 and
16.3% in 2008. Supply costs per equivalent admission increased
2.1% in 2009 compared to 2008. Same facility supply costs
increased 5.9% for medical devices, 4.0% for pharmacy supplies,
7.1% for blood products and 7.0% for general medical and
surgical items in 2009 compared to 2008.
Other operating expenses, as a percentage of revenues, declined
to 15.7% in 2009 from 16.1% in 2008. Other operating expenses
are primarily comprised of contract services, professional fees,
repairs and maintenance, rents and leases, utilities, insurance
(including professional liability insurance) and nonincome
taxes. The overall decline in other operating expenses, as a
percentage of revenues, is comprised of relatively small
53
reductions in several areas, including utilities, employee
recruitment and travel and entertainment. Other operating
expenses include $248 million and $144 million of
indigent care costs in certain Texas markets during 2009 and
2008, respectively. Provisions for losses related to
professional liability risks were $211 million and
$175 million for 2009 and 2008, respectively.
Provision for doubtful accounts declined $133 million, from
$3.409 billion in 2008 to $3.276 billion in 2009, and
as a percentage of revenues, declined to 10.9% for 2009 from
12.0% in 2008. The provision for doubtful accounts and the
allowance for doubtful accounts relate primarily to uninsured
amounts due directly from patients. The decline in the provision
for doubtful accounts can be attributed to the
$1.486 billion increase in the combined self-pay revenue
deductions for charity care and uninsured discounts during 2009,
compared to 2008. The sum of the provision for doubtful
accounts, uninsured discounts and charity care, as a percentage
of the sum of net revenues, uninsured discounts and charity
care, was 23.8% for 2009, compared to 21.9% for 2008. At
December 31, 2009, our allowance for doubtful accounts
represented approximately 94% of the $5.176 billion total
patient due accounts receivable balance, including accounts, net
of estimated contractual discounts, related to patients for
which eligibility for Medicaid coverage or uninsured discounts
was being evaluated.
Equity in earnings of affiliates increased from
$223 million for 2008 to $246 million for 2009. Equity
in earnings of affiliates relates primarily to our Denver,
Colorado market joint venture.
Depreciation and amortization decreased, as a percentage of
revenues, to 4.8% in 2009 from 5.0% in 2008. Depreciation
expense was $1.419 billion for 2009 and $1.412 billion
for 2008.
Interest expense decreased to $1.987 billion for 2009 from
$2.021 billion for 2008. The decrease in interest expense
was due to reductions in the average debt balance. Our average
debt balance was $26.267 billion for 2009 compared to
$27.211 billion for 2008. The average interest rate for our
long-term debt increased from 7.4% for 2008 to 7.6% for 2009.
Net losses on sales of facilities were $15 million for 2009
and included $8 million of net losses on the sales of three
hospital facilities and $7 million of net losses on sales
of real estate and other health care entity investments. Gains
on sales of facilities were $97 million for 2008 and
included $81 million of gains on the sales of two hospital
facilities and $16 million of net gains on sales of real
estate and other health care entity investments.
Impairments of long-lived assets were $43 million for 2009
and included $19 million related to goodwill and
$24 million related to property and equipment. Impairments
of long-lived assets were $64 million for 2008 and included
$48 million related to goodwill and $16 million
related to property and equipment.
The effective tax rate was 37.3% and 28.5% for 2009 and 2008,
respectively. The effective tax rate computations exclude net
income attributable to noncontrolling interests as it relates to
consolidated partnerships. Primarily as a result of reaching a
settlement with the IRS Appeals Division and the revision of the
amount of a proposed IRS adjustment related to prior taxable
periods, we reduced our provision for income taxes by
$69 million in 2008. Excluding the effect of these
adjustments, the effective tax rate for 2008 would have been
35.8%.
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests increased
from $229 million for 2008 to $321 million for 2009.
The increase in net income attributable to noncontrolling
interests related primarily to growth in operating results of
hospital joint ventures in two Texas markets.
Years
Ended December 31, 2008 and 2007
Net income attributable to HCA Inc. totaled $673 million
for the year ended December 31, 2008 compared to
$874 million for the year ended December 31, 2007.
Financial results for 2008 include gains on sales of facilities
of $97 million and asset impairment charges of
$64 million. Financial results for 2007 include gains on
sales of facilities of $471 million and an asset impairment
charge of $24 million.
Revenues increased 5.6% to $28.374 billion for 2008 from
$26.858 billion for 2007. The increase in revenues was due
primarily to the combined impact of a 5.2% increase in revenue
per equivalent admission
54
and a 0.5% increase in equivalent admissions compared to 2007.
Same facility revenues increased 7.0% due primarily to the
combined impact of a 5.1% increase in same facility revenue per
equivalent admission and a 1.9% increase in same facility
equivalent admissions compared to 2007.
During 2008, consolidated admissions declined 0.7% and same
facility admissions increased 0.9%, compared to 2007. Inpatient
surgical volumes declined 4.5% on a consolidated basis and same
facility inpatient surgeries declined 0.5% during 2008 compared
to 2007. Outpatient surgical volumes declined 0.9% on a
consolidated basis and same facility outpatient surgeries
declined 0.2% during 2008 compared to 2007. Emergency department
visits increased 2.5% on a consolidated basis and increased 3.6%
on a same facility basis during 2008 compared to 2007.
Salaries and benefits, as a percentage of revenues, were 40.3%
in 2008 and 39.9% in 2007. Salaries and benefits per equivalent
admission increased 6.3% in 2008 compared to 2007. Same facility
labor rate increases averaged 5.1% for 2008 compared to 2007.
Supplies, as a percentage of revenues, were 16.3% in 2008 and
16.4% in 2007. Supply costs per equivalent admission increased
4.5% in 2008 compared to 2007. Same facility supply costs
increased 8.0% for medical devices, 2.8% for pharmacy supplies,
18.7% for blood products and 6.6% for general medical and
surgical items in 2008 compared to 2007.
Other operating expenses, as a percentage of revenues, increased
to 16.1% in 2008 from 15.7% in 2007. Other operating expenses
are primarily comprised of contract services, professional fees,
repairs and maintenance, rents and leases, utilities, insurance
(including professional liability insurance) and nonincome
taxes. Increases in professional fees paid to hospitalists,
emergency room physicians and anesthesiologists represented
20 basis points of the 2008 increase in other operating
expenses. Other operating expenses include $144 million and
$187 million of indigent care costs in certain Texas
markets during 2008 and 2007, respectively. Provisions for
losses related to professional liability risks were
$175 million and $163 million for 2008 and 2007,
respectively.
Provision for doubtful accounts, as a percentage of revenues,
increased to 12.0% for 2008 from 11.7% in 2007. The provision
for doubtful accounts and the allowance for doubtful accounts
relate primarily to uninsured amounts due directly from
patients. The increase in the provision for doubtful accounts,
as a percentage of revenues, can be attributed to an increasing
amount of patient financial responsibility under certain managed
care plans and same facility increases in uninsured emergency
room visits of 4.5% and uninsured admissions of 1.7% in 2008
compared to 2007. At December 31, 2008, our allowance for
doubtful accounts represented approximately 92% of the
$5.148 billion total patient due accounts receivable
balance, including accounts, net of estimated contractual
discounts, related to patients for which eligibility for
Medicaid coverage or uninsured discounts was being evaluated.
Equity in earnings of affiliates increased from
$206 million for 2007 to $223 million for 2008. Equity
in earnings of affiliates relates primarily to our Denver,
Colorado market joint venture.
Depreciation and amortization declined, as a percentage of
revenues, to 5.0% in 2008 from 5.4% in 2007. Depreciation
expense was $1.412 billion for 2008 and $1.421 billion
for 2007.
Interest expense declined to $2.021 billion for 2008 from
$2.215 billion for 2007. The decline in interest expense
was due to reductions in both the average debt balance and the
average interest rate on long-term debt. Our average debt
balance was $27.211 billion for 2008 compared to
$27.732 billion for 2007. The average interest rate for our
long-term debt declined from 8.0% for 2007 to 7.4% for 2008.
Gains on sales of facilities were $97 million for 2008 and
included $81 million of net gains on the sales of two
hospital facilities and $16 million of net gains on sales
of real estate and other health care entity investments. Gains
on sales of facilities were $471 million for 2007 and
included a $312 million gain on the sale of our two
Switzerland hospitals, a $131 million gain on the sale of a
facility in Florida and $28 million of net gains on sales
of real estate and other health care entity investments.
55
Impairments of long-lived assets were $64 million for 2008
and included $48 million related to goodwill and
$16 million related to property and equipment. The
$24 million asset impairment for 2007 related to property
and equipment.
The effective tax rate was 28.5% for 2008 and 26.6% for 2007,
respectively. The effective tax rate computations exclude net
income attributable to noncontrolling interests as it relates to
consolidated partnerships. Primarily as a result of reaching a
settlement with the IRS Appeals Division and the revision of the
amount of a proposed IRS adjustment related to prior taxable
periods, we reduced our provision for income taxes by
$69 million in 2008. Our 2007 provision for income taxes
was reduced by $85 million, principally based on receiving
new information related to tax positions taken in a prior
taxable year, and by an additional $39 million to adjust
2006 state tax accruals to the amounts reported on
completed tax returns and based upon an analysis of the
Recapitalization costs. Excluding the effect of these
adjustments, the effective tax rates for 2008 and 2007 would
have been 35.8% and 37.0%, respectively.
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests increased
from $208 million for 2007 to $229 million for 2008.
The increase relates primarily to our Austin, Texas market
partnership and our group purchasing organization.
Liquidity
and Capital Resources
Our primary cash requirements are paying our operating expenses,
servicing our debt, capital expenditures on our existing
properties, acquisitions of hospitals and other health care
entities and distributions to noncontrolling interests. Our
primary cash sources are cash flow from operating activities,
issuances of debt and equity securities and dispositions of
hospitals and other health care entities.
Cash provided by operating activities totaled $901 million
for the quarter ended March 31, 2010 compared to
$615 million for the quarter ended March 31, 2009. The
$286 million increase in cash provided by operating
activities in the first quarter of 2010 compared to the first
quarter of 2009 related primarily to a $239 million
decrease in income taxes and a $44 million increase in net
income. Working capital totaled $2.167 billion at
March 31, 2010. Cash provided by operating activities
totaled $2.747 billion in 2009 compared to
$1.990 billion in 2008 and $1.564 billion in 2007.
Working capital totaled $2.264 billion at December 31,
2009 and $2.391 billion at December 31, 2008. The
$757 million increase in cash provided by operating
activities for 2009, compared to 2008, related primarily to the
$473 million increase in net income and $143 million
improvement from changes in operating assets and liabilities and
the provision for doubtful accounts. The $426 million
increase in cash provided by operating activities for 2008,
compared to 2007, relates primarily to changes in working
capital items. The changes in accounts receivable (net of the
provision for doubtful accounts), inventories and other assets,
and accounts payable and accrued expenses contributed
$42 million to cash provided by operating activities for
2008 while changes in these items decreased cash provided by
operating activities by $485 million for 2007. The net
impact of the cash payments for interest and income taxes was an
increase in cash payments of $203 million for 2009 compared
to 2008 and an increase of $111 million for 2008 compared
to 2007.
Cash used in investing activities was $181 million for the
quarter ended March 31, 2010 compared to $288 million
for the quarter ended March 31, 2009. Excluding
acquisitions, capital expenditures were $214 million in the
first quarter of 2010 and $337 million in the first quarter
of 2009. Cash used in investing activities was
$1.035 billion, $1.467 billion and $479 million
in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Excluding acquisitions,
capital expenditures were $1.317 billion in 2009,
$1.600 billion in 2008 and $1.444 billion in 2007. We
expended $61 million, $85 million and $32 million
for acquisitions of hospitals and health care entities during
2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Expenditures for acquisitions
in all three years were generally comprised of outpatient and
ancillary services entities and were funded by a combination of
cash flows from operations and the issuance or incurrence of
debt. Planned capital expenditures are expected to approximate
$1.5 billion in 2010. At March 31, 2010, there were
projects under construction which had an estimated additional
cost to complete and equip over the next five years of
$1.230 billion. We expect to finance capital expenditures
with internally generated and borrowed funds.
56
During 2009, we received cash proceeds of $41 million from
dispositions of three hospitals and sales of other health care
entities and real estate investments. We also received net cash
proceeds of $303 million related to net changes in our
investments. During 2008, we received cash proceeds of
$143 million from dispositions of two hospitals and
$50 million from sales of other health care entities and
real estate investments. During 2007, we sold three hospitals
for cash proceeds of $661 million, and we also received
cash proceeds of $106 million related primarily to the
sales of real estate investments and $207 million related
to net changes in our investments.
Cash used in financing activities totaled $644 million for
the quarter ended March 31, 2010 compared to
$436 million for the quarter ended March 31, 2009.
During the first quarter of 2010, cash flows used in financing
activities included payment of a cash distribution to
stockholders of $1.751 billion, increases in net borrowings
of $1.216 billion, payments of debt issuance costs of
$25 million and distributions to noncontrolling interests
of $83 million. During the first quarter of 2009, cash
flows used in financing activities included reductions in net
borrowings of $374 million, payments of debt issuance costs
of $14 million and distributions to noncontrolling
interests of $55 million. Cash used in financing activities
totaled $1.865 billion in 2009, $451 million in 2008
and $1.326 billion in 2007. During 2009, 2008 and 2007, we
used cash proceeds from sales of facilities and available cash
provided by operations to make net debt repayments of
$1.459 billion, $260 million and $1.270 billion,
respectively. During 2009, 2008 and 2007, we made distributions
to noncontrolling interests of $330 million,
$178 million and $152 million, respectively. We also
paid debt issuance costs of $70 million for 2009. We or our
affiliates, including affiliates of the Sponsors, may in the
future repurchase portions of our debt securities, subject to
certain limitations, from time to time in either the open market
or through privately negotiated transactions, in accordance with
applicable SEC and other legal requirements. The timing, prices,
and sizes of purchases depend upon prevailing trading prices,
general economic and market conditions, and other factors,
including applicable securities laws. Funds for the repurchase
of debt securities have, and are expected to, come primarily
from cash generated from operations and borrowed funds.
In addition to cash flows from operations, available sources of
capital include amounts available under our senior secured
credit facilities ($1.851 billion as of March 31, 2010
and $3.181 billion as of December 31, 2009) and
anticipated access to public and private debt markets.
On January 27, 2010, our Board of Directors declared a
distribution to the Companys stockholders and holders of
vested stock options. The distribution was $17.50 per share and
vested stock option, or $1.751 billion in the aggregate.
The distribution was paid on February 5, 2010 to holders of
record on February 1, 2010. The distribution was funded
using funds available under our existing senior secured credit
facilities and approximately $100 million of cash on hand.
On May 5, 2010, our Board of Directors declared a
distribution to the Companys existing stockholders and
holders of vested options. The distribution will be $5.00 per
share and vested stock option, or approximately
$500 million in the aggregate. The distribution is expected
to be paid on May 14, 2010 to holders of record on
May 6, 2010. The distribution is expected to be funded
using funds available under our senior secured credit facilities.
Investments of our professional liability insurance subsidiary,
to maintain statutory equity and pay claims, totaled
$1.303 billion, $1.316 billion and $1.622 billion
at March 31, 2010, December 31, 2009 and 2008,
respectively. The insurance subsidiary maintained net reserves
for professional liability risks of $588 million,
$590 million and $782 million at March 31, 2010,
December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. Our facilities
are insured by our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary for losses
up to $50 million per occurrence; however, since January
2007, this coverage is subject to a $5 million per
occurrence self-insured retention. Net reserves for the
self-insured professional liability risks retained were
$698 million, $679 million and $548 million at
March 31, 2010, December 31, 2009 and 2008,
respectively. At March 31, 2010, claims payments, net of
reinsurance recoveries, during the next 12 months are
expected to approximate $250 million. We estimate that
approximately $100 million of the expected net claim
payments during the next 12 months will relate to claims
subject to the self-insured retention.
57
Financing
Activities
We are a highly leveraged company with significant debt service
requirements. Our debt totaled $26.855 billion,
$25.670 billion and $26.989 billion at March 31,
2010, December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively. Our
interest expense was $516 million and $471 million for
the three months ended March 31, 2010 and March 31,
2009, respectively, and $1.987 billion for 2009 and
$2.021 billion for 2008.
During February 2009, we issued $310 million aggregate
principal amount of
97/8% senior
secured second lien notes due 2017 at a price of 96.673% of
their face value, resulting in $300 million of gross
proceeds. During April 2009, we issued $1.500 billion
aggregate principal amount of
81/2% senior
secured first lien notes due 2019 at a price of 96.755% of their
face value, resulting in $1.451 billion of gross proceeds.
During August 2009, we issued $1.250 billion aggregate
principal amount of
77/8% senior
secured first lien notes due 2020 at a price of 98.254% of their
face value, resulting in $1.228 billion of gross proceeds.
During March 2010, we issued $1.400 billion aggregate
principal amount of
71/4%
senior secured first lien notes due 2020 at a price of 99.095%
of their face value, resulting in $1.387 billion of gross
proceeds. After the payment of related fees and expenses, we
used the proceeds from these debt offerings to repay outstanding
indebtedness under our senior secured term loan facilities.
On April 6, 2010 we amended our cash flow credit facility
to (i) extend the maturity date for $2.0 billion of
our tranche B term loans from November 17, 2013 to
March 31, 2017 and (ii) increase the ABR margin and
LIBOR margin with respect to such extended term loans to 2.25%
and 3.25%, respectively.
Management believes that cash flows from operations, amounts
available under our senior secured credit facilities and our
anticipated access to public and private debt markets will be
sufficient to meet expected liquidity needs during the next
twelve months.
Contractual
Obligations and Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
As of December 31, 2009, maturities of contractual
obligations and other commercial commitments are presented in
the table below (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payments Due by Period
|
|
Contractual Obligations(a)
|
|
Total
|
|
|
Current
|
|
|
2-3 Years
|
|
|
4-5 Years
|
|
|
After 5 Years
|
|
|
Long-term debt including interest, excluding the senior secured
credit facilities(b)
|
|
$
|
26,739
|
|
|
$
|
2,175
|
|
|
$
|
3,780
|
|
|
$
|
4,915
|
|
|
$
|
15,869
|
|
Loans outstanding under the senior secured credit facilities,
including interest(b)
|
|
|
11,786
|
|
|
|
649
|
|
|
|
3,565
|
|
|
|
7,410
|
|
|
|
162
|
|
Operating leases(c)
|
|
|
1,190
|
|
|
|
226
|
|
|
|
355
|
|
|
|
223
|
|
|
|
386
|
|
Purchase and other obligations(c)
|
|
|
196
|
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
33
|
|
|
|
30
|
|
|
|
90
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total contractual obligations
|
|
$
|
39,911
|
|
|
$
|
3,093
|
|
|
$
|
7,733
|
|
|
$
|
12,578
|
|
|
$
|
16,507
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other Commercial Commitments Not Recorded on the
|
|
Commitment Expiration by Period
|
|
Consolidated Balance Sheet
|
|
Total
|
|
|
Current
|
|
|
2-3 Years
|
|
|
4-5 Years
|
|
|
After 5 Years
|
|
|
Surety bonds(d)
|
|
$
|
106
|
|
|
$
|
105
|
|
|
$
|
1
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Letters of credit(e)
|
|
|
100
|
|
|
|
23
|
|
|
|
44
|
|
|
|
33
|
|
|
|
|
|
Physician commitments(f)
|
|
|
40
|
|
|
|
30
|
|
|
|
10
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Guarantees(g)
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total commercial commitments
|
|
$
|
248
|
|
|
$
|
158
|
|
|
$
|
55
|
|
|
$
|
33
|
|
|
$
|
2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(a) |
|
We have not included obligations to pay estimated professional
liability claims ($1.322 billion at December 31,
2009) in this table. The estimated professional liability
claims, which occurred prior to 2007, are expected to be funded
by the designated investment securities that are restricted for
this purpose ($1.316 billion at December 31, 2009). We
also have not included obligations related to unrecognized tax |
58
|
|
|
|
|
benefits of $628 million at December 31, 2009, as we
cannot reasonably estimate the timing or amounts of additional
cash payments, if any, at this time. |
|
(b) |
|
Estimates of interest payments assumes that interest rates,
borrowing spreads and foreign currency exchange rates at
December 31, 2009, remain constant during the period
presented. |
|
(c) |
|
Amounts relate to future operating lease obligations, purchase
obligations and other obligations and are not recorded in our
consolidated balance sheet. Amounts also include physician
commitments that are recorded in our consolidated balance sheet. |
|
(d) |
|
Amounts relate primarily to instances in which we have agreed to
indemnify various commercial insurers who have provided surety
bonds to cover damages for malpractice cases which were awarded
to plaintiffs by the courts. These cases are currently under
appeal and the bonds will not be released by the courts until
the cases are closed. |
|
(e) |
|
Amounts relate primarily to various employee benefit plan
obligations in which we have letters of credit outstanding. |
|
(f) |
|
In consideration for physicians relocating to the communities in
which our hospitals are located and agreeing to engage in
private practice for the benefit of the respective communities,
we make advances to physicians, normally over a period of one
year, to assist in establishing the physicians practices.
The actual amount of these commitments to be advanced often
depends upon the financial results of the physicians
private practices during the recruitment agreement payment
period. The physician commitments reflected were based on our
maximum exposure on effective agreements at December 31,
2009. |
|
(g) |
|
We have entered into guarantee agreements related to certain
leases. |
Market
Risk
We are exposed to market risk related to changes in market
values of securities. The investments in debt and equity
securities of our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary were
$1.296 billion and $7 million, respectively, at
March 31, 2010. These investments are carried at fair
value, with changes in unrealized gains and losses being
recorded as adjustments to other comprehensive income. At
March 31, 2010, we had a net unrealized gain of
$22 million on the insurance subsidiarys investment
securities.
We are exposed to market risk related to market illiquidity.
Liquidity of the investments in debt and equity securities of
our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary could be impaired by the
inability to access the capital markets. Should the wholly-owned
insurance subsidiary require significant amounts of cash in
excess of normal cash requirements to pay claims and other
expenses on short notice, we may have difficulty selling these
investments in a timely manner or be forced to sell them at a
price less than what we might otherwise have been able to in a
normal market environment. At March 31, 2010, our
wholly-owned insurance subsidiary had invested $333 million
($336 million par value) in municipal, tax-exempt student
loan auction rate securities (ARS) that continue to
experience market illiquidity since February 2008 when multiple
failed auctions occurred due to a severe credit and liquidity
crisis in the capital markets. It is uncertain if
auction-related market liquidity will resume for these
securities. We may be required to recognize
other-than-temporary
impairments on these investments in future periods should
issuers default on interest payments or should the fair market
valuations of the securities deteriorate due to ratings
downgrades or other issue specific factors.
We are also exposed to market risk related to changes in
interest rates, and we periodically enter into interest rate
swap agreements to manage our exposure to these fluctuations.
Our interest rate swap agreements involve the exchange of fixed
and variable rate interest payments between two parties, based
on common notional principal amounts and maturity dates. The
notional amounts of the swap agreements represent balances used
to calculate the exchange of cash flows and are not our assets
or liabilities. Our credit risk related to these agreements is
considered low because the swap agreements are with creditworthy
financial institutions. The interest payments under these
agreements are settled on a net basis. These derivatives have
been recognized in the financial statements at their respective
fair values. Changes in the fair value of these derivatives are
included in other comprehensive income, and changes in the fair
value of derivatives which have not been designated as hedges
are recorded in operations.
59
With respect to our interest-bearing liabilities, approximately
$2.550 billion of long-term debt at March 31, 2010 is
subject to variable rates of interest, while the remaining
balance in long-term debt of $24.305 billion at
March 31, 2010 is subject to fixed rates of interest. Both
the general level of interest rates and, for the senior secured
credit facilities, our leverage affect our variable interest
rates. Our variable rate debt is comprised primarily of amounts
outstanding under the senior secured credit facilities.
Borrowings under the senior secured credit facilities bear
interest at a rate equal to an applicable margin plus, at our
option, either (a) a base rate determined by reference to
the higher of (1) the federal funds rate plus 0.50% and
(2) the prime rate of Bank of America or (b) a LIBOR
rate for the currency of such borrowing for the relevant
interest period. The applicable margin for borrowings under the
senior secured credit facilities, with the exception of term
loan B where the margin is static, may be reduced subject to
attaining certain leverage ratios. The average effective
interest rate for our long-term debt increased from 7.1% for the
quarter ended March 31, 2009 to 8.0% for the quarter ended
March 31, 2010.
On March 2, 2009, we amended our $13.550 billion and
1.000 billion senior secured cash flow credit
facility, dated as of November 17, 2006, as amended
February 16, 2007 (the cash flow credit
facility), to allow for one or more future issuances of
additional secured notes, which may include notes that are
secured on a pari passu basis or on a junior basis with
the obligations under the cash flow credit facility, so long as
(1) such notes do not require any scheduled payment or
redemption prior to the scheduled term loan B final maturity
date as currently in effect and (2) the proceeds from any
such issuance are used within three business days of receipt to
prepay term loans under the cash flow credit facility in
accordance with the terms of the cash flow credit facility. The
U.S. security documents related to the cash flow credit
facility were also amended and restated in connection with the
amendment in order to give effect to the security interests
granted to holders of such additional secured notes. On
June 18, 2009, we further amended our cash flow credit
facility to permit the unlimited incurrence of new term loans to
refinance the term loans initially incurred as well as any
previously incurred refinancing term loans and to permit the
establishment of commitments under a replacement cash flow
revolver under the cash flow credit facility to replace all or a
portion of the revolving commitments initially established under
the cash flow credit facility as well as any previously issued
replacement revolvers. On April 6, 2010, we further amended
our cash flow credit facility to (i) extend the maturity
date for $2.0 billion of our tranche B term loans from
November 17, 2013 to March 31, 2017 and
(ii) increase the ABR margin and LIBOR margin with respect
to such extended term loans to 2.25% and 3.25%, respectively.
On March 2, 2009, we amended our $2.000 billion senior
secured asset-based revolving credit facility, dated as of
November 17, 2006, as amended and restated as of
June 20, 2007 (the
asset-based
revolving credit facility), to allow for one or more
future issuances of additional secured notes or loans, which may
include notes or loans that are secured on a pari passu
basis or on a junior basis with the obligations under the
cash flow credit facility, so long as the proceeds from any such
issuance are used to prepay term loans under the cash flow
credit facility within three business days of the receipt
thereof. The amendment to the ABL credit facility also altered
the excess facility availability requirement to include a
separate minimum facility availability requirement applicable to
the ABL credit facility, and increased the applicable LIBOR and
ABR margins for all borrowings under the ABL credit facility by
0.25% each.
The estimated fair value of our total long-term debt was
$27.007 billion at March 31, 2010. The estimates of
fair value are based upon the quoted market prices for the same
or similar issues of long-term debt with the same maturities.
Based on a hypothetical 1% increase in interest rates, the
potential annualized reduction to future pretax earnings would
be approximately $26 million. To mitigate the impact of
fluctuations in interest rates, we generally target a portion of
our debt portfolio to be maintained at fixed rates.
Our international operations and foreign currency denominated
loans expose us to market risks associated with foreign
currencies. In order to mitigate the currency exposure related
to foreign currency denominated debt service obligations, we
have entered into cross currency swap agreements. A cross
currency swap is an agreement between two parties to exchange a
stream of principal and interest payments in one currency for a
stream of principal and interest payments in another currency
over a specified period. Our credit risk related to these
agreements is considered low because the swap agreements are
with creditworthy financial institutions.
60
Financial
Instruments
Derivative financial instruments are employed to manage risks,
including foreign currency and interest rate exposures, and are
not used for trading or speculative purposes. We recognize
derivative instruments, such as interest rate swap agreements
and foreign exchange contracts, in the consolidated balance
sheets at fair value. Changes in the fair value of derivatives
are recognized periodically either in earnings or in
stockholders equity, as a component of other comprehensive
income, depending on whether the derivative financial instrument
qualifies for hedge accounting, and if so, whether it qualifies
as a fair value hedge or a cash flow hedge. Gains and losses on
derivatives designated as cash flow hedges, to the extent they
are effective, are recorded in other comprehensive income, and
subsequently reclassified to earnings to offset the impact of
the hedged items when they occur. Changes in the fair value of
derivatives not qualifying as hedges, and for any portion of a
hedge that is ineffective, are reported in earnings.
The net interest paid or received on interest rate swaps is
recognized as interest expense. Gains and losses resulting from
the early termination of interest rate swap agreements are
deferred and amortized as adjustments to expense over the
remaining period of the debt originally covered by the
terminated swap.
Effects
of Inflation and Changing Prices
Various federal, state and local laws have been enacted that, in
certain cases, limit our ability to increase prices. Revenues
for general, acute care hospital services rendered to Medicare
patients are established under the federal governments
prospective payment system. Total
fee-for-service
Medicare revenues approximated 23% in 2009, 23% in 2008 and 24%
in 2007 of our total patient revenues.
Management believes hospital industry operating margins have
been, and may continue to be, under significant pressure because
of changes in payer mix and growth in operating expenses in
excess of the increase in prospective payments under the
Medicare program. In addition, as a result of increasing
regulatory and competitive pressures, our ability to maintain
operating margins through price increases to non-Medicare
patients is limited.
IRS
Disputes
At March 31, 2010, we were contesting before the Appeals
Division of the IRS certain claimed deficiencies and adjustments
proposed by the IRS in connection with its examinations of the
2003 and 2004 federal income returns for HCA and eight
affiliates that are treated as partnerships for federal income
tax purposes (affiliated partnerships). The disputed
items include the timing of recognition of certain patient
service revenues and our method for calculating the tax
allowance for doubtful accounts.
Six taxable periods of HCA and its predecessors ended in 1997
through 2002 and the 2002 taxable year of four affiliated
partnerships, for which the remaining issue is the computation
of the tax allowance for doubtful accounts, are pending before
the IRS Examination Division as of March 31, 2010.
The IRS completed its audit of HCAs 2005 and 2006 federal
income tax returns in April 2010. We will contest certain
claimed deficiencies and adjustments proposed by the IRS
Examination Division in connection with this audit, including
the timing of recognition of certain patient service revenues,
before the IRS Appeals Division. We anticipate the IRS will
begin an audit of the 2007, 2008 and 2009 federal income tax
returns for HCA and one or more affiliated partnerships during
2010.
Management believes HCA, its predecessors and affiliates
properly reported taxable income and paid taxes in accordance
with applicable laws and agreements established with the IRS and
final resolution of these disputes will not have a material,
adverse effect on our results of operations or financial
position. However, if payments due upon final resolution of
these issues exceed our recorded estimates, such resolutions
could have a material, adverse effect on our results of
operations or financial position.
61
BUSINESS
Our
Company
We are the largest non-governmental hospital operator in the
U.S. and a leading comprehensive, integrated provider of
health care and related services. We provide these services
through a network of acute care hospitals, outpatient
facilities, clinics and other patient care delivery settings. As
of March 31, 2010, we operated a diversified portfolio of
162 hospitals (with approximately 41,000 beds) and 106
freestanding surgery centers across 20 states throughout
the U.S. and in England. As a result of our efforts to
establish significant market share in large and growing urban
markets with attractive demographic and economic profiles, we
currently have a substantial market presence in 14 of the top 25
fastest growing markets in the U.S. and currently maintain the
first or second position, based on inpatient admissions, in many
of our key markets. We believe our ability to successfully
position and grow our assets in attractive markets and execute
our operating plan has contributed to the strength of our
financial performance over the last several years. For the year
ended December 31, 2009, we generated revenues of
$30.052 billion, net income attributable to HCA Inc. of
$1.054 billion and Adjusted EBITDA of $5.472 billion.
For the three months ended March 31, 2010, we generated
revenues of $7.544 billion, net income attributable to HCA
Inc. of $388 million and Adjusted EBITDA of
$1.574 billion.
Our patient-first strategy is to provide high quality health
care services in a cost-efficient manner. We intend to build
upon our history of profitable growth by maintaining our
dedication to quality care, increasing our presence in key
markets through organic expansion and strategic acquisitions,
leveraging our scale and infrastructure, and further developing
our physician and employee relationships. We believe pursuing
these core elements of our strategy helps us develop a
faster-growing, more stable and more profitable business and
increases our relevance to patients, physicians, payers and
employers.
Using our scale, significant resources and over 40 years of
operating experience we have developed a significant management
and support infrastructure. Some of the key components of our
support infrastructure include a revenue cycle management
organization, a health care group purchasing organization, or
GPO, an information technology and services provider, a nurse
staffing agency and a medical malpractice insurance underwriter.
These shared services have helped us to maximize our cash
collection efficiency, achieve savings in purchasing through our
scale, more rapidly deploy information technology upgrades, more
effectively manage our labor pool and achieve greater stability
in malpractice insurance premiums. Collectively, these
components have helped us to further enhance our operating
effectiveness, cost efficiency and overall financial results.
Since the founding of our business in 1968 as a single-facility
hospital company, we have demonstrated an ability to
consistently innovate and sustain growth during varying economic
and regulatory climates. Under the leadership of an experienced
senior management team, whose tenure at HCA averages over
20 years, we have established an extensive record of
providing high quality care, profitably growing our business,
making and integrating strategic acquisitions and efficiently
and strategically allocating capital spending.
On November 17, 2006, we were acquired by a private
investor group comprised of affiliates of or funds sponsored by
Bain Capital Partners, LLC, Kohlberg Kravis Roberts &
Co., Merrill Lynch Global Private Equity (now BAML Capital
Partners), Citigroup Inc., Bank of America Corporation and HCA
founder Dr. Thomas F. Frist, Jr., a group we collectively
refer to as the Investors, and by members of
management and certain other investors. We refer to the merger,
the financing transactions related to the merger and other
related transactions collectively as the
Recapitalization.
Since the Recapitalization, we have achieved substantial
operational and financial progress. During this time, we have
made significant investments in expanding our service lines and
expanding our alignment with highly specialized and primary care
physicians. In addition, we have enhanced our operating
efficiencies through a number of corporate cost-saving
initiatives and an expansion of our support infrastructure. We
have made investments in information technology to optimize our
facilities and systems. We have also undertaken a number of
initiatives to improve clinical quality and patient
satisfaction. As a result of these initiatives, our financial
performance has improved significantly from the year ended
December 31, 2007, the first full year
62
following the Recapitalization, to the year ended
December 31, 2009, with revenues growing by
$3.194 billion, net income attributable to HCA Inc.
increasing by $180 million and Adjusted EBITDA increasing
by $880 million. This represents compounded annual growth
rates on these key metrics of 5.8%, 9.8% and 9.2%, respectively.
Our
Industry
We believe well-capitalized, comprehensive and integrated health
care delivery providers are well-positioned to benefit from the
current industry trends, some of which include:
Aging Population and Continued Growth in the Need for Health
Care Services. According to the U.S. Census
Bureau, the demographic age group of persons aged 65 and over is
expected to experience compounded annual growth of 3.0% over the
next 20 years, and constitute 19.3% of the total
U.S. population by 2030. The Centers for
Medicare & Medicaid Services, or CMS, projects
continued increases in hospital services based on the aging of
the U.S. population, advances in medical procedures,
expansion of health coverage, increasing consumer demand for
expanded medical services and increased prevalence of chronic
conditions such as diabetes, heart disease and obesity. We
believe these factors will continue to drive increased
utilization of health care services and the need for
comprehensive, integrated hospital networks that can provide a
wide array of essential and sophisticated health care.
Continued Evolution of Quality-Based Reimbursement Favors
Large-Scale, Comprehensive and Integrated
Providers. We believe the U.S. health care
system is continuing to evolve in ways that favor large-scale,
comprehensive and integrated providers that provide high levels
of quality care. Specifically, we believe there are a number of
initiatives that will continue to gain importance in the
foreseeable future, including: introduction of value-based
payment methodologies tied to performance, quality and
coordination of care, implementation of integrated electronic
health records and information, and an increasing ability for
patients and consumers to make choices about all aspects of
health care. We believe our company is well positioned to
respond to these emerging trends and has the resources,
expertise and flexibility necessary to adapt in a timely manner
to the changing health care regulatory and reimbursement
environment.
Impact of Health Reform Law. The recently
enacted Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act, as amended
by the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act of 2010
(collectively, the Health Reform Law), will change
how health care services are covered, delivered and reimbursed.
It will do so through expanded coverage of uninsured
individuals, significant reductions in the growth of Medicare
program payments, material decreases in Medicare and Medicaid
disproportionate share hospital (DSH) payments, and
the establishment of programs where reimbursement is tied in
part to quality and integration. The Health Reform Law is
expected to expand health insurance coverage to approximately 32
to 34 million additional individuals through a combination of
public program expansion and private sector health insurance
reforms. We believe the expansion of private sector and
Medicaid coverage will, over time, increase our reimbursement
related to providing services to individuals who were previously
uninsured. On the other hand, the reductions in the growth in
Medicare payments and the decreases in DSH payments will
adversely affect our government reimbursement. Because of the
many variables involved, we are unable to predict the net impact
of the Health Reform Law on us; however, we believe our
experienced management team, emphasis on quality care and our
diverse service offerings will enable us to capitalize on the
opportunities presented by the Health Reform Law, as well as
adapt in a timely manner to its challenges.
Our
Competitive Strengths
We believe our key competitive strengths include:
Largest Comprehensive, Integrated Health Care Delivery
System. We are the largest
non-governmental
hospital operator in the U.S., providing approximately 4% to 5%
of all U.S. hospital services through our national
footprint. The scope and scale of our operations, evidenced by
the types of facilities we operate, the diverse medical
specialties we offer and the numerous patient care access points
we provide enable us to provide a comprehensive range of health
care services in a cost-effective manner. As a result, we
believe the breadth of our platform is a competitive advantage
in the marketplace enabling us to attract patients,
63
physicians and clinical staff while also providing significant
economies of scale and increasing our relevance with commercial
payers.
Reputation for High Quality Patient-Centered
Care. Since our founding, we have maintained an
unwavering focus on patients and clinical outcomes. We believe
clinical quality influences physician and patient choices about
health care delivery. We align our quality initiatives
throughout the organization by engaging corporate, local,
physician and nurse leaders to share best practices and develop
standards for delivering high quality care. We have invested
extensively in quality of care initiatives, with an emphasis on
implementing information technology and adopting industry-wide
best practices and clinical protocols. As a result of these
measures, we have achieved significant progress in clinical
quality, as measured by the CMS HQA Grand Composite Score (based
on publicly available data for the twelve months ended
June 30, 2009) wherein HCA hospitals achieved 97.3% of the
CMS core measures versus the national average of 94.1%, making
HCA the best performing non-governmental system in the U.S.
Similarly, 88% of the core measure sets performed by our
facilities ranked in the top quartile and 65% ranked in the top
decile based on publicly available data for the twelve months
ended June 30, 2009. In addition, the Health Reform Law
establishes a value-based purchasing system and adjusts hospital
payment rates based on
hospital-acquired
conditions and hospital readmissions. We also believe our
quality initiatives favorably position us in a payment
environment that is increasingly performance-based.
Leading Local Market Positions in Large, Growing, Urban
Markets. Over our history, we have sought to
selectively expand and upgrade our asset base to create a
premium portfolio of assets in attractive growing markets. As a
result, we have a strong market presence in 14 of the top 25
fastest growing markets in the U.S. We currently operate in
29 markets, 17 of which have populations of 1 million
or more, with all but one of these markets projecting growth
above the national average from 2009 to 2014. Our inpatient
market share places us first or second in many of our key
markets. In addition, we operate in markets that have
demonstrated relative economic stability, with the unemployment
rate in a majority of our markets below the national average as
of March 2010. We believe the strength and stability of these
market positions will create organic growth opportunities and
allow us to develop long-term relationships with patients,
physicians, large employers and third-party payers.
Diversified Revenue Base and Payer Mix. We
believe our broad geographic footprint, varied service lines and
diverse revenue base mitigate our risks in numerous ways. Our
diversification limits our exposure to competitive dynamics and
economic conditions in any single local market, reimbursement
changes in specific service lines and disruptions with respect
to payers such as state Medicaid programs or large commercial
insurers. We have a diverse portfolio of assets with no single
facility contributing more than 2.4% of our revenues and no
single metropolitan statistical area contributing more than 7.8%
of revenues for the year ended December 31, 2009. We have
also developed a highly diversified payer base, including
approximately 3,000 managed care contracts, with no single
commercial payer representing more than 8% of revenues for the
year ended December 31, 2009. In addition, we are one of
the countrys largest providers of outpatient services,
which accounted for approximately 38% of our revenues for the
year ended December 31, 2009. We believe the geographic
diversity of our market positions and the scope of our inpatient
and outpatient operations help reduce volatility in our
operating results.
Scale and Infrastructure Drives Cost Savings and
Efficiencies. Our scale allows us to leverage our
support infrastructure to achieve significant cost savings and
operating efficiencies, thereby driving margin expansion. We
strategically manage our supply chain through centralized
purchasing and supply warehouses, as well as our revenue cycle
through centralized billing, collections and health information
management functions. We also manage the provision of
information technology through a combination of centralized
systems with regional service support as well as centralize many
other clinical and corporate functions, creating economies of
scale in managing expenses and business processes. In addition
to the cost savings and operating efficiencies, this support
infrastructure simultaneously generates revenue from third
parties that utilize our services.
Well-Capitalized Portfolio of High Quality
Assets. In order to expand the range and improve
the quality of services provided at our facilities, we invested
over $7.8 billion in our facilities and information
technology
64
systems over the five-year period ended December 31, 2009.
We believe our significant capital investments in these areas
will continue to attract new and returning patients, attract and
retain high-quality physicians, maximize cost efficiencies and
address the health care needs of our local communities.
Furthermore, we believe our platform as well as electronic
health record infrastructure, national research and physician
management capabilities provide a strategic advantage by
enhancing our ability to capitalize on anticipated incentives
through the HITECH provisions of the American Recovery and
Reinvestment Act of 2009 and positions us well in an environment
that increasingly emphasizes quality, transparency and
coordination of care.
Strong Operating Results and Cash Flows. Our
leading scale, diversification, favorable market positions,
dedication to clinical quality and focus on operational
efficiency have enabled us to achieve attractive historical
financial performance even during the most recent economic
period. In the year ended December 31, 2009, we generated
net income attributable to HCA Inc. of $1.054 billion,
Adjusted EBITDA of $5.472 billion and cash flows from
operating activities of $2.747 billion, while for the three
months ended March 31, 2010, we generated net income
attributable to HCA Inc. of $388 million, Adjusted EBITDA
of $1.574 billion and cash flows from operating activities
of $901 million. Our ability to generate strong and
consistent cash flow from operations has enabled us to invest in
our operations, reduce our debt, enhance earnings per share and
continue to pursue attractive growth opportunities.
Proven and Experienced Management Team. We
believe the extensive experience and depth of our management
team are a distinct competitive advantage in the complicated and
evolving industry in which we compete. Our CEO and Chairman of
the Board of Directors, Richard M. Bracken, began his career
with our company approximately 30 years ago and has held
various executive positions with us over that period, including,
most recently, as our President and Chief Operating Officer. Our
Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Director,
R. Milton Johnson, joined our company over 27 years ago and
has held various positions in our financial operations since
that time. Our six Group Presidents average over 20 years
of experience with our company. Members of our senior management
hold significant equity interests in our company, further
aligning their long-term interests with those of our
stockholders.
Our
Growth Strategy
We are committed to providing the communities we serve with high
quality, cost-effective health care while growing our business,
increasing our profitability and creating long-term value for
our stockholders. To achieve these objectives, we align our
efforts around the following growth agenda:
Grow Our Presence in Existing Markets. We
believe we are well positioned in a number of large and growing
markets that will allow us the opportunity to generate
long-term, attractive growth through the expansion of our
presence in these markets. We plan to continue recruiting and
strategically collaborating with the physician community and
adding attractive service lines such as cardiology, emergency
services, oncology and womens services. Additional
components of our growth strategy include expanding our
footprint through developing various outpatient access points,
including surgery centers, rural outreach, freestanding
emergency departments and walk-in clinics. Since our
Recapitalization, we have invested significant capital into
these markets and expect to continue to see the benefit of this
investment.
Achieve Industry-Leading Performance in Clinical and
Satisfaction Measures. Achieving high levels of
patient safety, patient satisfaction and clinical quality are
central goals of our business model. To achieve these goals, we
have implemented a number of initiatives including infection
reduction initiatives, hospitalist programs, advanced health
information technology and evidence-based medicine programs. We
routinely analyze operational practices from our best-performing
hospitals to identify ways to implement organization-wide
performance improvements and reduce clinical variation. We
believe these initiatives will continue to improve patient care,
help us achieve cost efficiencies, grow our revenues and
favorably position us in an environment where our constituents
are increasingly focused on quality, efficacy and efficiency.
Recruit and Employ Physicians to Meet Need for High Quality
Health Services. We depend on the quality and
dedication of the health care providers and other team members
who serve at our facilities. We believe a critical component of
our growth strategy is our ability to successfully recruit and
strategically
65
collaborate with physicians and other professionals to provide
high quality care. We attract and retain physicians by providing
high quality, convenient facilities with advanced technology, by
expanding our specialty services and by building our outpatient
operations. We believe our continued investment in the
employment, recruitment and retention of physicians will improve
the quality of care at our facilities.
Continue to Leverage Our Scale and Market Positions to
Enhance Profitability. We believe there is
significant opportunity to continue to grow the profitability of
our company by fully leveraging the scale and scope of our
franchise. We are currently pursuing next generation performance
improvement initiatives such as contracting for services on a
multistate basis and expanding our support infrastructure for
additional clinical and support functions, such as physician
credentialing, medical transcription and electronic medical
recordkeeping. We believe our centrally managed business
processes and ability to leverage cost-saving practices across
our extensive network will enable us to continue to manage costs
effectively.
Selectively Pursue a Disciplined Development
Strategy. We continue to believe there are
significant growth opportunities in our markets. We will
continue to provide financial and operational resources to
successfully execute on our in-market opportunities. To
complement our in-market growth agenda, we intend to focus on
selectively developing and acquiring new hospitals, outpatient
facilities and other health care service providers. We believe
the challenges faced by the hospital industry may spur
consolidation and we believe our size, scale, national presence
and access to capital will position us well to participate in
any such consolidation. We have a strong record of successfully
acquiring and integrating hospitals and entering into joint
ventures and intend to continue leveraging this experience.
Business
Drivers and Measures
Our
Financial Policies and Objectives
We seek to optimize our financial and operating performance by
implementing the business strategy set forth under
Our Growth Strategy. Our success in
implementing this strategy depends, in turn, on our ability to
fulfill our financial policies and objectives, which include the
following:
|
|
|
|
|
Operations: We plan to focus on our core
operations the provision of high quality,
cost-effective health care in large, high growth urban
communities, primarily in the southern and western regions of
the United States. Our specific policies designed to maintain
this focus include:
|
|
|
|
|
|
using investments in new and expanded services to drive use of
our facilities;
|
|
|
|
seeking rate increases from managed care payers commensurate
with increases in our underlying costs to provide high quality
services;
|
|
|
|
managing operating expenses by, among other methods, leveraging
our scale;
|
|
|
|
seeking cost savings by reducing variations in our patient care
and support processes and reducing our discretionary operating
expenses; and
|
|
|
|
considering divesting non-core assets, where appropriate.
|
|
|
|
|
|
Leverage: We expect to have significant
indebtedness for the foreseeable future. However, we expect to:
|
|
|
|
|
|
manage our floating interest rate exposure through our
$7.1 billion aggregate notional amount of pay-fixed rate
swap agreements related to our senior secured credit facilities
debt at March 31, 2010; and
|
|
|
|
endeavor to improve our credit quality over time.
|
|
|
|
|
|
Capital Expenditures: We plan to maintain a
disciplined capital expenditure approach by:
|
|
|
|
|
|
targeting new investments with potentially high returns;
|
66
|
|
|
|
|
deploying capital strategically to improve our competitive
position and market share and to enhance our operations; and
|
|
|
|
managing discretionary capital expenditures based on the
strength of our cash flows.
|
Operational
Factors
In pursuing our business and our financial policies and
objectives, we pay close attention to a number of performance
measures and operational factors.
Our revenues depend upon inpatient occupancy levels, the
ancillary services and therapy programs ordered by physicians
and provided to patients, the volume of outpatient procedures
and the charges and negotiated payment rates for such services.
Our expenses depend upon the levels of salaries and benefits
paid to our employees, the cost of supplies and the costs of
other operating expenses. To monitor these variables, we use a
variety of metrics, including those described below.
|
|
|
|
|
admissions, which is the total number of patients admitted to
our hospitals and which we use as a measure of inpatient volume;
|
|
|
|
equivalent admissions, which is a measure of patient volume that
takes into account both inpatient and outpatient volume;
|
|
|
|
the payer mix of our admissions, i.e., the percentage of our
admissions related to Medicare, Medicaid, managed Medicare,
managed Medicaid, managed care and other insurers, and uninsured
patients;
|
|
|
|
emergency room visits;
|
|
|
|
inpatient and outpatient surgeries; and
|
|
|
|
the average daily census of patients in our hospital beds.
|
|
|
|
|
|
revenue per equivalent admission; and
|
|
|
|
revenue, minus our provision for doubtful accounts, per
equivalent admission.
|
|
|
|
|
|
salaries and benefits per equivalent admission;
|
|
|
|
supply costs per equivalent admission;
|
|
|
|
other operating expenses (including contract services,
professional fees, repairs and maintenance, rents and leases,
utilities, insurance and nonincome taxes) per equivalent
admission; and
|
|
|
|
operating expenses, minus our provision for doubtful accounts,
per equivalent admission.
|
We set forth the volume measures described above, except for
payer mix, for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008,
2007, 2006 and 2005 and for the three months ended
March 31, 2010 and 2009 under the heading Operating
Data in Selected Financial Data. We give
details about the payer mix for the years ended
December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 and for the three months
ended March 31, 2010 and 2009 in Managements
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations Results of Operations Revenue/Volume
Trends.
The pricing and expense measures described above can be derived
by dividing (1) the amounts from the applicable line items
in our income statement (minus our provision for doubtful
accounts, where indicated) by (2) equivalent admissions,
which are set forth under the heading Operating Data
in Selected Financial Data.
67
Business
Segments
Our company operations are structured in three geographically
organized groups:
|
|
|
|
|
Western Group. The Western Group is comprised
of the markets in Alaska, California, Colorado, Idaho, Kansas,
Nevada, Oklahoma, Texas and Utah. Samuel Hazen, who has held
various positions with HCA for 27 years, is the Western
Groups President. As of March 31, 2010, there were 55
consolidating hospitals within the Western Group. The Western
Group includes seven of our non-consolidating hospitals, with
respect to which major strategic and operating decisions are
shared equally with non-HCA partners. For the year ended
December 31, 2009, the Western Group generated revenues of
$13.140 billion.
|
|
|
|
Central Group. The Central Group is comprised
of the markets in Indiana, Georgia (northern portion), Kansas,
Kentucky, Louisiana, Mississippi, Missouri, New Hampshire,
Tennessee and Virginia. Paul Rutledge, who has held various
positions with HCA for 27 years, is the Central
Groups President. As of March 31, 2010, there were 45
consolidating hospitals within the Central Group. The Central
Group includes one of our non-consolidating hospitals, with
respect to which major strategic and operating decisions are
shared equally with non-HCA partners. For the year ended
December 31, 2009, the Central Group generated revenues of
$7.225 billion.
|
|
|
|
Eastern Group. The Eastern Group is comprised
of the markets in Florida, Georgia (southern portion) and South
Carolina. Charles Hall, who has held various positions with HCA
for 23 years, is the Eastern Groups President. As of
March 31, 2010, there were 48 consolidating hospitals
within the Eastern Group. For the year ended December 31,
2009, the Eastern Group generated revenues of
$8.807 billion.
|
We also owned and operated six hospitals in England as of
March 31, 2010, which are included in our Corporate and
other group. These international facilities generated revenues
of $709 million for the year ended December 31, 2009.
Our divisions and market structures are designed to augment our
market-based strategy to provide integrated services to their
respective community. This structure allows our management to
focus on manageable groupings of hospitals and provide them with
direct support.
Note 13 to our consolidated financial statements contains
information by segment on our revenues, equity in earnings of
affiliates, adjusted segment EBITDA and depreciation and
amortization for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008
and 2007.
Health
Care Facilities
We currently own, manage or operate hospitals; freestanding
surgery centers; diagnostic and imaging centers; radiation and
oncology therapy centers; comprehensive rehabilitation and
physical therapy centers; and various other facilities.
At March 31, 2010, we owned and operated 149 general, acute
care hospitals with 38,213 licensed beds, and an additional
seven general, acute care hospitals with 2,269 licensed beds,
which are operated through joint ventures, which are accounted
for using the equity method. Most of our general, acute care
hospitals provide medical and surgical services, including
inpatient care, intensive care, cardiac care, diagnostic
services and emergency services. The general, acute care
hospitals also provide outpatient services such as outpatient
surgery, laboratory, radiology, respiratory therapy, cardiology
and physical therapy. Each hospital has an organized medical
staff and a local board of trustees or governing board, made up
of members of the local community.
Our hospitals do not typically engage in extensive medical
research and education programs. However, some of our hospitals
are affiliated with medical schools and may participate in the
clinical rotation of medical interns and residents and other
education programs.
At March 31, 2010, we operated five psychiatric hospitals
with 506 licensed beds. Our psychiatric hospitals provide
therapeutic programs including child, adolescent and adult
psychiatric care, adult and adolescent alcohol and drug abuse
treatment and counseling.
68
We also operate outpatient health care facilities which include
freestanding ambulatory surgery centers (ASCs),
diagnostic and imaging centers, comprehensive outpatient
rehabilitation and physical therapy centers, outpatient
radiation and oncology therapy centers and various other
facilities. These outpatient services are an integral component
of our strategy to develop comprehensive health care networks in
select communities. Most of our ASCs are operated through
partnerships or limited liability companies, with majority
ownership of each partnership or limited liability company
typically held by a general partner or subsidiary that is an
affiliate of HCA.
Certain of our affiliates provide a variety of management
services to our health care facilities, including patient safety
programs; ethics and compliance programs; national supply
contracts; equipment purchasing and leasing contracts;
accounting, financial and clinical systems; governmental
reimbursement assistance; construction planning and
coordination; information technology systems and solutions;
legal counsel; human resources services; and internal audit
services.
Sources
of Revenue
Hospital revenues depend upon inpatient occupancy levels, the
medical and ancillary services ordered by physicians and
provided to patients, the volume of outpatient procedures and
the charges or payment rates for such services. Charges and
reimbursement rates for inpatient services vary significantly
depending on the type of payer, the type of service (e.g.,
medical/surgical, intensive care or psychiatric) and the
geographic location of the hospital. Inpatient occupancy levels
fluctuate for various reasons, many of which are beyond our
control.
We receive payment for patient services from the federal
government under the Medicare program, state governments under
their respective Medicaid or similar programs, managed care
plans, private insurers and directly from patients. The
approximate percentages of our revenues from such sources were
as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year Ended
|
|
|
|
December 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Medicare
|
|
|
23
|
%
|
|
|
23
|
%
|
|
|
24
|
%
|
Managed Medicare
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Medicaid
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Managed Medicaid
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
3
|
|
Managed care and other insurers
|
|
|
52
|
|
|
|
53
|
|
|
|
54
|
|
Uninsured
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
10
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Medicare is a federal program that provides certain hospital and
medical insurance benefits to persons age 65 and over, some
disabled persons, persons with end-stage renal disease and
persons with Lou Gehrigs Disease. Medicaid is a
federal-state program, administered by the states, which
provides hospital and medical benefits to qualifying individuals
who are unable to afford health care. All of our general, acute
care hospitals located in the United States are certified as
health care services providers for persons covered under the
Medicare and Medicaid programs. Amounts received under the
Medicare and Medicaid programs are generally significantly less
than established hospital gross charges for the services
provided.
Our hospitals generally offer discounts from established charges
to certain group purchasers of health care services, including
private insurance companies, employers, HMOs, PPOs and other
managed care plans. These discount programs generally limit our
ability to increase revenues in response to increasing costs.
See Business Competition. Patients are
generally not responsible for the total difference between
established hospital gross charges and amounts reimbursed for
such services under Medicare, Medicaid, HMOs or PPOs and other
managed care plans, but are responsible to the extent of any
exclusions, deductibles or coinsurance features of their
coverage. The amount of such exclusions, deductibles and
coinsurance continues to increase. Collection of amounts due
from individuals is typically more difficult than from
governmental or third-party payers. We provide discounts to
uninsured patients who do not qualify for Medicaid or charity
care under our
69
charity care policy. These discounts are similar to those
provided to many local managed care plans. In implementing the
discount policy, we attempt to qualify uninsured patients for
Medicaid, other federal or state assistance or charity care
under our charity care policy. If an uninsured patient does not
qualify for these programs, the uninsured discount is applied.
Medicare
Inpatient
Acute Care
Under the Medicare program, we receive reimbursement under a
prospective payment system (PPS) for general, acute
care hospital inpatient services. Under the hospital inpatient
PPS, fixed payment amounts per inpatient discharge are
established based on the patients assigned Medicare
severity diagnosis-related group (MS-DRG). The
Centers for Medicare & Medicaid Services
(CMS) recently completed a two-year transition to
full implementation of MS-DRGs to replace the previously used
Medicare diagnosis related groups in an effort to better
recognize severity of illness in Medicare payment rates. MS-DRGs
classify treatments for illnesses according to the estimated
intensity of hospital resources necessary to furnish care for
each principal diagnosis. MS-DRG weights represent the average
resources for a given MS-DRG relative to the average resources
for all MS-DRGs. MS-DRG payments are adjusted for area wage
differentials. Hospitals, other than those defined as
new, receive PPS reimbursement for inpatient capital
costs based on MS-DRG weights multiplied by a geographically
adjusted federal rate. When the cost to treat certain patients
falls well outside the normal distribution, providers typically
receive additional outlier payments.
MS-DRG rates are updated and MS-DRG weights are recalibrated
using cost relative weights each federal fiscal year (which
begins October 1). The index used to update the MS-DRG rates
(the market basket) gives consideration to the
inflation experienced by hospitals and entities outside the
health care industry in purchasing goods and services. In
federal fiscal year 2009, the MS-DRG rate was increased by the
full market basket of 3.6%. For the federal fiscal year 2010,
CMS set the MS-DRG rate increase at the full market basket of
2.1%. However, in federal fiscal years 2008 and 2009, CMS
reduced payments to hospitals through a documentation and coding
adjustment intended to account for changes in payments under the
MS-DRG system that are not related to changes in patient case
mix. In addition, CMS has the authority to determine
retrospectively whether the documentation and coding adjustment
levels for federal fiscal years 2008 and 2009 were adequate to
account for changes in payments not related to changes in
patient case mix. CMS did not impose an adjustment for federal
fiscal year 2010, but announced its intent to impose reductions
to payments in federal fiscal years 2011 and 2012 because of
what CMS has determined to be an inadequate adjustment in
federal fiscal year 2008.
The Health Reform Law provides for annual decreases to the
market basket, including a 0.25% reduction in 2010 for
discharges occurring on or after April 1, 2010. The Health
Reform Law also provides for the following reductions to the
market basket update for each of the following federal fiscal
years: 0.25% in 2011, 0.1% in 2012 and 2013, 0.3% in 2014, 0.2%
in 2015 and 2016 and 0.75% in 2017, 2018 and 2019. For federal
fiscal year 2012 and each subsequent federal fiscal year, the
Health Reform Law provides for the annual market basket update
to be further reduced by a productivity adjustment. The amount
of that reduction will be the projected, nationwide productivity
gains over the preceding 10 years. To determine the
projection, HHS will use the Bureau of Labor Statistics
(BLS)
10-year
moving average of changes in specified economy-wide productivity
(the BLS data is typically a few years old). The Health Reform
Law does not contain guidelines for use by HHS in projecting the
productivity figure. Based upon the latest available data,
federal fiscal year 2012 market basket reductions resulting from
this productivity adjustment are likely to range from 1.0% to
1.4%. CMS estimates that the combined market basket and
productivity adjustments will reduce Medicare payments under the
inpatient PPS by $112.6 billion from 2010 to 2019. A
decrease in payments rates or an increase in rates that is below
the increase in our costs may adversely affect the results of
our operations.
On April 19, 2010, CMS issued a proposed rule related to the
federal fiscal year 2011 hospital inpatient PPS. In this rule,
CMS has proposed to increase the MS-DRG rate for federal fiscal
year 2011 by the full market basket of 2.4%. However, CMS has
also proposed to apply a documentation and coding adjustment of
70
negative 2.9% in federal fiscal year 2011. This reduction
represents half of the documentation and coding adjustment
required to recover the increase in aggregate payments made in
2008 and 2009 during implementation of the MS-DRG system. CMS
plans to recover the remaining 2.9% and interest in federal
fiscal year 2012. The market basket update, the documentation
and coding adjustment and the decreases mandated by the Health
Reform Law together show the aggregate market basket adjustment
for federal fiscal year 2011 to be negative 0.75%, if
implemented as proposed. Because the proposed rule expressly
does not take into account market basket reductions required by
the Health Reform Law, it is unclear what impact, if any, the
Health Reform Law will have on CMS proposal. CMS has also
announced that an additional prospective negative adjustment of
3.9% will be needed to avoid increased Medicare spending
unrelated to patient severity of illness. CMS is not proposing
this additional 3.9% reduction at this time but has stated that
it will be required in the future.
Further realignments in the MS-DRG system could also reduce the
payments we receive for certain specialties, including
cardiology and orthopedics. CMS has focused on payment levels
for such specialties in recent years in part because of the
proliferation of specialty hospitals. Changes in the payments
received for specialty services could have an adverse effect on
our results of operations.
The Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement, and Modernization
Act of 2003 (MMA) provides for rate increases at the
full market basket if data for patient care quality indicators
are submitted to the Secretary of HHS. As required by the
Deficit Reduction Act of 2005 (DRA 2005), CMS has
expanded, through a series of rulemakings, the number of quality
measures that must be reported to receive a full market basket
update. CMS currently requires hospitals to report 46 quality
measures in order to qualify for the full market basket update
to the inpatient PPS in federal fiscal year 2011. Failure to
submit the required quality indicators will result in a two
percentage point reduction to the market basket update. All of
our hospitals paid under Medicare inpatient MS-DRG PPS are
participating in the quality initiative by submitting the
requested quality data. While we will endeavor to comply with
all data submission requirements as additional requirements
continue to be added, our submissions may not be deemed timely
or sufficient to entitle us to the full market basket adjustment
for all of our hospitals.
As part of CMS goal of transforming Medicare from a
passive payer to an active purchaser of quality goods and
services, for discharges occurring after October 1, 2008,
Medicare no longer assigns an inpatient hospital discharge to a
higher paying MS-DRG if a selected hospital acquired condition
(HAC) was not present on admission. In this
situation, the case is paid as though the secondary diagnosis
was not present. Currently, there are ten categories of
conditions on the list of HACs. In addition, CMS has established
three National Coverage Determinations that prohibit Medicare
reimbursement for erroneous surgical procedures performed on an
inpatient or outpatient basis. The Health Reform Law provides
for reduced payments based on a hospitals HAC rates.
Beginning in federal fiscal year 2015, hospitals that rank in
the top 25% nationally of HACs for all hospitals in the previous
year will receive a 1% reduction in their total Medicare
payments. In addition, effective July 1, 2011, the Health
Reform Law prohibits the use of federal funds under the Medicaid
program to reimburse providers for medical services provided to
treat HACs.
The Health Reform Law also provides for reduced payments to
hospitals based on readmission rates. Beginning in federal
fiscal year 2013, inpatient payments will be reduced if a
hospital experiences excessive readmissions within a
30-day
period of discharge for heart attack, heart failure, pneumonia
or other conditions designated by HHS. Hospitals with what HHS
defines as excessive readmissions for these conditions will
receive reduced payments for all inpatient discharges, not just
discharges relating to the conditions subject to the excessive
readmission standard. Each hospitals performance will be
publicly reported by HHS. HHS has the discretion to determine
what excessive readmissions means, the amount of the
payment reduction and other terms and conditions of this program.
The Health Reform Law additionally establishes a value-based
purchasing program to further link payments to quality and
efficiency. In federal fiscal year 2013, HHS is directed to
implement a value-based purchasing program for inpatient
hospital services. Beginning in federal fiscal year 2013, CMS
will reduce the inpatient PPS payment amount for all discharges
by the following: 1% for 2013; 1.25% for 2014; 1.5% for 2015;
1.75% for 2016; and 2% for 2017 and subsequent years. For each
federal fiscal year, the total amount
71
collected from these reductions will be pooled and used to fund
payments to reward hospitals that meet certain quality
performance standards established by HHS. HHS will have the
authority to determine the quality performance measures, the
standards hospitals must achieve in order to meet the quality
performance measures and the methodology for calculating
payments to hospitals that meet the required quality threshold.
HHS will also determine the amount each hospital that meets or
exceeds the quality performance standards will receive from the
pool of dollars created by the reductions related to the
value-based purchasing program.
Historically, the Medicare program has set aside 5.10% of
Medicare inpatient payments to pay for outlier cases. CMS
estimates that outlier payments accounted for 4.8% of total
operating DRG payments for federal fiscal year 2008. For federal
fiscal year 2009, CMS established an outlier threshold of
$20,045, and for federal fiscal year 2010, CMS increased the
outlier threshold to $23,140. We do not anticipate the increase
to the outlier threshold for federal fiscal year 2010 will have
a material impact on our results of operations.
Outpatient
CMS reimburses hospital outpatient services (and certain
Medicare Part B services furnished to hospital inpatients
who have no Part A coverage) on a PPS basis. CMS continues
to use fee schedules to pay for physical, occupational and
speech therapies, durable medical equipment, clinical diagnostic
laboratory services and nonimplantable orthotics and
prosthetics, freestanding surgery centers services and services
provided by independent diagnostic testing facilities.
Hospital outpatient services paid under PPS are classified into
groups called ambulatory payment classifications
(APCs). Services for each APC are similar clinically
and in terms of the resources they require. A payment rate is
established for each APC. Depending on the services provided, a
hospital may be paid for more than one APC for a patient visit.
The APC payment rates were updated for calendar years 2008 and
2009 by market baskets of 3.30% and 3.60%, respectively. On
November 20, 2009, CMS published a final rule that updated
payment rates for calendar year 2010 by the full market basket
of 2.1%. However, the Health Reform Law includes a 0.25%
reduction to the market basket for 2010. The Health Reform Law
also provides for the following reductions to the market basket
update for each of the following calendar years: 0.25% in 2011,
0.1% in 2012 and 2013, 0.3% in 2014, 0.2% in 2015 and 2016 and
0.75% in 2017, 2018 and 2019. For calendar year 2012 and each
subsequent calendar year, the Health Reform Law provides for an
annual market basket update to be further reduced by a
productivity adjustment. The amount of that reduction will be
the projected, nationwide productivity gains over the preceding
10 years. To determine the projection, HHS will use the BLS
10-year
moving average of changes in specified economy-wide productivity
(the BLS data is typically a few years old). The Health Reform
Law does not contain guidelines for use by HHS in projecting the
productivity figure. However, CMS estimates that the combined
market basket and productivity adjustments will reduce Medicare
payments under the outpatient PPS by $26.3 billion from
2010 to 2019. CMS continues to require hospitals to submit
quality data relating to outpatient care to receive the full
market basket increase under the outpatient PPS in calendar year
2010. CMS required hospitals to report data on eleven quality
measures in calendar year 2009 for the payment determination in
calendar year 2010 and will continue to require hospitals to
report the existing eleven quality measures in calendar year
2010 for the 2011 payment determination. Hospitals that fail to
submit such data will receive the market basket update minus two
percentage points for the outpatient PPS.
Rehabilitation
CMS reimburses inpatient rehabilitation facilities
(IRFs) on a PPS basis. Under IRF PPS, patients are
classified into case mix groups based upon impairment, age,
comorbidities (additional diseases or disorders from which the
patient suffers) and functional capability. IRFs are paid a
predetermined amount per discharge that reflects the
patients case mix group and is adjusted for area wage
levels, low-income patients, rural areas and high-cost outliers.
CMS provided for a market basket update of 2.5% for federal
fiscal year 2010. However, the Health Reform Law requires a
0.25% reduction to the market basket for 2010 for discharges
occurring on or after April 1, 2010. The Health Reform Law
also provides for the following reductions to the market basket
update for each of the following federal fiscal years: 0.25% in
2011, 0.1% in 2012 and 2013, 0.3% in 2014, 0.2% in 2015 and 2016
and 0.75% in 2017, 2018 and 2019. For federal fiscal year 2012
and each subsequent federal fiscal year, the Health Reform Law
provides for the annual market basket update to be further
reduced by a productivity adjustment. The amount of that
reduction will be the projected, nationwide productivity gains
over the preceding 10 years. To determine the
72
projection, HHS will use the BLS
10-year
moving average of changes in specified economy-wide productivity
(the BLS data is typically a few years old). The Health Reform
Law does not contain guidelines for use by HHS in projecting the
productivity figure. However, CMS estimates that the combined
market basket and productivity adjustments will reduce Medicare
payments under the IRF PPS by $5.7 billion from 2010 to
2019. Beginning in federal fiscal year 2014, IRFs will be
required to report quality measures to HHS or will receive a two
percentage point reduction to the market basket update. As of
December 31, 2009, we had one rehabilitation hospital,
which is operated through a joint venture, and 46 hospital
rehabilitation units.
On May 7, 2004, CMS published a final rule to change the
criteria for being classified as an IRF. Pursuant to that final
rule, 75% of a facilitys inpatients over a given year had
to have been treated for at least one of 10 specified
conditions, and a subsequent regulation expanded the number of
specified conditions to 13. Since then, several statutory and
regulatory adjustments have been made to the rule, including
adjustments to the percentage of a facilitys patients that
must be treated for one of the 13 specified conditions.
Currently, the compliance threshold is set by statute at 60%.
Implementation of this 60% threshold has reduced our IRF
admissions and can be expected to continue to restrict the
treatment of patients whose medical conditions do not meet any
of the 13 approved conditions. In addition, effective
January 1, 2010, IRFs must meet additional coverage
criteria, including patient selection and care requirements
relating to pre-admission screenings, post-admission
evaluations, ongoing coordination of care and involvement of
rehabilitation physicians. A facility that fails to meet the 60%
threshold or other criteria to be classified as an IRF will be
paid under the acute care hospital inpatient or outpatient PPS,
which generally provide for lower payment amounts.
Psychiatric
Inpatient hospital services furnished in psychiatric hospitals
and psychiatric units of general, acute care hospitals and
critical access hospitals are reimbursed under a prospective
payment system (IPF PPS), a per diem payment, with
adjustments to account for certain patient and facility
characteristics. IPF PPS contains an outlier policy
for extraordinarily costly cases and an adjustment to a
facilitys base payment if it maintains a full-service
emergency department. CMS has established the IPF PPS payment
rate in a manner intended to be budget neutral and has adopted a
July 1 update cycle, with each twelve month period referred to
as a rate year. The rehabilitation, psychiatric and
long-term care (RPL) market basket update is used to
update the IPF PPS. The annual RPL market basket update for rate
year 2010 was 2.1%, and the annual RPL market basket update for
rate year 2011 is 2.4%. However, the Health Reform Law includes
a 0.25% reduction to the market basket for rate year 2010 and
again in 2011. The Health Reform Law also provides for the
following reductions to the market basket update for each of the
following rate years: 0.1% in 2012 and 2013, 0.3% in 2014, 0.2%
in 2015 and 2016 and 0.75% in 2017, 2018 and 2019. For rate year
2012 and each subsequent rate year, the Health Reform Law
provides for the annual market basket update to be further
reduced by a productivity adjustment. The amount of that
reduction will be the projected, nationwide productivity gains
over the preceding 10 years. To determine the projection,
HHS will use the BLS
10-year
moving average of changes in specified economy-wide productivity
(the BLS data is typically a few years old). The Health Reform
Law does not contain guidelines for use by HHS in projecting the
productivity figure. However, CMS estimates that the combined
market basket and productivity adjustments will reduce Medicare
payments under the IPF PPS by $4.3 billion from 2010 to 2019. As
of December 31, 2009, we had five psychiatric hospitals and
32 hospital psychiatric units.
Ambulatory
Surgery Centers
CMS reimburses ASCs using a predetermined fee schedule.
Reimbursements for ASC overhead costs are limited to no more
than the overhead costs paid to hospital outpatient departments
under the Medicare hospital outpatient PPS for the same
procedure. Effective January 1, 2008, ASC payment groups
increased from nine clinically disparate payment groups to an
extensive list of covered surgical procedures among the APCs
used under the outpatient PPS for these surgical services.
Because the new payment system has a significant impact on
payments for certain procedures, for services previously in the
nine payment groups, CMS has established a four-year transition
period for implementing the required payment rates. Moreover, if
CMS determines that a procedure is commonly performed in a
physicians office, the ASC reimbursement for that
procedure is limited to the reimbursement allowable under the
Medicare Part B Physician Fee Schedule, with limited
exceptions. In addition, all surgical procedures, other than
those that pose a significant safety risk or generally require
an
73
overnight stay, are payable as ASC procedures. As a result, more
Medicare procedures now performed in hospitals may be moved to
ASCs, reducing surgical volume in our hospitals. Also, more
Medicare procedures now performed in ASCs may be moved to
physicians offices. Commercial third-party payers may
adopt similar policies. The Health Reform Law requires HHS to
issue a plan by January 1, 2011 for developing a
value-based purchasing program for ASCs. Such a program may
further impact Medicare reimbursement of ASCs or increase our
operating costs in order to satisfy the value-based standards.
For federal fiscal year 2011 and each subsequent federal fiscal
year, the Health Reform Law provides for the annual market
basket update to be reduced by a productivity adjustment. The
amount of that reduction will be the projected nationwide
productivity gains over the preceding 10 years. To
determine the projection, HHS will use the BLS
10-year
moving average of changes in specified economy-wide productivity
(the BLS data is typically a few years old).
Other
Under PPS, the payment rates are adjusted for the area
differences in wage levels by a factor (wage index)
reflecting the relative wage level in the geographic area
compared to the national average wage level. Beginning in
federal fiscal year 2007, CMS adjusted 100% of the wage index
factor for occupational mix. The redistributive impact of wage
index changes, while slightly negative in the aggregate, is not
anticipated to have a material financial impact for 2010.
However, the Health Reform Law requires HHS to report to
Congress by December 31, 2011 with recommendations on how
to comprehensively reform the Medicare wage index system.
As required by the MMA, CMS is implementing contractor reform
whereby CMS has competitively bid the Medicare fiscal
intermediary and Medicare carrier functions to 15 Medicare
Administrative Contractors (MACs), which are
geographically assigned. CMS has awarded contracts to all 15 MAC
jurisdictions; as a result of filed protests, CMS is taking
corrective action regarding the contracts in several
jurisdictions. While chain providers had the option of having
all hospitals use one home office MAC, HCA chose to use the MACs
assigned to the geographic areas in which our hospitals are
located. The individual MAC jurisdictions are in varying phases
of transition. For the transition periods and for a potentially
unforeseen period thereafter, all of these changes could impact
claims processing functions and the resulting cash flow;
however, we are unable to predict the impact at this time.
Under the Recovery Audit Contractor (RAC) program,
CMS contracts with RACs to conduct post-payment reviews to
detect and correct improper payments in the
fee-for-service
Medicare program. CMS has awarded contracts to four RACs that
are implementing the RAC program on a nationwide basis as
required by statute.
Managed
Medicare
Managed Medicare plans relate to situations where a private
company contracts with CMS to provide members with Medicare
Part A, Part B and Part D benefits. Managed
Medicare plans can be structured as HMOs, PPOs or private
fee-for-service
plans. The Medicare program allows beneficiaries to choose
enrollment in certain managed Medicare plans. In 2003, MMA
increased reimbursement to managed Medicare plans and expanded
Medicare beneficiaries health care options. Since 2003,
the number of beneficiaries choosing to receive their Medicare
benefits through such plans has increased. However, the Medicare
Improvements for Patients and Providers Act of 2008 imposed new
restrictions and implemented focused cuts to certain managed
Medicare plans. In addition, the Health Reform Law reduces, over
a three year period, premium payments to managed Medicare plans
such that CMS managed care per capita premium payments
are, on average, equal to traditional Medicare. The CBO has
estimated that, as a result of these changes, payments to plans
will be reduced by $138 billion between 2010 and 2019,
while CMS has estimated the reduction to be $145 billion. In
addition, the Health Reform Law expands the RAC program to
include managed Medicare plans. In light of the current economic
downturn and the recently enacted legislation, managed Medicare
plans may experience reduced premium payments, which may lead to
decreased enrollment in such plans.
74
Medicaid
Medicaid programs are funded jointly by the federal government
and the states and are administered by states under approved
plans. Most state Medicaid program payments are made under a PPS
or are based on negotiated payment levels with individual
hospitals. Medicaid reimbursement is often less than a
hospitals cost of services. The Health Reform Law also
requires states to expand Medicaid coverage to all individuals
under age 65 with incomes up to 133% of the federal poverty
level by 2014. However, the Health Reform Law also requires
states to apply a 5% income disregard to the
Medicaid eligibility standard, so that Medicaid eligibility will
effectively be extended to those with incomes up to 138% of the
federal poverty level (FPL). In addition, effective
July 1, 2011, the Health Reform Law will prohibit the use of
federal funds under the Medicaid program to reimburse providers
for medical assistance provided to treat HACs.
Since most states must operate with balanced budgets and since
the Medicaid program is often the states largest program,
states can be expected to adopt or consider adopting legislation
designed to reduce their Medicaid expenditures. The current
economic downturn has increased the budgetary pressures on most
states, and these budgetary pressures have resulted and likely
will continue to result in decreased spending for Medicaid
programs in many states. Further, many states have also adopted,
or are considering, legislation designed to reduce coverage,
enroll Medicaid recipients in managed care programs
and/or
impose additional taxes on hospitals to help finance or expand
the states Medicaid systems. Effective March 23, 2010, the
Health Reform Law requires states to at least maintain Medicaid
eligibility standards established prior to the enactment of the
law for adults until January 1, 2014 and for children until
October 1, 2019. However, states with budget deficits may seek
exemptions from this requirement to address eligibility
standards that apply to adults making more than 133% of the
federal poverty level. As permitted by law, certain states in
which we operate have adopted broad-based provider taxes to fund
the
non-federal
share of Medicaid programs.
Through DRA 2005, Congress has expanded the federal
governments involvement in fighting fraud, waste and abuse
in the Medicaid program by creating the Medicaid Integrity
Program. Among other things, the DRA 2005 requires CMS to employ
private contractors, referred to as Medicaid Integrity
Contractors (MICs), to perform post-payment audits
of Medicaid claims and identify overpayments. MICs are assigned
to five geographic regions and have commenced audits in several
of the states assigned to those regions. Throughout 2010, MIC
audits will continue to expand to other states. The Health
Reform Law increases federal funding for the MIC program for
federal fiscal year 2011 and later years. In addition to MICs,
several other contractors, including the state Medicaid
agencies, have increased their review activities. The Health
Reform Law expands the RAC programs scope to include
Medicaid claims by requiring all states to enter contracts with
RACs by December 31, 2010.
Managed
Medicaid
Managed Medicaid programs enable states to contract with one or
more entities for patient enrollment, care management and claims
adjudication. The states usually do not relinquish program
responsibilities for financing, eligibility criteria and core
benefit plan design. We generally contract directly with one of
the designated entities, usually a managed care organization.
The provisions of these programs are state-specific.
Enrollment in managed Medicaid plans has increased in recent
years, as state governments seek to control the cost of Medicaid
programs. However, general economic conditions in the states in
which we operate may require reductions in premium payments to
these plans and may reduce reimbursement received from these
plans.
Accountable
Care Organizations and Pilot Projects
The Health Reform Law requires HHS to establish a Medicare
Shared Savings Program that promotes accountability and
coordination of care through the creation of Accountable Care
Organizations (ACOs), beginning no later than
January 1, 2012. The program will allow providers
(including hospitals), physicians and other designated
professionals and suppliers to form ACOs and voluntarily
work together to invest in infrastructure and redesign delivery
processes to achieve high quality and efficient delivery of
services. The program is intended to produce savings as a result
of improved quality and operational efficiency. ACOs that
75
achieve quality performance standards established by HHS will be
eligible to share in a portion of the amounts saved by the
Medicare program. HHS has significant discretion to determine
key elements of the program, including what steps providers must
take to be considered an ACO, how to decide if Medicare program
savings have occurred, and what portion of such savings will be
paid to ACOs. In addition, HHS will determine to what degree
hospitals, physicians and other eligible participants will be
able to form and operate an ACO without violating certain
existing laws, including the Civil Monetary Penalty Law, the
Anti-kickback Statute and the Stark Law. The Health Reform Law
does not authorize HHS to waive other laws that may impact the
ability of hospitals and other eligible participants to
participate in ACOs, such as antitrust laws.
The Health Reform Law requires HHS to establish a five-year,
voluntary national bundled payment pilot program for Medicare
services beginning no later than January 1, 2013. Under the
program, providers would agree to receive one payment for
services provided to Medicare patients for certain medical
conditions or episodes of care. HHS will have the discretion to
determine how the program will function. For example, HHS will
determine what medical conditions will be included in the
program and the amount of the payment for each condition. In
addition, the Health Reform Law provides for a five-year bundled
payment pilot program for Medicaid services to begin
January 1, 2012. HHS will select up to eight states to
participate based on the potential to lower costs under the
Medicaid program while improving care. State programs may target
particular categories of beneficiaries, selected diagnoses or
geographic regions of the state. The selected state programs
will provide one payment for both hospital and physician
services provided to Medicaid patients for certain episodes of
inpatient care. For both pilot programs, HHS will determine the
relationship between the programs and restrictions in certain
existing laws, including the Civil Monetary Penalty Law, the
Anti-kickback Statute, the Stark Law and the Health Insurance
Portability and Accountability Act of 1996 (HIPAA)
privacy, security and transaction standard requirements.
However, the Health Reform Law does not authorize HHS to waive
other laws that may impact the ability of hospitals and other
eligible participants to participate in the pilot programs, such
as antitrust laws.
Disproportionate
Share Hospitals
In addition to making payments for services provided directly to
beneficiaries, Medicare makes additional payments to hospitals
that treat a disproportionately large number of low-income
patients (Medicaid and Medicare patients eligible to receive
Supplemental Security Income). Disproportionate share hospital
(DSH) payments are determined annually based on
certain statistical information required by HHS and are
calculated as a percentage addition to MS-DRG payments. The
primary method used by a hospital to qualify for DSH payments is
a complex statutory formula that results in a DSH percentage
that is applied to payments on MS-DRGs.
Under the Health Reform Law, beginning in federal fiscal year
2014, Medicare DSH payments will be reduced to 25% of the amount
they otherwise would have been absent the new law. The remaining
75% of the amount that would otherwise be paid under Medicare
DSH will be effectively pooled, and this pool will be reduced
further each year by a formula that reflects reductions in the
national level of uninsured who are under 65 years of age. Each
DSH hospital will then be paid, out of the reduced DSH payment
pool, an amount allocated based upon its level of uncompensated
care. It is difficult to predict the full impact of the Medicare
DSH reductions. The CBO estimates $22 billion in reductions
to Medicare DSH payments between 2010 and 2019, while for the
same time period, CMS estimates reimbursement reductions
totaling $50 billion.
Hospitals that provide care to a disproportionately high number
of low-income patients may receive Medicaid DSH payments. The
federal government distributes federal Medicaid DSH funds to
each state based on a statutory formula. The states then
distribute the DSH funding among qualifying hospitals. States
have broad discretion to define which hospitals qualify for
Medicaid DSH payments and the amount of such payments. The
Health Reform Law will reduce funding for the Medicaid DSH
hospital program in federal fiscal years 2014 through 2020 by
the following amounts: 2014 ($500 million); 2015
($600 million); 2016 ($600 million); 2017
($1.8 billion); 2018 ($5 billion); 2019
($5.6 billion); and 2020 ($4 billion). How such cuts
are allocated among the states and how the states allocate these
cuts among providers, have yet to be determined.
76
TRICARE
TRICARE is the Department of Defenses health care program
for members of the armed forces. On May 1, 2009, the
Department of Defense implemented a prospective payment system
for hospital outpatient services furnished to TRICARE
beneficiaries similar to that utilized for services furnished to
Medicare beneficiaries. Because the Medicare outpatient
prospective payment system APC rates have historically been
below TRICARE rates, the adoption of this payment methodology
for TRICARE beneficiaries reduces our reimbursement; however,
TRICARE outpatient services do not represent a significant
portion of our patient volumes.
Annual
Cost Reports
All hospitals participating in the Medicare, Medicaid and
TRICARE programs, whether paid on a reasonable cost basis or
under a PPS, are required to meet certain financial reporting
requirements. Federal and, where applicable, state regulations
require the submission of annual cost reports covering the
revenues, costs and expenses associated with the services
provided by each hospital to Medicare beneficiaries and Medicaid
recipients.
Annual cost reports required under the Medicare and Medicaid
programs are subject to routine audits, which may result in
adjustments to the amounts ultimately determined to be due to us
under these reimbursement programs. These audits often require
several years to reach the final determination of amounts due to
or from us under these programs. Providers also have rights of
appeal, and it is common to contest issues raised in audits of
cost reports.
Managed
Care and Other Discounted Plans
Most of our hospitals offer discounts from established charges
to certain large group purchasers of health care services,
including managed care plans and private insurance companies.
Admissions reimbursed by commercial managed care and other
insurers were 34%, 35% and 37% of our total admissions for the
years ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
Managed care contracts are typically negotiated for terms
between one and three years. While we generally received annual
average yield increases of 6% to 7% from managed care payers
during 2009, there can be no assurance that we will continue to
receive increases in the future. It is not clear what impact, if
any, the increased obligations on managed care payers and other
health plans imposed by the Health Reform Law will have on our
ability to negotiate reimbursement increases.
Uninsured
and Self-Pay Patients
A high percentage of our uninsured patients are initially
admitted through our emergency rooms. For the year ended
December 31, 2009, approximately 81% of our admissions of
uninsured patients occurred through our emergency rooms. The
Emergency Medical Treatment and Active Labor Act
(EMTALA) requires any hospital that participates in
the Medicare program to conduct an appropriate medical screening
examination of every person who presents to the hospitals
emergency room for treatment and, if the individual is suffering
from an emergency medical condition, to either stabilize that
condition or make an appropriate transfer of the individual to a
facility that can handle the condition. The obligation to screen
and stabilize emergency medical conditions exists regardless of
an individuals ability to pay for treatment. The Health
Reform Law requires health plans to reimburse hospitals for
emergency services provided to enrollees without prior
authorization and without regard to whether a participating
provider contract is in place. Further, the Health Reform Law
contains provisions that seek to decrease the number of
uninsured individuals, including requirements, which do not
become effective until 2014, for individuals to obtain, and
employers to provide, insurance coverage. These mandates may
reduce the financial impact of screening for and stabilizing
emergency medical conditions. However, many factors are unknown
regarding the impact of the Health Reform Law, including how
many previously uninsured individuals will obtain coverage as a
result of the new law or the change, if any, in the volume of
inpatient and outpatient hospital services that are sought by
and provided to previously uninsured individuals. In addition,
it is difficult to predict the full impact of the Health Reform
Law due to the
77
laws complexity, lack of implementing regulations or
interpretive guidance, gradual implementation and possible
amendment.
We are taking proactive measures to reduce our provision for
doubtful accounts by, among other things: screening all
patients, including the uninsured, through our emergency
screening protocol, to determine the appropriate care setting in
light of their condition, while reducing the potential for bad
debt and increasing up-front collections from patients subject
to co-pay and deductible requirements and uninsured patients.
Hospital
Utilization
We believe that the most important factors relating to the
overall utilization of a hospital are the quality and market
position of the hospital and the number and quality of
physicians and other health care professionals providing patient
care within the facility. Generally, we believe the ability of a
hospital to be a market leader is determined by its breadth of
services, level of technology, emphasis on quality of care and
convenience for patients and physicians. Other factors that
impact utilization include the growth in local population, local
economic conditions and market penetration of managed care
programs.
The following table sets forth certain operating statistics for
our health care facilities. Health care facility operations are
subject to certain seasonal fluctuations, including decreases in
patient utilization during holiday periods and increases in the
cold weather months. The data set forth in this table includes
only those facilities that are consolidated for financial
reporting purposes.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Years Ended December 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
2005
|
|
|
Number of hospitals at end of period(a)
|
|
|
155
|
|
|
|
158
|
|
|
|
161
|
|
|
|
166
|
|
|
|
175
|
|
Number of freestanding outpatient surgery centers at end of
period(b)
|
|
|
97
|
|
|
|
97
|
|
|
|
99
|
|
|
|
98
|
|
|
|
87
|
|
Number of licensed beds at end of period(c)
|
|
|
38,839
|
|
|
|
38,504
|
|
|
|
38,405
|
|
|
|
39,354
|
|
|
|
41,265
|
|
Weighted average licensed beds(d)
|
|
|
38,825
|
|
|
|
38,422
|
|
|
|
39,065
|
|
|
|
40,653
|
|
|
|
41,902
|
|
Admissions(e)
|
|
|
1,556,500
|
|
|
|
1,541,800
|
|
|
|
1,552,700
|
|
|
|
1,610,100
|
|
|
|
1,647,800
|
|
Equivalent admissions(f)
|
|
|
2,439,000
|
|
|
|
2,363,600
|
|
|
|
2,352,400
|
|
|
|
2,416,700
|
|
|
|
2,476,600
|
|
Average length of stay (days)(g)
|
|
|
4.8
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
|
|
4.9
|
|
Average daily census(h)
|
|
|
20,650
|
|
|
|
20,795
|
|
|
|
21,049
|
|
|
|
21,688
|
|
|
|
22,225
|
|
Occupancy rate(i)
|
|
|
53
|
%
|
|
|
54
|
%
|
|
|
54
|
%
|
|
|
53
|
%
|
|
|
53
|
%
|
Emergency room visits(j)
|
|
|
5,593,500
|
|
|
|
5,246,400
|
|
|
|
5,116,100
|
|
|
|
5,213,500
|
|
|
|
5,415,200
|
|
Outpatient surgeries(k)
|
|
|
794,600
|
|
|
|
797,400
|
|
|
|
804,900
|
|
|
|
820,900
|
|
|
|
836,600
|
|
Inpatient surgeries(l)
|
|
|
494,500
|
|
|
|
493,100
|
|
|
|
516,500
|
|
|
|
533,100
|
|
|
|
541,400
|
|
|
|
|
(a) |
|
Excludes eight facilities in 2009, 2008 and 2007 and seven
facilities in 2006 and 2005 that are not consolidated (accounted
for using the equity method) for financial reporting purposes. |
|
(b) |
|
Excludes eight facilities in 2009 and 2008, nine facilities in
2007 and 2006 and seven facilities in 2005 that are not
consolidated (accounted for using the equity method) for
financial reporting purposes. |
|
(c) |
|
Licensed beds are those beds for which a facility has been
granted approval to operate from the applicable state licensing
agency. |
|
(d) |
|
Weighted average licensed beds represents the average number of
licensed beds, weighted based on periods owned. |
|
(e) |
|
Represents the total number of patients admitted to our
hospitals and is used by management and certain investors as a
general measure of inpatient volume. |
|
(f) |
|
Equivalent admissions are used by management and certain
investors as a general measure of combined inpatient and
outpatient volume. Equivalent admissions are computed by
multiplying admissions (inpatient volume) by the sum of gross
inpatient revenue and gross outpatient revenue and then dividing
the |
78
|
|
|
|
|
resulting amount by gross inpatient revenue. The equivalent
admissions computation equates outpatient revenue to
the volume measure (admissions) used to measure inpatient
volume, resulting in a general measure of combined inpatient and
outpatient volume. |
|
(g) |
|
Represents the average number of days admitted patients stay in
our hospitals. |
|
(h) |
|
Represents the average number of patients in our hospital beds
each day. |
|
(i) |
|
Represents the percentage of hospital licensed beds occupied by
patients. Both average daily census and occupancy rate provide
measures of the utilization of inpatient rooms. |
|
(j) |
|
Represents the number of patients treated in our emergency rooms. |
|
(k) |
|
Represents the number of surgeries performed on patients who
were not admitted to our hospitals. Pain management and
endoscopy procedures are not included in outpatient surgeries. |
|
(l) |
|
Represents the number of surgeries performed on patients who
have been admitted to our hospitals. Pain management and
endoscopy procedures are not included in inpatient surgeries. |
Competition
Generally, other hospitals in the local communities served by
most of our hospitals provide services similar to those offered
by our hospitals. Additionally, in recent years the number of
freestanding ASCs and diagnostic centers (including facilities
owned by physicians) in the geographic areas in which we operate
has increased significantly. As a result, most of our hospitals
operate in a highly competitive environment. In some cases,
competing hospitals are more established than our hospitals.
Some competing hospitals are owned by tax-supported government
agencies and many others are owned by
not-for-profit
entities that may be supported by endowments, charitable
contributions
and/or tax
revenues and are exempt from sales, property and income taxes.
Such exemptions and support are not available to our hospitals.
In certain localities there are large teaching hospitals that
provide highly specialized facilities, equipment and services
which may not be available at most of our hospitals. We are
facing increasing competition from specialty hospitals, some of
which are physician-owned, and both our own and unaffiliated
freestanding ASCs for market share in high margin services.
Psychiatric hospitals frequently attract patients from areas
outside their immediate locale and, therefore, our psychiatric
hospitals compete with both local and regional hospitals,
including the psychiatric units of general, acute care hospitals.
Our strategies are designed to ensure our hospitals are
competitive. We believe our hospitals compete within local
communities on the basis of many factors, including the quality
of care, ability to attract and retain quality physicians,
skilled clinical personnel and other health care professionals,
location, breadth of services, technology offered and prices
charged. Pursuant to the Health Reform Law, hospitals will be
required to publish annually a list of their standard charges
for items and services. We have increased our focus on operating
outpatient services with improved accessibility and more
convenient service for patients, and increased predictability
and efficiency for physicians.
Two of the most significant factors to the competitive position
of a hospital are the number and quality of physicians
affiliated with or employed by the hospital. Although physicians
may at any time terminate their relationship with a hospital we
operate, our hospitals seek to retain physicians with varied
specialties on the hospitals medical staffs and to attract
other qualified physicians. We believe physicians refer patients
to a hospital on the basis of the quality and scope of services
it renders to patients and physicians, the quality of physicians
on the medical staff, the location of the hospital and the
quality of the hospitals facilities, equipment and
employees. Accordingly, we strive to maintain and provide
quality facilities, equipment, employees and services for
physicians and patients.
Another major factor in the competitive position of a hospital
is our ability to negotiate service contracts with purchasers of
group health care services. Managed care plans attempt to direct
and control the use of hospital services and obtain discounts
from hospitals established gross charges. In addition,
employers and traditional health insurers continue to attempt to
contain costs through negotiations with hospitals for managed
care programs and discounts from established gross charges.
Generally, hospitals compete for service contracts
79
with group health care services purchasers on the basis of
price, market reputation, geographic location, quality and range
of services, quality of the medical staff and convenience. Our
future success will depend, in part, on our ability to retain
and renew our managed care contracts and enter into new managed
care contracts on favorable terms. Other health care providers
may impact our ability to enter into managed care contracts or
negotiate increases in our reimbursement and other favorable
terms and conditions. For example, some of our competitors may
negotiate exclusivity provisions with managed care plans or
otherwise restrict the ability of managed care companies to
contract with us. The trend toward consolidation among
non-government payers tends to increase their bargaining power
over fee structures. In addition, as various provisions of the
Health Reform Law are implemented, including the establishment
of Exchanges and limitations on rescissions of coverage and
pre-existing condition exclusions, non-government payers may
increasingly demand reduced fees or be unwilling to negotiate
reimbursement increases. The importance of obtaining contracts
with managed care organizations varies from community to
community, depending on the market strength of such
organizations.
State certificate of need (CON) laws, which place
limitations on a hospitals ability to expand hospital
services and facilities, make capital expenditures and otherwise
make changes in operations, may also have the effect of
restricting competition. We currently operate health care
facilities in a number of states with CON laws. Before issuing a
CON, these states consider the need for additional or expanded
health care facilities or services. In those states which have
no CON laws or which set relatively high levels of expenditures
before they become reviewable by state authorities, competition
in the form of new services, facilities and capital spending is
more prevalent. See Regulation and Other Factors.
We and the health care industry as a whole face the challenge of
continuing to provide quality patient care while dealing with
rising costs and strong competition for patients. Changes in
medical technology, existing and future legislation, regulations
and interpretations and managed care contracting for provider
services by private and government payers remain ongoing
challenges.
Admissions, average lengths of stay and reimbursement amounts
continue to be negatively affected by payer-required
pre-admission authorization, utilization review and payer
pressure to maximize outpatient and alternative health care
delivery services for less acutely ill patients. The Health
Reform Law potentially expands the use of prepayment review by
Medicare contractors by eliminating statutory restrictions on
their use. Increased competition, admission constraints and
payer pressures are expected to continue. To meet these
challenges, we intend to expand our facilities or acquire or
construct new facilities where appropriate, to enhance the
provision of a comprehensive array of outpatient services, offer
market competitive pricing to private payer groups, upgrade
facilities and equipment and offer new or expanded programs and
services.
Environmental
Matters
We are subject to various federal, state and local statutes and
ordinances regulating the discharge of materials into the
environment. We do not believe that we will be required to
expend any material amounts in order to comply with these laws
and regulations.
Insurance
As is typical in the health care industry, we are subject to
claims and legal actions by patients in the ordinary course of
business. Subject to a $5 million per occurrence
self-insured retention, our facilities are insured by our
wholly-owned insurance subsidiary for losses up to
$50 million per occurrence. The insurance subsidiary has
obtained reinsurance for professional liability risks generally
above a retention level of $15 million per occurrence. We
also maintain professional liability insurance with unrelated
commercial carriers for losses in excess of amounts insured by
our insurance subsidiary.
We purchase, from unrelated insurance companies, coverage for
directors and officers liability and property loss in amounts we
believe are adequate. The directors and officers liability
coverage includes a $25 million corporate deductible for
the period prior to the Recapitalization and a $1 million
corporate deductible subsequent to the Recapitalization. In
addition, we will continue to purchase coverage for our
directors and officers on an ongoing basis. The property
coverage includes varying deductibles depending on
80
the cause of the property damage. These deductibles range from
$500,000 per claim up to 5% of the affected property values for
certain flood and wind and earthquake related incidents.
Employees
and Medical Staffs
At March 31, 2010, we had approximately
192,000 employees, including approximately
49,000 part-time employees. References herein to
employees refer to employees of our affiliates. We
are subject to various state and federal laws that regulate
wages, hours, benefits and other terms and conditions relating
to employment. At March 31, 2010, employees at 21 of our
hospitals are represented by various labor unions. It is
possible additional hospitals may unionize in the future. We
consider our employee relations to be good and have not
experienced work stoppages that have materially, adversely
affected our business or results of operations. Our hospitals,
like most hospitals, have experienced labor costs rising faster
than the general inflation rate. In some markets, nurse and
medical support personnel availability has become a significant
operating issue to health care providers. To address this
challenge, we have implemented several initiatives to improve
retention, recruiting, compensation programs and productivity.
Our hospitals are staffed by licensed physicians, who generally
are not employees of our hospitals. However, some physicians
provide services in our hospitals under contracts, which
generally describe a term of service, provide and establish the
duties and obligations of such physicians, require the
maintenance of certain performance criteria and fix compensation
for such services. Any licensed physician may apply to be
accepted to the medical staff of any of our hospitals, but the
hospitals medical staff and the appropriate governing
board of the hospital, in accordance with established
credentialing criteria, must approve acceptance to the staff.
Members of the medical staffs of our hospitals often also serve
on the medical staffs of other hospitals and may terminate their
affiliation with one of our hospitals at any time.
We may be required to continue to enhance wages and benefits to
recruit and retain nurses and other medical support personnel or
to hire more expensive temporary or contract personnel. As a
result, our labor costs could increase. We also depend on the
available labor pool of semi-skilled and unskilled employees in
each of the markets in which we operate. Certain proposed
changes in federal labor laws, including the Employee Free
Choice Act, could increase the likelihood of employee
unionization attempts. To the extent a significant portion of
our employee base unionizes, our costs could increase
materially. In addition, the states in which we operate could
adopt mandatory nurse-staffing ratios or could reduce mandatory
nurse-staffing ratios already in place. State-mandated
nurse-staffing ratios could significantly affect labor costs,
and have an adverse impact on revenues if we are required to
limit patient admissions in order to meet the required ratios.
81
Properties
The following table lists, by state, the number of hospitals
(general, acute care, psychiatric and rehabilitation) directly
or indirectly owned and operated by us as of March 31, 2010:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
State
|
|
Hospitals
|
|
|
Beds
|
|
|
Alaska
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
250
|
|
California
|
|
|
5
|
|
|
|
1,587
|
|
Colorado
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
2,259
|
|
Florida
|
|
|
38
|
|
|
|
9,818
|
|
Georgia
|
|
|
11
|
|
|
|
1,946
|
|
Idaho
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
481
|
|
Indiana
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
278
|
|
Kansas
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
1,286
|
|
Kentucky
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
384
|
|
Louisiana
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
1,251
|
|
Mississippi
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
130
|
|
Missouri
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
1,055
|
|
Nevada
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
1,074
|
|
New Hampshire
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
295
|
|
Oklahoma
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
793
|
|
South Carolina
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
740
|
|
Tennessee
|
|
|
12
|
|
|
|
2,329
|
|
Texas
|
|
|
35
|
|
|
|
10,497
|
|
Utah
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
968
|
|
Virginia
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
2,963
|
|
International
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
England
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
704
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
162
|
|
|
|
41,088
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In addition to the hospitals listed in the above table, we
directly or indirectly operate 106 freestanding surgery centers.
We also operate medical office buildings in conjunction with
some of our hospitals. These office buildings are primarily
occupied by physicians who practice at our hospitals. Fourteen
of our general, acute care hospitals and three of our other
properties have been mortgaged to support our obligations under
our senior secured cash flow credit facility and the first lien
secured notes we issued in 2009 and 2010. These three other
properties are also subject to second mortgages to support our
obligations under the second lien secured notes we issued in
2006 and 2009.
We maintain our headquarters in approximately
1,200,000 square feet of space in the Nashville, Tennessee
area. In addition to the headquarters in Nashville, we maintain
regional service centers related to our shared services
initiatives. These service centers are located in markets in
which we operate hospitals.
We believe our headquarters, hospitals and other facilities are
suitable for their respective uses and are, in general, adequate
for our present needs. Our properties are subject to various
federal, state and local statutes and ordinances regulating
their operation. Management does not believe that compliance
with such statutes and ordinances will materially affect our
financial position or results of operations.
Legal
Proceedings
We operate in a highly regulated and litigious industry. As a
result, various lawsuits, claims and legal and regulatory
proceedings have been and can be expected to be instituted or
asserted against us. The resolution of
82
any such lawsuits, claims or legal and regulatory proceedings
could materially and adversely affect our results of operations
and financial position in a given period.
Government
Investigations, Claims and Litigation
In January 2001, we entered into an eight-year Corporate
Integrity Agreement (the CIA) with the Office of
Inspector General at HHS (OIG), which expired on
January 24, 2009. Under the CIA, we had numerous
affirmative obligations, including the requirement to report
potential violations of applicable federal health care laws and
regulations. Pursuant to these obligations, we reported a number
of potential violations of the Stark Law, the Anti-kickback
Statute, EMTALA and other laws, most of which we consider to be
nonviolations or technical violations. We submitted our final
report pursuant to the CIA on April 30, 2009. In
April 2010, we received notice from the OIG that the final
report was accepted, relieving us of future obligations under
the CIA. However, the government could still determine that our
reporting
and/or our
resolution of reported issues was inadequate. Violation or
breach of the CIA, or violation of federal or state laws
relating to Medicare, Medicaid or similar programs, could
subject us to substantial monetary fines, civil and criminal
penalties
and/or
exclusion from participation in the Medicare and Medicaid
programs. Alleged violations may be pursued by the government or
through private qui tam actions. Sanctions imposed
against us as a result of such actions could have a material,
adverse effect on our results of operations or financial
position.
New
Hampshire Hospital Litigation
In 2006, the Foundation for Seacoast Health (the
Foundation) filed suit against HCA in state court in
New Hampshire. The Foundation alleged that both the 2006
Recapitalization transaction and a prior 1999 intra-corporate
transaction violated a 1983 agreement that placed certain
restrictions on transfers of the Portsmouth Regional Hospital.
In May 2007, the trial court ruled against the Foundation on all
its claims. On appeal, the New Hampshire Supreme Court affirmed
the ruling on the Recapitalization, but remanded to the trial
court the claims based on the 1999 intra-corporate transaction.
The trial court ruled in December 2009 that the 1999
intra-corporate transaction breached the transfer restriction
provisions of the 1983 agreement. The court will now conduct
additional proceedings to determine whether any harm has flowed
from the alleged breach, and if so, what the appropriate remedy
should be. The court may consider whether to, among other
things, award monetary damages, rescind or undo the 1999
intra-corporate transfer or give the Foundation a right to
purchase hospital assets at a price to be determined (which the
Foundation asserts should be below the fair market value of the
hospital).
General
Liability and Other Claims
We are a party to certain proceedings relating to claims for
income taxes and related interest before the IRS Appeals
Division. For a description of those proceedings, see
Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations IRS
Disputes and Note 5 to our consolidated financial
statements.
We are also subject to claims and suits arising in the ordinary
course of business, including claims for personal injuries or
for wrongful restriction of, or interference with,
physicians staff privileges. In certain of these actions
the claimants have asked for punitive damages against us, which
may not be covered by insurance. In the opinion of management,
the ultimate resolution of these pending claims and legal
proceedings will not have a material, adverse effect on our
results of operations or financial position.
83
REGULATION AND
OTHER FACTORS
Licensure,
Certification and Accreditation
Health care facility construction and operation are subject to
numerous federal, state and local regulations relating to the
adequacy of medical care, equipment, personnel, operating
policies and procedures, maintenance of adequate records, fire
prevention, rate-setting and compliance with building codes and
environmental protection laws. Facilities are subject to
periodic inspection by governmental and other authorities to
assure continued compliance with the various standards necessary
for licensing and accreditation. We believe our health care
facilities are properly licensed under applicable state laws.
Each of our acute care hospitals are certified for participation
in the Medicare and Medicaid programs and are accredited by The
Joint Commission. If any facility were to lose its Medicare or
Medicaid certification, the facility would be unable to receive
reimbursement from federal health care programs. If any facility
were to lose accreditation by The Joint Commission, the facility
would be subject to state surveys, potentially be subject to
increased scrutiny by CMS and likely lose payment from
non-government payers. Management believes our facilities are in
substantial compliance with current applicable federal, state,
local and independent review body regulations and standards. The
requirements for licensure, certification and accreditation are
subject to change and, in order to remain qualified, it may
become necessary for us to make changes in our facilities,
equipment, personnel and services. The requirements for
licensure also may include notification or approval in the event
of the transfer or change of ownership. Failure to obtain the
necessary state approval in these circumstances can result in
the inability to complete an acquisition or change of ownership.
Certificates
of Need
In some states where we operate hospitals and other health care
facilities, the construction or expansion of health care
facilities, the acquisition of existing facilities, the transfer
or change of ownership and the addition of new beds or services
may be subject to review by and prior approval of state
regulatory agencies under a CON program. Such laws generally
require the reviewing state agency to determine the public need
for additional or expanded health care facilities and services.
Failure to obtain necessary state approval can result in the
inability to expand facilities, complete an acquisition or
change ownership.
State
Rate Review
Some states have adopted legislation mandating rate or budget
review for hospitals or have adopted taxes on hospital revenues,
assessments or licensure fees to fund indigent health care
within the state. In the aggregate, indigent tax provisions have
not materially, adversely affected our results of operations.
Although we do not currently operate facilities in states that
mandate rate or budget reviews, we cannot predict whether we
will operate in such states in the future, or whether the states
in which we currently operate may adopt legislation mandating
such reviews.
Federal
Health Care Program Regulations
Participation in any federal health care program, including the
Medicare and Medicaid programs, is heavily regulated by statute
and regulation. If a hospital fails to substantially comply with
the numerous conditions of participation in the Medicare and
Medicaid programs or performs certain prohibited acts, the
hospitals participation in the federal health care
programs may be terminated, or civil and/or criminal penalties
may be imposed.
Anti-kickback
Statute
A section of the Social Security Act known as the
Anti-kickback Statute prohibits providers and others
from directly or indirectly soliciting, receiving, offering or
paying any remuneration with the intent of generating referrals
or orders for services or items covered by a federal health care
program. Courts have interpreted this statute broadly and held
that there is a violation of the Anti-kickback Statute if just
one purpose of the remuneration is to generate referrals, even
if there are other lawful purposes. Furthermore, the Health
Reform Law provides that knowledge of the law or the intent to
violate the law is not required.
84
Violations of the Anti-kickback Statute may be punished by a
criminal fine of up to $25,000 for each violation or
imprisonment, civil money penalties of up to $50,000 per
violation and damages of up to three times the total amount of
the remuneration
and/or
exclusion from participation in federal health care programs,
including Medicare and Medicaid. The Health Reform Law provides
that submission of a claim for services or items generated in
violation of the Anti-kickback Statute constitutes a false or
fraudulent claim and may be subject to additional penalties
under the federal False Claims Act (FCA).
The OIG, among other regulatory agencies, is responsible for
identifying and eliminating fraud, abuse and waste. The OIG
carries out this mission through a nationwide program of audits,
investigations and inspections. As one means of providing
guidance to health care providers, the OIG issues Special
Fraud Alerts. These alerts do not have the force of law,
but identify features of arrangements or transactions that the
government believes may cause the arrangements or transactions
to violate the Anti-kickback Statute or other federal health
care laws. The OIG has identified several incentive arrangements
that constitute suspect practices, including: (a) payment
of any incentive by a hospital each time a physician refers a
patient to the hospital, (b) the use of free or
significantly discounted office space or equipment in facilities
usually located close to the hospital, (c) provision of
free or significantly discounted billing, nursing or other staff
services, (d) free training for a physicians office
staff in areas such as management techniques and laboratory
techniques, (e) guarantees which provide, if the
physicians income fails to reach a predetermined level,
the hospital will pay any portion of the remainder,
(f) low-interest or interest-free loans, or loans which may
be forgiven if a physician refers patients to the hospital,
(g) payment of the costs of a physicians travel and
expenses for conferences, (h) coverage on the
hospitals group health insurance plans at an
inappropriately low cost to the physician, (i) payment for
services (which may include consultations at the hospital) which
require few, if any, substantive duties by the physician,
(j) purchasing goods or services from physicians at prices
in excess of their fair market value, and (k) rental of
space in physician offices, at other than fair market value
terms, by persons or entities to which physicians refer. The OIG
has encouraged persons having information about hospitals who
offer the above types of incentives to physicians to report such
information to the OIG.
The OIG also issues Special Advisory Bulletins as a means of
providing guidance to health care providers. These bulletins,
along with the Special Fraud Alerts, have focused on certain
arrangements that could be subject to heightened scrutiny by
government enforcement authorities, including:
(a) contractual joint venture arrangements and other joint
venture arrangements between those in a position to refer
business, such as physicians, and those providing items or
services for which Medicare or Medicaid pays, and
(b) certain gainsharing arrangements, i.e., the
practice of giving physicians a share of any reduction in a
hospitals costs for patient care attributable in part to
the physicians efforts.
In addition to issuing Special Fraud Alerts and Special Advisory
Bulletins, the OIG issues compliance program guidance for
certain types of health care providers. The OIG guidance
identifies a number of risk areas under federal fraud and abuse
statutes and regulations. These areas of risk include
compensation arrangements with physicians, recruitment
arrangements with physicians and joint venture relationships
with physicians.
As authorized by Congress, the OIG has published safe harbor
regulations that outline categories of activities deemed
protected from prosecution under the Anti-kickback Statute.
Currently, there are statutory exceptions and safe harbors for
various activities, including the following: certain investment
interests, space rental, equipment rental, practitioner
recruitment, personnel services and management contracts, sale
of practice, referral services, warranties, discounts,
employees, group purchasing organizations, waiver of beneficiary
coinsurance and deductible amounts, managed care arrangements,
obstetrical malpractice insurance subsidies, investments in
group practices, freestanding surgery centers, ambulance
replenishing, and referral agreements for specialty services.
The fact that conduct or a business arrangement does not fall
within a safe harbor, or it is identified in a Special Fraud
Alert or Advisory Bulletin or as a risk area in the Supplemental
Compliance Guidelines for Hospitals, does not necessarily render
the conduct or business arrangement illegal under the
Anti-kickback Statute. However, such conduct and business
arrangements may lead to increased scrutiny by government
enforcement authorities.
85
We have a variety of financial relationships with physicians and
others who either refer or influence the referral of patients to
our hospitals and other health care facilities, including
employment contracts, leases, medical director agreements,
professional service agreements and joint ventures. We also have
similar relationships with physicians and facilities to which
patients are referred from our facilities. In addition, we
provide financial incentives, including minimum revenue
guarantees, to recruit physicians into the communities served by
our hospitals. While we endeavor to comply with the applicable
safe harbors, certain of our current arrangements, including
joint ventures and financial relationships with physicians and
other referral sources and persons and entities to which we
refer patients, do not qualify for safe harbor protection.
Although we believe our arrangements with physicians and other
referral sources have been structured to comply with current law
and available interpretations, there can be no assurance
regulatory authorities enforcing these laws will determine these
financial arrangements comply with the Anti-kickback Statute or
other applicable laws. An adverse determination could subject us
to liability, including criminal penalties, civil monetary
penalties and exclusion from participation in Medicare, Medicaid
or other federal health care programs.
Stark
Law
The Social Security Act also includes a provision commonly known
as the Stark Law. The Stark Law prevents the entity
from billing Medicare and Medicaid programs for any items or
services that result from a prohibited referral and requires the
entity to refund amounts received for items or services provided
pursuant to the prohibited referral. The law, thus, effectively
prohibits physicians from referring Medicare and Medicaid
patients to entities with which they or any of their immediate
family members have a financial relationship, if these entities
provide certain designated health services
reimbursable by Medicare or Medicaid, including inpatient and
outpatient hospital services, clinical laboratory services and
radiology services. Sanctions for violating the Stark Law
include denial of payment, civil monetary penalties of up to
$15,000 per claim submitted and exclusion from the federal
health care programs. The statute also provides for a penalty of
up to $100,000 for a circumvention scheme. There are exceptions
to the self-referral prohibition for many of the customary
financial arrangements between physicians and providers,
including employment contracts, leases and recruitment
agreements. Unlike safe harbors under the Anti-kickback Statute
with which compliance is voluntary, an arrangement must comply
with every requirement of a Stark Law exception or the
arrangement is in violation of the Stark Law. Although there is
an exception for a physicians ownership interest in an
entire hospital, the Health Reform Law prohibits newly created
physician-owned hospitals from billing for Medicare patients
referred by their physician owners. As a result, the new law
will effectively prevent the formation of physician-owned
hospitals after December 31, 2010. While the new law
grandfathers existing physician-owned hospitals, it does not
allow these hospitals to increase the percentage of physician
ownership and significantly restricts their ability to expand
services.
Through a series of rulemakings, CMS has issued final
regulations implementing the Stark Law. Additional changes to
these regulations, which became effective October 1, 2009,
further restrict the types of arrangements facilities and
physicians may enter, including additional restrictions on
certain leases, percentage compensation arrangements, and
agreements under which a hospital purchases services under
arrangements. While these regulations were intended to
clarify the requirements of the exceptions to the Stark Law, it
is unclear how the government will interpret many of these
exceptions for enforcement purposes. CMS has indicated it is
considering additional changes to the Stark Law regulations.
Because many of these laws and their implementing regulations
are relatively new, we do not always have the benefit of
significant regulatory or judicial interpretation of these laws
and regulations. We attempt to structure our relationships to
meet an exception to the Stark Law, but the regulations
implementing the exceptions are detailed and complex, and we
cannot assure that every relationship complies fully with the
Stark Law.
On September 14, 2007, CMS published an information
collection request called the Disclosure of Financial Relations
Report (DFRR). The DFRR and its supporting
documentation are currently under review by the Office of
Management and Budget, and it is unclear when, or if, it will be
finalized. CMS has indicated that responding hospitals will have
a limited amount of time to compile a significant amount of
information relating to their financial relationships with
physicians. A hospital may be subject to substantial penalties
if it is unable to assemble and report this information within
the required time frame or if any applicable
86
government agency determines that the submission is inaccurate
or incomplete. Depending on the final format of the DFRR,
responding hospitals may be subject to substantial penalties as
a result of enforcement actions brought by government agencies
and whistleblowers acting pursuant to the FCA and similar state
laws, based on such allegations as failure to respond within
required deadlines, that the response is inaccurate or contains
incomplete information, or that the response indicates a
potential violation of the Stark Law or other requirements.
Similar
State Laws
Many states in which we operate also have laws similar to the
Anti-kickback Statute that prohibit payments to physicians for
patient referrals and laws similar to the Stark Law that
prohibit certain self-referrals. The scope of these state laws
is broad, since they can often apply regardless of the source of
payment for care, they frequently cover a broad range of health
care services, and little precedent exists for their
interpretation or enforcement. These statutes typically provide
for criminal and civil penalties, as well as loss of facility
licensure.
Other
Fraud and Abuse Provisions
The Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996
(HIPAA) broadened the scope of certain fraud and
abuse laws by adding several criminal provisions for health care
fraud offenses that apply to all health benefit programs. The
Social Security Act also imposes criminal and civil penalties
for making false claims and statements to Medicare and Medicaid.
False claims include, but are not limited to, billing for
services not rendered or for misrepresenting actual services
rendered in order to obtain higher reimbursement, billing for
unnecessary goods and services and cost report fraud. Federal
enforcement officials have the ability to exclude from Medicare
and Medicaid any investors, officers and managing employees
associated with business entities that have committed health
care fraud, even if the officer or managing employee had no
knowledge of the fraud. Criminal and civil penalties may be
imposed for a number of other prohibited activities, including
failure to return known overpayments, certain gainsharing
arrangements, billing Medicare amounts that are substantially in
excess of a providers usual charges, offering remuneration
to influence a Medicare or Medicaid beneficiarys selection
of a health care provider, contracting with an individual or
entity known to be excluded from a federal health care program,
making or accepting a payment to induce a physician to reduce or
limit services, and soliciting or receiving any remuneration in
return for referring an individual for an item or service
payable by a federal health care program. Like the Anti-kickback
Statute, these provisions are very broad. Under the Health
Reform Law, civil penalties may be imposed for the failure to
report and return an overpayment within 60 days of
identifying the overpayment or by the date a corresponding cost
report is due, whichever is later. To avoid liability, providers
must, among other things, carefully and accurately code claims
for reimbursement, promptly return overpayments and accurately
prepare cost reports.
Some of these provisions, including the federal Civil Monetary
Penalty Law, require a lower burden of proof than other fraud
and abuse laws, including the Anti-kickback Statute. Civil
monetary penalties that may be imposed under the federal Civil
Monetary Penalty Law range from $10,000 to $50,000 per act, and
in some cases may result in penalties of up to three times the
remuneration offered, paid, solicited or received. In addition,
a violator may be subject to exclusion from federal and state
health care programs. Federal and state governments increasingly
use the federal Civil Monetary Penalty Law, especially where
they believe they cannot meet the higher burden of proof
requirements under the Anti-kickback Statute. Further,
individuals can receive up to $1,000 for providing information
on Medicare fraud and abuse that leads to the recovery of at
least $100 of Medicare funds under the Medicare Integrity
Program.
The
Federal False Claims Act and Similar State Laws
The qui tam, or whistleblower, provisions of the FCA
allow private individuals to bring actions on behalf of the
government alleging that the defendant has defrauded the federal
government. Further, the government may use the FCA to prosecute
Medicare and other government program fraud in areas such as
coding errors, billing for services not provided and submitting
false cost reports. When a private party brings a qui tam
action under the FCA, the defendant is not made aware of the
lawsuit until the government commences its own investigation or
makes a determination whether it will intervene. When a
defendant is determined by a
87
court of law to be liable under the FCA, the defendant may be
required to pay three times the actual damages sustained by the
government, plus mandatory civil penalties of between $5,500 and
$11,000 for each separate false claim. There are many potential
bases for liability under the FCA. Liability often arises when
an entity knowingly submits a false claim for reimbursement to
the federal government. The FCA defines the term
knowingly broadly. Though simple negligence will not
give rise to liability under the FCA, submitting a claim with
reckless disregard to its truth or falsity constitutes a
knowing submission under the FCA and, therefore,
will qualify for liability. The Fraud Enforcement and Recovery
Act of 2009 expanded the scope of the FCA by, among other
things, creating liability for knowingly and improperly avoiding
repayment of an overpayment received from the government and
broadening protections for whistleblowers. Under the Health
Reform Law, the FCA is implicated by the knowing failure to
report and return an overpayment within 60 days of
identifying the overpayment or by the date a corresponding cost
report is due, whichever is later. Further, the Health Reform
Law expands the scope of the FCA to cover payments in connection
with the new health insurance exchanges to be created by the
Health Reform Law, if those payments include any federal funds.
In some cases, whistleblowers and the federal government have
taken the position, and some courts have held, that providers
who allegedly have violated other statutes, such as the
Anti-kickback Statute and the Stark Law, have thereby submitted
false claims under the FCA. The Health Reform Law clarifies this
issue with respect to the Anti-kickback Statute by providing
that submission of claims for services or items generated in
violation of the Anti-kickback Statute constitutes a false or
fraudulent claim under the FCA. Every entity that receives at
least $5 million annually in Medicaid payments must have
written policies for all employees, contractors or agents,
providing detailed information about false claims, false
statements and whistleblower protections under certain federal
laws, including the FCA, and similar state laws. In addition,
federal law provides an incentive to states to enact false
claims laws comparable to the FCA. A number of states in which
we operate have adopted their own false claims provisions as
well as their own whistleblower provisions under which a private
party may file a civil lawsuit in state court. We have adopted
and distributed policies pertaining to the FCA and relevant
state laws.
HIPAA
Administrative Simplification and Privacy and Security
Requirements
The Administrative Simplification Provisions of HIPAA require
the use of uniform electronic data transmission standards for
certain health care claims and payment transactions submitted or
received electronically. These provisions are intended to
encourage electronic commerce in the health care industry. HHS
has issued regulations implementing the HIPAA Administrative
Simplification Provisions and compliance with these regulations
is mandatory for our facilities. In addition, HIPAA requires
that each provider use a National Provider Identifier. In
January 2009, CMS published a final rule making changes to the
formats used for certain electronic transactions and requiring
the use of updated standard code sets for certain diagnoses and
procedures known as ICD-10 code sets. While use of the ICD-10
code sets is not mandatory until October 1, 2013, we will
be modifying our payment systems and processes to prepare for
the implementation. Implementing the ICD-10 code sets will
require significant administrative changes, but we believe that
the cost of compliance with these regulations has not had and is
not expected to have a material, adverse effect on our business,
financial position or results of operations. The Health Reform
Law requires HHS to adopt standards for additional electronic
transactions and to establish operating rules to promote
uniformity in the implementation of each standardized electronic
transaction.
The privacy and security regulations promulgated pursuant to
HIPAA extensively regulate the use and disclosure of
individually identifiable health information and require covered
entities, including health plans and most health care providers,
to implement administrative, physical and technical safeguards
to protect the security of such information. The American
Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (ARRA), which
was signed into law on February 17, 2009, broadened the
scope of the HIPAA privacy and security regulations. In
addition, ARRA extends the application of certain provisions of
the security and privacy regulations to business associates
(entities that handle identifiable health information on behalf
of covered entities) and subjects business associates to civil
and criminal penalties for violation of the regulations. We
currently enforce a HIPAA compliance plan, which we believe
complies with HIPAA privacy and security requirements and under
which a HIPAA compliance group monitors our compliance. The
privacy regulations and security
88
regulations have and will continue to impose significant costs
on our facilities in order to comply with these standards.
As required by ARRA, HHS published an interim final rule on
August 24, 2009, that requires covered entities to report
breaches of unsecured protected health information to affected
individuals without unreasonable delay but not to exceed
60 days of discovery of the breach by a covered entity or
its agents. Notification must also be made to HHS and, in
certain situations involving large breaches, to the media. HHS
is required to publish on its website a list of all covered
entities that report a breach involving more than 500
individuals. Various state laws and regulations may also require
us to notify affected individuals in the event of a data breach
involving individually identifiable information.
Violations of the HIPAA privacy and security regulations may
result in civil and criminal penalties, and ARRA has
strengthened the enforcement provisions of HIPAA, which may
result in increased enforcement activity. Under ARRA, HHS is
required to conduct periodic compliance audits of covered
entities and their business associates. ARRA broadens the
applicability of the criminal penalty provisions to employees of
covered entities and requires HHS to impose penalties for
violations resulting from willful neglect. ARRA also
significantly increases the amount of the civil penalties, with
penalties of up to $50,000 per violation for a maximum civil
penalty of $1,500,000 in a calendar year for violations of the
same requirement. In addition, ARRA authorizes state attorneys
general to bring civil actions seeking either injunction or
damages in response to violations of HIPAA privacy and security
regulations that threaten the privacy of state residents. Our
facilities also remain subject to any federal or state
privacy-related laws that are more restrictive than the privacy
regulations issued under HIPAA. These laws vary and could impose
additional penalties.
There are numerous other laws and legislative and regulatory
initiatives at the federal and state levels addressing privacy
and security concerns. For example, the Federal Trade Commission
issued a final rule in October 2007 requiring financial
institutions and creditors, which may include health providers
and health plans, to implement written identity theft prevention
programs to detect, prevent and mitigate identity theft in
connection with certain accounts. The Federal Trade Commission
has delayed enforcement of this rule until June 1, 2010.
EMTALA
All of our hospitals in the United States are subject to EMTALA.
This federal law requires any hospital participating in the
Medicare program to conduct an appropriate medical screening
examination of every individual who presents to the
hospitals emergency room for treatment and, if the
individual is suffering from an emergency medical condition, to
either stabilize the condition or make an appropriate transfer
of the individual to a facility able to handle the condition.
The obligation to screen and stabilize emergency medical
conditions exists regardless of an individuals ability to
pay for treatment. There are severe penalties under EMTALA if a
hospital fails to screen or appropriately stabilize or transfer
an individual or if the hospital delays appropriate treatment in
order to first inquire about the individuals ability to
pay. Penalties for violations of EMTALA include civil monetary
penalties and exclusion from participation in the Medicare
program. In addition, an injured individual, the
individuals family or a medical facility that suffers a
financial loss as a direct result of a hospitals violation
of the law can bring a civil suit against the hospital.
The government broadly interprets EMTALA to cover situations in
which individuals do not actually present to a hospitals
emergency room, but present for emergency examination or
treatment to the hospitals campus, generally, or to a
hospital-based clinic that treats emergency medical conditions
or are transported in a hospital-owned ambulance, subject to
certain exceptions. At least one court has interpreted the law
also to apply to a hospital that has been notified of a
patients pending arrival in a non-hospital owned
ambulance. EMTALA does not generally apply to individuals
admitted for inpatient services. The government has expressed
its intent to investigate and enforce EMTALA violations actively
in the future. We believe our hospitals operate in substantial
compliance with EMTALA.
Corporate
Practice of Medicine/Fee Splitting
Some of the states in which we operate have laws prohibiting
corporations and other entities from employing physicians,
practicing medicine for a profit and making certain direct and
indirect payments or fee-splitting
89
arrangements between health care providers designed to induce or
encourage the referral of patients to, or the recommendation of,
particular providers for medical products and services. Possible
sanctions for violation of these restrictions include loss of
license and civil and criminal penalties. In addition,
agreements between the corporation and the physician may be
considered void and unenforceable. These statutes vary from
state to state, are often vague and have seldom been interpreted
by the courts or regulatory agencies.
Health
Care Industry Investigations
Significant media and public attention has focused in recent
years on the hospital industry. This media and public attention,
changes in government personnel or other factors may lead to
increased scrutiny of the health care industry. While we are
currently not aware of any material investigations of the
Company under federal or state health care laws or regulations,
it is possible that governmental entities could initiate
investigations or litigation in the future at facilities we
operate and that such matters could result in significant
penalties, as well as adverse publicity. It is also possible
that our executives and managers could be included in
governmental investigations or litigation or named as defendants
in private litigation.
Our substantial Medicare, Medicaid and other governmental
billings result in heightened scrutiny of our operations. We
continue to monitor all aspects of our business and have
developed a comprehensive ethics and compliance program that is
designed to meet or exceed applicable federal guidelines and
industry standards. Because the law in this area is complex and
constantly evolving, governmental investigations or litigation
may result in interpretations that are inconsistent with our or
industry practices.
In public statements surrounding current investigations,
governmental authorities have taken positions on a number of
issues, including some for which little official interpretation
previously has been available, that appear to be inconsistent
with practices that have been common within the industry and
that previously have not been challenged in this manner. In some
instances, government investigations that have in the past been
conducted under the civil provisions of federal law may now be
conducted as criminal investigations.
Both federal and state government agencies have increased their
focus on and coordination of civil and criminal enforcement
efforts in the health care area. The OIG and the Department of
Justice have, from time to time, established national
enforcement initiatives, targeting all hospital providers that
focus on specific billing practices or other suspected areas of
abuse. The Health Reform Law includes additional federal funding
of $350 million over the next 10 years to fight health
care fraud, waste and abuse, including $95 million for
federal fiscal year 2011, $55 million in federal fiscal
year 2012 and additional increased funding through 2016. In
addition, governmental agencies and their agents, such as the
MACs, fiscal intermediaries and carriers, may conduct audits of
our health care operations. Private payers may conduct similar
post-payment audits, and we also perform internal audits and
monitoring.
In addition to national enforcement initiatives, federal and
state investigations have addressed a wide variety of routine
health care operations such as: cost reporting and billing
practices, including for Medicare outliers; financial
arrangements with referral sources; physician recruitment
activities; physician joint ventures; and hospital charges and
collection practices for self-pay patients. We engage in many of
these routine health care operations and other activities that
could be the subject of governmental investigations or
inquiries. For example, we have significant Medicare and
Medicaid billings, numerous financial arrangements with
physicians who are referral sources to our hospitals and joint
venture arrangements involving physician investors. Certain of
our individual facilities have received, and other facilities
may receive, government inquiries from federal and state
agencies. Any additional investigations of the Company, our
executives or managers could result in significant liabilities
or penalties to us, as well as adverse publicity.
Commencing in 1997, we became aware we were the subject of
governmental investigations and litigation relating to our
business practices. As part of the investigations, the United
States intervened in a number of qui tam actions brought
by private parties. The investigations related to, among other
things, DRG coding, outpatient laboratory billing, home health
issues, physician relations, cost report and wound care issues.
The investigations were concluded through a series of agreements
executed in 2000 and 2003 with the Criminal Division of the
Department of Justice, the Civil Division of the Department of
Justice, various U.S. Attorneys offices, CMS, a
negotiating team representing states with claims against us, and
others. In January 2001, we entered into an eight-
90
year CIA with the OIG, which expired January 24, 2009. We
submitted our final report pursuant to the CIA on April 30,
2009, and in April 2010, we received notice from the OIG that
our final report was accepted, relieving us of future
obligations under the CIA. If the government were to determine
that we violated or breached the CIA or other federal or state
laws relating to Medicare, Medicaid or similar programs, we
could be subject to substantial monetary fines, civil and
criminal penalties
and/or
exclusion from participation in the Medicare and Medicaid
programs and other federal and state health care programs.
Alleged violations may be pursued by the government or through
private qui tam actions. Sanctions imposed against us as
a result of such actions could have a material, adverse effect
on our results of operations and financial position.
Health
Care Reform
The Health Reform Law will change how health care services are
covered, delivered and reimbursed through expanded coverage of
uninsured individuals, reduced growth in Medicare program
spending, reductions in Medicare and Medicaid DSH payments, and
the establishment of programs where reimbursement is tied to
quality and integration. In addition, the new law reforms
certain aspects of health insurance, expands existing efforts to
tie Medicare and Medicaid payments to performance and quality,
and contains provisions intended to strengthen fraud and abuse
enforcement.
Expanded
Coverage
Based on the Congressional Budget Office (CBO) and
CMS estimates, by 2019, the Health Reform Law will expand
coverage to 32 to 34 million additional individuals
(resulting in coverage of an estimated 94% of the legal
U.S. population). This increased coverage will occur
through a combination of public program expansion and private
sector health insurance and other reforms.
Medicaid
Expansion
The primary public program coverage expansion will occur through
changes in Medicaid, and to a lesser extent, expansion of the
Childrens Health Insurance Program (CHIP). The
most significant changes will expand the categories of
individuals eligible for Medicaid coverage and permit
individuals with relatively higher incomes to qualify. The
federal government reimburses the majority of a states
Medicaid expenses, and it conditions its payment on the state
meeting certain requirements. The federal government currently
requires that states provide coverage for only limited
categories of low-income adults under 65 years old (e.g.,
women who are pregnant, and the blind or disabled). In addition,
the income level required for individuals and families to
qualify for Medicaid varies widely from state to state.
The Health Reform Law materially changes the requirements for
Medicaid eligibility. Commencing January 1, 2014, all state
Medicaid programs are required to provide, and the federal
government will subsidize, Medicaid coverage to virtually all
adults under 65 years old with incomes at or under 133% of
the FPL. This expansion will create a minimum Medicaid
eligibility threshold that is uniform across states. Further,
the Health Reform Law also requires states to apply a
5% income disregard to the Medicaid
eligibility standard, so that Medicaid eligibility will
effectively be extended to those with incomes up to 138% of the
FPL. These new eligibility requirements will expand Medicaid and
CHIP coverage by an estimated 16 to 18 million persons
nationwide. A disproportionately large percentage of the new
Medicaid coverage is likely to be in states that currently have
relatively low income eligibility requirements.
As Medicaid is a joint federal and state program, the federal
government provides states with matching funds in a
defined percentage, known as the federal medical assistance
percentage (FMAP). Beginning in 2014, states will
receive an enhanced FMAP for the individuals enrolled in
Medicaid pursuant to the Health Reform Law. The FMAP percentage
is as follows: 100% for calendar years 2014 through 2016; 95%
for 2017; 94% in 2018; 93% in 2019; and 90% in 2020 and
thereafter.
The Health Reform Law also provides that the federal government
will subsidize states that create non-Medicaid plans for
residents whose incomes are greater than 133% of the FPL but do
not exceed 200% of the FPL. Approved state plans will be
eligible to receive federal funding. The amount of that funding
per individual will be equal to 95% of subsidies that would have
been provided for that individual had he or she
91
enrolled in a health plan offered through one of the Exchanges,
as discussed below.
Historically, states often have attempted to reduce Medicaid
spending by limiting benefits and tightening Medicaid
eligibility requirements. Effective March 23, 2010, the
Health Reform Law requires states to at least maintain Medicaid
eligibility standards established prior to the enactment of the
law for adults until January 1, 2014 and for children until
October 1, 2019. States with budget deficits may, however,
seek exemptions from this requirement, but only to address
eligibility standards that apply to adults making more than 133%
of the FPL.
Private
Sector Expansion
The expansion of health coverage through the private sector as a
result of the Health Reform Law will occur through new
requirements on health insurers, employers and individuals.
Commencing January 1, 2014, health insurance companies will
be prohibited from imposing annual coverage limits, dropping
coverage, excluding persons based upon pre-existing conditions
or denying coverage for any individual who is willing to pay the
premiums for such coverage. Effective January 1, 2011, each
health plan must keep its annual non-medical costs lower than
15% of premium revenue for the group market and lower than 20%
in the small group and individual markets or rebate its
enrollees the amount spent in excess of the percentage. In
addition, effective September 23, 2010, health insurers
will not be permitted to deny coverage to children based upon a
pre-existing condition and must allow dependent care coverage
for children up to 26 years old.
Larger employers will be subject to new requirements and
incentives to provide health insurance benefits to their full
time employees. Effective January 1, 2014, employers with
50 or more employees that do not offer health insurance will be
held subject to a penalty if an employee obtains coverage
through an Exchange if the coverage is subsidized by the
government. The employer penalties will range from $2,000 to
$3,000 per employee, subject to certain thresholds and
conditions.
The Health Reform Law uses various means to induce individuals
who do not have health insurance to obtain coverage. By
January 1, 2014, individuals will be required to maintain
health insurance for a minimum defined set of benefits or pay a
tax penalty. The penalty in most cases is $95 in 2014, $325 in
2015, $695 in 2016, and indexed to a cost of living adjustment
in subsequent years. The IRS, in consultation with HHS, is
responsible for enforcing the tax penalty, although the Health
Reform Law limits the availability of certain IRS enforcement
mechanisms. In addition, for individuals and families below 400%
of the FPL, the cost of obtaining health insurance will be
subsidized by the federal government. Those with lower incomes
will be eligible to receive greater subsidies. It is anticipated
that those at the lowest income levels will have the majority of
their premiums subsidized by the federal government, in some
cases in excess of 95% of the premium amount.
To facilitate the purchase of health insurance by individuals
and small employers, each state must establish an Exchange by
January 1, 2014. Based on CBO and CMS estimates, between 29
and 31 million individuals will obtain their health
insurance coverage through an Exchange by 2019. Of that amount,
an estimated 16 million will be individuals who were
previously uninsured, and 13 to 15 million will be
individuals who switched from their prior insurance coverage to
a plan obtained through the Exchange. The Health Reform Law
requires that the Exchanges be designed to make the process of
evaluating, comparing and acquiring coverage simple for
consumers. For example, each states Exchange must maintain
an internet website through which consumers may access health
plan ratings that are assigned by the state based on quality and
price, view governmental health program eligibility requirements
and calculate the actual cost of health coverage. Health
insurers participating in the Exchange must offer a set of
minimum benefits to be defined by HHS and may offer more
benefits. Health insurers must offer at least two, and up to
five, levels of plans that vary by the percentage of medical
expenses that must be paid by the enrollee. These levels are
referred to as platinum, gold, silver, bronze and catastrophic
plans, with gold and silver being the two mandatory levels of
plans. Each level of plan must require the enrollee to share the
following percentages of medical expenses up to the
deductible/co-payment limit: platinum, 10%; gold, 20%; silver,
30%; bronze, 40%; and catastrophic, 100%. Health insurers may
establish varying deductible/co-payment levels, up to the
statutory
92
maximum (estimated to be between $6,000 and $7,000 for an
individual). The health insurers must cover 100% of the amount
of medical expenses in excess of the deductible/co-payment
limit. For example, an individual making 100% to 200% of the FPL
will have co-payments and deductibles reduced to about one-third
of the amount payable by those with the same plan with incomes
at or above 400% of the FPL.
Public
Program Spending
The Health Reform Law provides for Medicare, Medicaid and other
federal health care program spending reductions between 2010 and
2019. The CBO estimates that these will include
$156 billion in Medicare
fee-for-service
market basket and productivity reimbursement reductions for all
providers, the majority of which will come from hospitals; CMS
sets this estimate at $233 billion. The CBO estimates also
include an additional $36 billion in reductions of Medicare
and Medicaid disproportionate share funding ($22 billion
for Medicare and $14 billion for Medicaid). CMS estimates
include an additional $64 billion in reductions of Medicare
and Medicaid disproportionate share funding, with
$50 billion of the reductions coming from Medicare.
Payments
for Hospitals and ASCs
Inpatient Market Basket and Productivity
Adjustment. Under the Medicare program,
hospitals receive reimbursement under a PPS for general, acute
care hospital inpatient services. CMS establishes fixed PPS
payment amounts per inpatient discharge based on the
patients assigned MS-DRG. These MS-DRG rates are updated
each federal fiscal year, which begins October 1, using the
market basket, which takes into account inflation experienced by
hospitals and other entities outside the health care industry in
purchasing goods and services.
The Health Reform Law provides for three types of annual
reductions in the market basket. The first is a general
reduction of a specified percentage each federal fiscal year
starting in 2010 and extending through 2019. These reductions
are as follows: federal fiscal year 2010, 0.25% for discharges
occurring on or after April 1, 2010; 2011 (0.25%); 2012
(0.1%); 2013 (0.1%); 2014 (0.3%); 2015 (0.2%); 2016 (0.2%); 2017
(0.75%); 2018 (0.75%); and 2019 (0.75%).
The second type of reduction to the market basket is a
productivity adjustment that will be implemented by
HHS beginning in federal fiscal year 2012. The amount of that
reduction will be the projected nationwide productivity gains
over the preceding 10 years. To determine the projection,
HHS will use the Bureau of Labor Statistics (BLS)
10-year
moving average of changes in specified economy-wide productivity
(the BLS data is typically a few years old). The Health Reform
Law does not contain guidelines for HHS to use in projecting the
productivity figure. Based upon the latest available data,
federal fiscal year 2012 market basket reductions resulting from
this productivity adjustment are likely to range from 1% to 1.4%.
The third type of reduction is in connection with the
value-based purchasing program discussed in more detail below.
Beginning in federal fiscal year 2013, CMS will reduce the
inpatient PPS payment amount for all discharges by the
following: 1% for 2013; 1.25% for 2014; 1.5% for 2015; 1.75% for
2016; and 2% for 2017 and subsequent years. For each federal
fiscal year, the total amount collected from these reductions
will be pooled and used to fund payments to hospitals that
satisfy certain quality metrics. While some or all of these
reductions may be recovered if a hospital satisfies these
quality metrics, the recovery amounts may be delayed.
If the aggregate of the three market basket reductions described
above is more than the annual market basket adjustments made to
account for inflation, there will be a reduction in the MS-DRG
rates paid to hospitals. For example, if market basket increases
to account for inflation would result in a 2% market basket
update and the aggregate Health Reform Law market basket
adjustments would result in a 3% reduction, then the rates paid
to a hospital for inpatient services would be 1% less than rates
paid for the same services in the prior year.
93
Quality-Based Payment Adjustments and Reductions for
Inpatient Services. The Health Reform Law
establishes or expands three provisions to promote value-based
purchasing and to link payments to quality and efficiency.
First, in federal fiscal year 2013, HHS is directed to implement
a value-based purchasing program for inpatient hospital
services. This program will reward hospitals that meet certain
quality performance standards established by HHS. The Health
Reform Law provides HHS considerable discretion over the
value-based purchasing program. For example, HHS will have the
authority to determine the quality performance measures, the
standards hospitals must achieve in order to meet the quality
performance measures, and the methodology for calculating
payments to hospitals that meet the required quality threshold.
HHS will also determine how much money each hospital will
receive from the pool of dollars created by the reductions
related to the value-based purchasing program as described
above. Because the Health Reform Law provides that the pool will
be fully distributed, hospitals that meet or exceed the quality
performance standards set by HHS will receive greater
reimbursement under the value-based purchasing program than they
would have otherwise. On the other hand, hospitals that do not
achieve the necessary quality performance will receive reduced
Medicare inpatient hospital payments.
Second, beginning in federal fiscal year 2013, inpatient
payments will be reduced if a hospital experiences
excessive readmissions within a
30-day
period of discharge for heart attack, heart failure, pneumonia
or other conditions designated by HHS. Hospitals with what HHS
defines as excessive readmissions for these
conditions will receive reduced payments for all inpatient
discharges, not just discharges relating to the conditions
subject to the excessive readmission standard. Each
hospitals performance will be publicly reported by HHS.
HHS has the discretion to determine what excessive
readmissions means, the amount of the payment reduction
and other terms and conditions of this program.
Third, reimbursement will be reduced based on a facilitys
hospital acquired condition, or HAC, rates. An HAC is a
condition that is acquired by a patient while admitted as an
inpatient in a hospital, such as a surgical site infection.
Beginning in federal fiscal year 2015, hospitals that rank in
the top 25% nationally of HACs for all hospitals in the previous
year will receive a 1% reduction in their total Medicare
payments. In addition, effective July 1, 2011, the Health
Reform Law prohibits the use of federal funds under the Medicaid
program to reimburse providers for medical services provided to
treat HACs.
Outpatient Market Basket and Productivity
Adjustment. Hospital outpatient services paid
under PPS are classified into APCs. The APC payment rates are
updated each calendar year based on the market basket. The first
two market basket changes outlined above the general
reduction and the productivity adjustment apply to
outpatient services as well as inpatient services, although
these are applied on a calendar year basis. The percentage
changes specified in the Health Reform Law summarized above as
the general reduction for inpatients e.g., 0.2% in
2015 are the same for outpatients.
Medicare and Medicaid Disproportionate Share Hospital
(DSH) Payments. The Medicare DSH
program provides for additional payments to hospitals that treat
a disproportionate share of low-income patients. Under the
Health Reform Law, beginning in federal fiscal year 2014,
Medicare DSH payments will be reduced to 25% of the amount they
otherwise would have been absent the new law. The remaining 75%
of the amount that would otherwise be paid under Medicare DSH
will be effectively pooled, and this pool will be reduced
further each year by a formula that reflects reductions in the
national level of uninsured who are under 65 years of age.
In other words, the greater the level of coverage for the
uninsured nationally, the more the Medicare DSH payment pool
will be reduced. Each hospital will then be paid, out of the
reduced DSH payment pool, an amount allocated based upon its
level of uncompensated care.
It is difficult to predict the full impact of the Medicare DSH
reductions, and CBO and CMS estimates differ by
$38 billion. The Health Reform Law does not mandate what
data source HHS must use to determine the reduction, if any, in
the uninsured population nationally. In addition, the Health
Reform Law does not contain a definition of uncompensated
care. As a result, it is unclear how a hospitals
share of the Medicare DSH payment pool will be calculated. CMS
could use the definition of uncompensated care used
in connection with hospital cost reports. However, in July 2009,
CMS proposed material revisions to the definition of
uncompensated care used for cost report purposes.
Those revisions would exclude certain significant costs that had
historically been covered, such as unreimbursed costs of
Medicaid services. CMS has
94
not issued a final rule, and the Health Reform Law does not
require HHS to use this definition, even if finalized, for DSH
purposes. How CMS ultimately defines uncompensated
care for purposes of these DSH funding provisions could
have a material effect on a hospitals Medicare DSH
reimbursements.
In addition to Medicare DSH funding, hospitals that provide care
to a disproportionately high number of low-income patients may
receive Medicaid DSH payments. The federal government
distributes federal Medicaid DSH funds to each state based on a
statutory formula. The states then distribute the DSH funding
among qualifying hospitals. Although Federal Medicaid law
defines some level of hospitals that must receive Medicaid DSH
funding, states have broad discretion to define additional
hospitals that also may qualify for Medicaid DSH payments and
the amount of such payments. The Health Reform Law will reduce
funding for the Medicaid DSH hospital program in federal fiscal
years 2014 through 2020 by the following amounts: 2014
($500 million); 2015 ($600 million); 2016
($600 million); 2017 ($1.8 billion); 2018
($5 billion); 2019 ($5.6 billion); and 2020
($4 billion). How such cuts are allocated among the states,
and how the states allocate these cuts among providers, have yet
to be determined.
Accountable Care Organizations. The
Health Reform Law requires HHS to establish a Medicare Shared
Savings Program that promotes accountability and coordination of
care through the creation of ACOs. Beginning no later than
January 1, 2012, the program will allow providers
(including hospitals), physicians and other designated
professionals and suppliers to form ACOs and voluntarily
work together to invest in infrastructure and redesign delivery
processes to achieve high quality and efficient delivery of
services. The program is intended to produce savings as a result
of improved quality and operational efficiency. ACOs that
achieve quality performance standards established by HHS will be
eligible to share in a portion of the amounts saved by the
Medicare program. HHS has significant discretion to determine
key elements of the program, including what steps providers must
take to be considered an ACO, how to decide if Medicare program
savings have occurred, and what portion of such savings will be
paid to ACOs. In addition, HHS will determine to what degree
hospitals, physicians and other eligible participants will be
able to form and operate an ACO without violating certain
existing laws, including the Civil Monetary Penalty Law, the
Anti-kickback Statute and the Stark Law. However, the Health
Reform Law does not authorize HHS to waive other laws that may
impact the ability of hospitals and other eligible participants
to participate in ACOs, such as antitrust laws.
Bundled Payment Pilot Programs. The
Health Reform Law requires HHS to establish a five-year,
voluntary national bundled payment pilot program for Medicare
services beginning no later than January 1, 2013. Under the
program, providers would agree to receive one payment for
services provided to Medicare patients for certain medical
conditions or episodes of care. HHS will have the discretion to
determine how the program will function. For example, HHS will
determine what medical conditions will be included in the
program and the amount of the payment for each condition. In
addition, the Health Reform Law provides for a five-year bundled
payment pilot program for Medicaid services to begin
January 1, 2012. HHS will select up to eight states to
participate based on the potential to lower costs under the
Medicaid program while improving care. State programs may target
particular categories of beneficiaries, selected diagnoses or
geographic regions of the state. The selected state programs
will provide one payment for both hospital and physician
services provided to Medicaid patients for certain episodes of
inpatient care. For both pilot programs, HHS will determine the
relationship between the programs and restrictions in certain
existing laws, including the Civil Monetary Penalty Law, the
Anti-kickback Statute, the Stark Law and the HIPAA privacy,
security and transaction standard requirements. However, the
Health Reform Law does not authorize HHS to waive other laws
that may impact the ability of hospitals and other eligible
participants to participate in the pilot programs, such as
antitrust laws.
Ambulatory Surgery Centers. The Health
Reform Law reduces reimbursement for ASCs through a productivity
adjustment to the market basket similar to the productivity
adjustment for inpatient and outpatient hospital services,
beginning in federal fiscal year 2011.
Medicare Managed Care (Medicare Advantage or
MA). Under the MA program, the
federal government contracts with private health plans to
provide inpatient and outpatient benefits to beneficiaries who
enroll in such plans. Nationally, approximately 22% of Medicare
beneficiaries have elected to enroll in MA
95
plans. Effective in 2014, the Health Reform Law requires MA
plans to keep annual administrative costs lower than 15% of
annual premium revenue. The Health Reform Law reduces, over a
three year period, premium payments to the MA Plans such that
CMS managed care per capita premium payments are, on
average, equal to traditional Medicare. As a result of these
changes, payments to MA plans will be reduced by $138 to
$145 billion between 2010 and 2019. These reductions to MA
plan premium payments may cause some plans to raise premiums or
limit benefits, which in turn might cause some Medicare
beneficiaries to terminate their MA coverage and enroll in
traditional Medicare.
Specialty
Hospital Limitations
Over the last decade, we have faced significant competition from
hospitals that have physician ownership. The Health Reform Law
prohibits newly created physician-owned hospitals from billing
for Medicare patients referred by their physician owners. As a
result, the new law will effectively prevent the formation of
physician-owned hospitals after December 31, 2010. While
the new law grandfathers existing physician-owned hospitals, it
does not allow these hospitals to increase the percentage of
physician ownership and significantly restricts their ability to
expand services.
Program
Integrity and Fraud and Abuse
The Health Reform Law makes several significant changes to
health care fraud and abuse laws, provides additional
enforcement tools to the government, increases cooperation
between agencies by establishing mechanisms for the sharing of
information and enhances criminal and administrative penalties
for non-compliance. For example, the Health Reform Law:
(1) provides $350 million in increased federal funding
over the next 10 years to fight health care fraud, waste
and abuse; (2) expands the scope of the RAC program to
include MA plans and Medicaid; (3) authorizes HHS, in
consultation with the OIG, to suspend Medicare and Medicaid
payments to a provider of services or a supplier pending
an investigation of a credible allegation of fraud;
(4) provides Medicare contractors with additional
flexibility to conduct random prepayment reviews; and
(5) tightens up the rules for returning overpayments made
by governmental health programs and expands False Claims Act
liability to include failure to timely repay identified
overpayments.
Impact
of Health Reform Law on the Company
The expansion of health insurance coverage under the Health
Reform Law may result in a material increase in the number of
patients using our facilities who have either private or public
program coverage. In addition, a disproportionately large
percentage of the new Medicaid coverage is likely to be in
states that currently have relatively low income eligibility
requirements. Two such states are Texas and Florida, where about
one-half of the Companys licensed beds are located. The
Company also has a significant presence in other relatively low
income eligibility states, including Georgia, Kansas, Louisiana,
Missouri, Oklahoma and Virginia. Further, the Health Reform Law
provides for a value-based purchasing program, the establishment
of ACOs and bundled payment pilot programs, which will create
possible sources of additional revenue.
However, it is difficult to predict the size of the potential
revenue gains to the Company as a result of these elements of
the Health Reform Law, because of uncertainty surrounding a
number of material factors, including the following:
|
|
|
|
|
how many previously uninsured individuals will obtain coverage
as a result of the Health Reform Law (while the CBO estimates
32 million, CMS estimates almost 34 million; both
agencies made a number of assumptions to derive that figure,
including how many individuals will ignore substantial subsidies
and decide to pay the penalty rather than obtain health
insurance and what percentage of people in the future will meet
the new Medicaid income eligibility requirements);
|
|
|
|
what percentage of the newly insured patients will be covered
under the Medicaid program and what percentage will be covered
by private health insurers;
|
|
|
|
the extent to which states will enroll new Medicaid participants
in managed care programs;
|
96
|
|
|
|
|
the pace at which insurance coverage expands, including the pace
of different types of coverage expansion;
|
|
|
|
the change, if any, in the volume of inpatient and outpatient
hospital services that are sought by and provided to previously
uninsured individuals;
|
|
|
|
the rate paid to hospitals by private payers for newly covered
individuals, including those covered through the newly created
Exchanges and those who might be covered under the Medicaid
program under contracts with the state;
|
|
|
|
the rate paid by state governments under the Medicaid program
for newly covered individuals;
|
|
|
|
how the value-based purchasing and other quality programs will
be implemented;
|
|
|
|
the percentage of individuals in the Exchanges who select the
high deductible plans, since health insurers offering those
kinds of products have traditionally sought to pay lower rates
to hospitals;
|
|
|
|
whether the net effect of the Health Reform Law, including the
prohibition on excluding individuals based on pre-existing
conditions, the requirement to keep medical costs lower than a
specified percentage of premium revenue, other health insurance
reforms and the annual fee applied to all health insurers, will
be to put pressure on the bottom line of health insurers, which
in turn might cause them to seek to reduce payments to hospitals
with respect to both newly insured individuals and their
existing business; and
|
|
|
|
the possibility that implementation of provisions expanding
health insurance coverage will be delayed or even blocked due to
court challenges or revised or eliminated as a result of efforts
to repeal or amend the new law.
|
On the other hand, the Health Reform Law provides for
significant reductions in the growth of Medicare spending,
reductions in Medicare and Medicaid DSH payments and the
establishment of programs where reimbursement is tied to quality
and integration. Since approximately 40% of our revenues in 2009
were from Medicare and Medicaid, reductions to these programs
may significantly impact the Company and could offset any
positive effects of the Health Reform Law. It is difficult to
predict the size of the revenue reductions to Medicare and
Medicaid spending, because of uncertainty regarding a number of
material factors, including the following:
|
|
|
|
|
the amount of overall revenues the Company will generate from
Medicare and Medicaid business when the reductions are
implemented;
|
|
|
|
whether reductions required by the Health Reform Law will be
changed by statute prior to becoming effective;
|
|
|
|
the size of the Health Reform Laws annual productivity
adjustment to the market basket beginning in 2012 payment years;
|
|
|
|
the amount of the Medicare DSH reductions that will be made,
commencing in federal fiscal year 2014;
|
|
|
|
the allocation to our hospitals of the Medicaid DSH reductions,
commencing in federal fiscal year 2014;
|
|
|
|
what the losses in revenues will be, if any, from the Health
Reform Laws quality initiatives;
|
|
|
|
how successful ACOs, in which we participate, will be at
coordinating care and reducing costs;
|
|
|
|
the scope and nature of potential changes to Medicare
reimbursement methods, such as an emphasis on bundling payments
or coordination of care programs;
|
|
|
|
whether the Companys revenues from UPL programs will be
adversely affected, because there may be fewer indigent,
non-Medicaid patients for whom the Company provides services
pursuant to UPL programs; and
|
|
|
|
reductions to Medicare payments CMS may impose for
excessive readmissions.
|
97
Because of the many variables involved, we are unable to predict
the net effect on the Company of the expected increases in
insured individuals using our facilities, the reductions in
Medicare spending and reductions in Medicare and Medicaid DSH
Funding, and numerous other provisions in the Health Reform Law
that may affect the Company.
General
Economic and Demographic Factors
The United States economy has weakened significantly. Depressed
consumer spending and higher unemployment rates continue to
pressure many industries. During economic downturns,
governmental entities often experience budget deficits as a
result of increased costs and lower than expected tax
collections. These budget deficits have forced federal, state
and local government entities to decrease spending for health
and human service programs, including Medicare, Medicaid and
similar programs, which represent significant payer sources for
our hospitals. Other risks we face from general economic
weakness include potential declines in the population covered
under managed care agreements, patient decisions to postpone or
cancel elective and non-emergency health care procedures,
potential increases in the uninsured and underinsured
populations and further difficulties in our collecting patient
co-payment and deductible receivables. The Health Reform Law
seeks to decrease over time the number of uninsured individuals,
by among other things requiring employers to offer, and
individuals to carry, health insurance or be subject to
penalties. However, it is difficult to predict the full impact
of the Health Reform Law due to the laws complexity, lack
of implementing regulations or interpretive guidance, gradual
implementation and possible amendment.
The health care industry is impacted by the overall United
States financial pressures. The federal deficit, the growing
magnitude of Medicare expenditures and the aging of the United
States population will continue to place pressure on federal
health care programs.
Compliance
Program and Corporate Integrity Agreement
We maintain a comprehensive ethics and compliance program that
is designed to meet or exceed applicable federal guidelines and
industry standards. The program is intended to monitor and raise
awareness of various regulatory issues among employees and to
emphasize the importance of complying with governmental laws and
regulations. As part of the ethics and compliance program, we
provide annual ethics and compliance training to our employees
and encourage all employees to report any violations to their
supervisor, an ethics and compliance officer or a toll-free
telephone ethics line. The Health Reform Law requires providers
to implement core elements of a compliance program criteria to
be established by HHS, on a timeline to be established by HHS,
as a condition of enrollment in the Medicare or Medicaid
programs, and we may have to modify our compliance programs to
comply with these new criteria.
Until January 24, 2009, we operated under a CIA, which was
structured to assure the federal government of our overall
federal health care program compliance and specifically covered
DRG coding, outpatient PPS billing and physician relations. We
underwent major training efforts to ensure that our employees
learned and applied the policies and procedures implemented
under the CIA and our ethics and compliance program. The CIA had
the effect of increasing the amount of information we provided
to the federal government regarding our health care practices
and our compliance with federal regulations. Under the CIA, we
had numerous affirmative obligations, including the requirement
to report potential violations of applicable federal health care
laws and regulations. Pursuant to this obligation, we reported a
number of potential violations of the Stark Law, the
Anti-kickback Statute, EMTALA, HIPAA and other laws, most of
which we consider to be nonviolations or technical violations.
We submitted our final report pursuant to the CIA on
April 30, 2009, and in April 2010, we received notice from
the OIG that our final report was accepted, relieving us of
future obligations under the CIA. These reports could result in
greater scrutiny by regulatory authorities. The government could
determine that our reporting
and/or our
resolution of reported issues was inadequate. A determination
that we breached the CIA
and/or a
finding of violations of applicable health care laws or
regulations could subject us to repayment requirements,
substantial monetary penalties, civil penalties, exclusion from
participation in the Medicare and Medicaid and other federal and
state health care programs and, for violations of certain laws
and regulations, criminal penalties. Although the CIA expired on
January 24, 2009, we maintain our ethics and compliance
program in substantially the same form. However, the audit plans
in the CIA have been modified, and the reportable events process
has been converted to an internal reporting process.
98
Antitrust
Laws
The federal government and most states have enacted antitrust
laws that prohibit certain types of conduct deemed to be
anti-competitive. These laws prohibit price fixing, concerted
refusal to deal, market monopolization, price discrimination,
tying arrangements, acquisitions of competitors and other
practices that have, or may have, an adverse effect on
competition. Violations of federal or state antitrust laws can
result in various sanctions, including criminal and civil
penalties. Antitrust enforcement in the health care industry is
currently a priority of the Federal Trade Commission. We believe
we are in compliance with such federal and state laws, but
future review of our practices by courts or regulatory
authorities could result in a determination that could adversely
affect our operations.
99
MANAGEMENT
Directors
The following is a brief description of the background and
business experience of each member of our Board of Directors:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Director
|
|
|
Name
|
|
Age(1)
|
|
Since
|
|
Position(s)
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
57
|
|
|
|
2002
|
|
|
Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
53
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Director
|
Christopher J. Birosak
|
|
|
56
|
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
Director
|
John P. Connaughton
|
|
|
44
|
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
Director
|
James D. Forbes
|
|
|
50
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Director
|
Kenneth W. Freeman
|
|
|
59
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Director
|
Thomas F. Frist III
|
|
|
42
|
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
Director
|
William R. Frist
|
|
|
40
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Director
|
Christopher R. Gordon
|
|
|
37
|
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
Director
|
Michael W. Michelson
|
|
|
58
|
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
Director
|
James C. Momtazee
|
|
|
38
|
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
Director
|
Stephen G. Pagliuca
|
|
|
55
|
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
Director
|
Nathan C. Thorne
|
|
|
56
|
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
Director
|
Richard M. Bracken has served as Chief Executive Officer
of the Company since January 2009 and was appointed as Chairman
of the Board in December 2009. Mr. Bracken served as
President and Chief Executive Officer from January 2009 to
December 2009. Mr. Bracken was appointed Chief Operating
Officer in July 2001 and served as President and Chief Operating
Officer from January 2002 to January 2009. Mr. Bracken
served as President Western Group of the Company
from August 1997 until July 2001. From January 1995 to August
1997, Mr. Bracken served as President of the Pacific
Division of the Company. Prior to 1995, Mr. Bracken served
in various hospital Chief Executive Officer and Administrator
positions with
HCA-Hospital
Corporation of America.
R. Milton Johnson has served as Executive Vice President
and Chief Financial Officer of the Company since July 2004 and
was appointed as a director in December 2009. Mr. Johnson
served as Senior Vice President and Controller of the
Company from July 1999 until July 2004. Mr. Johnson served
as Vice President and Controller of the Company from November
1998 to July 1999. Prior to that time, Mr. Johnson served
as Vice President Tax of the Company from April 1995
to October 1998. Prior to that time, Mr. Johnson served as
Director of Tax for Healthtrust, Inc. The Hospital
Company from September 1987 to April 1995.
Christopher J. Birosak is a Managing Director of BAML
Capital Partners, the private equity division of Bank of America
Corporation. BAML Capital Partners is the successor organization
to Merrill Lynch Global Private Equity. Prior to joining the
Global Private Equity Division of Merrill Lynch in 2004,
Mr. Birosak worked in various capacities in the Merrill
Lynch Leveraged Finance Group with particular emphasis on
leveraged buyouts and mergers and acquisitions related
financings. Mr. Birosak served as a director of Atrium
Companies, Inc. from 2004 to 2009 and currently serves on the
board of directors of NPC International. Mr. Birosak joined
Merrill Lynch in 1994.
John P. Connaughton has been a Managing Director of Bain
Capital Partners, LLC since 1997 and a member of the firm since
1989. Prior to joining Bain Capital, Mr. Connaughton was a
consultant at Bain &
100
Company, Inc., where he worked in the health care, consumer
products and business services industries. Mr. Connaughton
served as a director of Stericycle, Inc. from 1999 to 2005, M/C
Communications (PriMed) from 2004 to 2009 and AMC Theatres from
2007 to 2009 and currently serves as a director of Clear Channel
Communications, Inc., CRC Health Corporation, Warner Chilcott,
Ltd., Sungard Data Systems, Warner Music Group, Quintiles
Transnational Corp. and The Boston Celtics.
James D. Forbes has been Head of Bank of Americas
Global Principal Investments Division since March 2009. From
November 2008 to March 2009, Mr. Forbes served as Head of Asia
Pacific Corporate and Investment Banking based in Hong Kong.
Mr. Forbes chairs the Investment Committee at BAML Capital
Partners, the private equity division of the Bank of America
Corporation. From August 2002 to November 2008, he served as
Global Head of Healthcare Investment Banking at Merrill Lynch.
Before joining Merrill Lynch in 1995, Mr. Forbes worked at
CS First Boston where he was part of its Debt Capital Markets
Group. Mr. Forbes also serves on the Board of Conversus
Capital, L.P. and Sterling Stamos Capital Management, L.P.
Kenneth W. Freeman has been a member of KKR Management
LLC, the general partner of KKR & Co. L.P., since
October 1, 2009. Before that, he was a member of the
limited liability company which served as the general partner of
Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P. since 2007 and
joined the firm as Managing Director in May 2005. From May 2004
to December 2004, Mr. Freeman was Chairman of Quest
Diagnostics Incorporated, and from January 1996 to May 2004, he
served as Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Quest
Diagnostics Incorporated. From May 1995 to December 1996,
Mr. Freeman was President and Chief Executive Officer of
Corning Clinical Laboratories, the predecessor company to Quest
Diagnostics. Prior to that, he served in various general
management and financial roles with Corning Incorporated.
Mr. Freeman currently serves as a director of Accellent,
Inc. and Masonite, Inc. and is chairman of the board of trustees
of Bucknell University.
Thomas F. Frist III is a principal of Frist Capital
LLC, a private investment vehicle for Mr. Frist and certain
related persons and has held such position since 1998.
Mr. Frist is also a general partner at Frisco Partners,
another Frist family investment vehicle. Mr. Frist served
as a director of Triad Hospitals, Inc. from 1998 to October 2006
and currently serves as a director of SAIC, Inc. Mr. Frist
is the brother of William R. Frist, who also serves as a
director of the Company.
William R. Frist is a principal of Frist Capital LLC, a
private investment vehicle for Mr. Frist and certain
related persons and has held such position since 2003.
Mr. Frist is also a general partner at Frisco Partners,
another Frist family investment vehicle. Mr. Frist is the
brother of Thomas F. Frist III, who also serves as a director of
the Company.
Christopher R. Gordon is a Managing Director of Bain
Capital Partners, LLC and joined the firm in 1997. Prior to
joining Bain Capital, Mr. Gordon was a consultant at
Bain & Company. Mr. Gordon currently serves as a
director of Accellent, Inc., CRC Health Corporation and
Quintiles Transnational Corp.
Michael W. Michelson has been a member of KKR Management,
LLC, the general partner of KKR & Co. L.P., since
October 1, 2009. Before that, he was a member of the
limited liability company which served as the general partner of
Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P. since 1996. Prior
to that, he was a general partner of Kohlberg Kravis
Roberts & Co. L.P. Mr. Michelson served as a director
of Accellent Inc. from 2005 to 2009 and Alliance Imaging from
1999 to 2007. Mr. Michelson is currently a director of
Biomet, Inc. and Jazz Pharmaceuticals, Inc.
James C. Momtazee has been a member of KKR Management
LLC, the general partner of KKR & Co. L.P. since
October 1, 2009. Before that, he was a member of the
limited liability company which served as the general partner of
Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P. since 2009. From
1996 to 2009, he was an executive of Kohlberg Kravis
Roberts & Co. L.P. From 1994 to 1996,
Mr. Momtazee was with Donaldson, Lufkin &
Jenrette in its investment banking department. Mr. Momtazee
served as a director of Alliance Imaging from 2002 to 2007 and
Accuride from March 2005 to December 2005 and currently serves
as a director of Accellent, Inc. and Jazz Pharmaceuticals, Inc.
Stephen G. Pagliuca is a Managing Director of Bain
Capital Partners, LLC. Mr. Pagliuca is also a Managing
Partner and an owner of the Boston Celtics basketball franchise.
Mr. Pagliuca joined Bain & Company in 1982 and
101
founded the Information Partners private equity fund for Bain
Capital in 1989. He also worked as a senior accountant and
international tax specialist for Peat Marwick
Mitchell & Company in the Netherlands.
Mr. Pagliuca served as a director of Warner Chilcott, Ltd.
from 2005 to 2009, HCA Inc. from November 2006 to September
2009, Quintiles Transnational Corp. from 2008 to 2009, M/C
Communications from 2004 to 2009 and FCI, S.A. from 2005 to 2009
and currently serves as a director of Burger King Holdings Inc.
and Gartner, Inc.
Nathan C. Thorne was a Senior Vice President of Merrill
Lynch & Co., Inc., a subsidiary of Bank of America
Corporation, from February 2006 to July 2009, and President of
Merrill Lynch Global Private Equity from 2002 to 2009.
Mr. Thorne joined Merrill Lynch in 1984. Mr. Thorne
currently serves as a director of Nuveen Investments, Inc.
Executive
Officers
As of April 1, 2010, our executive officers (other than
Messrs. Bracken and Johnson who are listed above) were as
follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Name
|
|
Age
|
|
Position(s)
|
|
David G. Anderson
|
|
|
62
|
|
|
Senior Vice President Finance and Treasurer
|
Victor L. Campbell
|
|
|
63
|
|
|
Senior Vice President
|
Charles J. Hall
|
|
|
57
|
|
|
President Eastern Group
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
49
|
|
|
President Western Group
|
A. Bruce Moore, Jr.
|
|
|
50
|
|
|
President Outpatient Services Group
|
Jonathan B. Perlin, M.D.
|
|
|
49
|
|
|
President Clinical Services Group and Chief Medical
Officer
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
55
|
|
|
President Central Group
|
Joseph A. Sowell, III
|
|
|
53
|
|
|
Senior Vice President and Chief Development Officer
|
Joseph N. Steakley
|
|
|
55
|
|
|
Senior Vice President Internal Audit Services
|
John M. Steele
|
|
|
54
|
|
|
Senior Vice President Human Resources
|
Donald W. Stinnett
|
|
|
54
|
|
|
Senior Vice President and Controller
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
59
|
|
|
President Shared Services Group
|
Robert A. Waterman
|
|
|
56
|
|
|
Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Chief Labor Relations
Officer
|
Noel Brown Williams
|
|
|
55
|
|
|
Senior Vice President and Chief Information Officer
|
Alan R. Yuspeh
|
|
|
60
|
|
|
Senior Vice President and Chief Ethics and Compliance Officer
|
David G. Anderson has served as Senior Vice
President Finance and Treasurer of the Company since
July 1999. Mr. Anderson served as Vice
President Finance of the Company from September 1993
to July 1999 and was appointed to the additional position of
Treasurer in November 1996. From March 1993 until September
1993, Mr. Anderson served as Vice President
Finance and Treasurer of Galen Health Care, Inc. From July 1988
to March 1993, Mr. Anderson served as Vice
President Finance and Treasurer of Humana Inc.
Victor L. Campbell has served as Senior Vice President of
the Company since February 1994. Prior to that time,
Mr. Campbell served as HCA-Hospital Corporation of
Americas Vice President for Investor, Corporate and
Government Relations. Mr. Campbell joined HCA-Hospital
Corporation of America in 1972. Mr. Campbell serves on the
board of the Nashville Health Care Council, as a member of the
American Hospital Associations Presidents Forum, and
on the board and Executive Committee of the Federation of
American Hospitals.
Charles J. Hall was appointed President
Eastern Group of the Company in October 2006. Prior to that
time, Mr. Hall had served as President North
Florida Division since April 2003. Mr. Hall had previously
served the Company as President of the East Florida Division
from January 1999 until April 2003, as a Market
102
President in the East Florida Division from January 1998 until
December 1998, as President of the South Florida Division from
February 1996 until December 1997, and as President of the
Southwest Florida Division from October 1994 until February
1996, and in various other capacities since 1987.
Samuel N. Hazen was appointed President
Western Group of the Company in July 2001. Mr. Hazen served
as Chief Financial Officer Western Group of the
Company from August 1995 to July 2001. Mr. Hazen served as
Chief Financial Officer North Texas Division of the
Company from February 1994 to July 1995. Prior to that time,
Mr. Hazen served in various hospital and regional Chief
Financial Officer positions with Humana Inc. and Galen Health
Care, Inc.
Bruce Moore, Jr. was appointed President
Outpatient Services Group in January 2006. Mr. Moore had
served as Senior Vice President and as Chief Operating
Officer Outpatient Services Group since July 2004
and as Senior Vice President Operations
Administration from July 1999 until July 2004. Mr. Moore
served as Vice President Operations Administration
of the Company from September 1997 to July 1999, as Vice
President Benefits from October 1996 to September
1997, and as Vice President Compensation from March
1995 until October 1996.
Dr. Jonathan B. Perlin was appointed
President Clinical Services Group and Chief Medical
Officer in November 2007. Dr. Perlin had served as Chief
Medical Officer and Senior Vice President Quality of
the Company from August 2006 to November 2007. Prior to joining
the Company, Dr. Perlin served as Under Secretary for
Health in the U.S. Department of Veterans Affairs since
April 2004. Dr. Perlin joined the Veterans Health
Administration in November 1999 where he served in various
capacities, including as Deputy Under Secretary for Health from
July 2002 to April 2004, and as Chief Quality and Performance
Officer from November 1999 to September 2002.
W. Paul Rutledge was appointed as
President Central Group in October 2005.
Mr. Rutledge had served as President of the MidAmerica
Division since January 2001. He served as President of TriStar
Health System from June 1996 to January 2001 and served as
President of Centennial Medical Center from May 1993 to June
1996. He has served in leadership capacities with HCA for more
than 27 years, working with hospitals in the United States
and London, England.
Joseph A. Sowell, III was appointed as Senior Vice
President and Chief Development Officer of the Company in
December 2009. From 1987 to 1996 and again from 1999 to 2009,
Mr. Sowell was a partner at the law firm of Waller Lansden
Dortch & Davis where he specialized in the areas of
health care law, mergers and acquisitions, joint ventures,
private equity financing, tax law and general corporate law. He
also co-managed the firms corporate and commercial
transactions practice. From 1996 to 1999, Mr. Sowell served
as the head of development, and later as the Chief Operating
Officer of Arcon Healthcare.
Joseph N. Steakley has served as Senior Vice
President Internal Audit Services of the Company
since July 1999. Mr. Steakley served as Vice
President Internal Audit Services from November 1997
to July 1999. From October 1989 until October 1997,
Mr. Steakley was a partner with Ernst & Young
LLP. Mr. Steakley is a member of the board of directors of
J. Alexanders Corporation, where he serves on the
compensation committee and as chairman of the audit committee.
John M. Steele has served as Senior Vice
President Human Resources of the Company since
November 2003. Mr. Steele served as Vice
President Compensation and Recruitment of the
Company from November 1997 to October 2003. From March 1995
to November 1997, Mr. Steele served as Assistant Vice
President Recruitment.
Donald W. Stinnett has served as Senior Vice President
and Controller since December 2008. Mr. Stinnett served as
Chief Financial Officer Eastern Group from October
2005 to December 2008 and Chief Financial Officer of the Far
West Division from July 1999 to October 2005. Mr. Stinnett
served as Chief Financial Officer and Vice President of Finance
of Franciscan Health System of the Ohio Valley from 1995 until
1999, and served in various capacities with Franciscan Health
System of Cincinnati and Providence Hospital in Cincinnati prior
to that time.
103
Beverly B. Wallace was appointed President
Shared Services Group in March 2006. From January 2003 until
March 2006, Ms. Wallace served as President
Financial Services Group. Ms. Wallace served as Senior Vice
President Revenue Cycle Operations Management of the
Company from July 1999 to January 2003. Ms. Wallace served
as Vice President Managed Care of the Company from
July 1998 to July 1999. From 1997 to 1998, Ms. Wallace
served as President Homecare Division of the
Company. From 1996 to 1997, Ms. Wallace served as Chief
Financial Officer Nashville Division of the Company.
From 1994 to 1996, Ms. Wallace served as Chief Financial
Officer
Mid-America
Division of the Company.
Robert A. Waterman has served as Senior Vice President
and General Counsel of the Company since November 1997 and Chief
Labor Relations Officer since March 2009. Mr. Waterman
served as a partner in the law firm of Latham &
Watkins from September 1993 to October 1997; he was Chair of the
firms health care group during 1997.
Noel Brown Williams has served as Senior Vice President
and Chief Information Officer of the Company since October 1997.
From October 1996 to September 1997, Ms. Williams served as
Chief Information Officer for American Service Group/Prison
Health Services, Inc. From September 1995 to September 1996,
Ms. Williams worked as an independent consultant. From June
1993 to June 1995, Ms. Williams served as Vice President,
Information Services for HCA Information Services. From February
1979 to June 1993, she held various positions with HCA-Hospital
Corporation of America Information Services.
Alan R. Yuspeh has served as Senior Vice President and
Chief Ethics and Compliance Officer of the Company since May
2007. From October 1997 to May 2007, Mr. Yuspeh served as
Senior Vice President Ethics, Compliance and
Corporate Responsibility of the Company. From September 1991
until October 1997, Mr. Yuspeh was a partner with the law
firm of Howrey & Simon. As a part of his law practice,
Mr. Yuspeh served from 1987 to 1997 as Coordinator of the
Defense Industry Initiative on Business Ethics and Conduct.
Board of
Directors
Our Board of Directors consists of thirteen directors, who are
each managers of Hercules Holding. The Amended and Restated
Limited Liability Company Agreement of Hercules Holding requires
that the members of Hercules Holding take all necessary action
to ensure that the persons who serve as managers of Hercules
Holding also serve on the Board of Directors of HCA. See
Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions. In addition, Mr. Brackens
employment agreement provides that he will continue to serve as
a member of our Board of Directors so long as he remains an
officer of HCA. Because of these requirements, together with
Hercules Holdings ownership of more than 95% of our
outstanding common stock prior to this offering, we do not
currently have a policy or procedures with respect to
stockholder recommendations for nominees to the Board of
Directors, nor do we have a nominating and corporate governance
committee, or a committee that serves a similar purpose. We
intend to establish stockholder recommendation procedures
following this offering. Effective December 31, 2008, Jack
O. Bovender, Jr. retired as Chief Executive Officer but
retained the role of executive Chairman of the Board until
December 15, 2009, and effective January 1, 2009,
Mr. Bracken was appointed to serve as Chief Executive
Officer of the Company. Effective December 15, 2009,
Mr. Bracken was appointed Chairman of the Board, and
Mr. Johnson was appointed as a member of the Board of
Directors.
Upon completion of this offering, we intend to
appoint ,
and
as new members of our Board of Directors. Our Board has
affirmatively determined that each of such nominees meets the
definition of independent director for purposes of
the New York Stock Exchange rules.
Controlled
Company Exception
After completion of this offering, the Investors will continue
to control a majority of our outstanding common stock. As a
result, we will be a controlled company within the
meaning of the New York Stock Exchange corporate governance
standards. Under the New York Stock Exchange rules, a company of
which more than 50% of the voting power is held by an
individual, group or another company is a controlled
104
company and may elect not to comply with certain New York
Stock Exchange corporate governance requirements, including:
|
|
|
|
|
the requirement that a majority of the Board of Directors
consist of independent directors;
|
|
|
|
the requirement that we have a nominating and corporate
governance committee that is composed entirely of independent
directors with a written charter addressing the committees
purpose and responsibilities;
|
|
|
|
the requirement that we have a compensation committee that is
composed entirely of independent directors with a written
charter addressing the committees purpose and
responsibilities; and
|
|
|
|
the requirement for an annual performance evaluation of the
nominating and corporate governance and compensation committees.
|
Following this offering, we intend to rely on these exemptions.
As a result, we will not have a majority of independent
directors nor will our compensation committee consist entirely
of independent directors. Accordingly, you will not have the
same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are
subject to all of the New York Stock Exchange corporate
governance requirements.
Committees
of the Board of Directors
Our Board of Directors currently has four standing committees:
the Audit and Compliance Committee, the Compensation Committee,
the Executive Committee and the Patient Safety and Quality of
Care Committee. Each of the Investors (other than Citigroup Inc.
and Bank of America Corporation (the Sponsor
Assignees)) has the right to have at least one director
serve on all standing committees.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Patient
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Safety and
|
|
|
Audit and
|
|
|
|
|
|
Quality of
|
Name of Director
|
|
Compliance
|
|
Compensation
|
|
Executive
|
|
Care
|
|
Christopher J. Birosak
|
|
X
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Richard M. Bracken*
|
|
|
|
|
|
Chair
|
|
|
John P. Connaughton
|
|
|
|
Chair
|
|
X
|
|
|
James D. Forbes
|
|
|
|
X
|
|
X
|
|
|
Kenneth W. Freeman
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
X
|
Thomas F. Frist III
|
|
X
|
|
|
|
X
|
|
|
William R. Frist
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
X
|
Christopher R. Gordon
|
|
X
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
R. Milton Johnson*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Michael W. Michelson
|
|
|
|
X
|
|
X
|
|
|
James C. Momtazee
|
|
Chair
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stephen G. Pagliuca
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
X
|
Nathan C. Thorne
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Chair
|
|
|
|
* |
|
Indicates management director. |
Audit and Compliance Committee. Our Audit and
Compliance Committee is composed of James C. Momtazee, Chairman,
Christopher J. Birosak, Thomas F. Frist III, and Christopher R.
Gordon. This committee reviews the programs of our internal
auditors, the results of their audits, and the adequacy of our
system of internal controls and accounting practices. This
committee also reviews the scope of the annual audit by our
independent registered public accounting firm before its
commencement, reviews the results of the audit and reviews the
types of services for which we retain our independent registered
public accounting firm. The Audit and Compliance Committee has
adopted a charter which can be obtained on the Corporate
Governance page of the Companys website at
www.hcahealthcare.com. In 2009, the Audit and Compliance
Committee met five times.
105
Upon completion of this offering, the current Audit and
Compliance Committee members will resign and we intend to
appoint ,
and
to our Audit and Compliance Committee. Our Board has
affirmatively determined that each of such nominees meets the
definition of independent director for purposes of
the New York Stock Exchange rules and the independence
requirements of
Rule 10A-3
of the Exchange Act. Our Board will also determine which member
of our Audit and Compliance Committee qualifies as an
audit committee financial expert under SEC rules and
regulations.
Our Audit and Compliance Committee will be responsible for,
among other things:
|
|
|
|
|
selecting the independent auditors,
|
|
|
|
pre-approving all audit engagement fees and terms, as well as
audit and permitted non-audit services to be provided by the
independent auditors,
|
|
|
|
at least annually, obtaining and reviewing a report of the
independent auditors describing the audit firms internal
quality-control procedures and any material issues raised by its
most recent review of internal quality controls,
|
|
|
|
annually evaluating the qualifications, performance and
independence of the independent auditors,
|
|
|
|
discussing the scope of the audit and any problems or
difficulties,
|
|
|
|
setting policies regarding the hiring of current and former
employees of the independent auditors,
|
|
|
|
reviewing and discussing the annual audited and quarterly
unaudited financial statements with management and the
independent auditor,
|
|
|
|
discussing types of information to be disclosed in earnings
press releases and provided to analysts and rating agencies,
|
|
|
|
discussing policies governing the process by which risk
assessment and risk management is to be undertaken,
|
|
|
|
reviewing disclosures made by the CEO and CFO regarding any
significant deficiencies or material weaknesses in our internal
control over financial reporting,
|
|
|
|
reviewing internal audit activities, projects and budget,
|
|
|
|
establishing procedures for receipt, retention and treatment of
complaints received by the Company regarding accounting,
auditing or internal controls and the submission of anonymous
employee concerns regarding accounting and auditing,
|
|
|
|
discussing with our general counsel legal matters that could
reasonably be expected to have a material impact on business or
financial statements,
|
|
|
|
periodically reviewing and reassessing the Audit and Compliance
Committee charter,
|
|
|
|
providing information to our Board that may be relevant to the
annual evaluation of performance and effectiveness of the Board
and its committees and
|
|
|
|
preparing the report required by the SEC to be included in our
annual report on Form 10-K or our proxy or information
statement.
|
Our Board of Directors will update its written charter for the
Audit and Compliance Committee in connection with this offering
which will be available on our website as soon as practical
after the closing of this offering.
Compensation Committee. Our Compensation
Committee is currently composed of John P. Connaughton,
Chairman, James D. Forbes and Michael W. Michelson.
Responsibilities of the Compensation Committee include the
review and approval of the following items:
|
|
|
|
|
Executive compensation strategy and philosophy;
|
106
|
|
|
|
|
Compensation arrangements for executive management;
|
|
|
|
Design and administration of the annual cash-based Senior
Officer Performance Excellence Program;
|
|
|
|
Design and administration of our equity incentive plans;
|
|
|
|
Executive benefits and perquisites (including the HCA
Restoration Plan and the Supplemental Executive Retirement
Plan); and
|
|
|
|
Any other executive compensation or benefits related items
deemed noteworthy by the Compensation Committee.
|
In addition, the Compensation Committee considers the proper
alignment of executive pay policies with Company values and
strategy by overseeing employee compensation policies, corporate
performance measurement and assessment and Chief Executive
Officer performance assessment. The Compensation Committee may
retain the services of independent outside consultants, as it
deems appropriate, to assist in the strategic review of programs
and arrangements relating to executive compensation and
performance. In 2009 the Compensation Committee hired Semler
Brossy Consulting Group, LLC to assist in conducting an
assessment of competitive executive compensation. The
Compensation Committee may consider recommendations from our
Chief Executive Officer and compensation consultants, among
other factors, in making its compensation determinations. The
Compensation Committee has the authority to delegate any of its
responsibilities to one or more subcommittees as the committee
may deem appropriate. For a discussion of the processes and
procedures for determining executive and director compensation
and the role of executive officers and compensation consultants
in determining or recommending the amount or form of
compensation, see Executive Compensation
Compensation Discussion and Analysis. The Compensation
Committee has adopted a charter which can be obtained on the
Corporate Governance page of Companys website at
www.hcahealthcare.com. In 2009, the Compensation Committee met
eight times.
Upon completion of this offering, we intend to
appoint
and
as additional members of our Compensation Committee. Our Board
of Directors has affirmatively determined that each of such
newly-appointed nominees meets the definition of
independent director for purposes of the New York
Stock Exchange rules, the definition of outside
director for purposes of Section 162(m) of the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the definition of
non-employee director for purposes of
Section 16 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended. In addition, we intend to establish a sub-committee of
our Compensation Committee consisting
of
and
for purposes of approving any compensation that may otherwise be
subject to Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code of
1986, as amended.
Patient Safety and Quality of Care
Committee. Our Patient Safety and Quality of Care
Committee is composed of Nathan C. Thorne, Chairman, Kenneth W.
Freeman, William R. Frist and Stephen G. Pagliuca. This
committee reviews the Companys policies and procedures
relating to the delivery of quality medical care to patients as
well as matters concerning or relating to the efforts to advance
the quality of health care provided and patient safety. In
2009, the Patient Safety and Quality of Care Committee met three
times.
Director
Qualifications
The Board of Directors seeks to ensure the Board is composed of
members whose particular experience, qualifications, attributes
and skills, when taken together, will allow the Board to satisfy
its oversight responsibilities effectively. In identifying
candidates for membership on the Board, the Board takes into
account (1) minimum individual qualifications, such as high
ethical standards, integrity, mature and careful judgment,
industry knowledge or experience and an ability to work
collegially with the other members of the Board and (2) all
other factors it considers appropriate, including alignment with
our stockholders, especially investment funds affiliated with
the Sponsors. While we do not have any specific diversity
policies for considering Board candidates, we believe each
director contributes to the Board of Directors overall
diversity diversity being broadly construed to mean
a variety of opinions, perspectives, personal and professional
experiences and backgrounds.
107
In 2010, Messrs. Birosak, Bracken, Connaughton, Forbes,
Freeman, Frist III, Frist, Gordon, Johnson, Michelson, Momtazee,
Pagliuca and Thorne were elected to the Companys Board.
Messrs. Birosak, Connaughton, Forbes, Freeman, Frist III,
Frist, Gordon, Michelson, Momtazee, Pagliuca and Thorne were
appointed to the Board as a consequence of their respective
relationships with investment funds affiliated with the Sponsors
and the Frist Entities. They are collectively referred to as the
Sponsor Directors. Messrs. Bracken and Johnson
are collectively referred to as the Management
Directors.
When considering whether the Boards directors and nominees
have the experience, qualifications, attributes and skills,
taken as a whole, to enable the Board to satisfy its oversight
responsibilities effectively in light of the Companys
business and structure, the Board focused primarily on the
information discussed in each of the Board members and
nominees biographical information set forth above.
Each of the Companys directors and director nominees
possesses high ethical standards, acts with integrity, and
exercises careful, mature judgment. Each is committed to
employing their skills and abilities to aid the long-term
interests of the stakeholders of the Company. In addition, our
directors and director nominees are knowledgeable and
experienced in one or more business, governmental or civic
endeavors, which further qualifies them for service as members
of the Board. Alignment with our stockholders is important in
building value at the Company over time.
Each of the Sponsor Directors was elected to the Board pursuant
to the Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement
of Hercules Holding. Pursuant to such agreement,
Messrs. Freeman, Michelson and Momtazee were appointed to
the Board as a consequence of their respective relationships
with KKR, Messrs. Birosak, Forbes and Thorne were appointed
to the Board as a consequence of their respective relationships
with MLGPE (an affiliate of Bank of America Corporation),
Messrs. Connaughton, Gordon and Pagliuca were appointed to
the Board as a consequence of their respective relationships
with Bain Capital Partners, LLC and Messrs. Frist III
and Frist were appointed to the Board as a consequence of their
respective relationships with the Frist Entities.
As a group, the Sponsor Directors possess experience in owning
and managing enterprises like the Company and are familiar with
corporate finance, strategic business planning activities and
issues involving stakeholders more generally.
The Management Directors bring leadership, extensive business,
operating, legal and policy experience, and tremendous knowledge
of our Company and the Companys industry, to the Board. In
addition, the Management Directors bring their broad strategic
vision for our Company to the Board. Mr. Brackens
service as the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of the
Company and Mr. Johnsons service as Executive Vice
President, Chief Financial Officer and Director creates a
critical link between management and the Board, enabling the
Board to perform its oversight function with the benefits of
managements perspectives on the business. In addition,
having the Chief Executive Officer and Executive Vice President
and Chief Financial Officer, and Messrs. Bracken and
Johnson in particular, on our Board provides our Company with
ethical, decisive and effective leadership.
The Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of
Hercules Holding provides that each Sponsor has the right to
designate three directors, that the Frist Entities have the
right to designate two directors and that the Board will include
two representatives of management of our Company. Any directors
nominated to fill the directorships selected by the Sponsors and
the Frist Entities are chosen by the applicable Sponsor or the
Frist Entities, as the case may be. The Sponsors, the Frist
Entities and the other members of the Board participate in the
consideration of nominees to the Board as representatives of the
Companys management.
Board
Leadership Structure
The Board appointed the Companys Chief Executive Officer
as Chairman because he is the director most familiar with the
Companys business and industry, and as a result is best
suited to effectively identify strategic priorities and lead the
discussion and execution of strategy. The Board believes the
combined position of Chairman and CEO promotes a unified
direction and leadership for the Board and gives a single, clear
focus
108
for the chain of command for our organization, strategy and
business plans. Because the Company is a controlled corporation
and the Board is primarily composed of Sponsor Directors, the
Company does not currently have a lead or any other independent
directors.
Boards
Role in Risk Oversight
Risk is inherent with every business. Management is responsible
for the
day-to-day
management of risks the Company faces, while the Board of
Directors, as a whole and through its committees, has
responsibility for the oversight of risk management. In its risk
oversight role, the Board of Directors has the responsibility to
satisfy itself that the risk management processes designed and
implemented by management are adequate and functioning as
designed. Our Board of Directors oversees an enterprise-wide
approach to risk management, designed to support the achievement
of organizational objectives, including strategic objectives, to
improve long-term organizational performance and enhance
stockholder value. A fundamental aspect of risk management is
not only understanding the risks a company faces and what steps
management is taking to manage those risks, but also
understanding what level of risk is appropriate for the company.
The involvement of the full Board of Directors in setting the
Companys business strategy is a key part of its assessment
of managements appetite for risk and also a determination
of what constitutes an appropriate level of risk for the Company.
We conduct an annual enterprise risk management assessment,
which is facilitated by the Companys enterprise risk
management team in collaboration with the Companys
internal auditors. The senior internal audit executive officer
reports to the Chief Executive Officer and Chairman and to the
Audit and Compliance Committee in this capacity. In this
process, we assess risk throughout the Company by conducting
surveys and interviews of Company employees and directors
soliciting information regarding business risks that could
significantly adversely affect the Company, including the
achievement of its strategic plan. We then identify any controls
or initiatives in place to mitigate any material risk and the
effectiveness of any such controls or initiatives. The
enterprise risk management team annually prepares a report for
senior management and, ultimately, the Board of Directors
regarding the key identified risks and how the Company manages
these risks to review and analyze both on an annual and ongoing
basis. Senior management attends the quarterly Board meetings
and is available to address any questions or concerns raised by
the Board regarding risk management and any other matters.
Additionally, each quarter, the Board of Directors receives
presentations from senior management on strategic matters
involving our operations.
While the Board of Directors has the ultimate oversight
responsibility for the risk management process, various
committees of the Board assist the Board in fulfilling its
oversight responsibilities in certain areas of risk. In
particular, the Audit and Compliance Committee focuses on
financial and enterprise risk exposures, including internal
controls, and discusses with management, the senior internal
audit executive officer, the senior chief ethics and compliance
officer and the independent auditor the Companys policies
with respect to risk assessment and risk management. The Audit
and Compliance Committee also assists the Board in fulfilling
its duties and oversight responsibilities relating to the
Companys compliance with applicable laws and regulations,
the Company Code of Conduct and related Company policies and
procedures, including the Corporate Ethics and Compliance
Program. The Compensation Committee assists the Board in
fulfilling its oversight responsibilities with respect to the
management of risks arising from our compensation policies and
programs. The Patient Safety and Quality of Care Committee
assists the Board in fulfilling its risk oversight
responsibility with respect to the Companys policies and
procedures relating to patient safety and the delivery of
quality medical care to patients.
Board
Meetings
During 2009, our Board of Directors held nine meetings. All
directors attended at least 75% of the Board meetings and
meetings of the committees of the Board on which the director
served. The Company did not have an annual meeting of
stockholders in 2009 or 2010, and our directors were re-elected
through stockholder actions taken on written consent effective
September 21, 2009 and April 28, 2010.
109
Policy
Regarding Communications with the Board of
Directors
Stockholders, employees and other interested parties may
communicate with any of our directors by writing to such
director(s)
c/o Board
of Directors, HCA Inc., One Park Plaza, Nashville, TN 37203,
Attention: Corporate Secretary. All communications from
stockholders, employees and other interested parties addressed
in that manner will be forwarded to the appropriate director. If
the volume of communication becomes such that the Board adopts a
process for determining which communications will be relayed to
Board members, that process will appear on the Corporate
Governance page of our website at www.hcahealthcare.com.
Code of
Ethics
We have a Code of Conduct, which is applicable to all our
directors, officers and employees (the Code of
Conduct). The Code of Conduct is available on the Ethics
and Compliance and Corporate Governance pages of our website at
www.hcahealthcare.com. To the extent required pursuant to
applicable SEC regulations, we intend to post amendments to or
waivers from our Code of Conduct (to the extent applicable to
our chief executive officer, principal financial officer or
principal accounting officer) at these locations on our website
or report the same on a Current Report on Form
8-K. Our
Code of Conduct is available free of charge upon request to our
Corporate Secretary, HCA Inc., One Park Plaza, Nashville, TN
37203.
110
EXECUTIVE
COMPENSATION
Compensation
Risk Assessment
In consultation with the Compensation Committee, members of
Human Resources, Legal, Enterprise Risk Management and Internal
Audit, management conducted an assessment of whether the
Companys compensation policies and practices encourage
excessive or inappropriate risk taking by our employees,
including employees other than our named executive officers.
This assessment included a review of the risk characteristics of
our business and the design of our incentive plans and policies.
Although a significant portion of our executive compensation
program is performance-based, the Compensation Committee has
focused on aligning the Companys compensation policies
with the long-term interests of the Company and avoiding rewards
or incentive structures that could create unnecessary risks to
the Company.
Management reported its findings to the Compensation Committee,
which agreed with managements assessment that our plans
and policies do not encourage excessive or inappropriate risk
taking and determined such policies or practices are not
reasonably likely to have a material, adverse effect on the
Company.
Compensation
Discussion and Analysis
The Compensation Committee (the Committee) of the
Board of Directors is generally charged with the oversight of
our executive compensation and rewards programs. The Committee
is currently composed of John P. Connaughton, James D. Forbes
and Michael W. Michelson. In early 2009, the Committee also
included George A. Bitar, and determinations with respect to
2009 compensation were made by such Committee. Responsibilities
of the Committee include the review and approval of the
following items:
|
|
|
|
|
Executive compensation strategy and philosophy;
|
|
|
|
Compensation arrangements for executive management;
|
|
|
|
Design and administration of the annual cash-based Senior
Officer Performance Excellence Program (PEP);
|
|
|
|
Design and administration of our equity incentive plans;
|
|
|
|
Executive benefits and perquisites (including the HCA
Restoration Plan and the Supplemental Executive Retirement
Plan); and
|
|
|
|
Any other executive compensation or benefits related items
deemed appropriate by the Committee.
|
In addition, the Committee considers the proper alignment of
executive pay policies with Company values and strategy by
overseeing executive compensation policies, corporate
performance measurement and assessment, and Chief Executive
Officer performance assessment. The Committee may retain the
services of independent outside consultants, as it deems
appropriate, to assist in the strategic review of programs and
arrangements relating to executive compensation and performance.
The following executive compensation discussion and analysis
describes the principles underlying our executive compensation
policies and decisions as well as the material elements of
compensation for our named executive officers. Our named
executive officers for 2009 were:
|
|
|
|
|
Richard M. Bracken, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer;
|
|
|
|
R. Milton Johnson, Executive Vice President and Chief Financial
Officer;
|
|
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace, President Shared Services Group;
|
|
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen, President Western Group;
|
|
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge, President Central Group; and
|
|
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr., Executive Chairman of the Board
(Retired).
|
111
Effective December 31, 2008, Mr. Bovender retired as
Chief Executive Officer but retained the role of executive
Chairman of the Board, and effective January 1, 2009,
Mr. Bracken was appointed to serve as Chief Executive
Officer and President of the Company. Mr. Bovender retired
as executive Chairman of the Board on December 15, 2009,
and Mr. Bracken assumed the additional responsibilities as
Chairman of the Board at such time.
As discussed in more detail below, the material elements and
structure of the named executive officers compensation
program were negotiated and determined in connection with the
Recapitalization, subject to annual adjustments in the
Committees discretion.
Compensation
Philosophy and Objectives
The core philosophy of our executive compensation program is to
support the Companys primary objective of providing the
highest quality health care to our patients while enhancing the
long term value of the Company to our stockholders.
Specifically, the Committee believes the most effective
executive compensation program (for all executives, including
named executive officers):
|
|
|
|
|
Reinforces HCAs strategic initiatives;
|
|
|
|
Aligns the economic interests of our executives with those of
our stockholders; and
|
|
|
|
Encourages attraction and long term retention of key
contributors.
|
The Committee is committed to a strong, positive link between
our objectives and our compensation and benefits practices.
Our compensation philosophy also allows for flexibility in
establishing executive compensation based on an evaluation of
information prepared by management or other advisors and other
subjective and objective considerations deemed appropriate by
the Committee, subject to any contractual agreements with our
executives. The Committee will also consider the recommendations
of our Chief Executive Officer. This flexibility is important to
ensure our compensation programs are competitive and that our
compensation decisions appropriately reflect the unique
contributions and characteristics of our executives.
Compensation
Structure and Benchmarking
Our compensation program is heavily weighted towards
performance-based compensation, reflecting our philosophy of
increasing the long-term value of the Company and supporting
strategic imperatives. Total direct compensation and other
benefits consist of the following elements:
|
|
|
Total Direct Compensation
|
|
Base Salary
|
|
|
Annual Cash-Based Incentives (offered
through
|
|
|
our PEP)
|
|
|
Long-Term Equity Incentives (in the form
of
|
|
|
Stock Options)
|
Other Benefits
|
|
Retirement Plans
|
|
|
Limited Perquisites and Other Personal
Benefits
|
|
|
Severance Benefits
|
The Committee does not support rigid adherence to benchmarks or
compensatory formulas and strives to make compensation decisions
which effectively support our compensation objectives and
reflect the unique attributes of the Company and each executive.
Our general practice, however, with respect to pay positioning,
is that executive base salaries and annual incentive (PEP)
target values should generally position total annual cash
compensation between the median and 75th percentile of
similarly-sized general industry companies. We utilize the
general industry as our primary source for competitive pay
levels because HCA is significantly larger than its industry
peers. See the discussion of benchmarking below for further
information. The named executive officers pay fell within
the range noted above for jobs with equivalent market
comparisons.
112
The cash compensation mix between salary and PEP has
historically been more weighted towards salary than competitive
practice among our general industry peers would suggest. Over
time, we have made steps towards a mix of cash compensation that
will place a greater emphasis on annual performance-based
compensation.
Although we look at competitive long-term equity incentive award
values in similarly-sized general industry companies when
assessing the competitiveness of our compensation programs, we
do not make annual executive option grants (and we did not base
our initial post-Recapitalization 2007 stock option grants on
these levels) since equity is structured differently in closely
held companies than in publicly-traded companies. As is typical
in similar situations, the Investors wanted to share a certain
percentage of the equity with executives shortly after the
consummation of the Recapitalization and establish performance
objectives and incentives up front in lieu of annual grants to
ensure our executives long-term economic interests would
be aligned with those of the Investors. This pool of equity was
then further allocated based on the executives
responsibilities and anticipated impact on, and potential for,
driving Company strategy and performance. The resulting total
direct pay mix on a cumulative basis, is heavily weighted
towards performance-based pay (PEP plus stock options) rather
than fixed pay, which the Committee believes reflects the
compensation philosophy and objectives discussed above.
In accordance with agreements entered into at the time of the
Recapitalization, our named executive officers received the 2x
Time Options (as defined below) in 2009 with an exercise price
equal to two times the share price at the Recapitalization (or
$102.00). The Committee allocated those options in consultation
with our Chief Executive Officer based on past executive
contributions and future anticipated impact on Company
objectives. For additional information regarding the 2x Time
Options, see Elements of
Compensation Long-Term Equity Incentive Awards:
Options below.
Compensation
Process
The Committee ensures executives pay levels are materially
consistent with the compensation strategy described above, in
part, by conducting annual assessments of competitive executive
compensation. Management (but no named executive officer), in
collaboration with the Committees independent consultant,
Semler Brossy Consulting Group, LLC, collects and presents
compensation data from similarly-sized general industry
companies, based to the extent possible on comparable position
matches and compensation components. The following nationally
recognized survey sources were utilized in anticipation of
establishing 2009 executive compensation:
|
|
|
Survey
|
|
Revenue Scope
|
|
Towers Perrin Executive Compensation Database
|
|
Greater than $20B
|
Hewitt Total Compensation Measurement
|
|
$10B - $25B
|
Hewitt Total Compensation Measurement
|
|
Greater than $25B
|
These particular revenue scopes were selected because they were
the closest approximations to HCAs revenue size. Each
survey that provided an appropriate position match and
sufficient sample size to be used in the compensation review was
weighted equally. For this purpose, the two Hewitt survey cuts
were considered as one survey, and we used a weighted average of
the two surveys (65% for the $10B $25B cut and 35%
for the Greater than $25B).
Data was also collected from health care providers within our
industry including Community Health Systems, Inc., Health
Management Associates, Inc., Kindred Healthcare, Inc., LifePoint
Hospitals, Inc., Tenet Healthcare Corporation and Universal
Health Services, Inc. These health care providers are used only
to obtain a general understanding of current industry
compensation practices since we are significantly larger than
these companies. CEO and CFO compensation data was also
collected and reviewed for large public health care companies
which included, in addition to health care providers, companies
in the health insurance, pharmaceutical, medical supplies and
related industries. This peer groups 2008 revenues ranged
from $7.2 billion to $81.2 billion with median
revenues of $21.3 billion. The companies in this analysis
included Abbott Laboratories, Aetna Inc., Amgen Inc., Baxter
International Inc., Boston Scientific Corporation, Bristol-Myers
Squibb Company, CIGNA Corporation, Coventry Health Care, Inc.,
Express Scripts, Inc., Humana Inc.,
113
Johnson & Johnson, Eli Lilly and Company, Medco
Health Solutions Inc., Merck & Co., Inc., Pfizer Inc.,
Quest Diagnostics Incorporated, Schering-Plough Corporation,
Tenet Healthcare Corporation, Thermo Fisher Scientific Inc.,
UnitedHealth Group Incorporated, WellPoint, Inc. and Wyeth.
Consistent with our flexible compensation philosophy, the
Committee is not required to approve compensation precisely
reflecting the results of these surveys, and may also consider,
among other factors (typically not reflected in these surveys):
the requirements of the applicable employment agreements, the
executives individual performance during the year, his or
her projected role and responsibilities for the coming year, his
or her actual and potential impact on the successful execution
of Company strategy, recommendations from our Chief Executive
Officer and compensation consultants, an officers prior
compensation, experience, and professional status, internal pay
equity considerations, and employment market conditions and
compensation practices within our peer group. The weighting of
these and other relevant factors is determined on a
case-by-case
basis for each executive upon consideration of the relevant
facts and circumstances.
Employment
Agreements
In connection with the Recapitalization, we entered into
employment agreements with each of our named executive officers
and certain other members of senior management to help ensure
the retention of those executives critical to the future success
of the Company. Among other things, these agreements set the
executives compensation terms, their rights upon a
termination of employment, and restrictive covenants around
non-competition, non-solicitation, and confidentiality. These
terms and conditions are further explained in the remaining
portion of this Compensation Discussion and Analysis and under
Narrative Disclosure to Summary Compensation
Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table
Employment Agreements.
In light of Mr. Bovenders retirement from the
position of Chief Executive Officer, effective December 31,
2008, and continuing service to the Company as executive
Chairman until December 15, 2009, the Company entered into
an Amended and Restated Employment Agreement with
Mr. Bovender, effective December 31, 2008. The
material amendments to Mr. Bovenders prior employment
agreement as set forth in the Amended and Restated Employment
Agreement are described below under Severance
and Change in Control Benefits
Mr. Bovenders Continuing Severance Benefits and
under Narrative Disclosure to Summary
Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards
Table Employment Agreements.
The Company also amended Mr. Brackens employment
agreement, effective January 1, 2009, to reflect his
appointment to the position of Chief Executive Officer.
Elements
of Compensation
Base
Salary
Base salaries are intended to provide reasonable and competitive
fixed compensation for regular job duties. The threshold base
salaries for our executives are set forth in their employment
agreements. We did not increase named executive officer base
salaries in 2009, other than an increase in
Mr. Johnsons base salary, as detailed below, in order
to better align his salary with market for his position as Chief
Financial Officer based on general industry surveys. In light of
Mr. Bovenders retirement from the position of Chief
Executive Officer and continuing role as executive Chairman and
Mr. Brackens assumption of the responsibilities of
Chief Executive Officer, Mr. Bovenders base salary
for 2009 was reduced to $1.144 million (as described
further in Narrative Disclosure to Summary
Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards
Table Employment Agreements
Mr. Bovenders Employment Agreements), and
Mr. Brackens 2009 base salary was increased to
$1.325 million. Similarly, taking into consideration the
additional responsibilities being assumed by the position of
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer and
relevant market comparables from the survey data,
Mr. Johnsons 2009 salary was set at $850,000,
reflecting an increase of approximately 7.6% from his 2008
salary. In light of actual total cash compensation realized for
2009 and current target cash compensation opportunities levels,
no merit base salary increases are planned for 2010 at this
time. Mr. Rutledges salary will be increased by 3.7%
effective April 1, 2010 as an internal equity adjustment to
internal peer roles.
114
Annual
Incentive Compensation: PEP
The PEP is intended to reward named executive officers for
annual financial performance, with the goals of providing high
quality health care for our patients and increasing stockholder
value. Accordingly, in 2008, the Companys
2008-2009
Senior Officer Performance Excellence Program, as amended (the
2008-2009
PEP), was approved by the Committee to cover annual cash
incentive awards for both 2008 and 2009. Each named executive
officer in the
2008-2009
PEP was initially assigned a maximum 2009 annual award target
expressed as a percentage of salary ranging from 72% to 132%,
which under the terms of the
2008-2009
PEP applies to the lesser of (a) the named executive
officers 2009 base salary, or (b) 125% of the named
executive officers 2008 base salary. The Committee had the
discretion to reduce, but not increase, the 2009 Threshold,
Target and Maximum percentages as set forth in the
2008-2009
PEP. Mr. Bovenders 2009 PEP target and an additional
one-time $250,000 bonus opportunity based on his contributions
to certain legislative initiatives as determined by the
Committee were set forth in his Amended Employment Agreement, as
described in Narrative Disclosure to Summary
Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards
Table Employment Agreements
Mr. Bovenders Employment Agreement. The
Committee set Mr. Brackens 2009 target percentage at
130% of his 2009 base salary in connection with his appointment
as Chief Executive Officer and amended the
2008-2009
PEP to set Mr. Johnsons 2009 target percentage at 80%
of his 2009 base salary in light of the additional
responsibilities assumed by the position of Executive Vice
President and Chief Financial Officer. The 2009 target
percentage for each of Ms. Wallace and Messrs. Hazen
and Rutledge was set at 66% of their respective 2009 base
salaries (see individual targets in the table below). These
targets were intended to provide a meaningful incentive for
executives to achieve or exceed performance goals.
The
2008-2009
PEP was designed to provide 100% of the target award for target
performance, 50% of the target award for a minimum acceptable
(threshold) level of performance, and a maximum of 200% of the
target award for maximum performance, while no payments were to
be made for performance below threshold levels. The Committee
believes this payout curve is consistent with competitive
practice. More importantly, it promotes and rewards continuous
growth as performance goals have consistently been set at
increasingly higher levels each year. Actual awards under the
PEP are generally determined using the following two steps:
1. The executives conduct must reflect our mission
and values by upholding our Code of Conduct and following our
compliance policies and procedures. This step is critical to
reinforcing our commitment to integrity and the delivery of high
quality health care. In the event the Committee determines the
participants conduct during the fiscal year is not in
compliance with the first step, he or she will not be eligible
for an incentive award.
2. The actual award amount is determined based upon Company
performance. In 2009, the PEP for all named executive officers,
other than Mr. Hazen and Mr. Rutledge, incorporated
one Company financial performance measure, EBITDA, defined in
the
2008-2009
PEP as earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation,
amortization, minority interest expense (now, net income
attributable to noncontrolling interests), gains or losses on
sales of facilities, gains or losses on extinguishment of debt,
asset or investment impairment charges, restructuring charges,
and any other significant nonrecurring non-cash gains or charges
(but excluding any expenses for share-based compensation under
ASC 718, Compensation-Stock Compensation (ASC
718)) (EBITDA). The Company EBITDA target for
2009, as adjusted, was $4.768 billion for the named
executive officers. Mr. Hazens 2009 PEP, as the
Western Group President, was based 50% on Company EBITDA and 50%
on Western Group EBITDA (with a Western Group EBITDA target for
2009 of $2.352 billion, as adjusted) to ensure his
accountability for his groups results. Similarly,
Mr. Rutledges 2009 PEP, as the Central Group
President, was based 50% on Company EBITDA and 50% on Central
Group EBITDA (with a Central Group EBITDA target for 2009 of
$1.137 billion, as adjusted). The Committee chose to base
annual incentives on EBITDA for a number of reasons:
|
|
|
|
|
It effectively measures overall Company performance;
|
|
|
|
It can be considered an important surrogate for cash flow, a
critical metric related to paying down the Companys
significant debt obligation;
|
115
|
|
|
|
|
It is the key metric driving the valuation in the internal
Company model, consistent with the valuation approach used by
industry analysts; and
|
|
|
|
It is consistent with the metric used for the vesting of the
financial performance portion of our option grants.
|
These EBITDA targets should not be understood as
managements predictions of future performance or other
guidance and investors should not apply these in any other
context. Our 2009 threshold and maximum goals were set at
approximately +/- 3.6% of the target goal to reflect likely
performance volatility. EBITDA targets were linked to the
Companys short-term and long-term business objectives to
ensure incentives are provided for appropriate annual growth.
Upon review of the Companys 2009 financial performance,
the Committee determined that Company EBITDA performance for the
fiscal year ended December 31, 2009 was above the maximum
performance levels as set by the Compensation Committee, as
adjusted; likewise, the EBITDA performance of the Western Group
and Central Group also exceeded the maximum performance targets,
as adjusted.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009 Adjusted
|
|
2009 Actual
|
|
|
EBITDA Target
|
|
Adjusted EBITDA
|
|
Company
|
|
$
|
4.768 billion
|
|
|
$
|
5.512 billion
|
|
Western Group
|
|
$
|
2.352 billion
|
|
|
$
|
2.841 billion
|
|
Central Group
|
|
$
|
1.137 billion
|
|
|
$
|
1.325 billion
|
|
Accordingly, the 2009 PEP was paid out as follows to the named
executive officers (the actual 2009 PEP payout amounts are
included in the Non-Equity Incentive Plan
Compensation column of the Summary Compensation Table):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009 Actual PEP
|
|
|
2009 Target PEP
|
|
Award
|
Named Executive Officer
|
|
(% of Salary)
|
|
(% of Salary)
|
|
Richard M. Bracken (Chairman and CEO)
|
|
|
130
|
%
|
|
|
260
|
%
|
R. Milton Johnson (Executive Vice President and CFO)
|
|
|
80
|
%
|
|
|
160
|
%
|
Beverly B. Wallace (President, Shared Services Group)
|
|
|
66
|
%
|
|
|
132
|
%
|
Samuel N. Hazen (President, Western Group)
|
|
|
66
|
%
|
|
|
132
|
%
|
W. Paul Rutledge (President, Central Group)
|
|
|
66
|
%
|
|
|
132
|
%
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr. (Retired Chairman)
|
|
|
50
|
%
|
|
|
100
|
%
|
Mr. Bovender also received the additional bonus of $250,000
based upon his contributions to certain of the Companys
legislative initiatives as described above.
On March 31, 2010, the Committee adopted the 2010 Senior
Officer Performance Excellence Program (the 2010
PEP). Under the 2010 PEP, the named executive officers of
the Company shall be eligible to earn performance awards based
upon the achievement of certain specified performance targets.
The specified performance criteria for the Companys named
executive officers and other participants is EBITDA (as defined
in the 2010 PEP), and with respect to the Western and Central
Group Presidents, 50% of their respective award opportunities
are based on EBITDA for the Companys Western and Central
Groups, respectively. Target awards for the named executive
officers are the same as for 2009 and are as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
130% of base salary for Richard M. Bracken, our Chairman and CEO;
|
|
|
|
80% of base salary for R. Milton Johnson, our Executive Vice
President and CFO;
|
|
|
|
66% of base salary for Beverly B. Wallace, our
President Shared Services Group;
|
|
|
|
66% of base salary for Samuel N. Hazen, our
President Western Group; and
|
|
|
|
66% of base salary for W. Paul Rutledge, our
President Central Group.
|
Participants will receive 100% of the target award for target
performance, 25% of the target award for a minimum acceptable
(threshold) level of performance, and a maximum of 200% of the
target award for
116
maximum performance. No payments will be made for performance
below specified threshold amounts. Payouts between threshold and
maximum will be calculated by the Committee in its sole
discretion using straight-line interpolation. The Committee may
make adjustments to the terms and conditions of, and the
criteria included in, awards under the 2010 PEP in recognition
of unusual or nonrecurring events affecting a participant or the
Company, or the financial statements of the Company, or in
certain other instances specified in the 2010 PEP.
The Committee set the named executive officers 2010 target
performance goals under the PEP based on realistic expectations
of Company performance, ensuring successful execution of our
plans in order to realize the most value from these awards.
While we do not intend to disclose our 2010 PEP EBITDA target,
as an understanding of that target is not necessary for a fair
understanding of the named executive officers compensation
for 2009 and could result in competitive harm and market
confusion, we consistently set targets that require an increase
in EBITDA year over year to promote continuous growth consistent
with our business plan. For 2010, the Committee has the ability
to apply negative discretion based on performance of
company-wide quality metrics against industry benchmarks, and
for Ms. Wallace, negative discretion can be applied based
on performance of individual goals related to the operations of
the Shared Services Group.
Awards pursuant to the 2010 PEP that are attributable to the
performance goals being met at target level or below
will be paid solely in cash, and, in the event performance goals
are achieved above the target level, the amount of
an award attributable to performance results in excess of
target levels shall be payable 50% in cash and 50%
in restricted stock units.
The Company can recover (or clawback) incentive
compensation pursuant to our 2010 PEP that was based on
(i) achievement of financial results that are subsequently
the subject of a restatement due to material noncompliance with
any financial reporting requirement under either GAAP or federal
securities laws, other than as a result of changes to accounting
rules and regulations, or (ii) a subsequent finding that
the financial information or performance metrics used by the
Committee to determine the amount of the incentive compensations
are materially inaccurate, in each case regardless of individual
fault. In addition, the Company may recover any incentive
compensation awarded or paid pursuant to this policy based on
the participants conduct which is not in good faith and
which materially disrupts, damages, impairs or interferes with
the business of the Company and its affiliates. The Committee
may also provide for incremental additional payments to
then-current executives in the event any restatement or error
indicates that such executives should have received higher
performance-based payments. This policy is administered by the
Committee in the exercise of its discretion and business
judgment based on the relevant facts and circumstances.
Long-Term
Equity Incentive Awards: Options
In connection with the Recapitalization, the Board of Directors
approved and adopted the 2006 Stock Incentive Plan for Key
Employees of HCA Inc. and its Affiliates (the 2006
Plan). The purpose of the 2006 Plan is to:
|
|
|
|
|
Promote our long term financial interests and growth by
attracting and retaining management and other personnel and key
service providers with the training, experience and abilities to
enable them to make substantial contributions to the success of
our business;
|
|
|
|
Motivate management personnel by means of growth-related
incentives to achieve long range goals; and
|
|
|
|
Further the alignment of interests of participants with those of
our stockholders through opportunities for increased stock or
stock-based ownership in the Company.
|
In January 2007, pursuant to the terms of the named executive
officers respective employment agreements, the Committee
approved long-term stock option grants to our named executive
officers under the 2006 Plan consisting solely of a one-time,
multi-year stock option grant in lieu of annual long-term equity
incentive award grants (New Options). In addition to
the New Options granted in 2007, the Company committed to grant
the named executive officers 2x Time Options (as defined below)
in their respective employment agreements, as described in more
detail below under Narrative Disclosure to
Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards
Table Employment Agreements. The
117
Committee believes stock options are the most effective
long-term vehicle to directly align the interests of executives
with those of our stockholders by motivating performance that
results in the long-term appreciation of the Companys
value, since they only provide value to the executive if the
value of the Company increases. As is typical in leveraged
buyout situations, the Committee determined that granting all of
the stock options (except the 2x Time Options) up front rather
than annually was appropriate to aid in retaining key leaders
critical to the Companys success over the next several
years and, coupled with the executives significant
personal investments in connection with the Recapitalization,
provide an equity incentive and stake in the Company that
directly aligns the long-term economic interests of the
executives with those of the Investors.
The New Options have a ten year term and are divided so that
1/3
are time vested options,
1/3
are EBITDA-based performance vested options and
1/3
are performance options that vest based on investment return to
the Sponsors, each as described below. The combination of time,
performance and investor return based vesting of these awards is
designed to compensate executives for long term commitment to
the Company, while motivating sustained increases in our
financial performance and helping ensure the Sponsors have
received an appropriate return on their invested capital before
executives receive significant value from these grants.
The time vested options are granted to aid in retention.
Consistent with this goal, the time vested options granted in
2007 vest and become exercisable in equal increments of 20% on
each of the first five anniversaries of the grant date. The time
vested options have an exercise price equivalent to fair market
value on the date of grant. Since our common stock is not
currently traded on a national securities exchange, fair market
value was determined reasonably and in good faith by the Board
of Directors after consultation with the Chief Executive Officer
and other advisors.
The EBITDA-based performance vested options are intended to
motivate sustained improvement in long-term performance.
Consistent with this goal, the EBITDA-based performance vested
options granted in 2007 are eligible to vest and become
exercisable in equal increments of 20% at the end of fiscal
years 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 and 2011 if certain annual EBITDA
performance targets are achieved. These EBITDA performance
targets were established at the time of the Recapitalization and
can be adjusted by the Board of Directors in consultation with
the Chief Executive Officer as described below. We chose EBITDA
(defined in the award agreements as earnings before interest,
taxes, depreciation, amortization, minority interest expense
(now, net income attributable to noncontrolling interests),
gains or losses on sales of facilities, gains or losses on
extinguishment of debt, asset or investment impairment charges,
restructuring charges, and any other significant nonrecurring
non-cash gains or charges (but excluding any expenses for
share-based compensation under ASC 718 with respect to any
awards granted under the 2006 Plan)) as the performance metric
since it is a key driver of our valuation and for other reasons
as described above in the Elements of
Compensation Annual Incentive Compensation:
PEP section of this Compensation Discussion and Analysis.
Due to the number of events that can occur within our industry
in any given year that are beyond the control of management but
may significantly impact our financial performance (e.g., health
care regulations, industry-wide significant fluctuations in
volume, etc.), we have incorporated vesting provisions. The
EBITDA-based performance vested options may vest and become
exercisable on a catch up basis, such that options
that were eligible to vest but failed to vest due to our failure
to achieve prior EBITDA targets will vest if at the end of any
subsequent year or at the end of fiscal year 2012, the
cumulative total EBITDA earned in all prior years exceeds the
cumulative EBITDA target at the end of such fiscal year.
As discussed above, we do not intend to disclose the
2010-2011
EBITDA performance targets as they reflect competitive,
sensitive information regarding our budget. However, we
deliberately set our targets at increasingly higher levels.
Thus, while designed to be attainable, target performance levels
for these years require strong, improving performance and
execution, which in our view, provides an incentive firmly
aligned with stockholder interests.
As with the EBITDA targets under our PEP, pursuant to the terms
of the 2006 Plan and the Stock Option Agreements governing the
2007 grants, the Board of Directors, in consultation with our
Chief Executive Officer, has the ability to adjust the
established EBITDA targets for significant events, changes in
accounting rules and other customary adjustment events. We
believe these adjustments may be necessary in order to
effectuate the intents and purposes of our compensation plans
and to avoid unintended consequences that are
118
inconsistent with these intents and purposes. For example, the
Board of Directors exercised its ability to make adjustments to
the Companys
2009-2011
EBITDA performance targets (including cumulative EBITDA targets)
for facility dispositions and accounting changes occurring
during the 2009 fiscal year.
The options that vest based on investment return to the Sponsors
are intended to align the interests of executives with those of
our principal stockholders to ensure stockholders receive their
expected return on their investment before the executives can
receive their gains on this portion of the option grant. These
options vest and become exercisable with respect to 10% of the
common stock subject to such options at the end of fiscal years
2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 and 2011 if the Investor Return (as
defined below) is at least equal to two times the price paid to
stockholders in the Recapitalization (or $102.00), and with
respect to an additional 10% at the end of fiscal years 2007,
2008, 2009, 2010 and 2011 if the Investor Return is at least
equal to
two-and-a-half
times the price paid to stockholders in the Recapitalization (or
$127.50). Investor Return means, on any of the first
five anniversaries of the closing date of the Recapitalization,
or any date thereafter, all cash proceeds actually received by
affiliates of the Sponsors after the closing date in respect of
their common stock, including the receipt of any cash dividends
or other cash distributions (including the fair market value of
any distribution of common stock by the Sponsors to their
limited partners), determined on a fully diluted, per share
basis. The Sponsor investment return options also may become
vested and exercisable on a catch up basis if the
relevant Investor Return is achieved at any time occurring prior
to the expiration of such options.
Upon review of the Companys 2009 financial performance,
the Committee determined the Company achieved the 2009 EBITDA
performance target of $4.821 billion, as adjusted, under
the New Option awards; therefore, pursuant to the terms of the
2007 Stock Option Agreements, 20% of each named executive
officers EBITDA-based performance vested options vested as
of December 31, 2009. Further, 20% of each named executive
officers time vested options vested on the second
anniversary of their grant date, January 30, 2009. As of
the end of the 2009 fiscal year, no portion of the options that
vest based on Investor Return have vested; however, such options
remain subject to the catch up vesting provisions
described above.
In each of the employment agreements with the named executive
officers, we also committed to grant, among the named executive
officers and certain other executives, 10% of the options
initially authorized for grant under the 2006 Plan at some time
before November 17, 2011 (but with a good faith commitment
to do so before a change in control (as defined in
the 2006 Plan) or a public offering (as defined in
the 2006 Plan) and before the time when our Board of Directors
reasonably believes that the fair market value of our common
stock is likely to exceed the equivalent of $102.00 per share)
at an exercise price per share that is the equivalent of $102.00
per share (2x Time Options). On October 6,
2009, the 2x Time Options were granted. The Committee allocated
those options in consultation with our Chief Executive Officer
based on past executive contributions and future anticipated
impact on Company objectives. Forty percent of the 2x Time
Options were vested upon grant to reflect employment served
since the Recapitalization, an additional twenty percent of the
options vested on November 17, 2009, and twenty percent of
the options granted to each recipient will vest on
November 17, 2010 and November 17, 2011, respectively.
The terms of the 2x Time Options are otherwise consistent with
other time vesting options granted under the 2006 Plan.
For additional information concerning the options awarded in
2007 and 2009, see the 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards and
Outstanding Equity Awards at 2009 Fiscal Year-End Tables.
Ownership
Guidelines
While we have maintained stock ownership guidelines in the past,
as a non-listed company, we no longer have a policy regarding
stock ownership guidelines. However, we do believe equity
ownership aligns our executive officers interests with
those of the Investors. Accordingly, all of our named executive
officers were required to rollover at least half their
pre-Recapitalization equity and, therefore, maintain significant
stock ownership in the Company.
119
Retirement
Plans
We currently maintain one qualified retirement plan for which
the named executive officers are eligible, the HCA 401(k) Plan,
to aid in retention and to assist employees in providing for
their retirement. We also used to maintain the HCA Retirement
Plan, which as of April 1, 2008, merged into the HCA 401(k)
Plan resulting in one qualified retirement plan. Generally all
employees who have completed the required service are eligible
to participate in the HCA 401(k) Plan. Each of our named
executive officers participates in the plan. For additional
information on these plans, including amounts contributed by HCA
in 2009 to the named executive officers, see the Summary
Compensation Table and related footnotes and narratives and
2009 Pension Benefits.
Our key executives, including the named executive officers, also
participate in two supplemental retirement programs. The
Committee and the Board initially approved these supplemental
programs to:
|
|
|
|
|
Recognize significant long-term contributions and commitments by
executives to the Company and to performance over an extended
period of time;
|
|
|
|
Induce our executives to continue in our employ through a
specified normal retirement age (initially 62 through 65, but
reduced to 60 upon the change in control at the time of the
Recapitalization in 2006); and
|
|
|
|
Provide a competitive benefit to aid in attracting and retaining
key executive talent.
|
The Restoration Plan provides a benefit to replace a portion of
the contributions lost in the HCA 401(k) Plan due to certain IRS
limitations. Effective January 1, 2008, participants in the
SERP (described below) are no longer eligible for Restoration
Plan contributions; however, the hypothetical accounts
maintained for each named executive officer as of
January 1, 2008 will continue to be maintained and will be
increased or decreased with hypothetical investment returns
based on the actual investment return of the Mix B fund within
the HCA 401(k) Plan. For additional information concerning the
Restoration Plan, see 2009 Nonqualified Deferred
Compensation.
Key executives also participate in the Supplemental Executive
Retirement Plan (the SERP), adopted in 2001. The
SERP benefit brings the total value of annual retirement income
to a specific income replacement level. For named executive
officers with 25 years or more of service, this income
replacement level is 60% of final average pay (base salary and
PEP payouts) at normal retirement, a competitive level of
benefit at the time the plan was implemented. Due to the
Recapitalization, all participants are fully vested in their
SERP benefits and the plan is now frozen to new entrants. For
additional information concerning the SERP, see
2009 Pension Benefits.
In the event a participant renders service to another health
care organization within five years following retirement or
termination of employment, he or she forfeits the rights to any
further payment, and must repay any payments already made. This
non-competition provision is subject to waiver by the Committee
with respect to the named executive officers.
Personal
Benefits
Our executive officers receive limited, if any, benefits outside
of those offered to our other employees. Generally, we provide
these benefits to increase travel and work efficiencies and
allow for more productive use of the executives time.
Mr. Bracken is permitted to use the Company aircraft for
personal trips, subject to the aircrafts availability.
Prior to his retirement, Mr. Bovender was also permitted to
use the Company aircraft for personal trips, subject to the
aircrafts availability. The named executive officers may
have their spouses accompany them on business trips taken on the
Company aircraft, subject to seat availability. In addition,
there are times when it is appropriate for an executives
spouse to attend events related to our business. On those
occasions, we will pay for the travel expenses of the
executives spouse. We will, on an as needed basis, provide
mobile telephones and personal digital assistants to our
employees and certain of our executive officers have obtained
such devices through us. The value of these personal benefits,
if any, is included in the executive officers income for
tax purposes and, in certain limited circumstances, the
additional income
120
attributed to an executive officer as a result of one or more of
these benefits will be grossed up to cover the taxes due on that
income. Except as otherwise discussed herein, other welfare and
employee-benefit programs are the same for all of our eligible
employees, including our executive officers. For additional
information, see footnote (4) to the Summary Compensation
Table.
Severance
and Change in Control Benefits
As noted above, all of our named executive officers have entered
into employment agreements, which provide, among other things,
each executives rights upon a termination of employment in
exchange for non-competition, non-solicitation, and
confidentiality covenants. We believe that reasonable severance
benefits are appropriate in order to be competitive in our
executive retention efforts. These benefits should reflect the
fact that it may be difficult for such executives to find
comparable employment within a short period of time. We also
believe that these types of agreements are appropriate and
customary in situations such as the Recapitalization wherein the
executives have made significant personal investments in the
Company and that investment is generally illiquid for a
significant period of time. Finally, we believe formalized
severance arrangements are common benefits offered by employers
competing for similar senior executive talent.
Severance
Benefits for Named Executive Officers (other than
Mr. Bovender)
If employment is terminated by the Company without
cause or by the executive for good
reason (whether or not the termination was in connection
with a
change-in-control),
the executive would be entitled to accrued rights
(cause, good reason and accrued rights are as defined in
Narrative Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table
and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table
Employment Agreements) plus:
|
|
|
|
|
Subject to restrictive covenants and the signing of a general
release of claims, an amount equal to two times for
Ms. Wallace and Messrs. Hazen and Rutledge and three
times in the case of Messrs. Bracken and Johnson the sum of
base salary plus PEP paid or payable in respect of the fiscal
year immediately preceding the fiscal year in which termination
occurs, payable over a two year period;
|
|
|
|
Pro-rata bonus; and
|
|
|
|
Continued coverage under our group health plans during the
period over which the cash severance is paid.
|
Additionally, unvested options will be forfeited; however,
vested New Options (including 2x Time Options) will remain
exercisable until the first anniversary of the termination of
the executives employment.
Because we believe a termination by the executive for good
reason (a constructive termination) is conceptually the same as
an actual termination by the Company without cause, we believe
it is appropriate to provide severance benefits following such a
constructive termination of the named executive officers
employment. All of our severance provisions are believed to be
within the realm of competitive practice and are intended to
provide fair and reasonable compensation to the executive upon a
termination event.
Mr. Bovenders
Continuing Severance Benefits
In light of his long-term service to the Company and his
retirement from the position of Chief Executive Officer, the
Company entered into an Amended and Restated Employment
Agreement with Mr. Bovender, effective December 31,
2008 (the Amended Employment Agreement).
Mr. Bovenders Amended Employment Agreement provides
that, effective as of the expiration of the Employment Term (as
defined in Narrative Disclosure to Summary
Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards
Table Employment Agreements),
Mr. Bovender was entitled to receive the accrued
rights as described above for the other named executive
officers. Mr. Bovender was also entitled to receive a pro
rata portion of his bonus under the
2008-2009
PEP based on the Companys actual results for 2009
(Mr. Bovenders Prorated Bonus).
Mr. Bovender is also entitled to continued coverage under
the Companys group health plans for Mr. Bovender and
his wife until age 65, reimbursement of any unreimbursed
business expenses properly incurred and such
121
employee benefits, if any, as to which Mr. Bovender would
be entitled under the Companys employee benefit plans.
The Amended Employment Agreement also provides that, effective
as of the expiration of the Employment Term (December 15,
2009), (i) neither Mr. Bovender nor the Company have
any put or call rights with respect to Mr. Bovenders
New Options or stock acquired upon the exercise of any such
options; (ii) Mr. Bovenders rollover
stock options will remain exercisable as if
Mr. Bovenders employment terminated by reason of
retirement in accordance with the terms of the
applicable equity plans and award agreements; (iii) the
unvested New Options (including the 2x Time Options) held by
Mr. Bovender that vest solely based on the passage of time
will vest as if Mr. Bovenders employment had
continued through the next three anniversaries of their date of
grant; (iv) the unvested New Options held by
Mr. Bovender that are EBITDA performance options will
remain outstanding and will vest, if at all, on the next four
dates that they would have otherwise vested had
Mr. Bovenders employment continued, based upon the
extent to which performance goals are met; (v) the unvested
New Options held by Mr. Bovender that are Investor
Return performance options will remain outstanding and
will vest, if at all, on the dates that they would have
otherwise vested had Mr. Bovenders employment
continued through the expiration of such options, based upon the
extent to which performance goals are met; and
(vi) Mr. Bovenders New Options will remain
exercisable until the second anniversary of the last date on
which his EBITDA performance options are eligible to vest (which
is December 31, 2014), except that
(a) Mr. Bovenders 2x Time Options will remain
exercisable until the fifth anniversary of the last date on
which his EBITDA performance options are eligible to vest (which
is December 31, 2017), and
(b) Mr. Bovenders Investor Return
performance options will remain exercisable until the expiration
of such options.
Change in
Control Benefits
Pursuant to the Stock Option Agreements governing the New
Options granted in 2007 and the 2x Time Options granted in 2009,
both under the 2006 Plan, upon a Change in Control of the
Company (as defined below), all unvested time vesting New
Options and 2x Time Options (that have not otherwise terminated
or become exercisable) shall become immediately exercisable.
Performance options that vest subject to the achievement of
EBITDA targets will become exercisable upon a Change in Control
of the Company if: (i) prior to the date of the occurrence
of such event, all EBITDA targets have been achieved for years
ending prior to such date; (ii) on the date of the
occurrence of such event, the Companys actual cumulative
total EBITDA earned in all years occurring after the performance
option grant date, and ending on the date of the Change in
Control, exceeds the cumulative total of all EBITDA targets in
effect for those same years; or (iii) the Investor Return
is at least
two-and-a-half
times the price paid to the stockholders in the Recapitalization
(or $127.50). For purposes of the vesting provision set forth in
clause (ii) above, the EBITDA target for the year in which
the Change in Control occurs shall be equitably adjusted by the
Board of Directors in good faith in consultation with the chief
executive officer (which adjustment shall take into account the
time during such year at which the Change in Control occurs).
Performance vesting options that vest based on the investment
return to the Sponsors will only vest upon the occurrence of a
Change in Control if, as a result of such event, the applicable
Investor Return (i.e., at least two times the price paid to the
stockholders in the Recapitalization for half of these options
and at least
two-and-one-half
times the price paid to the stockholders in the Recapitalization
for the other half of these options) is also achieved in such
transaction (if not previously achieved). Change in
Control means in one or more of a series of transactions
(i) the transfer or sale of all or substantially all of the
assets of the Company (or any direct or indirect parent of the
Company) to an Unaffiliated Person (as defined below);
(ii) a merger, consolidation, recapitalization or
reorganization of the Company (or any direct or indirect parent
of the Company) with or into another Unaffiliated Person, or a
transfer or sale of the voting stock of the Company (or any
direct or indirect parent of the Company), an Investor, or any
affiliate of any of the Investors to an Unaffiliated Person, in
any such event that results in more than 50% of the common stock
of the Company (or any direct or indirect parent of the Company)
or the resulting company being held by an Unaffiliated Person;
or (iii) a merger, consolidation, recapitalization or
reorganization of the Company (or any direct or indirect parent
of the Company) with or into another Unaffiliated Person, or a
transfer or sale by the Company (or any direct or indirect
parent of the Company), an Investor or any affiliate of any of
the Investors, in any such event after which the Investors and
their affiliates
122
(x) collectively own less than 15% of the common stock of
and (y) collectively have the ability to appoint less than
50% of the directors to the Board (or any resulting company
after a merger). For purposes of this definition, the term
Unaffiliated Person means a person or group who is
not an Investor, an affiliate of any of the Investors or an
entity in which any Investor holds, directly or indirectly, a
majority of the economic interest in such entity.
Additional information regarding applicable payments under such
agreements for the named executive officers is provided under
Narrative Disclosure to Summary Compensation
Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table
Employment Agreements and Potential Payments
Upon Termination or Change in Control.
Recoupment
of Compensation
Information regarding the Companys policy with respect to
recovery of incentive compensation is provided under
Elements of Compensation Annual
Incentive Compensation: PEP above.
Tax
and Accounting Implications
On April 29, 2008, we registered our common stock pursuant
to Section 12(g) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended; and the Company became subject to Section 162(m)
of the Internal Revenue Code, as amended (the Code)
for fiscal year 2008 and beyond, so long as the Companys
stock remains registered with the SEC. The Committee considers
the impact of Section 162(m) in the design of its
compensation strategies. Under Section 162(m), compensation
paid to executive officers in excess of $1,000,000 cannot be
taken by us as a tax deduction unless the compensation qualifies
as performance-based compensation. We have determined, however,
that we will not necessarily seek to limit executive
compensation to amounts deductible under Section 162(m) if
such limitation is not in the best interests of our
stockholders. While considering the tax implications of its
compensation decisions, the Committee believes its primary focus
should be to attract, retain and motivate executives and to
align the executives interests with those of our
stakeholders.
The Committee operates its compensation programs with the good
faith intention of complying with Section 409A of the
Internal Revenue Code. We account for stock based payments with
respect to our long term equity incentive award programs in
accordance with the requirements of ASC 718.
123
2009
Summary Compensation Table
The following table sets forth information regarding the
compensation earned by the Chief Executive Officer, the Chief
Financial Officer and our other three most highly compensated
executive officers during 2009 and Mr. Bovender, who would
have been one of our most highly compensated executive officers
had he not retired as an executive officer on December 15,
2009.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changes in
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Pension
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-Equity
|
|
Value and
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Incentive
|
|
Nonqualified
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Option
|
|
Plan
|
|
Deferred
|
|
All Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salary
|
|
Awards
|
|
Compensation
|
|
Compensation
|
|
Compensation
|
|
|
Name and Principal Positions
|
|
Year
|
|
($)
|
|
($)(1)
|
|
($)(2)
|
|
Earnings ($)(3)
|
|
($)(4)
|
|
Total ($)
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
$
|
1,324,975
|
|
|
$
|
3,361,016
|
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
|
$
|
4,096,368
|
|
|
$
|
25,532
|
|
|
$
|
12,252,891
|
|
Chairman and Chief
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
$
|
1,060,872
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
694,370
|
|
|
$
|
1,740,620
|
|
|
$
|
31,781
|
|
|
$
|
3,527,643
|
|
Executive Officer
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
$
|
1,060,872
|
|
|
$
|
5,560,666
|
|
|
$
|
1,909,570
|
|
|
$
|
590,370
|
|
|
$
|
142,932
|
|
|
$
|
9,264,410
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
$
|
849,984
|
|
|
$
|
2,520,714
|
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
|
$
|
2,032,089
|
|
|
$
|
17,674
|
|
|
$
|
6,780,461
|
|
Executive Vice President,
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
$
|
786,698
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
355,491
|
|
|
$
|
1,871,790
|
|
|
$
|
38,769
|
|
|
$
|
3,052,748
|
|
Chief Financial Officer
and Director
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
$
|
750,379
|
|
|
$
|
3,971,905
|
|
|
$
|
900,455
|
|
|
$
|
509,442
|
|
|
$
|
82,462
|
|
|
$
|
6,214,643
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
$
|
700,000
|
|
|
$
|
997,771
|
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
|
$
|
2,047,036
|
|
|
$
|
16,500
|
|
|
$
|
4,685,325
|
|
President Shared
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
$
|
700,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
314,992
|
|
|
$
|
2,080,836
|
|
|
$
|
15,651
|
|
|
$
|
3,111,479
|
|
Services Group
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
$
|
700,000
|
|
|
$
|
2,224,258
|
|
|
$
|
840,000
|
|
|
$
|
676,111
|
|
|
$
|
75,013
|
|
|
$
|
4,515,382
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
$
|
788,672
|
|
|
$
|
997,771
|
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
|
$
|
1,725,405
|
|
|
$
|
16,499
|
|
|
$
|
4,569,414
|
|
President Western Group
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
$
|
788,672
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
350,807
|
|
|
$
|
810,462
|
|
|
$
|
15,651
|
|
|
$
|
1,965,592
|
|
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
$
|
788,672
|
|
|
$
|
2,542,007
|
|
|
$
|
830,779
|
|
|
$
|
258,787
|
|
|
$
|
84,767
|
|
|
$
|
4,505,012
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
$
|
675,000
|
|
|
$
|
997,771
|
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
|
$
|
1,510,040
|
|
|
$
|
16,500
|
|
|
$
|
4,090,328
|
|
President Central Group
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
$
|
1,288,676
|
|
|
$
|
1,470,443
|
|
|
$
|
1,250,000
|
|
|
$
|
4,127,725
|
|
|
$
|
76,399
|
|
|
$
|
8,213,243
|
|
Executive Chairman*
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
$
|
1,620,228
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,391,886
|
|
|
$
|
3,926,217
|
|
|
$
|
45,321
|
|
|
$
|
6,983,652
|
|
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
$
|
1,620,228
|
|
|
$
|
6,355,038
|
|
|
$
|
3,888,547
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
197,092
|
|
|
$
|
12,060,905
|
|
|
|
|
* |
|
Mr. Bovender retired as executive Chairman of the Company
effective December 15, 2009. |
|
(1) |
|
Option Awards for 2007 and 2009 include the aggregate grant date
fair value of the stock option awards granted during fiscal
years 2007 and 2009, respectively, in accordance with ASC 718
with respect to New Options (including the 2x Time Options) to
purchase shares of our common stock awarded to the named
executive officers in fiscal years 2007 and 2009, respectively,
under the 2006 Plan. See Note 2 to our consolidated
financial statements included in this prospectus. |
|
(2) |
|
Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation for 2009 reflects amounts
earned for the year ended December 31, 2009 under the
2008-2009
PEP, which amounts were paid in the first quarter of 2010
pursuant to the terms of the
2008-2009
PEP. For 2009, the Company exceeded its maximum performance
level, as adjusted, with respect to the Companys EBITDA
and the Central and Western Group EBITDA; therefore, pursuant to
the terms of the
2008-2009
PEP, awards under the
2008-2009
PEP were paid out to the named executive officers, at the
maximum level of 200% of their respective target amounts.
Mr. Bovender was also awarded, pursuant to his Amended
Employment Agreement, an additional one-time bonus of $250,000
based upon his contributions to certain legislative initiatives
as determined by the Committee. |
|
|
|
Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation for 2008 reflects amounts
earned for the year ended December 31, 2008 under the
2008-2009
PEP, which amounts were paid in the first quarter of 2009
pursuant to the terms of the
2008-2009
PEP. For 2008, the Company did not achieve its target
performance level, but exceeded its threshold performance level,
as adjusted, with respect to the Companys EBITDA;
therefore, pursuant to the terms of the
2008-2009
PEP, 2008 awards under the
2008-2009
PEP were paid out to the named executive officers at
approximately 68.2% of each such officers respective
target amount, with the exception of Mr. Hazen, whose award
was paid out at approximately 67.4% of his target amount, due to
the 50% of his PEP based on the Western Group EBITDA, which also
exceeded the threshold performance level but did not reach the
target performance level. |
|
|
|
Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation for 2007 reflects amounts
earned for the year ended December 31, 2007 under the 2007
PEP, which amounts were paid in the first quarter of 2008
pursuant to |
124
|
|
|
|
|
the terms of the 2007 PEP. For 2007, the Company exceeded its
maximum performance level, as adjusted, with respect to the
Companys EBITDA; therefore, pursuant to the terms of the
2007 PEP, awards under the 2007 PEP were paid out to the named
executive officers, at the maximum level of 200% of their
respective target amounts, with the exception of Mr. Hazen,
whose award was paid out at 175.6% of the target amount, due to
the 50% of his PEP based on the Western Group EBITDA, which
exceeded the target but did not reach the maximum performance
level. |
|
(3) |
|
All amounts for 2009 are attributable to changes in value of the
SERP benefits. Assumptions used to calculate these figures are
provided under the table titled 2009 Pension
Benefits. The changes in the SERP benefit value during
2009 were impacted mainly by: (i) the passage of time which
reflects another year of pay and service plus actual investment
return, (ii) the discount rate changing from 6.25% to
5.00%, which resulted in an increase in the value and
(iii) the use of the actual 2009 interest rate of 4.24% for
Mr. Bovender who retired in 2009. The impact of these
events on the SERP benefit values was: |
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Bracken
|
|
Johnson
|
|
Wallace
|
|
Hazen
|
|
Rutledge
|
|
Bovender
|
|
Passage of Time
|
|
$
|
1,655,097
|
|
|
$
|
618,320
|
|
|
$
|
788,376
|
|
|
$
|
343,653
|
|
|
$
|
420,979
|
|
|
$
|
2,053,402
|
|
Discount Rate Change
|
|
$
|
2,441,271
|
|
|
$
|
1,413,769
|
|
|
$
|
1,258,660
|
|
|
$
|
1,381,752
|
|
|
$
|
1,089,061
|
|
|
|
|
|
Actual Retirement
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,074,323
|
|
All amounts for 2008 are attributable to changes in value of the
SERP benefits. Assumptions used to calculate these figures are
provided under the table titled 2009 Pension
Benefits. The changes in the SERP benefit value during
2008 were impacted mainly by: (i) the passage of time which
reflects another year of pay and service plus actual investment
return, (ii) the discount rate changing from 6.00% to
6.25%, which resulted in a decrease in the value and
(iii) the opportunity for participants to change their
benefit election before 2009 for terminations and retirements
occurring after 2008. Mr. Bovender elected to change his
benefit payment from an annuity to a lump sum. The impact of
these events on the SERP benefit values was:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Bracken
|
|
Johnson
|
|
Wallace
|
|
Hazen
|
|
Bovender
|
|
Passage of Time
|
|
$
|
2,142,217
|
|
|
$
|
2,100,290
|
|
|
$
|
2,301,107
|
|
|
$
|
1,037,631
|
|
|
$
|
1,432,831
|
|
Discount Rate Change
|
|
$
|
(401,597
|
)
|
|
$
|
(228,500
|
)
|
|
$
|
(220,271
|
)
|
|
$
|
(227,169
|
)
|
|
$
|
(467,374
|
)
|
Change in Election
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,960,760
|
|
All amounts for 2007 are attributable to changes in value of the
SERP benefits. Assumptions used to calculate these figures are
provided under the table titled 2009 Pension
Benefits. The changes in the SERP benefit value during
2007 were impacted mainly by: (i) the passage of time which
reflects another year of pay and service, (ii) the discount
rate changing from 5.75% to 6.00%, which resulted in a decrease
in the value and (iii) the use of the named executive
officers actual elections compared to 2006 when benefits
were valued assuming a 50% probability of electing a lump sum
and a 50% probability of electing an annuity. All named
executive officers elected a lump sum payment at retirement,
with the exception of Mr. Bovender, who elected an annuity.
The impact of these events on the SERP benefit values was:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Bracken
|
|
Johnson
|
|
Wallace
|
|
Hazen
|
|
Bovender
|
|
Passage of Time
|
|
$
|
399,630
|
|
|
$
|
510,118
|
|
|
$
|
549,404
|
|
|
$
|
266,066
|
|
|
$
|
(966,974
|
)
|
Discount Rate Change
|
|
$
|
(351,603
|
)
|
|
$
|
(145,992
|
)
|
|
$
|
(165,945
|
)
|
|
$
|
(186,325
|
)
|
|
$
|
(542,195
|
)
|
Actual Election
|
|
$
|
542,343
|
|
|
$
|
145,315
|
|
|
$
|
292,652
|
|
|
$
|
179,046
|
|
|
$
|
(1,322,788
|
)
|
|
|
|
(4) |
|
2009 amounts generally consist of: |
|
|
|
|
|
Matching Company contributions to our 401(k) Plan as set forth
below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Bracken
|
|
Johnson
|
|
Wallace
|
|
Hazen
|
|
Rutledge
|
|
Bovender
|
|
HCA 401(k) matching contribution
|
|
$
|
16,500
|
|
|
$
|
16,500
|
|
|
$
|
16,500
|
|
|
$
|
16,499
|
|
|
$
|
16,500
|
|
|
$
|
16,500
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Personal use of corporate aircraft. In 2009,
Messrs. Bracken, Johnson and Bovender were allowed personal
use of Company aircraft with an estimated incremental cost of
$5,025, $1,129 and $13,141, respectively, to the Company.
Ms. Wallace and Messrs. Hazen and Rutledge did not
have any personal
|
125
|
|
|
|
|
travel on Company aircraft in 2009. We calculate the aggregate
incremental cost of the personal use of Company aircraft based
on a methodology that includes the average aggregate cost, on a
per nautical mile basis, of variable expenses incurred in
connection with personal plane usage, including trip-related
maintenance, landing fees, fuel, crew hotels and meals, on-board
catering, trip-related hangar and parking costs and other
variable costs. Because our aircraft are used primarily for
business travel, our incremental cost methodology does not
include fixed costs of owning and operating aircraft that do not
change based on usage. We grossed up the income attributed to
Mr. Bracken with respect to certain trips on Company
aircraft. The additional income attributed to him as a result of
gross ups was $594. In addition, we will pay the expenses of our
executives spouses associated with travel to
and/or
attendance at business related events at which spouse attendance
is appropriate. We paid approximately $2,477 and $13,327 for
travel
and/or other
expenses incurred by Messrs. Brackens and
Bovenders wives, respectively, for such business related
events, and additional income of $891 and $4,793 was attributed
to Messrs. Bracken and Bovender, respectively, as a result
of the gross up on such amounts.
|
|
|
|
|
|
Additional income of $28,638 was attributed to Mr. Bovender
for gifts received from the Company in connection with his
retirement.
|
2008 amounts consist of:
|
|
|
|
|
Company contributions to our former Retirement Plan and matching
Company contributions to our 401(k) Plan as set forth below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Bracken
|
|
|
Johnson
|
|
|
Wallace
|
|
|
Hazen
|
|
|
Bovender
|
|
|
HCA Retirement Plan
|
|
$
|
3,163
|
|
|
$
|
3,163
|
|
|
$
|
3,163
|
|
|
$
|
3,163
|
|
|
$
|
3,163
|
|
HCA 401(k) matching contribution
|
|
$
|
12,488
|
|
|
$
|
12,488
|
|
|
$
|
12,488
|
|
|
$
|
12,488
|
|
|
$
|
12,488
|
|
HCA Restoration Plan
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Effective January 1, 2008, participants in the SERP are no
longer eligible for Restoration Plan contributions.
|
|
|
|
|
Personal use of corporate aircraft. In 2008,
Messrs. Bovender, Bracken and Johnson were allowed personal
use of Company aircraft with an estimated incremental cost of
$28,913, $15,233 and $4,546, respectively, to the Company.
Ms. Wallace and Mr. Hazen did not have any personal
travel on Company aircraft in 2008. We calculate the aggregate
incremental cost of the personal use of Company aircraft based
on a methodology that includes the average aggregate cost, on a
per nautical mile basis, of variable expenses incurred in
connection with personal plane usage, including trip-related
maintenance, landing fees, fuel, crew hotels and meals, on-board
catering, trip-related hangar and parking costs and other
variable costs. Because our aircraft are used primarily for
business travel, our incremental cost methodology does not
include fixed costs of owning and operating aircraft that do not
change based on usage. We grossed up the income attributed to
Messrs. Bovender and Bracken with respect to certain trips
on Company aircraft. The additional income attributed to them as
a result of gross ups was $588 and $599, respectively. In
addition, we will pay the expenses of our executives
spouses associated with travel to
and/or
attendance at business related events at which spouse attendance
is appropriate. We paid approximately $107, $189 and $13,660 for
travel
and/or other
expenses incurred by Messrs. Bovenders,
Brackens and Johnsons wives, respectively, for such
business related events, and additional income of $62, $109 and
$4,912 was attributed to Messrs. Bovender, Bracken and
Johnson, respectively, as a result of the gross up on such
amounts.
|
2007 amounts consist of:
|
|
|
|
|
Company contributions to our former Retirement Plan, matching
Company contributions to our 401(k) Plan and Company accruals
for our Restoration Plan as set forth below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Bracken
|
|
|
Johnson
|
|
|
Wallace
|
|
|
Hazen
|
|
|
Bovender
|
|
|
HCA Retirement Plan
|
|
$
|
19,388
|
|
|
$
|
19,388
|
|
|
$
|
19,388
|
|
|
$
|
19,388
|
|
|
$
|
19,388
|
|
HCA 401(k) matching contribution
|
|
$
|
3,375
|
|
|
$
|
3,375
|
|
|
$
|
3,375
|
|
|
$
|
3,375
|
|
|
$
|
2,250
|
|
HCA Restoration Plan
|
|
$
|
91,946
|
|
|
$
|
57,792
|
|
|
$
|
52,250
|
|
|
$
|
62,004
|
|
|
$
|
153,475
|
|
126
|
|
|
|
|
Personal use of corporate aircraft. In 2007,
Messrs. Bovender and Bracken were allowed personal use of
Company aircraft with an estimated incremental cost of $21,350
and $26,895, respectively, to the Company, calculated as
described above. Ms. Wallace and Mr. Hazen did not
have any personal travel on Companys aircraft in 2007. We
grossed up the income attributed to Messrs. Bovender and
Bracken with respect to certain trips on Company aircraft. The
additional income attributed to them as a result of gross ups
was $629 and $863, respectively. In addition, we will pay the
travel expenses of our executives spouses associated with
travel to business related events at which spouse attendance is
appropriate. We paid approximately $342 for travel by
Mr. Brackens wife on a commercial airline and related
expenses for such an event, and additional income of $123 was
attributed to Mr. Bracken as a result of the gross up on
such amount.
|
2009
Grants of Plan-Based Awards
The following table provides information with respect to awards
made under our 2006 Plan and
2008-2009
PEP during the 2009 fiscal year.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
All Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Estimated Possible Payouts
|
|
|
Estimated Possible Payouts
|
|
|
Awards:
|
|
|
Exercise or
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Under Non-Equity Incentive
|
|
|
Under Equity Incentive
|
|
|
Number of
|
|
|
Base Price
|
|
|
Grant Date
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Plan Awards ($)(1)
|
|
|
Plan Awards (#)
|
|
|
Securities
|
|
|
of Option
|
|
|
Fair Value
|
|
|
|
Grant
|
|
|
Threshold
|
|
|
Target
|
|
|
Maximum
|
|
|
Threshold
|
|
|
Target
|
|
|
Maximum
|
|
|
Underlying
|
|
|
Awards
|
|
|
of Option
|
|
Name
|
|
Date
|
|
|
($)
|
|
|
($)
|
|
|
($)
|
|
|
(#)
|
|
|
(#)
|
|
|
(#)
|
|
|
Options(2)
|
|
|
($/sh)
|
|
|
Awards
|
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
10/6/2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
315,742
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
$
|
3,361,016
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
N/A
|
|
|
$
|
861,250
|
|
|
$
|
1,722,500
|
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
10/6/2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
236,802
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
$
|
2,520,714
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
N/A
|
|
|
$
|
340,000
|
|
|
$
|
680,000
|
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
10/6/2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
93,733
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
$
|
997,771
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
N/A
|
|
|
$
|
231,004
|
|
|
$
|
462,009
|
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
10/6/2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
93,733
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
$
|
997,771
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
N/A
|
|
|
$
|
260,267
|
|
|
$
|
520,534
|
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
10/6/2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
93,733
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
$
|
997,771
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
N/A
|
|
|
$
|
222,754
|
|
|
$
|
445,509
|
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
10/6/2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
138,137
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
$
|
1,470,443
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
N/A
|
|
|
$
|
250,000
|
|
|
$
|
500,000
|
|
|
$
|
1,000,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Non-equity incentive awards granted to each of the named
executive officers pursuant to our
2008-2009
PEP for the 2009 fiscal year, as described in more detail under
Compensation Discussion and Analysis
Elements of Compensation Annual Incentive
Compensation: PEP. The amounts shown in the
Threshold column reflect the threshold payment,
which is 50% of the amount shown in the Target
column. The amount shown in the Maximum column is
200% of the target amount. Mr. Bovenders Amended
Employment Agreement set forth his PEP target for the 2009
fiscal year. Pursuant to the terms of the
2008-2009
PEP, the Company exceeded its maximum performance level, as
adjusted, for 2009 with respect to the Companys EBITDA and
the Central and Western Group EBITDA; therefore, pursuant to the
terms of the
2008-2009
PEP, awards were paid out to the named executive officers, at
the maximum level of 200% of their respective target amounts for
2009. Messrs. Bracken, Johnson, Hazen, Rutledge and
Bovender and Ms. Wallace received $3,445,000, $1,360,000,
$1,041,067, $891,017, $1,000,000 and $924,018, respectively,
under the
2008-2009
Senior Officer PEP for the 2009 fiscal year. Such amounts are
reflected in the Non-Equity Incentive Plan
Compensation column of the Summary Compensation Table. |
|
(2) |
|
Stock options awarded under the 2006 Plan, pursuant to the named
executive officers respective employment agreements, by
the Compensation Committee as a part of the named executive
officers long term equity incentive award. The 2x Time
Options granted in 2009 are structured, pursuant to the named
executive officers respective employment agreements, so
that 40% were vested on the grant date to reflect employment
served since the Recapitalization, an additional 20% vested on
November 17, 2009 and an additional 20% will vest on each
of November 17, 2010 and November 17, 2011,
respectively. The terms of these option awards are described in
more detail under Compensation Discussion and
Analysis Elements of Compensation Long Term
Equity Incentive Awards: Options. The aggregate grant date
fair value of these option grants in accordance with ASC 718 is
reflected in the Option Awards column of the Summary
Compensation Table. |
127
Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table
Total
Compensation
In 2009, 2008 and 2007, total direct compensation, as described
in the Summary Compensation Table, consisted primarily of base
salary, annual PEP awards payable in cash, and, in 2007, long
term stock option grants designed to be one-time grants to cover
at least five years of service and, in 2009, 2x Time Option
grants as set forth in each named executive officers
employment agreement to be fully vested on the fifth anniversary
of the Recapitalization. This mix was intended to reflect our
philosophy that a significant portion of an executives
compensation should be equity-linked
and/or tied
to our operating performance. In addition, we provided an
opportunity for executives to participate in two supplemental
retirement plans; however, effective January 1, 2008,
participants in the SERP are no longer eligible for Restoration
Plan contributions, although Restoration Plan accounts will
continue to be maintained for such participants (for additional
information concerning the Restoration Plan, see
2009 Nonqualified Deferred Compensation).
Options
In January 2007, New Options to purchase common stock of the
Company were granted under the 2006 Plan to members of
management and key employees, including the named executive
officers. The New Options were designed to be long term equity
incentive awards, constituting a one-time stock option grant in
lieu of annual equity grants. The New Options granted in 2007
have a ten year term and are structured so that
1/3
are time vested options (vesting in five equal installments on
the first five anniversaries of the grant date),
1/3 are
EBITDA-based performance vested options and
1/3
are performance options that vest based on investment return to
the Sponsors. The terms of the New Options granted in 2007 are
described in greater detail under Compensation
Discussion and Analysis Elements of Compensation
Long Term Equity Incentive Awards: Options. The aggregate
grant date fair value of the New Options granted in 2007 in
accordance with ASC 718 is included under the Option
Awards column of the Summary Compensation Table.
In accordance with their employment agreements entered into at
the time of the Recapitalization, as each may have been or may
be subsequently amended, our named executive officers received
the 2x Time Options in October 2009 with an exercise price equal
to two times the share price at the Recapitalization (or
$102.00). The Committee allocated the 2x Time Options in
consultation with our Chief Executive Officer based on past
executive contributions and future anticipated impact on Company
objectives. The 2x Time Options have a ten year term and are
structured so that forty percent were vested upon grant, an
additional twenty percent of the options vested on
November 17, 2009, and twenty percent of the options
granted to each recipient will vest on November 17, 2010
and November 17, 2011, respectively. Thereby, a portion of
the grant was vested on the date of the grant based on
employment served since the Recapitalization. The terms of the
2x Time Options are otherwise consistent with other time vesting
options granted under the 2006 Plan. The terms of the 2x Time
Options granted in 2009 are described in greater detail under
Compensation Discussion and
Analysis Elements of Compensation Long
Term Equity Incentive Awards: Options. The aggregate grant
date fair value of the 2x Time Options granted in 2009 in
accordance with ASC 718 is included under the Option
Awards column of the Summary Compensation Table.
As a result of the Recapitalization, all unvested awards under
the HCA 2005 Equity Incentive Plan (the 2005 Plan)
(and all predecessor equity incentive plans) vested in November
2006. Generally, all outstanding options under the 2005 Plan
(and any predecessor plans) were cancelled and converted into
the right to receive a cash payment equal to the number of
shares of common stock underlying the option multiplied by the
amount by which the Recapitalization consideration of $51.00 per
share exceeded the exercise price for the options (without
interest and less any applicable withholding taxes). However,
certain members of management, including the named executive
officers, were given the opportunity to convert options held by
them prior to consummation of the Recapitalization into options
to purchase shares of common stock of the surviving corporation
(Rollover Options). Immediately after the
consummation of the Recapitalization, all Rollover Options
(other than those with an exercise price below $12.75) were
adjusted so that they retained the same spread value
(as defined below) as immediately prior to the Recapitalization,
but the new per share exercise price for all Rollover Options
would be $12.75. The term spread value means the
difference between (x) the
128
aggregate fair market value of the common stock (determined
using the Recapitalization consideration of $51.00 per share)
subject to the outstanding options held by the participant
immediately prior to the Recapitalization that became Rollover
Options, and (y) the aggregate exercise price of those
options.
New Options, 2x Time Options and Rollover Options held by the
named executive officers are described in the Outstanding Equity
Awards at 2009 Fiscal Year-End Table.
Employment
Agreements
In connection with the Recapitalization, on November 16,
2006, Hercules Holding entered into substantially similar
employment agreements with each of the named executive officers
and certain other executives, which agreements were shortly
thereafter assumed by the Company and which agreements govern
the terms of each executives employment. However, in light
of Mr. Bovenders retirement from the positions of
Chief Executive Officer and Chairman, effective
December 31, 2008 and December 15, 2009, respectively,
the Company entered into an Amended and Restated Employment
Agreement with Mr. Bovender, effective December 31,
2008, the terms of which are described below. The Company also
entered into an amendment to Mr. Brackens employment
agreement, effective January 1, 2009, to reflect his
appointment to the position of Chief Executive Officer.
Executive
Employment Agreements (Other than
Mr. Bovenders)
The term of employment under each of these agreements is
indefinite, and they are terminable by either party at any time;
provided that an executive must give no less than 90 days
notice prior to a resignation.
Each employment agreement sets forth the executives annual
base salary, which will be subject to discretionary annual
increases upon review by the Board of Directors, and states that
the executive will be eligible to earn an annual bonus as a
percentage of salary with respect to each fiscal year, based
upon the extent to which annual performance targets established
by the Board of Directors are achieved. The employment
agreements committed us to provide each executive with annual
bonus opportunities in 2008 that were consistent with those
applicable to the 2007 fiscal year, unless doing so would be
adverse to our interests or the interests of our stockholders,
and for later fiscal years, the agreements provide that the
Board of Directors will set bonus opportunities in consultation
with our Chief Executive Officer. With respect to the 2009 and
2008 fiscal years and the 2007 fiscal year, each executive was
eligible to earn under the
2008-2009
PEP and the
2007-2008
PEP, respectively, (i) a target bonus, if performance
targets were met; (ii) a specified percentage of the target
bonus, if threshold levels of performance were
achieved but performance targets were not met; or (iii) a
multiple of the target bonus if maximum performance
goals were achieved, with the annual bonus amount being
interpolated, in the sole discretion of the Board of Directors,
for performance results that exceeded threshold
levels but do not meet or exceed maximum levels. The
annual bonus opportunities for 2009 were set forth in the
2008-2009
PEP, as described in more detail under Compensation
Discussion and Analysis Annual Incentive
Compensation: PEP. As described above, the Company
exceeded its maximum performance level, as adjusted, for 2009
with respect to the Companys EBITDA and the Central and
Western Group EBITDA; therefore, pursuant to the terms of the
2008-2009
PEP, awards were paid out to the named executive officers, at
the maximum level of 200% of their respective target amounts for
2009. As described above, awards under the 2008 PEP were paid
out to the named executive officers at approximately 68.2% of
each such officers respective target amount, with the
exception of Mr. Hazen, whose award was paid out at
approximately 67.4% of the target amount. Awards under the 2007
PEP were paid out to the named executive officers, at the
maximum level of 200% of their respective target amounts, with
the exception of Mr. Hazen, whose award was paid out at
175.6% of his target amount. Each employment agreement also sets
forth the number of options that the executive received pursuant
to the 2006 Plan as a percentage of the total equity initially
made available for grants pursuant to the 2006 Plan. Such option
awards, the New Options, were made January 30, 2007 and are
described above under Options.
In each of the employment agreements with the named executive
officers, we also committed to grant, among the named executive
officers and certain other executives, the 2x Time Options,
which were granted, as described above, on October 6, 2009.
Additionally, pursuant to the employment agreements, we agree to
129
indemnify each executive against any adverse tax consequences
(including, without limitation, under Section 409A and 4999
of the Internal Revenue Code), if any, that result from the
adjustment by us of stock options held by the executive in
connection with Recapitalization or the future payment of any
extraordinary cash dividends.
Pursuant to each employment agreement, if an executives
employment terminates due to death or disability, the executive
would be entitled to receive (i) any base salary and any
bonus that is earned and unpaid through the date of termination;
(ii) reimbursement of any unreimbursed business expenses
properly incurred by the executive; (iii) such employee
benefits, if any, as to which the executive may be entitled
under our employee benefit plans (the payments and benefits
described in (i) through (iii) being accrued
rights); and (iv) a pro rata portion of any annual
bonus that the executive would have been entitled to receive
pursuant to the employment agreement based upon our actual
results for the year of termination (with such proration based
on the percentage of the fiscal year that shall have elapsed
through the date of termination of employment, payable to the
executive when the annual bonus would have been otherwise
payable (the pro rata bonus)).
If an executives employment is terminated by us without
cause (as defined below) or by the executive for
good reason (as defined below) (each a
qualifying termination), the executive would be
(i) entitled to the accrued rights; (ii) subject to
compliance with certain confidentiality, non-competition and
non-solicitation covenants contained in his or her employment
agreement and execution of a general release of claims on behalf
of the Company, an amount equal to the product of (x) two
(three in the case of Richard M. Bracken and R. Milton Johnson)
and (y) the sum of (A) the executives base
salary and (B) annual bonus paid or payable in respect of
the fiscal year immediately preceding the fiscal year in which
termination occurs, payable over a two-year period;
(iii) entitled to the pro rata bonus; and
(iv) entitled to continued coverage under our group health
plans during the period over which the cash severance described
in clause (ii) is paid. The executives vested New
Options and 2x Time Options would also remain exercisable until
the first anniversary of the termination of the executives
employment. However, in lieu of receiving the payments and
benefits described in (ii), (iii) and (iv) immediately
above, the executive may instead elect to have his or her
covenants not to compete waived by us. The same severance
applies regardless of whether the termination was in connection
with a change in control of the Company.
Cause is defined as an executives
(i) willful and continued failure to perform his material
duties to the Company which continues beyond 10 business days
after a written demand for substantial performance is delivered;
(ii) willful or intentional engagement in material
misconduct that causes material and demonstrable injury,
monetarily or otherwise, to the Company or the Sponsors;
(iii) conviction of, or a plea of nolo contendere
to, a crime constituting a felony, or a misdemeanor for
which a sentence of more than six months imprisonment is
imposed; or (iv) willful and material breach of his
covenants under the employment agreement which continues beyond
the designated cure period or of the agreements relating to the
new equity. Good Reason is defined as (i) a
reduction in the executives base salary (other than a
general reduction that affects all similarly situated employees
in substantially the same proportions which is implemented by
the Board in good faith after consultation with the chief
executive officer and chief operating officer), a reduction in
the executives annual incentive compensation opportunity,
or the reduction of benefits payable to the executive under the
SERP; (ii) a substantial diminution in the executives
title, duties and responsibilities; or (iii) a transfer of
the executives primary workplace to a location that is
more than 20 miles from his or her current workplace (other
than, in the case of (i) and (ii), any isolated,
insubstantial and inadvertent failure that is not in bad faith
and is cured within 10 business days after the executives
written notice to the Company).
In the event of an executives termination of employment
that is not a qualifying termination or a termination due to
death or disability, he or she will only be entitled to the
accrued rights (as defined above).
Additional information with respect to potential payments to the
named executive officers pursuant to their employment agreements
and the 2006 Plan is contained in Potential
Payments Upon Termination or Change in Control.
130
Mr. Bovenders
Employment Agreement
The Company entered into the Amended Employment Agreement with
Jack O. Bovender, Jr. on October 27, 2008, which
became effective on December 31, 2008. Pursuant to the
terms of the Amended Employment Agreement, Mr. Bovender was
employed by HCA Management Services, L.P., an affiliate of the
Company, and served as executive Chairman of the Company for a
period commencing December 31, 2008 and ending
December 15, 2009 (the Employment Term).
The Amended Employment Agreement provided that Mr. Bovender
receive a base salary (i) at the monthly rate of $135,000
for the first three months of the Employment Term and
(ii) at the monthly rate of $86,957 for the next eight and
one-half months of the Employment Term
(Mr. Bovenders Base Salary).
Mr. Bovender was also entitled to the full amount of any
annual bonus earned, but unpaid, as of the effective date of the
Amended Employment Agreement for the year ended
December 31, 2008 under the Companys
2008-2009
PEP. For calendar year 2009, Mr. Bovender was eligible to
earn a bonus under the
2008-2009
PEP with a target bonus of $500,000.
Mr. Bovender had an additional 2009 bonus opportunity of up
to $250,000 based upon his contributions to certain legislative
initiatives as determined by the Committee
(Mr. Bovenders Additional Bonus).
Pursuant to the terms of the
2008-2009
PEP, the Company exceeded its maximum performance level, as
adjusted, for 2009 with respect to the Companys EBITDA;
therefore, pursuant to the terms of the
2008-2009
PEP, Mr. Bovenders award for the 2009 fiscal year was
paid out at the maximum level of 200% of his target amount.
Mr. Bovender was also awarded, pursuant to his Amended
Employment Agreement, an additional one-time bonus of $250,000
based upon his contributions to certain legislative initiatives
as determined by the Committee. The Amended Employment Agreement
generally provides for the provision of or reimbursement of
expenses associated with office space, shared clerical support
and office equipment until Mr. Bovender reaches age 70.
The terms of Mr. Bovenders employment agreement with
respect to termination of his employment are described in detail
under Compensation Discussion and Analysis
Severance and Change in Control Agreements
Mr. Bovenders Continuing Severance Benefits.
Additional information with respect to payments to
Mr. Bovender pursuant to his Amended Employment Agreement
and the 2006 Plan is contained in Potential
Payments Upon Termination or Change in Control.
Outstanding
Equity Awards at 2009 Fiscal Year-End
The following table includes certain information with respect to
options held by the named executive officers as of
December 31, 2009.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity Incentive
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Plan Awards:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number of
|
|
|
Number of
|
|
|
Number of
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Securities
|
|
|
Securities
|
|
|
Securities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Underlying
|
|
|
Underlying
|
|
|
Underlying
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unexercised
|
|
|
Unexercised
|
|
|
Unexercised
|
|
|
Exercise
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
|
Options
|
|
|
Options
|
|
|
Unearned
|
|
|
Price
|
|
|
Expiration
|
|
Name
|
|
Exercisable(#)(1)(2)(3)
|
|
|
Unexercisable(#)(2)(3)
|
|
|
Options(#)(2)
|
|
|
($)(4)(5)(6)
|
|
|
Date
|
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
8,052
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
3/22/2011
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
26,248
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
7/26/2011
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
29,934
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/24/2012
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
40,490
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2013
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
30,235
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2014
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
10,739
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/27/2015
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
7,095
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/26/2016
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
116,550
|
|
|
|
69,932
|
|
|
|
163,172
|
|
|
$
|
51.00
|
|
|
|
1/30/2017
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
189,444
|
|
|
|
126,298
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
|
10/6/2019
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
6,039
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
3/22/2011
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
9,579
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/24/2012
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
9,254
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2013
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
8,062
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2014
|
|
131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity Incentive
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Plan Awards:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number of
|
|
|
Number of
|
|
|
Number of
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Securities
|
|
|
Securities
|
|
|
Securities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Underlying
|
|
|
Underlying
|
|
|
Underlying
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unexercised
|
|
|
Unexercised
|
|
|
Unexercised
|
|
|
Exercise
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
|
Options
|
|
|
Options
|
|
|
Unearned
|
|
|
Price
|
|
|
Expiration
|
|
Name
|
|
Exercisable(#)(1)(2)(3)
|
|
|
Unexercisable(#)(2)(3)
|
|
|
Options(#)(2)
|
|
|
($)(4)(5)(6)
|
|
|
Date
|
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
26,013
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
7/22/2014
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
6,441
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/27/2015
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
4,301
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/26/2016
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
83,250
|
|
|
|
49,951
|
|
|
|
116,552
|
|
|
$
|
51.00
|
|
|
|
1/30/2017
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
142,080
|
|
|
|
94,722
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
|
10/6/2019
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
6,039
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
3/22/2011
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
9,579
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/24/2012
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
13,882
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2013
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
11,422
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2014
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
4,601
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/27/2015
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
3,559
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/26/2016
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
46,620
|
|
|
|
27,973
|
|
|
|
65,268
|
|
|
$
|
51.00
|
|
|
|
1/30/2017
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
56,238
|
|
|
|
37,495
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
|
10/6/2019
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
6,039
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
3/22/2011
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
13,124
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
7/26/2011
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
19,158
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/24/2012
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
23,137
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2013
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
16,797
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2014
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
6,441
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/27/2015
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
4,301
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/26/2016
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
53,280
|
|
|
|
31,969
|
|
|
|
74,592
|
|
|
$
|
51.00
|
|
|
|
1/30/2017
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
56,238
|
|
|
|
37,495
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
|
10/6/2019
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
8,381
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/24/2012
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
9,254
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2013
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
5,375
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/29/2014
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
2,297
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/27/2015
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
5,395
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
10/1/2015
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
4,301
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
1/26/2016
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
46,620
|
|
|
|
27,973
|
|
|
|
65,268
|
|
|
$
|
51.00
|
|
|
|
1/30/2017
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
56,238
|
|
|
|
37,495
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
|
10/6/2019
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
133,200
|
|
|
|
79,922
|
|
|
|
186,482
|
|
|
$
|
51.00
|
|
|
|
1/30/2017
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
82,881
|
|
|
|
55,256
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
102.00
|
|
|
|
10/6/2019
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Reflects Rollover Options, as further described under
Narrative Disclosure to Summary Compensation
Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table
Options, the 40% of the named executive officers
time vested New Options, comprised of the 20% that vested as of
January 30, 2008 and January 30, 2009, respectively,
the 60% of the named executive officers EBITDA-based
performance vested New Options, comprised of the 20% that vested
as of December 31, 2007, December 31, 2008 and
December 31, 2009, respectively (upon the Committees
determination that the Company achieved the 2007, 2008 and 2009
EBITDA performance targets under the option awards, as adjusted,
as described in more detail under Compensation
Discussion and Analysis Elements of
Compensation Long Term Equity Incentive Awards:
Options) and the 60% of the named executive officers
vested 2x Time Options, comprised of the 40% that were vested on
the grant date and the 20% that vested on November 17, 2009. |
|
(2) |
|
Reflects New Options awarded in January 2007 under the 2006 Plan
by the Compensation Committee as part of the named executive
officers long term equity incentive award. The New Options
granted in 2007 are structured so that
1/3
are time vested options (vesting in five equal installments on
the first five anniversaries of the January 30, 2007 grant
date),
1/3
are EBITDA-based performance vested options (vesting in equal
increments of 20% at the end of fiscal years 2007, 2008, 2009,
2010 and 2011 if certain annual EBITDA performance targets are
achieved, subject to catch up vesting, such that,
options that were |
132
|
|
|
|
|
eligible to vest but failed to vest due to our failure to
achieve prior EBITDA targets will vest if at the end of any
subsequent year or at the end of fiscal year 2012, the
cumulative total EBITDA earned in all prior years exceeds the
cumulative EBITDA target at the end of such fiscal year) and
1/3
are performance options that vest based on investment return to
the Sponsors (vesting with respect to 10% of the common stock
subject to such options at the end of fiscal years 2007, 2008,
2009, 2010 and 2011 if the Investor Return is at least $102.00
and with respect to an additional 10% at the end of fiscal years
2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 and 2011 if the Investor Return is at
least $127.50, subject to catch up vesting if the
relevant Investor Return is achieved at any time occurring prior
to January 30, 2017, so long as the named executive officer
remains employed by the Company). The time vested options are
reflected in the Number of Securities Underlying
Unexercised Options Unexercisable column (with the
exception of the 40% of the time vested options that were vested
as of December 31, 2009, which are reflected in the
Number of Securities Underlying Unexercised Options
Exercisable column), and the EBITDA-based performance
vested options and investment return performance vested options
are both reflected in the Equity Incentive Plan Awards:
Number of Securities Underlying Unexercised Unearned
Options column (with the exception of the 60% of the
EBITDA-based performance vested options that were vested as of
December 31, 2009, which are reflected in the Number
of Securities Underlying Unexercised Options Exercisable
column). The terms of these option awards are described in more
detail under Narrative Disclosure to Summary
Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards
Table Options. |
|
(3) |
|
Reflects 2x Time Options awarded in October 2009 under the 2006
Plan by the Compensation Committee, pursuant to the named
executive officers employment agreement, as part of the
named executive officers long term equity incentive award.
The 2x Time Options are structured, pursuant to the named
executive officers respective employment agreements, so
that 40% were vested on the grant date, an additional 20% vested
on November 17, 2009 and an additional 20% will vest on
November 17, 2010 and November 17, 2011, respectively.
The 60% of the 2x Time Options that were vested as of
December 31, 2009 are reflected in the Number of
Securities Underlying Unexercised Options Exercisable
column, and the 40% of the 2x Time Options that were not vested
as of December 31, 2009 are reflected in the Number
of Securities Underlying Unexercised Options Unexercisable
column. The terms of these option awards are described in more
detail under Narrative Disclosure to Summary
Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards
Table Options. |
|
(4) |
|
Immediately after the consummation of the Recapitalization, all
Rollover Options (other than those with an exercise price below
$12.75) were adjusted such that they retained the same
spread value (as defined below) as immediately prior
to the Recapitalization, but the new per share exercise price
for all Rollover Options would be $12.75. The term spread
value means the difference between (x) the aggregate
fair market value of the common stock (determined using the
Recapitalization consideration of $51.00 per share) subject to
the outstanding options held by the participant immediately
prior to the Recapitalization that became Rollover Options, and
(y) the aggregate exercise price of those options. |
|
(5) |
|
The exercise price for the New Options granted under the 2006
Plan to the named executive officers on January 30, 2007
was equal to the fair value of our common stock on the date of
the grant, as determined by our Board of Directors in
consultation with our Chief Executive Officer and other
advisors, pursuant to the terms of the 2006 Plan. |
|
(6) |
|
The exercise price for the 2x Time Options granted under the
2006 Plan to the named executive officers on October 6,
2009 was $102.00, pursuant to the named executive officers
employment agreements. |
133
Option
Exercises and Stock Vested in 2009
The following table includes certain information with respect to
options exercised by the named executive officers during the
fiscal year ended December 31, 2009.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Option Awards
|
|
|
Number of Shares
|
|
|
|
|
Acquired on
|
|
Value Realized on
|
Name
|
|
Exercise(1)
|
|
Exercise ($)(2)
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
188,340
|
|
|
$
|
21,243,911
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Mr. Bovender elected a cashless exercise of 360,494 stock
options resulting in net shares realized of 188,340. |
|
(2) |
|
Represents the difference between the exercise price of the
options and the fair market value of the common stock on the
date of exercise, as determined by our Board of Directors in
consultation with our Chief Executive Officer and other advisors. |
2009
Pension Benefits
Our SERP is intended to qualify as a top-hat plan
designed to benefit a select group of management or highly
compensated employees. There are no other defined benefit plans
that provide for payments or benefits to any of the named
executive officers. Information about benefits provided by the
SERP is as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number of Years
|
|
Present Value of
|
|
Payments During
|
Name
|
|
Plan Name
|
|
Credited Service
|
|
Accumulated Benefit
|
|
Last Fiscal Year
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
SERP
|
|
|
|
28
|
|
|
$
|
14,303,696
|
|
|
|
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
SERP
|
|
|
|
27
|
|
|
$
|
6,353,324
|
|
|
|
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
SERP
|
|
|
|
26
|
|
|
$
|
8,696,543
|
|
|
|
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
SERP
|
|
|
|
27
|
|
|
$
|
5,330,983
|
|
|
|
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
SERP
|
|
|
|
28
|
|
|
$
|
5,504,026
|
|
|
|
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
SERP
|
|
|
|
29
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
26,300,528
|
|
Mr. Bovender retired in 2009, and he received a SERP
payment in April 2009. Mr. Bracken and Ms. Wallace are
eligible for early retirement. The remaining named executive
officers have not satisfied the eligibility requirements for
normal or early retirement. All of the named executive officers
are 100% vested in their accrued SERP benefit.
Plan
Provisions
In the event the employees accrued benefits under
the Companys Plans (computed using actuarial
factors) are insufficient to provide the life
annuity amount, the SERP will provide a benefit equal to
the amount of the shortfall. Benefits can be paid in the form of
an annuity or a lump sum. The lump sum is calculated by
converting the annuity benefit using the actuarial
factors. All benefits with a present value not exceeding
one million dollars are paid as a lump sum regardless of the
election made.
Normal retirement eligibility requires attainment of age 60
for employees who were participants at the time of the change in
control which occurred as a result of the Recapitalization,
including all of the named executive officers. Early retirement
eligibility requires age 55 with 20 or more years of
service. The service requirement for early retirement is waived
for employees participating in the SERP at the time of its
inception in 2001, including all of the named executive
officers. The life annuity amount payable to a
participant who takes early retirement is reduced by three
percent for each full year or portion thereof that the
participant retires prior to normal retirement age.
The life annuity amount is the annual benefit
payable as a life annuity to a participant upon normal
retirement. It is equal to the participants accrual
rate multiplied by the product of the participants
years of service times the participants
pay average. The SERP benefit for each year equals
the life annuity amount less the annual life annuity amount
produced by the employees accrued benefit under the
Companys Plans.
134
The accrual rate is a percentage assigned to each
participant, and is either 2.2% or 2.4%. All of the named
executive officers are assigned a percentage of 2.4%.
A participant is credited with a year of service for
each calendar year that the participant performs
1,000 hours of service for HCA or one of our subsidiaries,
or for each year the participant is otherwise credited by us,
subject to a maximum credit of 25 years of service.
A participants pay average is an amount equal
to one-fifth of the sum of the compensation during the period of
60 consecutive months for which total compensation is greatest
within the 120 consecutive month period immediately preceding
the participants retirement. For purposes of this
calculation, the participants compensation includes base
compensation, payments under the PEP, and bonuses paid prior to
the establishment of the PEP.
The accrued benefits under the Companys Plans
for an employee equals the sum of the employer-funded benefits
accrued under the former HCA Retirement Plan, the HCA 401(k)
Plan and any other tax-qualified plan maintained by us or one of
our subsidiaries, the income/loss adjusted amount distributed to
the participant under any of these plans, the account credit and
the income/loss adjusted amount distributed to the participant
under the Restoration Plan and any other nonqualified retirement
plans sponsored by us or one of our subsidiaries.
The actuarial factors include (a) interest at
the long term Applicable Federal Rate under Section 1274(d)
of the Code or any successor thereto as of the first day of
November preceding the plan year in or for which a benefit
amount is calculated, and (b) mortality being the
applicable Section 417(e)(3) of the Code mortality table,
as specified and changed by the U.S. Treasury Department.
Credited service does not include any amount other than service
with us or one of our subsidiaries.
Assumptions
The Present Value of Accumulated Benefit is based on a
measurement date of December 31, 2009.
The assumption is made that there is no probability of
pre-retirement death or termination. Retirement age is assumed
to be the Normal Retirement Age as defined in the SERP for all
named executive officers, as adjusted by the provisions relating
to change in control, or age 60. Age 60 also
represents the earliest date the named executive officers are
eligible to receive an unreduced benefit.
All other assumptions used in the calculations are the same as
those used for the valuation of the plan liabilities in this
prospectus.
Supplemental
Information
In the event a participant renders service to another health
care organization within five years following retirement or
termination of employment, he or she forfeits his rights to any
further payment, and must repay any benefits already paid. This
non-competition provision is subject to waiver by the Committee
with respect to the named executive officers.
135
2009
Nonqualified Deferred Compensation
Amounts shown in the table are attributable to the HCA
Restoration Plan, an unfunded, nonqualified defined contribution
plan designed to restore benefits under the HCA 401(k) Plan
based on compensation in excess of the Code
Section 401(a)(17) compensation limit ($245,000 in 2009).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Executive
|
|
|
Registrant
|
|
|
Aggregate
|
|
|
|
|
|
Aggregate
|
|
|
|
Contributions
|
|
|
Contributions
|
|
|
Earnings
|
|
|
Aggregate
|
|
|
Balance
|
|
|
|
in Last
|
|
|
in Last
|
|
|
in Last
|
|
|
Withdrawals/
|
|
|
at Last
|
|
Name
|
|
Fiscal Year
|
|
|
Fiscal Year
|
|
|
Fiscal Year
|
|
|
Distributions
|
|
|
Fiscal Year End
|
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
267,148
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,418,398
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
109,549
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
581,639
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
90,252
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
479,186
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
146,239
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
776,440
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
80,356
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
426,642
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
498,306
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,692,051
|
|
The following amounts from the column titled Aggregate
Balance at Last Fiscal Year have been reported in the
Summary Compensation Tables in prior years:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Restoration Contribution
|
|
Name
|
|
2001
|
|
|
2002
|
|
|
2003
|
|
|
2004
|
|
|
2005
|
|
|
2006
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
$
|
87,924
|
|
|
$
|
146,549
|
|
|
$
|
162,344
|
|
|
$
|
192,858
|
|
|
$
|
172,571
|
|
|
$
|
409,933
|
|
|
$
|
91,946
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
71,441
|
|
|
$
|
212,109
|
|
|
$
|
57,792
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
52,250
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
79,510
|
|
|
$
|
101,488
|
|
|
$
|
97,331
|
|
|
$
|
247,060
|
|
|
$
|
62,004
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
$
|
187,193
|
|
|
$
|
268,523
|
|
|
$
|
289,899
|
|
|
$
|
363,481
|
|
|
$
|
295,062
|
|
|
$
|
856,424
|
|
|
$
|
153,475
|
|
Plan
Provisions
Until 2008, hypothetical accounts for each participant were
credited each year with a contribution designed to restore the
HCA Retirement Plan based on compensation in excess of the Code
Section 401(a)(17) compensation limit ($245,000 in 2009),
based on years of service. Effective January 1, 2008,
participants in the SERP are no longer eligible for Restoration
Plan contributions. However, the hypothetical accounts as of
January 1, 2008 will continue to be maintained and will be
increased or decreased with hypothetical investment returns
based on the actual investment return of the Mix B fund of the
HCA 401(k) Plan.
No employee deferrals are allowed under this or any other
nonqualified deferred compensation plan.
Prior to January 1, 2010, eligible employees make a one
time election prior to participation (or prior to
December 31, 2006, if earlier) regarding the form of
distribution of the benefit. Participants chose between a lump
sum and five or ten-year installments. Effective January 1,
2010, all distributions are paid in the form of a lump-sum
distribution unless the participant had submitted an installment
payment election prior to April 30, 2009. Distributions are
paid (or begin) during the July following the year of
termination of employment or retirement. All balances not
exceeding $500,000 are automatically paid as a lump sum.
Supplemental
Information
In the event a participant renders service to another health
care organization within five years following retirement or
termination of employment, he or she forfeits the rights to any
further payment, and must repay any payments already made. This
non-competition provision is subject to waiver by the Committee
with respect to the named executive officers.
136
Potential
Payments Upon Termination or Change in Control
The following tables show the estimated amount of potential cash
severance payable to each of the named executive officers
(except for Mr. Bovender) (based upon his or her 2009 base
salary and PEP payment received in 2009 for 2008 performance),
as well as the estimated value of continuing benefits, based on
compensation and benefit levels in effect on December 31,
2009, assuming the executives employment terminates or the
Company undergoes a Change in Control (as defined in the 2006
Plan and set forth above under Narrative Disclosure
to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based
Awards Table Options) effective
December 31, 2009. Due to the numerous factors involved in
estimating these amounts, the actual value of benefits and
amounts to be paid can only be determined upon an
executives termination of employment. Mr. Bovender
retired from the Company on December 15, 2009, and the
Normal Retirement column of the table relating to
Mr. Bovender shows the estimated value of continuing
benefits, as well as, where noted, actual amounts paid to
Mr. Bovender under his Amended Employment Agreement in
connection with his retirement. As noted above, in the event a
named executive officer breaches or violates those certain
confidentiality, non-competition
and/or
non-solicitation covenants contained in his or her employment
agreement, the SERP or the HCA Restoration Plan, certain of the
payments described below may be subject to forfeiture
and/or
repayment. See Narrative Disclosure to Summary
Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards
Table Executive Employment Agreements,
2009 Pension Benefits Supplemental
Information, and 2009 Nonqualified Deferred
Compensation Supplemental Information.
Richard
M. Bracken
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Involuntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
Early
|
|
|
Normal
|
|
|
Without
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
for Good
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Cause
|
|
|
for Cause
|
|
|
Reason
|
|
|
Disability
|
|
|
Death
|
|
|
Control
|
|
|
Cash Severance(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
6,058,110
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
6,058,110
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-Equity Incentive Bonus(2)
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
|
$
|
3,445,000
|
|
Unvested Stock Options(3)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
8,622,517
|
|
SERP(4)
|
|
$
|
15,493,294
|
|
|
$
|
15,493,294
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
15,493,294
|
|
|
$
|
15,493,294
|
|
|
$
|
15,493,294
|
|
|
$
|
15,493,294
|
|
|
$
|
13,722,318
|
|
|
|
|
|
Retirement Plans(5)
|
|
$
|
2,522,553
|
|
|
$
|
2,522,553
|
|
|
$
|
2,522,553
|
|
|
$
|
2,522,553
|
|
|
$
|
2,522,553
|
|
|
$
|
2,522,553
|
|
|
$
|
2,522,553
|
|
|
$
|
2,522,553
|
|
|
|
|
|
Health and Welfare Benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Disability Income(6)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,819,299
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Life Insurance Benefits(7)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,401,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accrued Vacation Pay
|
|
$
|
183,462
|
|
|
$
|
183,462
|
|
|
$
|
183,462
|
|
|
$
|
183,462
|
|
|
$
|
183,462
|
|
|
$
|
183,462
|
|
|
$
|
183,462
|
|
|
$
|
183,462
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
$
|
21,644,309
|
|
|
$
|
21,644,309
|
|
|
$
|
6,151,015
|
|
|
$
|
27,702,419
|
|
|
$
|
18,199,309
|
|
|
$
|
27,702,419
|
|
|
$
|
23,463,608
|
|
|
$
|
21,274,333
|
|
|
$
|
12,067,517
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Represents amounts Mr. Bracken would be entitled to receive
pursuant to his employment agreement. See Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table Executive Employment
Agreements. |
|
(2) |
|
Represents the amount Mr. Bracken would be entitled to
receive for the 2009 fiscal year pursuant to the
2008-2009
PEP and his employment agreement, which amount is also included
in the Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation column
of the Summary Compensation Table. See Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table Executive Employment
Agreements. |
|
(3) |
|
Represents the intrinsic value of all unvested stock options,
which will become vested upon the Change in Control, calculated
as the difference between the exercise price of
Mr. Brackens unvested New Options and the fair value
price of our common stock on December 31, 2009 as
determined by our Board of Directors in consultation with our
Chief Executive Officer and other advisors for internal purposes
($87.99 per share). For the purposes of this calculation, it is
assumed that the Company achieved an Investor Return of at least
2.5 times the Base Price of $51.00 at the end of the 2009 fiscal
year. The $102.00 per share exercise price of 2x Time Options
was greater than the December 31, 2009 fair value price;
therefore, this value does not include Mr. Brackens
unvested 2x Time Options. |
|
(4) |
|
Reflects the actual lump sum value of the SERP based on the 2009
interest rate of 4.24%. |
137
|
|
|
(5) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of qualified and
nonqualified retirement plans to which Mr. Bracken would be
entitled. The value includes $1,104,155 from the HCA 401(k) Plan
(which represents the value of the Companys contributions)
and $1,418,398 from the HCA Restoration Plan. |
|
(6) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of all future
payments which Mr. Bracken would be entitled to receive
under our disability program, including five months of salary
continuation, monthly long term disability benefits of $10,000
per month payable after the five-month elimination period until
age 66, and monthly benefits of $10,000 per month from our
Supplemental Insurance Program payable after the six-month
elimination period to age 65. |
|
(7) |
|
No post-retirement or post-termination life insurance or death
benefits are provided to Mr. Bracken.
Mr. Brackens payment upon death while actively
employed includes $1,326,000 of Company-paid life insurance and
$75,000 from the Executive Death Benefit Plan. |
R. Milton
Johnson
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Involuntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
Early
|
|
|
Normal
|
|
|
Without
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
for Good
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Cause
|
|
|
for Cause
|
|
|
Reason
|
|
|
Disability
|
|
|
Death
|
|
|
Control
|
|
|
Cash Severance(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
3,616,473
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
3,616,473
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-Equity Incentive Bonus(2)
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
|
$
|
1,360,000
|
|
Unvested Stock Options(3)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
6,158,946
|
|
SERP(4)
|
|
$
|
7,685,014
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
7,685,014
|
|
|
$
|
7,685,014
|
|
|
$
|
7,685,014
|
|
|
$
|
7,685,014
|
|
|
$
|
7,162,791
|
|
|
|
|
|
Retirement Plans(5)
|
|
$
|
1,520,116
|
|
|
$
|
1,520,116
|
|
|
$
|
1,520,116
|
|
|
$
|
1,520,116
|
|
|
$
|
1,520,116
|
|
|
$
|
1,520,116
|
|
|
$
|
1,520,116
|
|
|
$
|
1,520,116
|
|
|
|
|
|
Health and Welfare Benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Disability Income(6)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,077,246
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Life Insurance Benefits(7)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
851,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accrued Vacation Pay
|
|
$
|
117,692
|
|
|
$
|
117,692
|
|
|
$
|
117,692
|
|
|
$
|
117,692
|
|
|
$
|
117,692
|
|
|
$
|
117,692
|
|
|
$
|
117,692
|
|
|
$
|
117,692
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
$
|
10,682,822
|
|
|
$
|
2,997,808
|
|
|
$
|
2,997,808
|
|
|
$
|
14,299,295
|
|
|
$
|
9,322,822
|
|
|
$
|
14,299,295
|
|
|
$
|
12,760,068
|
|
|
$
|
11,011,599
|
|
|
$
|
7,518,946
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Represents amounts Mr. Johnson would be entitled to receive
pursuant to his employment agreement. See Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table Executive Employment
Agreements. |
|
(2) |
|
Represents the amount Mr. Johnson would be entitled to
receive for the 2009 fiscal year pursuant to the
2008-2009
PEP and his employment agreement, which amount is also included
in the Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation column
of the Summary Compensation Table. See Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table Executive Employment
Agreements. |
|
(3) |
|
Represents the intrinsic value of all unvested stock options,
which will become vested upon the Change in Control, calculated
as the difference between the exercise price of
Mr. Johnsons unvested New Options and the fair value
price of our common stock on December 31, 2009 as
determined by our Board of Directors in consultation with our
Chief Executive Officer and other advisors for internal purposes
($87.99 per share). For the purposes of this calculation,
it is assumed that the Company achieved an Investor Return of at
least 2.5 times the Base Price of $51.00 at the end of the 2009
fiscal year. The $102.00 per share exercise price of 2x Time
Options was greater than the December 31, 2009 fair value
price; therefore, this value does not include
Mr. Johnsons unvested 2x Time Options. |
|
(4) |
|
Reflects the actual lump sum value of the SERP based on the 2009
interest rate of 4.24%. |
|
(5) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of qualified and
nonqualified retirement plans to which Mr. Johnson would be
entitled. The value includes $938,477 from the HCA 401(k) Plan
(which represents the value of the Companys contributions)
and $581,639 from the HCA Restoration Plan. |
|
(6) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of all future
payments which Mr. Johnson would be entitled to receive
under our disability program, including five months of salary
continuation, monthly long term disability benefits of $10,000
per month payable after the five-month elimination period until
age 66 and 4 months, and monthly benefits of $10,000
per month from our Supplemental Insurance Program payable after
the six-month elimination period to age 65. |
138
|
|
|
(7) |
|
No post-retirement or post-termination life insurance or death
benefits are provided to Mr. Johnson.
Mr. Johnsons payment upon death while actively
employed with the Company includes $851,000 of Company-paid life
insurance. |
Beverly
B. Wallace
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Involuntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
Early
|
|
|
Normal
|
|
|
Without
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
for Good
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Cause
|
|
|
for Cause
|
|
|
Reason
|
|
|
Disability
|
|
|
Death
|
|
|
Control
|
|
|
Cash Severance(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,030,010
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,030,010
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-Equity Incentive Bonus(2)
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
|
$
|
924,018
|
|
Unvested Stock Options(3)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
3,448,985
|
|
SERP(4)
|
|
$
|
8,658,884
|
|
|
$
|
8,658,884
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
8,658,884
|
|
|
$
|
8,658,884
|
|
|
$
|
8,658,884
|
|
|
$
|
8,658,884
|
|
|
$
|
7,794,032
|
|
|
|
|
|
Retirement Plans(5)
|
|
$
|
938,279
|
|
|
$
|
938,279
|
|
|
$
|
938,279
|
|
|
$
|
938,279
|
|
|
$
|
938,279
|
|
|
$
|
938,279
|
|
|
$
|
938,279
|
|
|
$
|
938,279
|
|
|
|
|
|
Health and Welfare Benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Disability Income(6)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,354,785
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Life Insurance Benefits(7)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
701,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accrued Vacation Pay
|
|
$
|
96,925
|
|
|
$
|
96,925
|
|
|
$
|
96,925
|
|
|
$
|
96,925
|
|
|
$
|
96,925
|
|
|
$
|
96,925
|
|
|
$
|
96,925
|
|
|
$
|
96,925
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
$
|
10,618,106
|
|
|
$
|
10,618,106
|
|
|
$
|
1,959,222
|
|
|
$
|
12,648,116
|
|
|
$
|
9,694,088
|
|
|
$
|
12,648,116
|
|
|
$
|
11,972,891
|
|
|
$
|
10,454,254
|
|
|
$
|
4,373,003
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Represents amounts Ms. Wallace would be entitled to receive
pursuant to her employment agreement. See Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table Executive Employment
Agreements. |
|
(2) |
|
Represents the amount Ms. Wallace would be entitled to
receive for the 2009 fiscal year pursuant to the
2008-2009
PEP and her employment agreement, which amount is also included
in the Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation column
of the Summary Compensation Table. See Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table Executive Employment
Agreements. |
|
(3) |
|
Represents the intrinsic value of all unvested stock options,
which will become vested upon the Change in Control, calculated
as the difference between the exercise price of
Ms. Wallaces unvested New Options and the fair value
price of our common stock on December 31, 2009 as
determined by our Board of Directors in consultation with our
Chief Executive Officer and other advisors for internal purposes
($87.99 per share). For the purposes of this calculation, it is
assumed that the Company achieved an Investor Return of at least
2.5 times the Base Price of $51.00 at the end of the 2009 fiscal
year. The $102.00 per share exercise price of 2x Time Options
was greater than the December 31, 2009 fair value price;
therefore, this value does not include Ms. Wallaces
unvested 2x Time Options. |
|
(4) |
|
Reflects the actual lump sum value of the SERP based on the 2009
interest rate of 4.24%. |
|
(5) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of qualified and
nonqualified retirement plans to which Ms. Wallace would be
entitled. The value includes $459,093 from the HCA 401(k) Plan
(which represents the value of the Companys contributions)
and $479,186 from the HCA Restoration Plan. |
|
(6) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of all future
payments which Ms. Wallace would be entitled to receive
under our disability program, including five months of salary
continuation, monthly long term disability benefits of $10,000
per month payable after the five-month elimination period until
age 66, and monthly benefits of $10,000 per month from our
Supplemental Insurance Program payable after the six-month
elimination period to age 65. |
|
(7) |
|
No post-retirement or post-termination life insurance or death
benefits are provided to Ms. Wallace.
Ms. Wallaces payment upon death while actively
employed includes $701,000 of Company-paid life insurance. |
139
Samuel
N. Hazen
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Involuntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
Early
|
|
|
Normal
|
|
|
Without
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
for Good
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Cause
|
|
|
for Cause
|
|
|
Reason
|
|
|
Disability
|
|
|
Death
|
|
|
Control
|
|
|
Cash Severance(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,278,988
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,278,988
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-Equity Incentive Bonus(2)
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
|
$
|
1,041,067
|
|
Unvested Stock Options(3)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
3,941,691
|
|
SERP(4)
|
|
$
|
6,464,523
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
6,464,523
|
|
|
$
|
6,464,523
|
|
|
$
|
6,464,523
|
|
|
$
|
6,464,523
|
|
|
$
|
6,307,519
|
|
|
|
|
|
Retirement Plans(5)
|
|
$
|
1,316,591
|
|
|
$
|
1,316,591
|
|
|
$
|
1,316,591
|
|
|
$
|
1,316,591
|
|
|
$
|
1,316,591
|
|
|
$
|
1,316,591
|
|
|
$
|
1,316,591
|
|
|
$
|
1,316,591
|
|
|
|
|
|
Health and Welfare Benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Disability Income(6)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,362,646
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Life Insurance Benefits(7)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
789,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accrued Vacation Pay
|
|
$
|
109,203
|
|
|
$
|
109,203
|
|
|
$
|
109,203
|
|
|
$
|
109,203
|
|
|
$
|
109,203
|
|
|
$
|
109,203
|
|
|
$
|
109,203
|
|
|
$
|
109,203
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
$
|
8,931,384
|
|
|
$
|
2,466,861
|
|
|
$
|
2,466,861
|
|
|
$
|
11,210,372
|
|
|
$
|
7,890,317
|
|
|
$
|
11,210,372
|
|
|
$
|
11,294,030
|
|
|
$
|
9,563,380
|
|
|
$
|
4,982,758
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Represents amounts Mr. Hazen would be entitled to receive
pursuant to his employment agreement. See Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table Executive Employment
Agreements. |
|
(2) |
|
Represents the amount Mr. Hazen would be entitled to
receive for the 2009 fiscal year pursuant to the
2008-2009
PEP and his employment agreement, which amount is also included
in the Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation column
of the Summary Compensation Table. See Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table Executive Employment
Agreements. |
|
(3) |
|
Represents the intrinsic value of all unvested stock options,
which will become vested upon the Change in Control, calculated
as the difference between the exercise price of
Mr. Hazens unvested New Options and the fair value
price of our common stock on December 31, 2009 as
determined by our Board of Directors in consultation with our
Chief Executive Officer and other advisors for internal purposes
($87.99 per share). For the purposes of this calculation, it is
assumed that the Company achieved an Investor Return of at least
2.5 times the Base Price of $51.00 at the end of the 2009 fiscal
year. The $102.00 per share exercise price of 2x Time Options
was greater than the December 31, 2009 fair value price;
therefore, this value does not include Mr. Hazens
unvested 2x Time Options. |
|
(4) |
|
Reflects the actual lump sum value of the SERP based on the 2009
interest rate of 4.24%. |
|
(5) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of qualified and
nonqualified retirement plans to which Mr. Hazen would be
entitled. The value includes $540,152 from the HCA 401(k) Plan
(which represents the value of the Companys contributions)
and $776,440 from the HCA Restoration Plan. |
|
(6) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of all future
payments which Mr. Hazen would be entitled to receive under
our disability program, including five months of salary
continuation, monthly long term disability benefits of $10,000
per month payable after the five-month elimination period until
age 67, and monthly benefits of $10,000 per month from our
Supplemental Insurance Program payable after the
six-month
elimination period to age 65. |
|
(7) |
|
No post-retirement or post-termination life insurance or death
benefits are provided to Mr. Hazen. Mr. Hazens
payment upon death while actively employed with the Company
includes $789,000 of
Company-paid
life insurance. |
140
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Involuntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Voluntary
|
|
|
Early
|
|
|
Normal
|
|
|
Without
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
for Good
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in
|
|
|
|
Termination
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Cause
|
|
|
for Cause
|
|
|
Reason
|
|
|
Disability
|
|
|
Death
|
|
|
Control
|
|
|
Cash Severance(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,653,768
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,653,768
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-Equity Incentive Bonus(2)
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
|
$
|
891,017
|
|
Unvested Stock Options(3)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
3,448,985
|
|
SERP(4)
|
|
$
|
6,633,387
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
6,633,387
|
|
|
$
|
6,633,387
|
|
|
$
|
6,633,387
|
|
|
$
|
6,633,387
|
|
|
$
|
6,046,496
|
|
|
|
|
|
Retirement Plans(5)
|
|
$
|
1,102,803
|
|
|
$
|
1,102,803
|
|
|
$
|
1,102,803
|
|
|
$
|
1,102,803
|
|
|
$
|
1,102,803
|
|
|
$
|
1,102,803
|
|
|
$
|
1,102,803
|
|
|
$
|
1,102,803
|
|
|
|
|
|
Health and Welfare Benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Disability Income(6)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,816,956
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Life Insurance Benefits(7)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
751,000
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accrued Vacation Pay
|
|
$
|
93,463
|
|
|
$
|
93,463
|
|
|
$
|
93,463
|
|
|
$
|
93,463
|
|
|
$
|
93,463
|
|
|
$
|
93,463
|
|
|
$
|
93,463
|
|
|
$
|
93,463
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
$
|
8,720,670
|
|
|
$
|
2,087,283
|
|
|
$
|
2,087,283
|
|
|
$
|
10,374,438
|
|
|
$
|
7,829,653
|
|
|
$
|
10,374,438
|
|
|
$
|
10,537,626
|
|
|
$
|
8,884,779
|
|
|
$
|
4,340,002
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Represents amounts Mr. Rutledge would be entitled to
receive pursuant to his employment agreement. See
Narrative Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009
Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table Executive
Employment Agreements. |
|
(2) |
|
Represents the amount Mr. Rutledge would be entitled to
receive for the 2009 fiscal year pursuant to the
2008-2009
PEP and his employment agreement, which amount is also included
in the Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation column
of the Summary Compensation Table. See Narrative
Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of
Plan-Based Awards Table Executive Employment
Agreements. |
|
(3) |
|
Represents the intrinsic value of all unvested stock options,
which will become vested upon the Change in Control, calculated
as the difference between the exercise price of
Mr. Rutledges unvested New Options and the fair value
price of our common stock on December 31, 2009 as
determined by our Board of Directors in consultation with our
Chief Executive Officer and other advisors for internal purposes
($87.99 per share). For the purposes of this calculation,
it is assumed that the Company achieved an Investor Return of at
least 2.5 times the Base Price of $51.00 at the end of the 2009
fiscal year. The $102.00 per share exercise price of 2x Time
Options was greater than the December 31, 2009 fair value
price; therefore, this value does not include
Mr. Rutledges unvested 2x Time Options. |
|
(4) |
|
Reflects the actual lump sum value of the SERP based on the 2009
interest rate of 4.24%. |
|
(5) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of qualified and
nonqualified retirement plans to which Mr. Rutledge would
be entitled. The value includes $676,161 from the HCA 401(k)
Plan (which represents the value of the Companys
contributions) and $426,642 from the HCA Restoration Plan. |
|
(6) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump sum present value of all future
payments which Mr. Rutledge would be entitled to receive
under our disability program, including five months of salary
continuation, monthly long term disability benefits of $10,000
per month payable after the five-month elimination period until
age 66 and 2 months, and monthly benefits of $10,000
per month from our Supplemental Insurance Program payable after
the six-month elimination period to age 65. |
|
(7) |
|
No post-retirement or post-termination life insurance or death
benefits are provided to Mr. Rutledge.
Mr. Rutledges payment upon death while actively
employed includes $676,000 of Company-paid life insurance and
$75,000 from the Executive Death Benefit Plan. |
141
Jack
O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Normal
|
|
|
Change in
|
|
|
|
Retirement
|
|
|
Control
|
|
|
Cash Severance
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Non-Equity Incentive Bonus(1)
|
|
$
|
1,250,000
|
|
|
$
|
1,250,000
|
|
Unvested Stock Options(2)
|
|
$
|
9,854,284
|
|
|
$
|
9,854,284
|
|
SERP(3)
|
|
$
|
26,300,528
|
|
|
|
|
|
Retirement Plans(4)
|
|
$
|
2,884,177
|
|
|
|
|
|
Health and Welfare Benefits(5)
|
|
$
|
6,234
|
|
|
|
|
|
Disability Income
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Life Insurance Benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accrued Vacation Pay(6)
|
|
$
|
144,485
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
$
|
40,439,708
|
|
|
$
|
11,104,284
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1) |
|
Represents the amount Mr. Bovender received for the 2009
fiscal year pursuant to the
2008-2009
PEP and his Amended Employment Agreement, which amount is also
included in the Non-Equity Incentive Plan
Compensation column of the Summary Compensation Table. See
Narrative Disclosure to Summary Compensation Table
and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table
Mr. Bovenders Employment Agreement. |
|
(2) |
|
For the purposes of the Normal Retirement column,
represents the intrinsic value of all unvested stock options,
which, pursuant to Mr. Bovenders Amended Employment
Agreement, will continue to vest after his retirement,
calculated as the difference between the exercise price of
Mr. Bovenders unvested New Options and 2x Time
Options subject to such continued vesting provision and the fair
value price of our common stock on December 15, 2009 as
determined by our Board of Directors in consultation with our
Chief Executive Officer and other advisors for internal purposes
($87.99 per share). For the purposes of this calculation, it is
assumed that the 2010 and 2011 EBITDA performance targets under
the option awards are achieved by the Company and that the
Company achieves an Investor Return of at least 2.5 times the
Base Price of $51.00 at the end of each of the 2010 and 2011
fiscal years, respectively. The $102.00 per share exercise price
of 2x Time Options was greater than the December 15, 2009
fair value price; therefore, this value does not include
Mr. Bovenders unvested 2x Time Options. See
Compensation Discussion and Analysis
Severance and Change in Control Agreements. |
|
|
|
For purposes of the Change in Control column,
represents the intrinsic value of all unvested stock options,
which will become vested upon the Change in Control, calculated
as the difference between the exercise price of
Mr. Bovenders unvested New Options and the fair value
price of our common stock on December 31, 2009 as
determined by our Board of Directors in consultation with our
Chief Executive Officer and other advisors for internal purposes
($87.99 per share). For the purposes of this calculation, it is
assumed that the Company achieved an Investor Return of at least
2.5 times the Base Price of $51.00 at the end of the 2009 fiscal
year. The $102.00 per share exercise price of 2x Time Options
was greater than the December 31, 2009 fair value price;
therefore, this value does not include Mr. Bovenders
unvested 2x Time Options. |
|
(3) |
|
Reflects the actual SERP lump sum paid in April 2009. |
|
(4) |
|
Reflects the estimated lump-sum present value of qualified and
nonqualified retirement plans to which Mr. Bovender is
entitled as of his retirement date of December 15, 2009.
The value includes $192,126 from the HCA 401(k) Plan (which
represents the value of the Companys contributions) and
$2,692,051 from the HCA Restoration Plan. |
|
(5) |
|
Reflects the present value of the medical premiums for
Mr. Bovender from termination to age 65 as required
pursuant to Mr. Bovenders Amended Employment
Agreement. See Narrative Disclosure to Summary
Compensation Table and 2009 Grants of Plan-Based Awards
Table Mr. Bovenders Employment
Agreement. |
142
|
|
|
(6) |
|
Reflects the actual accrued vacation pay received by
Mr. Bovender in December 2009, which amount is also
included in the Salary column of the Summary
Compensation Table. |
Director
Compensation
During the year ended December 31, 2009, none of our
directors received compensation for their service as a member of
our Board. Our directors are reimbursed for any expenses
incurred in connection with their service. Upon completion of
this offering and listing on the NYSE, we intend to establish a
policy for non-management director compensation consistent with
our status as a public company.
Compensation
Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation
During 2009, the Compensation Committee of the Board of
Directors was composed of John P. Connaughton, George A. Bitar
and Michael W. Michelson. Effective April 22, 2009,
Mr. Bitar retired from our Board of Directors, and James D.
Forbes joined our Board of Directors and was appointed as a
member of the Compensation Committee. None of the members of the
Compensation Committee have at any time been an officer or
employee of HCA or any of its subsidiaries. In addition, none of
our executive officers serves as a member of the Board of
Directors or Compensation Committee of any entity which has one
or more executive officers serving as a member of our Board of
Directors or Compensation Committee. Each member of the
Compensation Committee is also a manager of Hercules Holding,
and the Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement
of Hercules Holding requires that the members of Hercules
Holding take all necessary action to ensure that the persons who
serve as managers of Hercules Holding also serve on our Board of
Directors. Messrs. Michelson, Forbes and Connaughton are
affiliated with KKR, BAML Capital Partners (the private
equity division of Bank of America Corporation) and Bain Capital
Partners, LLC respectively, each of which is a party to the
sponsor management agreement with us. Mr. Bitar was
formerly associated with Merrill Lynch Global Private Equity.
The Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of
Hercules Holding, the sponsor management agreement and certain
transactions with affiliates of BAML Capital Partners and
KKR are described in greater detail in Certain
Relationships and Related Party Transactions.
143
PRINCIPAL
AND SELLING STOCKHOLDERS
The following table shows the amount of our common stock
beneficially owned as of April 1, 2010, and as adjusted to
reflect
the shares
of our common stock offered hereby, by those who were known by
us to beneficially own more than 5% of our common stock, by each
selling stockholder, by our directors and named executive
officers individually and by our directors and all of our
executive officers as a group.
The percentages of shares outstanding provided in the tables are
based on 94,626,087 shares of our common stock, par value
$0.01 per share, outstanding as of April 1, 2010.
Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules
of the SEC and generally includes voting or investment power
with respect to securities. Shares issuable upon the exercise of
options that are exercisable within 60 days of
April 1, 2010 are considered outstanding for the purpose of
calculating the percentage of outstanding shares of our common
stock held by the individual, but not for the purpose of
calculating the percentage of outstanding shares held by any
other individual. The address of each of our directors and
executive officers listed below is
c/o HCA
Inc., One Park Plaza, Nashville, Tennessee 37203.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Percentage
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shares of Common
|
|
|
of Common
|
|
|
Percentage of
|
|
|
|
Shares of
|
|
|
Shares of
|
|
|
Shares of
|
|
|
Stock Beneficially
|
|
|
Stock
|
|
|
Common Stock
|
|
|
|
Common Stock
|
|
|
Common
|
|
|
Common
|
|
|
Owned After this
|
|
|
Beneficially
|
|
|
Beneficially Owned
|
|
|
|
Beneficially
|
|
|
Stock
|
|
|
Stock
|
|
|
Offering
|
|
|
Owned
|
|
|
After this Offering
|
|
|
|
Owned Prior to
|
|
|
Being
|
|
|
Subject to
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
Without
|
|
|
Prior to this
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
Without
|
|
Name of Beneficial Owner
|
|
this Offering
|
|
|
Offered
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
Offering
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
Option
|
|
|
5% Stockholders and other Selling Stockholders:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Hercules Holding II, LLC
|
|
|
91,845,692
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
97.1
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Directors and Named Executive Officers:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Christopher J. Birosak
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Jack O. Bovender, Jr.
|
|
|
552,843
|
(2)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Richard M. Bracken
|
|
|
563,580
|
(3)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
John P. Connaughton
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
James D. Forbes
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Kenneth W. Freeman
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Thomas F. Frist III
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
William R. Frist
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Christopher R. Gordon
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Samuel N. Hazen
|
|
|
243,143
|
(4)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
354,442
|
(5)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Michael W. Michelson
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
James C. Momtazee
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stephen G. Pagliuca
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
W. Paul Rutledge
|
|
|
179,935
|
(6)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Nathan C. Thorne
|
|
|
|
(1)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Beverly B. Wallace
|
|
|
163,664
|
(7)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Directors and all executive officers as a group (28 persons)
|
|
|
2,441,244
|
(8)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2.5
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* |
|
Less than 1%. |
|
(1) |
|
Hercules Holding holds 91,845,692 shares, or 97.1%, of our
outstanding common stock. Hercules Holding is held by a private
investor group, including affiliates of or funds sponsored by
Bain Capital Partners, LLC (Bain Capital), Kohlberg
Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P. (KKR) and BAML
Capital Partners (BAMLCP, the private equity arm of
Bank of America Corporation and successor organization to
Merrill Lynch Global Private Equity), and affiliates of HCA
founder Dr. Thomas F. Frist, Jr., including Mr. Thomas
F. Frist III and Mr. William R. Frist, who serve as
directors. Messrs. Connaughton, Gordon |
144
|
|
|
|
|
and Pagliuca are affiliated with Bain Capital, whose related
funds may be deemed to have indirect beneficial ownership of
23,373,333 shares, or 24.7%, of our outstanding common
stock through their interests in Hercules Holding.
Messrs. Michelson, Momtazee and Freeman are affiliated with
KKR, which indirectly holds 23,373,332 shares, or 24.7%, of
our outstanding common stock through the interests of certain of
its affiliated funds in Hercules Holding. Messrs. Birosak,
Forbes and Thorne are affiliated with BAML Capital Partners, the
private equity division of Bank of America Corporation, which
indirectly holds 24,353,726 shares, or 25.7%, of our
outstanding common stock through the interests of certain of its
affiliated funds in Hercules Holding. Thomas F. Frist III
and William R. Frist may each be deemed to indirectly
beneficially hold 17,804,125 shares, or 18.8%, of our
outstanding common stock through their interests in Hercules
Holding. Each of such persons, other than Hercules Holding,
disclaims membership in any such group and disclaims beneficial
ownership of these securities, except to the extent of its
pecuniary interest therein. The principal office addresses of
Hercules Holding are
c/o Bain
Capital Investors, LLC, 111 Huntington Avenue, Boston, MA 02199;
c/o Kohlberg
Kravis Roberts & Co., 2800 Sand Hill Road, Suite 200,
Menlo Park, CA 94025;
c/o BAML
Capital Partners, Four World Financial Center, Floor 23, New
York, NY 10080; and
c/o Dr. Thomas
F. Frist, Jr., 3100 West End Ave., Suite 500,
Nashville, TN 37203. |
|
(2) |
|
Includes 242,721 shares issuable upon exercise of options.
Effective December 15, 2009, Mr. Bovender retired as
executive Chairman of the Board. |
|
(3) |
|
Includes 482,097 shares issuable upon exercise of options. |
|
(4) |
|
Includes 209,171 shares issuable upon exercise of options. |
|
(5) |
|
Includes 311,669 shares issuable upon exercise of options. |
|
(6) |
|
Includes 147,185 shares issuable upon exercise of options. |
|
(7) |
|
Includes 161,264 shares issuable upon exercise of options. |
|
(8) |
|
Includes 2,013,633 shares issuable upon exercise of
options. Does not include shares beneficially owned by
Mr. Bovender, who retired as executive Chairman of the
Board effective December 15, 2009. |
145
CERTAIN
RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
In accordance with its charter, our Audit and Compliance
Committee reviews and approves all material related party
transactions. Prior to its approval of any material related
party transaction, the Audit and Compliance Committee will
discuss the proposed transaction with management and our
independent auditor. In addition, our Code of Conduct requires
that all of our employees, including our executive officers,
remain free of conflicts of interest in the performance of their
responsibilities to the Company. An executive officer who wishes
to enter into a transaction in which their interests might
conflict with ours must first receive the approval of the Audit
and Compliance Committee. The Amended and Restated Limited
Liability Company Agreement of Hercules Holding generally
requires that an Investor must obtain the prior written consent
of each other Investor (other than the Sponsor Assignees) before
it or any of its affiliates (including our directors) enter into
any transaction with us.
Stockholder
Agreements
On January 30, 2007, our Board of Directors awarded to
members of management and certain key employees New Options to
purchase shares of our common stock (the New Options together
with the Rollover Options, Options) pursuant to the
2006 Plan. Our Compensation Committee approved additional option
awards periodically throughout the years ended December 31,
2009, 2008 and 2007 to members of management and certain key
employees in cases of promotions, significant contributions to
the Company and new hires. In connection with their option
awards, the participants under the 2006 Plan were required to
enter into a Management Stockholders Agreement, a Sale
Participation Agreement, and an Option Agreement with respect to
the New Options. Below are brief summaries of the principal
terms of the Management Stockholders Agreement and the
Sale Participation Agreement, each of which are qualified in
their entirety by reference to the agreements themselves, forms
of which were filed as Exhibits 10.12 and 10.13,
respectively, to the registration statement of which this
prospectus is a part. The terms of the Option Agreement with
respect to New Options and the 2006 Plan are described in more
detail in Executive Compensation Compensation
Discussion and Analysis Elements of
Compensation Long-Term Equity Incentive Awards:
Options.
Management
Stockholders Agreement
The Management Stockholders Agreement imposes significant
restrictions on transfers of shares of our common stock.
Generally, shares will be nontransferable by any means at any
time prior to the earlier of a Change in Control (as
defined in the Management Stockholders Agreement) or the
fifth anniversary of the closing date of the Recapitalization,
except (i) sales pursuant to an effective registration
statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the
Securities Act) filed by the Company in accordance
with the Management Stockholders Agreement, (ii) a
sale pursuant to the Sale Participation Agreement (described
below), (iii) a sale to certain Permitted
Transferees (as defined in the Management
Stockholders Agreement), or (iv) as otherwise
permitted by our Board of Directors or pursuant to a waiver of
the restrictions on transfers given by unanimous agreement of
the Sponsors. On and after such fifth anniversary through the
earlier of a Change in Control or the eighth anniversary of the
closing date of the Recapitalization, a management stockholder
will be able to transfer shares of our common stock, but only to
the extent that, on a cumulative basis, the management
stockholders in the aggregate do not transfer a greater
percentage of their equity than the percentage of equity sold or
otherwise disposed of by the Sponsors.
In the event that a management stockholder wishes to sell his or
her stock at any time following the fifth anniversary of the
closing date of the Recapitalization but prior to an initial
public offering of our common stock, the Management
Stockholders Agreement provides the Company with a right
of first offer on those shares upon the same terms and
conditions pursuant to which the management stockholder would
sell them to a third party. In the event that a registration
statement is filed with respect to our common stock in the
future, the Management Stockholders Agreement prohibits
management stockholders from selling shares not included in the
registration statement from the time of receipt of notice until
180 days (in the case of an initial public offering) or
90 days (in the case of any other public offering) of the
date of the registration statement. The Management
Stockholders Agreement also provides for the management
stockholders ability to cause us to repurchase their
outstanding stock and options in the event of the management
stockholders death or
146
disability, and for our ability to cause the management
stockholder to sell their stock or options back to the Company
upon certain termination events.
The Management Stockholders Agreement provides that, in
the event we propose to sell shares to the Sponsors, certain
members of senior management, including the executive officers
(the Senior Management Stockholders) have a
preemptive right to purchase shares in the offering. The maximum
shares a Senior Management Stockholder may purchase is a
proportionate number of the shares offered to the percentage of
shares owned by the Senior Management Stockholder prior to the
offering. Additionally, following the initial public offering of
our common stock, the Senior Management Stockholders will have
limited piggyback registration rights with respect
to their shares of common stock. The maximum number of shares of
Common Stock which a Senior Management Stockholder may register
is generally proportionate with the percentage of common stock
being sold by the Sponsors (relative to their holdings thereof).
Sale
Participation Agreement
The Sale Participation Agreement grants the Senior Management
Stockholders the right to participate in any private direct or
indirect sale of shares of common stock by the Sponsors (such
right being referred to herein as the Tag-Along
Right), and requires all management stockholders to
participate in any such private sale if so elected by the
Sponsors in the event that the Sponsors are proposing to sell at
least 50% of the outstanding common stock held by the Sponsors,
whether directly or through their interests in Hercules Holding
(such right being referred to herein as the Drag-Along
Right). The number of shares of common stock which would
be required to be sold by a management stockholder pursuant to
the exercise of the Drag-Along Right will be the sum of the
number of shares of common stock then owned by the management
stockholder and his affiliates plus all shares of common stock
the management stockholder is entitled to acquire under any
unexercised Options (to the extent such Options are exercisable
or would become exercisable as a result of the consummation of
the proposed sale), multiplied by a fraction (x) the
numerator of which shall be the aggregate number of shares of
common stock proposed to be transferred by the Sponsors in the
proposed sale and (y) the denominator of which shall be the
total number of shares of common stock owned by the Sponsors
entitled to participate in the proposed sale. Management
stockholders will bear their pro rata share of any fees,
commissions, adjustments to purchase price, expenses or
indemnities in connection with any sale under the Sale
Participation Agreement.
Amended
and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Hercules
Holding II, LLC
The Investors and certain other investment funds who agreed to
co-invest with them through a vehicle jointly controlled by the
Investors to provide equity financing for the Recapitalization
entered into a limited liability company operating agreement in
respect of Hercules Holding (the LLC Agreement). The
LLC Agreement contains agreements among the parties with respect
to the election of our directors, restrictions on the issuance
or transfer of interests in us, including a right of first
offer, tag-along rights and drag-along rights, and other
corporate governance provisions (including the right to approve
various corporate actions).
Pursuant to the LLC Agreement, Hercules Holding and its members
are required to take necessary action to ensure that each
manager on the board of Hercules Holding also serves on our
Board of Directors. Each of the Sponsors has the right to
appoint three managers to Hercules Holdings board, the
Frist family has the right to appoint two managers to the board,
and the remaining two managers on the board are to come from our
management team (currently Messrs. Bracken and Johnson).
The rights of the Sponsors and the Frist family to designate
managers are subject to their ownership percentages in Hercules
Holding remaining above a specified percentage of the
outstanding ownership interests in Hercules Holding.
The LLC Agreement also requires that, in addition to a majority
of the total number of managers being present to constitute a
quorum for the transaction of business at any board or committee
meeting, at least one manager designated by each of the
Investors (other than the Sponsor Assignees) must be present,
unless waived by that Investor. The LLC Agreement further
provides that, for so long as at least two Sponsors are entitled
to designate managers to Hercules Holdings board, at least
one manager from each of two Sponsors must consent to any board
or committee action in order for it to be valid. The LLC
Agreement requires that
147
our organizational and governing documents contain provisions
similar to those described in this paragraph. A copy of this
agreement has been filed as Exhibit 10.33 to the registration
statement of which this prospectus is a part.
Registration
Rights Agreement
Hercules Holding and the Investors entered into a registration
rights agreement with us upon completion of the
Recapitalization. Pursuant to this agreement, the Investors
(with certain exceptions as to the Sponsor Assignees) can cause
us to register shares of our common stock held by Hercules
Holding under the Securities Act and, if requested, to maintain
a shelf registration statement effective with respect to such
shares. The Investors are also entitled to participate on a pro
rata basis in any registration of our common stock under the
Securities Act that we may undertake. A copy of this agreement
has been filed as Exhibit 4.21 to the registration
statement of which this prospectus is a part.
Sponsor
Management Agreement
In connection with the Recapitalization, we entered into a
management agreement with affiliates of each of the Sponsors and
certain members of the Frist family, including Thomas F.
Frist, Jr., M.D., Thomas F. Frist III and William
R. Frist, pursuant to which such entities or their affiliates
will provide management services to us. Pursuant to the
agreement, in 2009, we paid management fees of
$15.3 million and reimbursed
out-of-pocket
expenses incurred in connection with the provision of services
pursuant to the agreement. The agreement provides that the
aggregate annual management fee, initially set at
$15 million, increases annually beginning in 2008 at a rate
equal to the percentage increase of Adjusted EBITDA (as defined
in the Management Agreement) in the applicable year compared to
the preceding year. The agreement also provides that we will pay
a 1% fee in connection with certain subsequent financing,
acquisition, disposition and change of control transactions, as
well as a termination fee based on the net present value of
future payment obligations under the management agreement, in
the event of an initial public offering or under certain other
circumstances. Accordingly, in connection with this offering we
will pay a transaction fee equal to
$ million in connection with
its termination. No fees were paid under either of these
provisions in 2009. The agreement includes customary exculpation
and indemnification provisions in favor of the Sponsors and
their affiliates and the Frists. A copy of this agreement has
been filed as an exhibit to the registration statement of which
this prospectus is a part.
Other
Relationships
In 2008 and 2007, we paid approximately $25.5 million and
$25.0 million, respectively, to HCP, Inc. (NYSE: HCP),
representing the aggregate annual lease payments for certain
medical office buildings leased by the Company. Charles A. Elcan
was an executive officer of HCP, Inc. until April 30, 2008
and is the
son-in-law
of Dr. Thomas F. Frist, Jr. (who was a member of our
Board of Directors in 2008) and
brother-in-law
of Thomas F. Frist III and William R. Frist, who are
members of our Board of Directors.
Christopher S. George serves as the chief executive officer of
an HCA-affiliated hospital, and in 2009, 2008 and 2007,
Mr. George earned total compensation in respect of base
salary and bonus of approximately $370,000, $440,000 and
$272,000, respectively, for his services. Mr. George also
received certain other benefits, including awards of equity,
customary to similar positions within the Company.
Mr. Georges father, V. Carl George, was an executive
officer of HCA until March 31, 2009.
Dustin A. Greene serves as the chief operating officer of an
HCA-affiliated hospital, and in 2009 and 2008, Mr. Greene
earned total compensation in respect of base salary and bonus of
approximately $160,000 and $143,000, respectively, for his
services. Mr. Greene also received certain other benefits,
including awards of equity, customary to similar positions
within the Company. Mr. Greenes
father-in-law,
W. Paul Rutledge, is an executive officer of HCA.
Bank of America, N.A. (Bank of America) acts as
administrative agent and is a lender under each of our senior
secured cash flow credit facility and our asset-based revolving
credit facility. Affiliates of Bank of America indirectly own
approximately 25.7% of the shares of our company. We engaged
Banc of America
148
Securities LLC, an affiliate of Bank of America, as arranger and
documentation agent in connection with certain amendments to our
cash flow credit facility and our asset-based revolving credit
facility in March 2009. Under that engagement, upon such
amendments becoming effective, we paid Banc of America
Securities LLC aggregate fees of $6 million relating to the
amendments to our senior secured credit facilities. Banc of
America also received its pro rata share of consent fees,
amounting to $121,816, paid to the lenders under our senior
secured cash flow credit facility in connection with certain
amendments to those facilities in June 2009.
In addition, Banc of America Securities LLC acted as joint
book-running manager and a representative of the initial
purchasers of the
97/8% Senior
Secured Notes due 2017 (the outstanding 2017 notes)
that we issued on February 19, 2009, the
81/2% Senior
Secured Notes due 2019 that we issued on April 22, 2009
(the outstanding 2019 notes), the
77/8% Senior
Secured Notes due 2020 that we issued on August 11, 2009
(the outstanding February 2020 notes) and the
71/4% Senior
Secured Notes due 2020 that we issued on March 10, 2010
(the outstanding September 2020 notes). The proceeds
of the issuance of the outstanding 2017 notes, the outstanding
2019 notes, the outstanding February 2020 notes and the
outstanding September 2020 notes were used to repay indebtedness
under the senior secured credit facilities, and Bank of America
received its pro rata portion of such repayment. In addition,
Banc of America Securities LLC received placement fees of
$1.4 million in connection with the issuance of the
outstanding 2017 notes, placement fees of $8.0 million in
connection with the issuance of the outstanding 2019 notes and
the outstanding February 2020 notes, and placement fees of
$3.8 million in connection with the issuance of the
outstanding September 2020 notes.
We also engaged Banc of America Securities LLC in connection
with certain amendments to our cash flow credit facility in
April 2010. Under that engagement, we paid Banc of America
Securities LLC aggregate fees of approximately $2.0 million
relating to those amendments.
KKR Capital Markets LLC, one of the other initial purchasers of
the outstanding 2017 notes, is an affiliate of KKR, whose
affiliates own approximately 24.7% of the shares of our company,
and received placement fees of $191,050 in connection with the
issuance of the outstanding 2017 notes.
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, an
affiliate of Bank of America, is acting as a joint book-running
manager for this offering. See Underwriting
Conflicts of Interest.
149
DESCRIPTION
OF INDEBTEDNESS
The summaries set forth below are qualified in their entirety by
the actual text of the applicable agreements and indentures,
each of which has been filed as an exhibit to the registration
statement, of which this prospectus is a part, or which may be
obtained on publicly available websites at the addresses set
forth under Where You Can Find More Information.
Senior
Secured Credit Facilities
On November 17, 2006 in connection with the
Recapitalization, we entered into the senior secured credit
facilities with Banc of America Securities LLC, J.P. Morgan
Securities Inc., Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and Merrill
Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, as joint
lead arrangers and bookrunners, Bank of America, N.A., as
administrative agent, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Citicorp
North America, Inc., as co-syndication agents and Merrill Lynch
Capital Corporation, as documentation agent.
The senior secured credit facilities provide senior secured
financing of $16.800 billion, consisting of:
|
|
|
|
|
$12.800 billion-equivalent in term loan facilities,
comprised of a $2.750 billion senior secured term loan A
facility with a term of six years, a $8.800 billion senior
secured term loan B facility with a term of seven years and a
1.000 billion senior secured European term loan
facility with a term of seven years; and
|
|
|
|
$4.000 billion in revolving credit facilities, comprised of
a $2.000 billion senior secured asset-based revolving
credit facility available in dollars with a term of six years
and a $2.000 billion senior secured revolving credit
facility available in dollars, euros and pounds sterling with a
term of six years. Availability under the asset-based revolving
credit facility is subject to a borrowing base of 85% of
eligible accounts receivable less customary reserves.
|
We refer to these senior secured credit facilities, excluding
the asset-based revolving credit facility, as the cash
flow credit facility and, collectively with the
asset-based revolving credit facility, the senior secured
credit facilities. The asset-based revolving credit
facility is documented in a separate loan agreement from the
other senior secured credit facilities.
HCA Inc. is the primary borrower under the senior secured credit
facilities, except that a U.K. subsidiary is the borrower under
the European term loan facility. The revolving credit facilities
include capacity available for the issuance of letters of credit
and for borrowings on
same-day
notice, referred to as the swingline loans. A portion of the
letter of credit availability under the cash-flow revolving
credit facility is available in euros, dollars and pounds
sterling. Lenders under the cash flow credit facility are
subject to a loss sharing agreement pursuant to which, upon the
occurrence of certain events, including a bankruptcy event of
default under the cash flow credit facility, each such lender
will automatically be deemed to have exchanged its interest in a
particular tranche of the cash flow credit facility for a pro
rata percentage in all of the tranches of the cash flow credit
facility.
On February 16, 2007, we amended our cash flow credit
facility to reduce the applicable margins with respect to the
term borrowings thereunder. On June 20, 2007, we amended
our asset-based revolving credit facility to reduce the
applicable margin with respect to borrowings thereunder.
On March 2, 2009, we amended our cash flow credit facility
to allow for one or more future issuances of additional secured
notes, which may include notes that are secured on a pari
passu basis or on a junior basis with the obligations under
the cash flow credit facility, so long as (1) such notes do
not require, subject to certain exceptions, scheduled
repayments, payment of principal or redemption prior to the
scheduled term loan B maturity date as currently in effect,
(2) the terms of such notes, taken as a whole, are not more
restrictive than those in the cash flow credit facility and
(3) the proceeds from any such issuance are used within
three business days of receipt to permanently prepay term loans
under the cash flow credit facility in accordance with the terms
of the cash flow credit facility. The U.S. security
documents related to the cash flow credit facility were also
amended and restated in connection with the amendment in order
to give effect to the security interests to be granted to
holders of such additional secured notes.
150
On March 2, 2009, we also amended our asset-based revolving
credit facility to allow for one or more future issuances of
additional secured notes or loans, which may include notes or
loans that are secured on a pari passu basis or on a
junior basis with the obligations under the cash flow credit
facility, so long as (1) such notes or loans do not
require, subject to certain exceptions, scheduled repayments,
payment of principal or redemption prior to the scheduled term
loan B final maturity date as currently in effect, (2) the
terms of such notes or loans, as applicable, taken as a whole,
are not more restrictive than those in the cash flow credit
facility and (3) the proceeds from any such issuance are
used within three business days of receipt to permanently prepay
term loans under the cash flow credit facility in accordance
with the terms of the cash flow credit facility. The amendment
to the asset-based revolving credit facility also altered the
excess facility availability requirement to include a separate
minimum facility availability requirement applicable to the
asset-based revolving credit facility and increased the
applicable LIBOR and asset-based revolving margins for all
borrowings under the asset-based revolving credit facility by
0.25% each.
On June 18, 2009, we amended our cash flow credit facility
to permit unlimited refinancings of the term loans initially
incurred in November 2006 under the cash flow credit facility
(the initial term loans), as well as any previously
incurred refinancing term loans through the incurrence of new
term loans under the cash flow credit facility
(refinancing term loans), (collectively, with the
initial term loans, the then-existing term loans),
and to permit the establishment of one or more series of
commitments under replacement cash flow revolvers under the cash
flow credit facility (replacement revolver) to
replace all or a portion of the revolving commitments initially
established in November 2006 under the cash flow credit facility
(the initial revolver) as well as any previously
issued replacement revolvers (with no more than three series of
revolving commitments to be outstanding at any time) in each
case, subject to the terms described below. The amendment to the
cash flow credit facility further permits the maturity date of
any then-existing term loan to be extended (any such loans so
extended, the extended term loans). The amendment to
the cash flow credit facility provides that:
|
|
|
|
|
As to refinancing term loans, (1) the proceeds from such
refinancing term loans be used to repay in full the initial term
loans before being used to repay any previously issued
refinancing term loans; (2) the refinancing term loans
mature later than the latest maturity date of any of the initial
term loans; (3) the weighted average life to maturity for
the refinancing term loans be greater than the remaining
weighted average life to maturity of the senior secured term
loan B facility under the cash flow credit facility measured at
the time such refinancing term loans are incurred; and
(4) refinancing term loans will not share in mandatory
prepayments resulting from the creation or issuance of extended
term loans
and/or first
lien notes until the initial term loans are repaid in full but
will share in other mandatory prepayments such as those from
asset sales.
|
|
|
|
As to replacement revolvers, terms of such replacement revolver
be substantially identical to the commitments being replaced,
other than with respect to maturity and pricing.
|
|
|
|
As to extended term loans, (1) any offer to extend must be
made to all lenders under the term loan being extended, and, if
such offer is oversubscribed, the extension will be allocated
ratably to the lenders according to the respective amounts then
held by the accepting lenders; (2) each series of extended
term loans having the same interest margins, extension fees and
amortization schedule shall be a separate class of term loans;
and (3) extended term loans will not share in mandatory
prepayments resulting from the creation or issuance of
refinancing term loans
and/or first
lien notes until the initial term loans are repaid in full but
will share in other mandatory prepayments such as those from
asset sales.
|
|
|
|
Any refinancing term loans and any obligations under replacement
revolvers will have a pari passu claim on the collateral
securing the initial term loans and the initial revolver.
|
On April 6, 2010, we amended our cash flow credit facility to
(i) extend the maturity date for $2.0 billion of our
tranche B term loans from November 17, 2013 to
March 31, 2017 and (ii) increase the ABR margin and
LIBOR margin with respect to such extended term loans to 2.25%
and 3.25%, respectively. The maturity date, interest margins and
fees, as applicable, with respect to all other loans, and all
commitments and letters of credit, outstanding under the cash
flow credit facility remain unchanged.
151
See also Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions for a description of certain relationships
between us and Bank of America, N.A., the administrative agent
under the cash flow credit facility and the asset-based
revolving credit facility.
Interest
Rate and Fees
Borrowings under the senior secured credit facilities bear
interest at a rate equal to, at our option, either
(a) LIBOR for deposits in the applicable currency plus an
applicable margin or (b) the higher of (1) the prime
rate of Bank of America, N.A. and (2) the federal funds
effective rate plus 0.50%, plus an applicable margin. The
applicable margins in effect for borrowings as of March 31,
2010 are (v) under the asset-based revolving credit
facility, 0.50% with respect to base rate borrowings and 1.50%
with respect to LIBOR borrowings, (w) under the senior
secured revolving credit facility, 0.75% with respect to base
rate borrowings and 1.75% with respect to LIBOR borrowings,
(x) under the term loan A facility, 0.50% with respect to
base rate borrowings and 1.50% with respect to LIBOR borrowings,
(y) under the term loan B facility, 1.25% with respect to
base rate borrowings and 2.25% with respect to LIBOR borrowings,
and (z) under the European term loan facility, 2.00% with
respect to LIBOR borrowings. Certain of the applicable margins
may be reduced or increased depending on our leverage ratios.
In addition to paying interest on outstanding principal under
the senior secured credit facilities, we are required to pay a
commitment fee to the lenders under the revolving credit
facilities in respect of the unutilized commitments thereunder.
The commitment fee rate as of March 31, 2010 is 0.375% per
annum for the revolving credit facility and the asset-based
revolving credit facility. The commitment fee rates may
fluctuate due to changes in specified leverage ratios. We must
also pay customary letter of credit fees.
Prepayments
The cash flow credit facility requires us to prepay outstanding
term loans, subject to certain exceptions, with:
|
|
|
|
|
50% (which percentage will be reduced to 25% if our total
leverage ratio is 5.50x or less and to 0% if our total leverage
ratio is 5.00x or less) of our annual excess cash flow;
|
|
|
|
100% of the net cash proceeds of all nonordinary course asset
sales or other dispositions of property, other than the
Receivables Collateral, as defined below, if we do not
(1) reinvest or commit to reinvest those proceeds in assets
to be used in our business or to make certain other permitted
investments within 15 months as long as, in the case of any
such commitment to reinvest or make certain other permitted
investments, such investment is completed within such
15-month
period or, if later, within 180 days after such commitment
is made or (2) apply such proceeds within 15 months to
repay debt of HCA Inc. that was outstanding on the effective
date of the Recapitalization scheduled to mature prior to the
earliest final maturity of the senior secured credit facilities
then outstanding; and
|
|
|
|
100% of the net cash proceeds of any incurrence of debt, other
than proceeds from the receivables facilities and other debt
permitted under the senior secured credit facilities.
|
The foregoing mandatory prepayments are applied among the term
loan facilities (1) during the first three years after the
effective date of the Recapitalization, pro rata to such
facilities based on the respective aggregate amounts of unpaid
principal installments thereof due during such period, with
amounts allocated to each facility being applied to the
remaining installments thereof in direct order of maturity and
(2) thereafter, pro rata to such facilities, with amounts
allocated to each facility being applied, in the case of the
term loan A facility, pro rata to the remaining installments
thereof and, in the case of the term loan B facility or the
European term loan facility, to the next eight unpaid scheduled
installments of principal of such facility and then pro rata to
the remaining amortization payments under such facility.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, (i) proceeds of asset sales
by foreign subsidiaries are applied solely to prepay European
term loans until such term loans have been repaid in full and
(ii) we are not required to prepay loans under the term
loan A facility or the term loan B facility with net cash
proceeds of asset sales or with excess cash flow, in each case
152
attributable to foreign subsidiaries, to the extent that the
repatriation of such amounts is prohibited or delayed by
applicable local law or would result in material adverse tax
consequences.
The asset-based revolving credit facility requires us to prepay
outstanding loans if borrowings exceed the borrowing base.
We may voluntarily repay outstanding loans under the senior
secured credit facilities at any time without premium or
penalty, other than customary breakage costs with
respect to LIBOR loans.
Amortization
We are required to repay the loans under the term loan
facilities as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
the term loan A facility amortizes in quarterly installments
such that the aggregate amount of the original funded principal
amount of such facility repaid pursuant to such amortization
payments in each year, commencing with the year ending
December 31, 2007, is equal to $112.5 million in years
1 and 2, $225 million in years 3 and 4, $450 million
in year 5 and $1.625 billion in year 6; and
|
|
|
|
each of the term loan B facility and the European term loan
facility amortizes in equal quarterly installments that
commenced on March 31, 2007 in aggregate annual amounts
equal to 1% of the original funded principal amount of such
facility, with the balance being payable on the final maturity
date of such term loans.
|
Due to prior mandatory prepayments, amortization payments under
the term loan A facility are not required until June 30,
2011, and no further amortization payments are required for
either the term loan B facility or the European term loan.
Principal amounts outstanding under the revolving credit
facilities are due and payable in full at maturity, six years
from the date of the closing of the senior secured credit
facilities.
Guarantee
and Security
All obligations under the senior secured credit facilities are
unconditionally guaranteed by substantially all existing and
future, direct and indirect, wholly-owned material domestic
subsidiaries that are Unrestricted Subsidiaries
under the 1993 Indenture (except for certain special purpose
subsidiaries that only guarantee and pledge their assets under
the asset-based revolving credit facility), and the obligations
under the European term loan facility are also unconditionally
guaranteed by HCA Inc. and each of our existing and future
wholly-owned material subsidiaries formed under the laws of
England and Wales, subject, in each of the foregoing cases, to
any applicable legal, regulatory or contractual constraints and
to the requirement that such guarantee does not cause adverse
tax consequences.
All obligations under the asset-based revolving credit facility,
and the guarantees of those obligations, are secured, subject to
permitted liens and other exceptions, by a first-priority lien
on substantially all of the receivables of the borrowers and
each guarantor under such asset-based revolving credit facility
(the Receivables Collateral).
All obligations under the cash flow credit facility and the
guarantees of such obligations, are secured, subject to
permitted liens and other exceptions, by:
|
|
|
|
|
a first-priority lien on the capital stock owned by HCA Inc. or
by any U.S. guarantor in each of their respective
first-tier subsidiaries (limited, in the case of foreign
subsidiaries, to 65% of the voting stock of such subsidiaries);
|
|
|
|
a first-priority lien on substantially all present and future
assets of HCA Inc. and of each U.S. guarantor other than
(i) Principal Properties (as defined in the
1993 Indenture), except for certain Principal
Properties the aggregate amount of indebtedness secured
thereby in respect of the cash flow credit facility and the
first lien notes and any future first lien obligations, taken as
a whole, do not exceed 10% of Consolidated Net Tangible
Assets (as defined under the 1993 Indenture),
(ii) certain other real properties and (iii) deposit
accounts, other bank or securities accounts, cash, leaseholds,
motor-
|
153
|
|
|
|
|
vehicles and certain other exceptions (such collateral under
this and the preceding bullet, the Non-Receivables
Collateral); and
|
|
|
|
|
|
a second-priority lien on certain of the Receivables Collateral
(such portion of the Receivables Collateral, the Shared
Receivables Collateral; the Receivables Collateral that
does not secure such cash flow credit facility on a
second-priority basis is referred to as the Separate
Receivables Collateral).
|
The obligations of the borrowers and the guarantors under the
European term loan facility are also secured by substantially
all present and future assets of the European subsidiary
borrower and each European guarantor (the European
Collateral), subject to permitted liens and other
exceptions (including, without limitation, exceptions for
deposit accounts, other bank or securities accounts, cash,
leaseholds, motor-vehicles and certain other exceptions) and
subject to such security interests otherwise being permitted by
applicable law and contract and not resulting in adverse tax
consequences. Neither our first lien notes nor our second lien
notes are secured by any of the European Collateral.
Certain
Covenants and Events of Default
The senior secured credit facilities contain a number of
covenants that, among other things, restrict, subject to certain
exceptions, our ability to:
|
|
|
|
|
incur additional indebtedness;
|
|
|
|
create liens;
|
|
|
|
enter into sale and leaseback transactions;
|
|
|
|
engage in mergers or consolidations;
|
|
|
|
sell or transfer assets;
|
|
|
|
pay dividends and distributions or repurchase our capital stock;
|
|
|
|
make investments, loans or advances;
|
|
|
|
prepay certain subordinated indebtedness, the second lien notes
and certain other indebtedness existing on the effective date of
the Recapitalization (Retained Indebtedness),
subject to exceptions, including for repayments of Retained
Indebtedness maturing prior to the senior secured credit
facilities and, in certain cases, to satisfaction of a maximum
first lien leverage condition;
|
|
|
|
make certain acquisitions;
|
|
|
|
engage in certain transactions with affiliates;
|
|
|
|
make certain material amendments to agreements governing certain
subordinated indebtedness, the second lien notes or Retained
Indebtedness; and
|
|
|
|
change our lines of business.
|
In addition, the senior secured credit facilities require us to
maintain the following financial covenants:
|
|
|
|
|
in the case of the asset-based revolving credit facility, a
minimum interest coverage ratio (applicable only when
availability under such facility is less than 10% of the
borrowing base thereunder); and
|
|
|
|
in the case of the other senior secured credit facilities, a
maximum total leverage ratio.
|
The senior secured credit facilities also contain certain
customary affirmative covenants and events of default, including
a change of control.
154
Senior
Secured Notes
Overview
of Senior Secured First Lien Notes
As of March 31, 2010, we had $4.150 billion aggregate
principal amount of senior secured first lien notes consisting
of:
|
|
|
|
|
$1.500 billion aggregate principal amount of
81/2% senior
secured notes due 2019 issued on April 22, 2009 at a price
of 96.755% of their face value, resulting in $1.451 billion
of gross proceeds;
|
|
|
|
$1.250 billion aggregate principal amount of
77/8% senior
secured notes due 2020 issued on August 11, 2009 at a price
of 98.254% of their face value, resulting in $1.228 billion
of gross proceeds.
|
|
|
|
$1.400 billion aggregate principal amount of
71/4% senior
secured first lien notes due 2020 issued on March 10, 2010
at a price of 99.095% of their face value, resulting in
$1.387 billion of gross proceeds.
|
We refer to these notes issued on April 22, 2009,
August 11, 2009 and March 10, 2010 as the first
lien notes and the indentures governing the first lien
notes as the first lien indentures.
The first lien notes and the related guarantees are secured by
first-priority liens, subject to permitted liens, on our and our
subsidiary guarantors assets, subject to certain
exceptions, that secure our cash flow credit facility on a
first-priority basis and are secured by second-priority liens,
subject to permitted liens, on our and our subsidiary
guarantors assets that secure our asset-based revolving
credit facility on a first-priority basis and our cash flow
credit facility on a second-priority basis.
Overview
of Senior Secured Second Lien Notes
As of March 31, 2010, we had $6.088 billion aggregate
principal amount of senior secured second lien notes consisting
of:
|
|
|
|
|
$4.200 billion of second lien notes (comprised of
$1.000 billion of
91/8% notes
due 2014 and $3.200 billion of
91/4% notes
due 2016) and $1.500 billion of
95/8%
cash/103/8%
pay-in-kind
second lien toggle notes due 2016 (which toggle notes allow us,
at our option, to pay interest in-kind during the first five
years at the higher interest rate of
103/8%).
We elected in November 2008 to pay interest in-kind in the
amount of $78 million for the interest period ending in May
2009.
|
|
|
|
$310 million aggregate principal amount of
97/8% senior
secured second lien notes due 2017.
|
We refer to these notes as the second lien notes
and, together with the first lien notes, the secured
notes. We refer to the indentures governing the second
lien notes as the second lien indentures and,
together with the first lien indentures, the indentures
governing the secured notes.
These second lien notes and the related guarantees are secured
by second-priority liens, subject to permitted liens, on our and
our subsidiary guarantors assets, subject to certain
exceptions, that secure our cash flow credit facility on a
first-priority basis and are secured by third-priority liens,
subject to permitted liens, on our and our subsidiary
guarantors assets that secure our asset-based revolving
credit facility on a first-priority basis and our cash flow
credit facility on a second-priority basis.
Optional
Redemption
The indentures governing the secured notes permit us to redeem
some or all of the secured notes at any time at redemption
prices described or set forth in the respective indenture. In
particular, in the event of an equity offering, we may, for
approximately three years following the date of issuance of that
series, redeem up to 35% of the principal amount of such series
at a redemption price equal to 100% plus the amount of the
respective coupon, using the net cash proceeds raised in the
equity offering.
Change
of Control
In addition, the indentures governing the secured notes provide
that, upon the occurrence of a change of control as defined
therein, each holder of secured notes has the right to require
us to repurchase some or all of
155
such holders secured notes at a purchase price in cash
equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and
unpaid interest, if any, to the repurchase date.
Covenants
The indentures governing the secured notes contain covenants
limiting, among other things, our ability and the ability of our
restricted subsidiaries to, subject to certain exceptions:
|
|
|
|
|
incur additional debt or issue certain preferred stock;
|
|
|
|
pay dividends on or make certain distributions of our capital
stock or make other restricted payments;
|
|
|
|
create certain liens or encumbrances;
|
|
|
|
sell certain assets;
|
|
|
|
enter into certain transactions with affiliates;
|
|
|
|
make certain investments; and
|
|
|
|
consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or
substantially all of our assets.
|
The indentures governing the secured notes also contain a
covenant limiting our ability to prepay certain series of
unsecured notes based on the maturity of those unsecured notes.
In particular, the indenture governing the first lien notes
issued in April 2009 permits us to prepay only those unsecured
notes maturing on or prior to April 15, 2019, the indenture
governing the first lien notes issued in August 2009 permits us
to prepay only those unsecured notes maturing on or prior to
February 15, 2020 and the indentures governing the notes
issued in November 2006 and in February 2009 permit us to prepay
only those unsecured notes maturing on or prior to
November 15, 2016.
Events
of Default
The indentures governing the secured notes also provide for
events of default which, if any of them occurs, would permit or
require the principal of and accrued interest on the secured
notes to become or to be declared due and payable.
Other
Secured Indebtedness
As of March 31, 2010, we had approximately
$345 million of capital leases and other secured debt
outstanding.
Under our lease with HRT of Roanoke, Inc., effective
December 20, 2005, we make annual payments for rent and
additional expenses for the use of premises in Roanoke and
Salem, Virginia. The rent payments will increase each year
beginning January 1, 2007 by the lesser of 3% or the change
in the Consumer Price Index. The lease is for a fixed term of
12 years with the option to extend the lease for another
ten years.
Under our lease with Medical City Dallas Limited, effective
March 18, 2004, we make annual payments for rent for the
use of premises that are a part of a complex known as
Medical City Dallas located in Dallas, Texas. The
rent payment is adjusted yearly based on the fair market value
of the premises and a capitalization rate. The initial term is
240 months with the option to extend for two more terms of
240 months each.
Unsecured
Indebtedness Overview
As of March 31, 2010, we had outstanding an aggregate
principal amount of $6.293 billion and
£121 million of senior notes and debentures,
consisting of the following series:
|
|
|
|
|
$440,020,000 aggregate principal amount of 8.75% Senior
Notes due 2010;
|
|
|
|
£121,359,000 aggregate principal amount of
8.75% Senior Notes due 2010;
|
|
|
|
$273,321,000 aggregate principal amount of 7.875% Senior
Notes due 2011;
|
156
|
|
|
|
|
$402,499,000 aggregate principal amount of 6.95% Senior
Notes due 2012;
|
|
|
|
$500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 6.30% Senior
Notes due 2012;
|
|
|
|
$500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 6.25% Senior
Notes due 2013;
|
|
|
|
$500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 6.75% Senior
Notes due 2013;
|
|
|
|
$500,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 5.75% Senior
Notes due 2014;
|
|
|
|
$750,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 6.375% Senior
Notes due 2015;
|
|
|
|
$1,000,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 6.50% Senior
Notes due 2016;
|
|
|
|
$291,436,000 aggregate principal amount of 7.69% Notes due
2025;
|
|
|
|
$250,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 7.50% Senior
Notes due 2033;
|
|
|
|
$150,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 7.19% Debentures
due 2015;
|
|
|
|
$135,645,000 aggregate principal amount of 7.50% Debentures
due 2023;
|
|
|
|
$150,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 8.36% Debentures
due 2024;
|
|
|
|
$150,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 7.05% Debentures
due 2027;
|
|
|
|
$100,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 7.75% Debentures
due 2036; and
|
|
|
|
$200,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 7.50% Debentures
due 2095.
|
As of March 31, 2010, we also had outstanding $121,110,000
aggregate principal amount of our 9.00% Medium Term Notes due
2014 and $125,000,000 aggregate principal amount of our 7.58%
Medium Term Notes due 2025.
All of our outstanding series of senior notes, debentures and
medium term notes, which we refer to collectively as the
unsecured notes, were issued under an indenture,
which we refer to as the 1993 Indenture.
Optional
Redemption
If permitted by the respective supplemental indenture, we are
permitted to redeem some or all of that series of unsecured
notes at any time at redemption prices described or set forth in
such supplemental indenture.
Covenants
The 1993 Indenture contains covenants limiting, among other
things, our ability
and/or the
ability of our subsidiaries to (subject to certain exceptions):
|
|
|
|
|
assume or guarantee indebtedness or obligation secured by
mortgages, liens, pledges or other encumbrances;
|
|
|
|
enter into sale and lease-back transactions with respect to any
Principal Property (as such term is defined in the
1993 Indenture);
|
|
|
|
create, incur, issue, assume or otherwise become liable with
respect to, extend the maturity of, or become responsible for
the payment of, any debt or preferred stock; and
|
|
|
|
consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or
substantially all of our assets.
|
In addition, the 1993 Indenture provides that the aggregate
amount of all other indebtedness of HCA secured by mortgages on
Principal Properties (as such term is defined in the
1993 Indenture) together with the aggregate principal amount of
all indebtedness of restricted subsidiaries (as such term is
defined in the 1993 Indenture) and the attributable debt in
respect of sale-leasebacks of Principal Properties, may not
exceed
157
15% of the consolidated net tangible assets of HCA and its
consolidated subsidiaries, subject to exceptions for certain
permitted mortgages and debt.
Events
of Default
The 1993 Indenture contains certain events of default, which, if
any of them occurs, would permit or require the principal of and
accrued interest on such series to become or to be declared due
and payable.
158
DESCRIPTION
OF CAPITAL STOCK
The following is a description of the material terms of our
certificate of incorporation and bylaws as each is anticipated
to be in effect upon the closing of this offering. We also refer
you to our certificate of incorporation and bylaws, copies of
which are filed as exhibits to the registration statement of
which this prospectus forms a part.
Authorized
Capital
At the time of the closing of this offering, our authorized
capital stock will consist of:
|
|
|
|
|
shares
of common stock, par value $.01 per share, of
which shares
were issued and outstanding as of March 31, 2010, and;
|
|
|
|
shares
of preferred stock, of which no shares are issued and
outstanding.
|
As of March 31, 2010, there
were
holders of record of our common stock.
Immediately following the closing of this offering, there are
expected to
be shares
of common stock issued and outstanding
(or shares
of common stock if the underwriters exercise their option to
purchase additional shares) and no shares of preferred stock
outstanding.
Common
Stock
Voting Rights. Holders of our common stock are
entitled to one vote for each share held of record on all
matters on which the stockholders may vote. The holders of
common stock do not have cumulative voting rights in the
election of directors. Accordingly, the holders of more than 50%
of the shares of common stock can, if they choose to do so,
elect all the directors. In such event, the holders of the
remaining shares of common stock will not be able to elect any
directors.
In the event of our liquidation, dissolution or winding up,
holders of our common stock are entitled to share ratably in the
assets available for distribution.
Dividend Rights. Holders of our common stock
are entitled to receive ratably out of our legally available
assets, when and if declared by our Board of Directors,
dividends in cash, property, shares of common stock or other
securities. The senior secured credit facilities and the
indentures governing our notes impose restrictions on our
ability to declare dividends on our common stock.
Liquidation Rights. Upon our liquidation,
dissolution or winding up, any business combination or a sale or
disposition of all or substantially all of our assets, the
holders of common stock are entitled to receive ratably the
assets available for distribution to the stockholders after
payment of liabilities and accumulated and unpaid dividends and
liquidation preferences on outstanding preferred stock, if any.
Other Matters. Holders of common stock have no
preemptive or conversion rights and, absent an individual
agreement with us, are not subject to further calls or
assessment by us. There are no redemption or sinking fund
provisions applicable to our common stock. All outstanding
shares of our common stock, including the shares of common stock
offered in this offering, are fully paid and non-assessable.
Preferred
Stock
Unless required by law or by any stock exchange on which our
common stock may be listed, the authorized shares of preferred
stock will be available for issuance without further action by
you. Our certificate of incorporation authorizes our Board of
Directors to determine the preferences, limitations and relative
rights of any shares of preferred stock that we choose to issue.
Authorized
but Unissued Capital Stock
Delaware law does not require stockholder approval for any
issuance of authorized shares. However, the listing requirements
of the New York Stock Exchange, which would apply as long as our
common stock is
159
listed on the New York Stock Exchange, require stockholder
approval of certain issuances equal to or exceeding 20% of the
then outstanding voting power or then outstanding number of
shares of common stock. These additional shares may be used for
a variety of corporate purposes, including future public
offerings, to raise additional capital or to facilitate
acquisitions.
One of the effects of the existence of unissued and unreserved
common stock or preferred stock may be to enable our Board of
Directors to issue shares to persons friendly to current
management, which issuance could render more difficult or
discourage an attempt to obtain control of our company by means
of a merger, tender offer, proxy contest or otherwise, and
thereby protect the continuity of our management and possibly
deprive the stockholder of opportunities to sell their shares of
common stock at prices higher than prevailing market prices.
Limitation
on Directors Liability and Indemnification
Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the
DGCL) grants each corporation organized thereunder
the power to indemnify any person who is or was a director,
officer, employee or agent of a corporation or enterprise,
against expenses, including attorneys fees, judgments,
fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably
incurred by him in connection with any threatened, pending or
completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal,
administrative or investigative, other than an action by or in
the right of the corporation, by reason of being or having been
in any such capacity, if he acted in good faith in a manner
reasonably believed to be in, or not opposed to, the best
interests of the corporation, and, with respect to any criminal
action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe his
conduct was unlawful. A similar standard of care is applicable
in the case of expenses, including attorneys fees, in
actions by or in the right of the corporation, except that no
indemnification may be made in respect of any claim, issue or
matter as to which such person shall have been adjudged to be
liable to the corporation unless and only to the extent that the
Delaware Court of Chancery or the court in which such action was
brought determines that, despite adjudication of liability, but
in view of all of the circumstances of the case, the person is
fairly and reasonably entitled to indemnity for expenses that
the Delaware Court of Chancery or other court shall deem proper.
Section 102(b)(7) of the DGCL enables a corporation in its
certificate of incorporation, or an amendment thereto, to
eliminate or limit the personal liability of a director to the
corporation or its stockholders of monetary damages for
violations of the directors fiduciary duty of care as a
director, except (i) for any breach of the directors
duty of loyalty to the corporation or its stockholders,
(ii) for acts or omissions not in good faith or that
involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law,
(iii) pursuant to Section 174 of the DGCL (providing
for liability of directors for unlawful payment of dividends or
unlawful stock purchases or redemptions) or (iv) for any
transaction from which a director derived an improper personal
benefit.
Our bylaws indemnify the directors and officers to the full
extent of the DGCL and also allow the Board of Directors to
indemnify all other employees. Such indemnification extends to
the payment of judgments against such officers and directors and
to reimbursement of amounts paid in settlement of such claims or
actions and may apply to judgments in favor of the corporation
or amounts paid in settlement to the corporation. Such
indemnification also extends to the payment of counsel fees and
expenses of such officers and directors in suits against them
where successfully defended by them or where unsuccessfully
defended, if there is no finding or judgment that the claim or
action arose from the gross negligence or willful misconduct of
such officers or directors. Such right of indemnification is not
exclusive of any right to which such officer or director may be
entitled as a matter of law and shall extend and apply to the
estates of deceased officers and directors.
We maintain a directors and officers insurance
policy. The policy insures directors and officers against
unindemnified losses arising from certain wrongful acts in their
capacities as directors and officers and reimburses us for those
losses for which we have lawfully indemnified the directors and
officers. The policy contains various exclusions that are normal
and customary for policies of this type.
On November 1, 2009, we entered into an indemnification
priority and information sharing agreement with the Sponsors and
certain of their affiliated funds to clarify the priority of
advancement and indemnification obligations among us and any of
our directors appointed by the Sponsors and other related
matters.
160
The foregoing summaries are subject to the complete text of our
amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended
and restated bylaws and the DGCL and are qualified in their
entirety by reference thereto.
We believe that our certificate of incorporation, bylaws and
insurance are necessary to attract and retain qualified persons
as directors and officers.
The limitation of liability and indemnification provisions in
our certificate of incorporation and bylaws may discourage
stockholders from bringing a lawsuit against directors for
breach of their fiduciary duty. They may also reduce the
likelihood of derivative litigation against directors and
officers, even though an action, if successful, might benefit us
and other stockholders. Furthermore, a stockholders
investment may be adversely affected to the extent we pay the
costs of settlement and damage awards against directors and
officers as required or allowed by these indemnification
provisions.
At present, we are not aware of any pending litigation or
proceeding involving any of our directors or officers in which
indemnification is required or permitted and we are not aware of
any threatened litigation or proceeding that may result in a
claim for indemnification.
Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the
Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers or
persons controlling us pursuant to the foregoing provisions or
any other provisions described in this prospectus, we have been
informed that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange
Commission such indemnification is against public policy as
expressed in the Securities Act and is therefore unenforceable.
Delaware
Anti-Takeover Statutes
Certain Delaware law provisions may make it more difficult for
someone to acquire us through a tender offer, proxy contest or
otherwise.
Section 203 of the DGCL, provides that, subject to certain
stated exceptions, an interested stockholder is any
person (other than the corporation and any direct or indirect
majority-owned subsidiary) who owns 15% or more of the
outstanding voting stock of the corporation or is an affiliate
or associate of the corporation and was the owner of 15% or more
of the outstanding voting stock of the corporation at any time
within the three-year period immediately prior to the date of
determination, and the affiliates and associates of such person.
A corporation may not engage in a business combination with any
interested stockholder for a period of three years following the
time that such stockholder became an interested stockholder
unless:
|
|
|
|
|
prior to such time the board of directors of the corporation
approved either the business combination or transaction which
resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder;
|
|
|
|
upon consummation of the transaction which resulted in the
stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, the interested
stockholder owned at least 85% of the voting stock of the
corporation outstanding at the time the transaction commenced,
excluding shares owned by persons who are directors and also
officers and employee stock plans in which participants do not
have the right to determine confidentially whether shares held
subject to the plan will be tendered in a tender or exchange
offer; or
|
|
|
|
at or subsequent to such time, the business combination is
approved by the board of directors and authorized at an annual
or special meeting of stockholders, and not by written consent,
by the affirmative vote of
662/3%
of the outstanding voting stock which is not owned by the
interested stockholder.
|
The effect of these provisions may make a change in control of
our business more difficult by delaying, deferring or preventing
a tender offer or other takeover attempt that a stockholder
might consider in its best interest. This includes attempts that
might result in the payment of a premium to stockholders over
the market price for their shares. These provisions also may
promote the continuity of our management by making it more
difficult for a person to remove or change the incumbent members
of the board of directors.
161
Amendments,
Supermajority Voting Requirements
When a quorum is present at an annual or special meeting of the
stockholders, a vote of the holders of a majority of the voting
power entitled to vote decides any question on which our
stockholders are entitled to vote, unless a different vote is
required by statute, the certificate of incorporation or the
bylaws. See Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions Amended and Restated Limited Liability
Company Agreement of Hercules Holding II, LLC.
Transfer
Agent and Registrar
is the transfer agent and registrar for our common stock.
Listing
We propose to list our common stock on the New York Stock
Exchange under the symbol HCA.
See Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions Amended and Restated Limited Liability
Company Agreement of Hercules Holding II, LLC.
162
SHARES
ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
After our Recapitalization and prior to this offering, there has
not been a public market for our common stock, and we cannot
predict what effect, if any, market sales of shares of common
stock or the availability of shares of common stock for sale
will have on the market price of our common stock prevailing
from time to time. Nevertheless, sales of substantial amounts of
common stock, including shares issued upon the exercise of
outstanding options, in the public market, or the perception
that such sales could occur, could materially and adversely
affect the market price of our common stock and could impair our
future ability to raise capital through the sale of our equity
or equity-related securities at a time and price that we deem
appropriate.
Upon the closing of this offering, we will have outstanding an
aggregate of
approximately shares
of common stock
( shares
of common stock if the underwriters exercise their option to
purchase additional shares). In addition, options to purchase an
aggregate of
approximately shares
of our common stock will be outstanding as of the closing of
this offering. Of these
options,
will have vested at or prior to the closing of this offering and
approximately
could vest over the next three to six years. Of the outstanding
shares, the shares sold in this offering will be freely tradable
without restriction or further registration under the Securities
Act, except that any shares held by our affiliates, as that term
is defined under Rule 144 of the Securities Act, may be
sold only in compliance with the limitations described below.
The remaining outstanding shares of common stock will be deemed
restricted securities, as defined under Rule 144.
Restricted securities may be sold in the public market only if
registered or if they qualify for an exemption from registration
under Rule 144 under the Securities Act, which we summarize
below.
Subject to the transfer restrictions described below, the
restricted shares and the shares held by our affiliates will be
available for sale in the public market as follows:
|
|
|
|
|
shares
will be eligible for sale at various times after the date of
this prospectus pursuant to Rule 144; and
|
|
|
|
shares
subject to the
lock-up
agreements will be eligible for sale at various times beginning
180 days after the date of this prospectus pursuant to
Rule 144.
|
All of our management stockholders are subject to a management
stockholders agreement that restricts, subject to certain
exceptions, including pursuant to an effective registration
statement, transfers of stock for a period of five years
beginning November 17, 2006, and limits the amount of stock
that can be transferred by a management stockholder for an
additional three years after that five year period ends. See
Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions Management Stockholders
Agreement.
The LLC Agreement of Hercules Holding II, LLC contains
restrictions on the transfer of interests by the Investors in
us. See Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions Amended and Restated Limited Liability
Company Agreement of Hercules Holding II, LLC.
Rule 144
In general, under Rule 144 as in effect on the date of this
prospectus, a person who is not one of our affiliates at any
time during the three months preceding a sale, and who has
beneficially owned shares of our common stock for at least six
months, would be entitled to sell an unlimited number of shares
of our common stock provided current public information about us
is available and, after owning such shares for at least one
year, would be entitled to sell an unlimited number of shares of
our common stock without restriction. Our affiliates who have
beneficially owned shares of our common stock for at least six
months are entitled to sell within any three-month period a
number of shares that does not exceed the greater of:
|
|
|
|
|
1% of the number of shares of our common stock then outstanding,
which was equal to
approximately shares
as of March 31, 2010; or
|
|
|
|
the average weekly trading volume of our common stock on
the
during the four calendar weeks preceding the filing of a notice
on Form 144 with respect to the sale.
|
163
Sales under Rule 144 by our affiliates are also subject to
manner of sale provisions and notice requirements and to the
availability of current public information about us.
Lock-Up
Agreements
In connection with this offering, we, our executive officers and
directors, the selling stockholders and the Investors have
agreed with the underwriters, subject to certain exceptions, not
to sell, dispose of or hedge any of our common stock or
securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of common
stock, during the period ending 180 days after the date of
this prospectus, except with the prior written consent of two of
the representatives of the underwriters. This agreement does not
apply to any existing employee benefit plans.
The 180-day
restricted period described in the preceding paragraph will be
automatically extended if:
|
|
|
|
|
during the last 17 days of the 180-day restricted period we
issue an earnings release or material news or a material event
relating to us occurs; or
|
|
|
|
prior to the expiration of the 180-day restricted period, we
announce that we will release earnings results or become aware
that material news or a material event will occur during the
16-day
period beginning on the last day of the 180-day period,
|
in which case the restrictions described in this paragraph will
continue to apply until the expiration of the
18-day
period beginning on the issuance of the earnings release or the
occurrence of the material news or material event. See
Underwriting.
Registration
on
Form S-8
We have filed a registration statement on
Form S-8
under the Securities Act to register shares of common stock
issuable under our 2006 Plan. As a result, shares issued
pursuant to such stock incentive plan, including upon exercise
of stock options, will be eligible for resale in the public
market without restriction, subject to the Rule 144
limitations applicable to affiliates and the restrictions
described under Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions Management Stockholders
Agreement.
As of March 31,
2010, shares
of common stock were reserved pursuant to our stock incentive
plans for future issuance in connection with the exercise of
outstanding options awarded under this plan, and options with
respect
to
of these shares were vested as of March 31, 2010. In
addition to the vested options as of March 31, 2010,
additional options to purchase
approximately shares
of common stock could vest on or prior
to .
Registration
Rights
Pursuant to a registration rights agreement, we have granted the
Investors the right to cause us, in certain instances, at our
expense, to file registration statements under the Securities
Act covering resales of our common stock held by them. These
shares will represent
approximately % of our outstanding
common stock after this offering,
or % if the underwriters exercise
their option to purchase additional shares in full. These shares
also may be sold under Rule 144 under the Securities Act,
depending on their holding period and subject to restrictions in
the case of shares held by persons deemed to be our affiliates.
For a description of rights some holders of common stock have to
require us to register the shares of common stock they own, see
Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.
164
MATERIAL
UNITED STATES FEDERAL INCOME AND ESTATE TAX CONSEQUENCES
TO NON-U.S.
HOLDERS
The following is a summary of the material United States federal
income and estate tax consequences of the purchase, ownership
and disposition of our common stock as of the date hereof.
Except where noted, this summary deals only with common stock
purchased in this offering that is held as a capital asset by a
non-U.S. holder.
Except as modified for estate tax purposes, a
non-U.S. holder
means a beneficial owner of our common stock that is not, for
United States federal income tax purposes, any of the following:
|
|
|
|
|
an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States;
|
|
|
|
a corporation (or any other entity treated as a corporation for
United States federal income tax purposes) created or organized
in or under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or
the District of Columbia;
|
|
|
|
a partnership (including any entity or arrangement treated as a
partnership for United States federal income tax purposes);
|
|
|
|
an estate the income of which is subject to United States
federal income taxation regardless of its source; or
|
|
|
|
a trust if it (1) is subject to the primary supervision of
a court within the United States and one or more United States
persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions
of the trust or (2) has a valid election in effect under
applicable United States Treasury regulations to be treated as a
United States person.
|
This summary is based upon provisions of the Internal Revenue
Code of 1986, as amended (the Code), and
regulations, rulings and judicial decisions as of the date
hereof. Those authorities may be changed, perhaps retroactively,
so as to result in United States federal income and estate tax
consequences different from those summarized below. This summary
does not address all aspects of United States federal income and
estate taxes and does not deal with foreign, state, local or
other tax considerations that may be relevant to
non-U.S. holders
in light of their particular circumstances. In addition, it does
not represent a detailed description of the United States
federal income or estate tax consequences applicable to you if
you are subject to special treatment under the United States
federal income or estate tax laws (including if you are a
financial institution, United States expatriate,
controlled foreign corporation, passive
foreign investment company, person subject to the
alternative minimum tax, dealer in securities, broker, person
who has acquired our common stock as part of a straddle, hedge,
conversion transaction or other integrated investment, or a
partnership or other pass-through entity for United States
federal income tax purposes (or an investor in such a
pass-through entity)). We cannot assure you that a change in law
will not alter significantly the tax considerations that we
describe in this summary.
We have not and will not seek any rulings from the Internal
Revenue Service (the IRS) regarding the matters
discussed below. There can be no assurance that the IRS will not
take positions concerning the tax consequences of the purchase,
ownership or disposition of shares of our common stock that are
different from those discussed below.
If any entity or arrangement treated as a partnership for United
States federal income tax purposes holds our common stock, the
tax treatment of a partner will generally depend upon the status
of the partner and the activities of the partnership and upon
certain determinations made at the partner level. If you are a
partner of a partnership holding our common stock, you should
consult your tax advisors.
If you are considering the purchase of our common stock, you
should consult your own tax advisors concerning the particular
United States federal income and estate tax consequences to you
of the purchase, ownership and disposition of our common stock,
as well as the consequences to you arising under the laws of any
other applicable taxing jurisdiction, in light of your
particular circumstances.
165
This discussion assumes that a non-U.S. holder will structure
its ownership of our common stock so as to not be subject to the
newly enacted withholding tax discussed below under
Additional Withholding Requirements.
Dividends
We do not intend to pay any cash dividends on our common stock
in the foreseeable future. See Dividend Policy.
However, if we do make distributions on our common stock, those
payments will constitute dividends for United States federal
income tax purposes to the extent paid from our current or
accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under United
States federal income tax principles. To the extent those
distributions exceed both our current and our accumulated
earnings and profits, they will constitute a return of capital
and will first reduce your basis in our common stock (determined
on a share by share basis), but not below zero, and then will be
treated as gain from the sale of stock.
In the event that we pay dividends on our common stock, the
dividends paid to a
non-U.S. holder
generally will be subject to withholding of United States
federal income tax at a 30% rate, or such lower rate as may be
specified by an applicable income tax treaty, of the gross
amount of the dividends paid. However, dividends that are
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business by
the
non-U.S. holder
within the United States generally are not subject to the
withholding tax, provided certain certification and disclosure
requirements are satisfied. Instead, such dividends are
generally subject to United States federal income tax on a net
income basis in the same manner as if the
non-U.S. holder
were a United States person as defined under the Code (unless an
applicable income tax treaty provides otherwise). A foreign
corporation may be subject to an additional branch profits
tax at a 30% rate (or such lower rate as may be specified
by an applicable income tax treaty) on its effectively connected
earnings and profits attributable to such dividends.
A
non-U.S. holder
of our common stock who wishes to claim the benefit of an
applicable treaty rate and avoid backup withholding, as
discussed below, for dividends will be required (a) to
complete IRS
Form W-8BEN
(or other applicable form) and certify under penalty of perjury
that such holder is not a United States person as defined under
the Code and is eligible for treaty benefits or (b) if our
common stock is held through certain foreign intermediaries, to
satisfy the relevant certification requirements of applicable
United States Treasury regulations. Special certification and
other requirements apply to certain
non-U.S. holders
that are pass-through entities rather than corporations or
individuals.
A
non-U.S. holder
of our common stock eligible for a reduced rate of United States
withholding tax pursuant to an income tax treaty may obtain a
refund of any excess amounts withheld by timely filing an
appropriate claim for refund with the IRS.
Gain on
Disposition of Common Stock
Any gain realized by a
non-U.S. holder
on the disposition of our common stock generally will not be
subject to United States federal income tax unless:
|
|
|
|
|
the gain is effectively connected with a trade or business of
the
non-U.S. holder
in the United States;
|
|
|
|
the
non-U.S. holder
is an individual who is present in the United States for
183 days or more in the taxable year of that disposition,
and certain other conditions are met; or
|
|
|
|
we are or have been a United States real property holding
corporation for United States federal income tax purposes
at any time during the shorter of the five-year period ending on
the date of the disposition or the period that the
non-U.S. holder
held our common stock.
|
In the case of a
non-U.S. holder
described in the first bullet point immediately above, the gain
will be subject to United States federal income tax a net income
basis generally in the same manner as if the
non-U.S. holder
were a United States person as defined under the Code (unless an
applicable income tax treaty provides otherwise), and a
non-U.S. holder
that is a foreign corporation may be subject to the branch
profits tax equal to 30% of its effectively connected earnings
and profits attributable to such gain (or at such lower rate as
may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty). In the
case of an individual
non-U.S. holder
166
described in the second bullet point immediately above, except
as otherwise provided by an applicable income tax treaty, the
gain, which may be offset by United States source capital
losses, will be subject to a flat 30% tax even though the
individual is not considered a resident of the United States
under the Code.
We believe we are not and do not anticipate becoming a
United States real property holding corporation for
United States federal income tax purposes. If, however, we are
or become a United States real property holding
corporation, so long as our common stock is regularly
traded on an established securities market, only a
non-U.S.
holder who holds or held (at any time during the shorter of the
five year period ending on the date of disposition or the
non-U.S.
holders holding period) more than 5% of our common stock
will be subject to United States federal income tax on the
disposition of our common stock. You should consult your own
advisor about the consequences that could result if we are, or
become, a United States real property holding
corporation.
Information
Reporting and Backup Withholding
We must report annually to the IRS and to each
non-U.S. holder
the amount of dividends paid to such holder and the tax withheld
with respect to such dividends, regardless of whether
withholding was required. Copies of the information returns
reporting such dividends and withholding may also be made
available to the tax authorities in the country in which the
non-U.S. holder
resides under the provisions of an applicable income tax treaty
or agreement.
A
non-U.S. holder
will be subject to backup withholding (currently at a rate of
28%) for dividends paid to such holder unless such holder
certifies under penalty of perjury that it is a
non-U.S. holder
(and the payer does not have actual knowledge or reason to know
that such holder is a United States person as defined under the
Code), or such holder otherwise establishes an exemption.
Information reporting and, depending on the circumstances,
backup withholding will apply to the proceeds of a sale of our
common stock within the United States or conducted through
certain United States-related financial intermediaries, unless
the beneficial owner certifies under penalty of perjury that it
is a
non-U.S. holder
(and the payer does not have actual knowledge or reason to know
that the beneficial owner is a United States person as defined
under the Code), or such owner otherwise establishes an
exemption.
Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules may be
allowed as a refund or a credit against a
non-U.S. holders
United States federal income tax liability provided the required
information is timely furnished to the IRS.
Additional
Withholding Requirements
Under recently enacted legislation, the relevant withholding
agent may be required to withhold 30% of any dividends and the
proceeds of a sale of our common stock paid after
December 31, 2012 to (i) a foreign financial
institution (whether holding stock for its own account or on
behalf of its account holders/investors) unless such foreign
financial institution agrees to verify, report and disclose its
U.S. account holders and meets certain other specified
requirements or (ii) a non-financial foreign entity that is
the beneficial owner of the payment unless such entity certifies
that it does not have any substantial United States owners
or provides the name, address and taxpayer identification number
of each substantial United States owner and such entity meets
certain other specified requirements. Non-U.S. holders should
consult their own tax advisors regarding the effect of this
newly enacted legislation.
Federal
Estate Tax
Our common stock that is owned (or treated as owned) by an
individual who is not a citizen or resident of the United States
(as specially defined for United States federal estate tax
purposes) at the time of death will be included in such
individuals gross estate for United States federal estate
tax purposes, unless an applicable estate or other tax treaty
provides otherwise, and, therefore, may be subject to United
States federal estate tax.
167
UNDERWRITING
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated,
Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and J.P. Morgan Securities
Inc. are acting as representatives of each of the underwriters
named below. Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in a
purchase agreement among us, the selling stockholders and the
underwriters, we and the selling stockholders have agreed to
sell to the underwriters, and each of the underwriters has
agreed, severally and not jointly, to purchase from us and the
selling stockholders, the number of shares of common stock set
forth opposite its name below.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Number
|
|
Underwriter
|
|
of Shares
|
|
|
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated
|
|
|
|
|
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
|
|
|
|
|
J.P. Morgan Securities Inc.
|
|
|
|
|
Barclays Capital Inc.
|
|
|
|
|
Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC
|
|
|
|
|
Deutsche Bank Securities Inc.
|
|
|
|
|
Goldman, Sachs & Co.
|
|
|
|
|
Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated
|
|
|
|
|
Wells Fargo Securities, LLC
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the purchase
agreement, the underwriters have agreed, severally and not
jointly, to purchase all of the shares sold under the purchase
agreement if any of these shares are purchased. If an
underwriter defaults, the purchase agreement provides that the
purchase commitments of the nondefaulting underwriters may be
increased or the purchase agreement may be terminated.
We and the selling stockholders have agreed to indemnify the
underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities
under the Securities Act, or to contribute to payments the
underwriters may be required to make in respect of those
liabilities.
The underwriters are offering the shares, subject to prior sale,
when, as and if issued to and accepted by them, subject to
approval of legal matters by their counsel, including the
validity of the shares, and other conditions contained in the
purchase agreement, such as the receipt by the underwriters of
officers certificates and legal opinions. The underwriters
reserve the right to withdraw, cancel or modify offers to the
public and to reject orders in whole or in part.
Commissions
and Discounts
The representatives have advised us and the selling stockholders
that the underwriters propose initially to offer the shares to
the public at the public offering price set forth on the cover
page of this prospectus and to dealers at that price less a
concession not in excess of $ per
share. After the initial offering, the public offering price,
concession or any other term of the offering may be changed.
The following table shows the public offering price,
underwriting discount and proceeds before expenses to us and the
selling stockholders. The information assumes either no exercise
or full exercise by the underwriters of their overallotment
option.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Per Share
|
|
|
Without Option
|
|
|
With Option
|
|
|
Public offering price
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Underwriting discount
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Proceeds, before expenses, to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Proceeds, before expenses, to the selling stockholders
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
168
The expenses of the offering, not including the underwriting
discount, are estimated at $ and
are payable by us and the selling stockholders.
Overallotment
Option
We and the selling stockholders have granted an option to the
underwriters to purchase up
to additional
shares at the public offering price, less the underwriting
discount. The underwriters may exercise this option for
30 days from the date of this prospectus solely to cover
any overallotments. If the underwriters exercise this option,
each will be obligated, subject to conditions contained in the
purchase agreement, to purchase a number of additional shares
proportionate to that underwriters initial amount
reflected in the above table.
Reserved
Shares
At our request, the underwriters have reserved for sale, at the
initial public offering price, up
to shares
offered by this prospectus for sale to some of our directors,
officers, employees, distributors, dealers, business associates
and related persons. If these persons purchase reserved shares,
this will reduce the number of shares available for sale to the
general public. Any reserved shares that are not so purchased
will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the
same terms as the other shares offered by this prospectus.
No Sales
of Similar Securities
We and the selling stockholders, our executive officers and
directors and the Investors have agreed not to sell or transfer
any common stock or securities convertible into, exchangeable
for, exercisable for, or repayable with common stock, for
180 days after the date of this prospectus without first
obtaining the written consent of two of the representatives.
Specifically, we and these other persons have agreed, with
certain limited exceptions, not to directly or indirectly
|
|
|
|
|
offer, pledge, sell or contract to sell any common stock,
|
|
|
|
sell any option or contract to purchase any common stock,
|
|
|
|
purchase any option or contract to sell any common stock,
|
|
|
|
grant any option, right or warrant for the sale of any common
stock,
|
|
|
|
lend or otherwise dispose of or transfer any common stock,
|
|
|
|
request or demand that we file a registration statement related
to the common stock, or
|
|
|
|
enter into any swap or other agreement that transfers, in whole
or in part, the economic consequence of ownership of any common
stock whether any such swap or transaction is to be settled by
delivery of shares or other securities, in cash or otherwise.
|
This lock-up
provision applies to common stock and to securities convertible
into or exchangeable or exercisable for or repayable with common
stock. It also applies to common stock owned now or acquired
later by the person executing the agreement or for which the
person executing the agreement later acquires the power of
disposition. In the event that either (x) during the last
17 days of the
lock-up
period referred to above, we issue an earnings release or
material news or a material event relating to us occurs or
(y) prior to the expiration of the
lock-up
period, we announce that we will release earnings results or
become aware that material news or a material event will occur
during the
16-day
period beginning on the last day of the
lock-up
period, the restrictions described above shall continue to apply
until the expiration of the
18-day
period beginning on the issuance of the earnings release or the
occurrence of the material news or material event.
169
New York
Stock Exchange Listing
We intend to apply to list the common stock on the New York
Stock Exchange under the symbol HCA. In order to
meet the requirements for listing on that exchange, the
underwriters have undertaken to sell a minimum number of shares
to a minimum number of beneficial owners as required by that
exchange.
After our Recapitalization and prior to the offering, there has
been no public market for our common stock. The initial public
offering price will be determined through negotiations among us,
the selling stockholders and the representatives. In addition to
prevailing market conditions, the factors to be considered in
determining the initial public offering price are
|
|
|
|
|
the valuation multiples of publicly traded companies that the
representatives believe to be comparable to us,
|
|
|
|
our financial information,
|
|
|
|
the history of, and the prospects for, our company and the
industry in which we compete,
|
|
|
|
an assessment of our management, its past and present
operations, and the prospects for, and timing of, our future
revenues,
|
|
|
|
the present state of our development, and
|
|
|
|
the above factors in relation to market values and various
valuation measures of other companies engaged in activities
similar to ours.
|
An active trading market for the shares may not develop. It is
also possible that after the offering the shares will not trade
in the public market at or above the initial public offering
price.
The underwriters do not expect to sell more than 5% of the
shares in the aggregate to accounts over which they exercise
discretionary authority. The underwriters have informed us that
they do not intend to confirm sales to discretionary accounts
without prior written approval of the customer.
Price
Stabilization, Short Positions and Penalty Bids
Until the distribution of the shares is completed, SEC rules may
limit underwriters and selling group members from bidding for
and purchasing our common stock. However, Citigroup Global
Markets Inc., on behalf of the underwriters, may engage in
transactions that stabilize the price of the common stock, such
as bids or purchases to peg, fix or maintain that price.
In connection with the offering, the underwriters may purchase
and sell our common stock in the open market. These transactions
may include short sales, purchases on the open market to cover
positions created by short sales and stabilizing transactions.
Short sales involve the sale by the underwriters of a greater
number of shares than they are required to purchase in the
offering. Covered short sales are sales made in an
amount not greater than the underwriters overallotment
option described above. The underwriters may close out any
covered short position by either exercising their overallotment
option or purchasing shares in the open market. In determining
the source of shares to close out the covered short position,
the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of
shares available for purchase in the open market as compared to
the price at which they may purchase shares through the
overallotment option. Naked short sales are sales in
excess of the overallotment option. The underwriters must close
out any naked short position by purchasing shares in the open
market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if
the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward
pressure on the price of our common stock in the open market
after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase
in the offering. Stabilizing transactions consist of various
bids for or purchases of shares of common stock made by the
underwriters in the open market prior to the completion of the
offering.
The underwriters may also impose a penalty bid. This occurs when
a particular underwriter repays to the underwriters a portion of
the underwriting discount received by it because the
representatives have repurchased shares sold by or for the
account of such underwriter in stabilizing or short covering
transactions.
170
Similar to other purchase transactions, the underwriters
purchases to cover the syndicate short sales may have the effect
of raising or maintaining the market price of our common stock
or preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of our
common stock. As a result, the price of our common stock may be
higher than the price that might otherwise exist in the open
market. The underwriters may conduct these transactions on the
New York Stock Exchange, in the over-the-counter market or
otherwise.
Neither we nor any of the underwriters make any representation
or prediction as to the direction or magnitude of any effect
that the transactions described above may have on the price of
our common stock. In addition, neither we nor any of the
underwriters make any representation that the representatives
will engage in these transactions or that these transactions,
once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice.
Electronic
Offer, Sale and Distribution of Shares
In connection with the offering, certain of the underwriters or
securities dealers may distribute prospectuses by electronic
means, such as
e-mail. In
addition, the representatives may facilitate Internet
distribution for this offering to certain of its Internet
subscription customers. The representatives may allocate a
limited number of shares for sale to its online brokerage
customers. An electronic prospectus is available on Internet web
sites maintained by the representatives. Other than the
prospectus in electronic format, the information on the web
sites of the representatives is not part of this prospectus.
Conflicts
of Interest
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated
and/or its
affiliates indirectly owns in excess of 10% of our issued and
outstanding common stock, and may therefore be deemed to be our
affiliates and have a conflict of interest within
the meaning of NASD Rule 2720 (Rule 2720)
of the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. Therefore
this offering will be conducted in accordance with
Rule 2720, which requires that the initial public offering
price be no higher than that recommended by a qualified
independent underwriter (QIU) which has
participated in the preparation of the registration statement of
which this Prospectus is a part and has performed its usual
standard of due
diligence.
will serve as the QIU and the initial public offering price will
be no higher than the price recommended
by .
We have agreed to indemnify against liabilities incurred in
connection with acting as QIU, including liabilities under the
Securities Act.
Affiliates of one or more of the underwriters are lenders
and/or
agents under the senior secured credit facilities and as such
are entitled to be repaid with the proceeds that are used to
repay the senior secured credit facilities and will receive
their pro rata portion of such repayment. In addition, Banc of
America Securities LLC
and/or its
affiliate Bank of America, N.A., the administrative agent under
our senior secured credit facilities, as well as affiliates of
certain of the other underwriters that are lenders
and/or
agents under our senior secured credit facilities, received fees
in connection with the amendments to the senior secured credit
facilities. See Certain Relationships and Related Party
Transactions Other Relationships. Affiliates
of Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated
indirectly own approximately 25.8% of the shares of our company
and are entitled to seats on our Board of Directors. Certain of
our directors are directors of other companies that are
affiliates of certain of the underwriters.
Affiliates of or funds sponsored by Bain Capital Partners, LLC,
KKR, BAMLCP and certain members of the Frist family provide
management and advisory services to us and our affiliates
pursuant to a management agreement we executed in connection
with our Recapitalization. Upon the completion of this offering,
pursuant to our management agreement, we will pay a fee of
approximately $ million to
Bain Capital Partners, LLC, KKR, BAMLCP and the certain members
of the Frist family party to the management agreement in
connection with its termination.
Affiliates of Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated, whose parent company, Bank of America Corporation,
is also the parent company of one of our Investors, BAML Capital
Partners, the successor organization to Merrill Lynch Global
Private Equity, are permitted to elect three members to our
board of directors pursuant to the LLC Agreement. Christopher J.
Birosak, James D. Forbes and Nathan C. Thorne currently serve on
our board of directors. Mr. Birosak is a managing director
of BAML Capital
171
Partners, Mr. Forbes is the head of Bank of Americas
Global Principal Investments Division, and Mr. Thorne is a
consultant for Merrill Lynch Global Private Equity, Inc., a
wholly owned subsidiary of Bank of America Corporation.
Other
Relationships
Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates
have, from time to time, performed, and may in the future
perform, various financial advisory, investment banking,
commercial banking and other services for us for which they
received or will receive customary fees and expenses.
Furthermore, certain of the underwriters and their respective
affiliates may, from time to time, enter into arms-length
transactions with us in the ordinary course of their business.
The underwriters or their affiliates have in the past engaged,
and may in the future engage, in transactions with and perform
services for, including commercial banking, financial advisory
and investment banking services, us and our affiliates in the
ordinary course of business for which they have received or will
receive customary fees and expenses. In addition, certain of the
underwriters or their affiliates have in the past, and may in
the future, sold or leased equipment to us in the ordinary
course of business.
Notice to
Prospective Investors in the EEA
In relation to each Member State of the European Economic Area
which has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a
Relevant Member State) an offer to the public of any
shares which are the subject of the offering contemplated by
this prospectus may not be made in that Relevant Member State,
except that an offer to the public in that Relevant Member State
of any shares may be made at any time under the following
exemptions under the Prospectus Directive, if they have been
implemented in that Relevant Member State:
(a) to legal entities which are authorized or regulated to
operate in the financial markets or, if not so authorized or
regulated, whose corporate purpose is solely to invest in
securities;
(b) to any legal entity which has two or more of
(1) an average of at least 250 employees during the
last financial year; (2) a total balance sheet of more than
43,000,000 and (3) an annual net turnover of more
than 50,000,000, as shown in its last annual or
consolidated accounts;
(c) by the underwriters to fewer than 100 natural or legal
persons (other than qualified investors as defined
in the Prospectus Directive) subject to obtaining the prior
consent of the representatives for any such offer; or
(d) in any other circumstances falling within
Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive;
provided that no such offer of shares shall result in a
requirement for the publication by us or any representative of a
prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus
Directive.
Any person making or intending to make any offer of shares
within the EEA should only do so in circumstances in which no
obligation arises for us or any of the underwriters to produce a
prospectus for such offer. Neither we nor the underwriters have
authorized, nor do they authorize, the making of any offer of
shares through any financial intermediary, other than offers
made by the underwriters which constitute the final offering of
shares contemplated in this prospectus.
For the purposes of this provision, and your representation
below, the expression an offer to the public in
relation to any shares in any Relevant Member State means the
communication in any form and by any means of sufficient
information on the terms of the offer and any shares to be
offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase any
shares, as the same may be varied in that Relevant Member State
by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that
Relevant Member State and the expression Prospectus
Directive means Directive 2003/71/EC and includes any
relevant implementing measure in each Relevant Member State.
172
Each person in a Relevant Member State who receives any
communication in respect of, or who acquires any shares under,
the offer of shares contemplated by this prospectus will be
deemed to have represented, warranted and agreed to and with us
and each underwriter that:
(A) it is a qualified investor within the
meaning of the law in that Relevant Member State implementing
Article 2(1)(e) of the Prospectus Directive; and
(B) in the case of any shares acquired by it as a financial
intermediary, as that term is used in Article 3(2) of the
Prospectus Directive, (i) the shares acquired by it in the
offering have not been acquired on behalf of, nor have they been
acquired with a view to their offer or resale to, persons in any
Relevant Member State other than qualified investors
(as defined in the Prospectus Directive), or in circumstances in
which the prior consent of the representatives has been given to
the offer or resale; or (ii) where shares have been
acquired by it on behalf of persons in any Relevant Member State
other than qualified investors, the offer of those shares to it
is not treated under the Prospectus Directive as having been
made to such persons.
In addition, in the United Kingdom, this document is being
distributed only to, and is directed only at, and any offer
subsequently made may only be directed at persons who are
qualified investors (as defined in the Prospectus
Directive) (i) who have professional experience in matters
relating to investments falling within Article 19
(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000
(Financial Promotion) Order 2005, as amended (the
Order)
and/or
(ii) who are high net worth companies (or persons to whom
it may otherwise be lawfully communicated) falling within
Article 49(2)(a) to (d) of the Order (all such persons
together being referred to as relevant persons).
This document must not be acted on or relied on in the United
Kingdom by persons who are not relevant persons. In the United
Kingdom, any investment or investment activity to which this
document relates is only available to, and will be engaged in
with, relevant persons.
Notice to
Prospective Investors in Switzerland
This document, as well as any other material relating to the
shares which are the subject of the offering contemplated by
this prospectus, do not constitute an issue prospectus pursuant
to Article 652a
and/or 1156
of the Swiss Code of Obligations. The shares will not be listed
on the SIX Swiss Exchange and, therefore, the documents relating
to the shares, including, but not limited to, this document, do
not claim to comply with the disclosure standards of the listing
rules of SIX Swiss Exchange and corresponding prospectus schemes
annexed to the listing rules of the SIX Swiss Exchange. The
shares are being offered in Switzerland by way of a private
placement, i.e., to a small number of selected investors
only, without any public offer and only to investors who do not
purchase the shares with the intention to distribute them to the
public. The investors will be individually approached by the
issuer from time to time. This document, as well as any other
material relating to the shares, is personal and confidential
and do not constitute an offer to any other person. This
document may only be used by those investors to whom it has been
handed out in connection with the offering described herein and
may neither directly nor indirectly be distributed or made
available to other persons without express consent of the
issuer. It may not be used in connection with any other offer
and shall in particular not be copied
and/or
distributed to the public in (or from) Switzerland.
Notice to
Prospective Investors in the Dubai International Financial
Centre
This document relates to an exempt offer in accordance with the
Offered Securities Rules of the Dubai Financial Services
Authority. This document is intended for distribution only to
persons of a type specified in those rules. It must not be
delivered to, or relied on by, any other person. The Dubai
Financial Services Authority has no responsibility for reviewing
or verifying any documents in connection with exempt offers. The
Dubai Financial Services Authority has not approved this
document nor taken steps to verify the information set out in
it, and has no responsibility for it. The shares which are the
subject of the offering contemplated by this prospectus may be
illiquid
and/or
subject to restrictions on their resale. Prospective purchasers
of the shares offered should conduct their own due diligence on
the shares. If you do not understand the contents of this
document you should consult an authorised financial adviser.
173
Notice to
Prospective Investors in Hong Kong
This prospectus has not been approved by or registered with the
Securities and Futures Commission of Hong Kong or the Registrar
of Companies of Hong Kong. The shares will not be offered or
sold in Hong Kong other than (a) to professional
investors as defined in the Securities and Futures
Ordinance (Cap. 571) of Hong Kong and any rules made under
that Ordinance; or (b) in other circumstances which do not
result in the document being a prospectus as defined
in the Companies Ordinance (Cap. 32) of Hong Kong or which
do not constitute an offer to the public within the meaning of
that Ordinance. No advertisement, invitation or document
relating to the shares which is directed at, or the contents of
which are likely to be accessed or read by, the public of Hong
Kong (except if permitted to do so under the securities laws of
Hong Kong) has been issued or will be issued in Hong Kong or
elsewhere other than with respect to shares which are or are
intended to be disposed of only to persons outside Hong Kong or
only to professional investors as defined in the
Securities and Futures Ordinance and any rules made under that
Ordinance.
Notice to
Prospective Investors in Singapore
This prospectus has not been registered as a prospectus with the
Monetary Authority of Singapore. Accordingly, this prospectus
and any other document or material in connection with the offer
or sale, or invitation for subscription or purchase, of the
shares may not be circulated or distributed, nor may the shares
be offered or sold, or be made the subject of an invitation for
subscription or purchase, whether directly or indirectly, to
persons in Singapore other than (i) to an institutional
investor under Section 274 of the Securities and Futures
Act (Chapter 289) (the SFA), (ii) to a
relevant person, or any person pursuant to Section 275(1A),
and in accordance with the conditions, specified in
Section 275 of the SFA or (iii) otherwise pursuant to,
and in accordance with the conditions of, any other applicable
provision of the SFA. Where the shares are subscribed or
purchased under Section 275 by a relevant person which is:
(a) a corporation (which is not an accredited investor) the
sole business of which is to hold investments and the entire
share capital of which is owned by one or more individuals, each
of whom is an accredited investor; or (b) a trust (where
the trustee is not an accredited investor) whose sole purpose is
to hold investments and each beneficiary is an accredited
investor, then shares, debentures and units of shares and
debentures of that corporation or the beneficiaries rights
and interest in that trust shall not be transferable for
6 months after that corporation or that trust has acquired
the shares under Section 275 except: (i) to an
institutional investor under Section 274 of the SFA or to a
relevant person, or any person pursuant to Section 275(1A),
and in accordance with the conditions, specified in
Section 275 of the SFA; (ii) where no consideration is
given for the transfer; or (iii) by operation of law.
Notice to
Prospective Investors in Japan
The shares have not been and will not be registered under the
Financial Instruments and Exchange Law of Japan (Law No. 25
of 1948, as amended) and, accordingly, will not be offered or
sold, directly or indirectly, in Japan, or for the benefit of
any Japanese Person or to others for re-offering or resale,
directly or indirectly, in Japan or to any Japanese Person,
except in compliance with all applicable laws, regulations and
ministerial guidelines promulgated by relevant Japanese
governmental or regulatory authorities in effect at the relevant
time. For the purposes of this paragraph, Japanese
Person shall mean any person resident in Japan, including
any corporation or other entity organized under the laws of
Japan.
174
LEGAL
MATTERS
Certain legal matters in connection with the offering will be
passed upon for us by Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP,
New York, New York, and certain regulatory matters will be
passed upon for us by Bass, Berry & Sims PLC,
Nashville, Tennessee. Certain legal matters in connection with
the offering will be passed upon for the underwriters by Cahill
Gordon & Reindel
llp, New York, New
York. An investment vehicle comprised of several partners of
Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP, members of their
families, related persons and others own interests representing
less than 1% of the capital commitments of the KKR Millennium
Fund, L.P. and KKR 2006 Fund L.P.
EXPERTS
The consolidated financial statements of HCA Inc. as of
December 31, 2009 and 2008, and for each of the three years
in the period ended December 31, 2009, appearing in this
prospectus and registration statement, and the effectiveness of
HCA Inc.s internal control over financial reporting as of
December 31, 2009, have been audited by Ernst &
Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set
forth in its reports thereon included elsewhere herein. Such
consolidated financial statements and HCA Inc. managements
assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over
financial reporting as of December 31, 2009 are included in
reliance upon such reports given on the authority of such firm
as experts in accounting and auditing.
175
WHERE YOU
CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION
We file certain reports with the Securities and Exchange
Commission (the SEC), including annual reports on
Form 10-K,
quarterly reports on
Form 10-Q
and current reports on
Form 8-K.
The public may read and copy any materials we file with the SEC
at the SECs Public Reference Room at
100 F Street, N.E., Washington, DC 20549. The public
may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference
Room by calling the SEC at
1-800-SEC-0330.
We are an electronic filer, and the SEC maintains an Internet
site at
http://www.sec.gov
that contains the reports, proxy and information statements and
other information we file electronically with the SEC. Our
website address is www.hcahealthcare.com. Please note that our
website address is provided as an inactive textual reference
only. We make available free of charge, through our website, our
annual report on
Form 10-K,
quarterly reports on
Form 10-Q,
current reports on
Form 8-K
and all amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant
to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, as soon as
reasonably practicable after such material is electronically
filed with or furnished to the SEC. The information provided on
our website is not part of this prospectus, and is therefore not
incorporated by reference unless such information is
specifically referenced elsewhere in this prospectus.
Our Code of Conduct is available free of charge upon request to
our Corporate Secretary, HCA Inc., One Park Plaza, Nashville,
Tennessee 37203.
176
HCA
INC.
Audited
Financial Statements for the Years Ended December 31, 2009,
2008 and 2007
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-2
|
|
|
|
|
F-3
|
|
|
|
|
F-5
|
|
|
|
|
F-6
|
|
|
|
|
F-7
|
|
|
|
|
F-8
|
|
|
|
|
F-9
|
|
|
|
|
F-44
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for the
Quarters Ended March 31, 2010 and 2009:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-45
|
|
|
|
|
F-46
|
|
|
|
|
F-47
|
|
Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements
|
|
|
F-48
|
|
F-1
Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining
effective internal control over financial reporting, as such
term is defined in Exchange Act
Rule 13a-15(f).
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over
financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.
Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can
provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial
statement preparation and presentation.
Under the supervision and with the participation of our
management, including our principal executive officer and
principal financial officer, we conducted an assessment of the
effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting
based on the framework in Internal Control
Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring
Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on our
assessment under the framework in Internal Control
Integrated Framework, our management concluded that our internal
control over financial reporting was effective as of
December 31, 2009.
Ernst & Young, LLP, the independent registered public
accounting firm that audited our consolidated financial
statements, has issued a report on our internal control over
financial reporting, which is included herein.
F-2
REPORT OF
THE INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
The Board of Directors and Stockholders
HCA Inc.
We have audited HCA Inc.s internal control over financial
reporting as of December 31, 2009, based on criteria
established in Internal Control Integrated Framework
issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the
Treadway Commission (the COSO criteria). HCA Inc.s
management is responsible for maintaining effective internal
control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the
effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting
included in the accompanying Managements Report on
Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is
to express an opinion on the companys internal control
over financial reporting based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the
Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those
standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control
over financial reporting was maintained in all material
respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of
internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk
that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the
design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on
the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we
considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our
audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
A companys internal control over financial reporting is a
process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the
reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of
financial statements for external purposes in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles. A companys
internal control over financial reporting includes those
policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance
of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly
reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the
company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions
are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial
statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting
principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company
are being made only in accordance with authorizations of
management and directors of the company; and (3) provide
reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of
unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the
companys assets that could have a material effect on the
financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over
financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.
Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future
periods are subject to the risk that controls may become
inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree
of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
In our opinion, HCA Inc. maintained, in all material respects,
effective internal control over financial reporting as of
December 31, 2009, based on the COSO criteria.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the
Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the
consolidated balance sheets of HCA Inc. as of December 31,
2009 and 2008, and the related consolidated statements of
income, stockholders deficit, and cash flows for each of
the three years in the period ended December 31, 2009 and
our report dated March 1, 2010 expressed an unqualified
opinion thereon.
/s/ Ernst & Young LLP
Nashville, Tennessee
March 1, 2010
F-3
REPORT OF
INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
The Board of Directors and Stockholders
HCA Inc.
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of
HCA Inc. as of December 31, 2009 and 2008, and the related
consolidated statements of income, stockholders deficit,
and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended
December 31, 2009. These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Companys management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial
statements based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the
Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those
standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are
free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a
test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in
the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the
accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial
statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a
reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above
present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated
financial position of HCA Inc. at December 31, 2009 and
2008, and the consolidated results of its operations and its
cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended
December 31, 2009, in conformity with U.S. generally
accepted accounting principles.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the
Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), HCA
Inc.s internal control over financial reporting as of
December 31, 2009, based on criteria established in
Internal Control Integrated Framework issued by the
Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission
and our report dated March 1, 2010 expressed an unqualified
opinion thereon.
Nashville, Tennessee
March 1, 2010
F-4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
30,052
|
|
|
$
|
28,374
|
|
|
$
|
26,858
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
11,958
|
|
|
|
11,440
|
|
|
|
10,714
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
4,868
|
|
|
|
4,620
|
|
|
|
4,395
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
4,724
|
|
|
|
4,554
|
|
|
|
4,233
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
3,276
|
|
|
|
3,409
|
|
|
|
3,130
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(246
|
)
|
|
|
(223
|
)
|
|
|
(206
|
)
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
1,425
|
|
|
|
1,416
|
|
|
|
1,426
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
1,987
|
|
|
|
2,021
|
|
|
|
2,215
|
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
(97
|
)
|
|
|
(471
|
)
|
Impairment of long-lived assets
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
28,050
|
|
|
|
27,204
|
|
|
|
25,460
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
2,002
|
|
|
|
1,170
|
|
|
|
1,398
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
627
|
|
|
|
268
|
|
|
|
316
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
1,375
|
|
|
|
902
|
|
|
|
1,082
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
321
|
|
|
|
229
|
|
|
|
208
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
1,054
|
|
|
$
|
673
|
|
|
$
|
874
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated
financial statements.
F-5
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
ASSETS
|
Current assets:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents
|
|
$
|
312
|
|
|
$
|
465
|
|
Accounts receivable, less allowance for doubtful accounts of
$4,860 and $4,741
|
|
|
3,692
|
|
|
|
3,780
|
|
Inventories
|
|
|
802
|
|
|
|
737
|
|
Deferred income taxes
|
|
|
1,192
|
|
|
|
914
|
|
Other
|
|
|
579
|
|
|
|
405
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,577
|
|
|
|
6,301
|
|
Property and equipment, at cost:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Land
|
|
|
1,202
|
|
|
|
1,189
|
|
Buildings
|
|
|
9,108
|
|
|
|
8,670
|
|
Equipment
|
|
|
13,575
|
|
|
|
12,833
|
|
Construction in progress
|
|
|
784
|
|
|
|
1,022
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24,669
|
|
|
|
23,714
|
|
Accumulated depreciation
|
|
|
(13,242
|
)
|
|
|
(12,185
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,427
|
|
|
|
11,529
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investments of insurance subsidiary
|
|
|
1,166
|
|
|
|
1,422
|
|
Investments in and advances to affiliates
|
|
|
853
|
|
|
|
842
|
|
Goodwill
|
|
|
2,577
|
|
|
|
2,580
|
|
Deferred loan costs
|
|
|
418
|
|
|
|
458
|
|
Other
|
|
|
1,113
|
|
|
|
1,148
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
$
|
24,280
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS DEFICIT
|
Current liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts payable
|
|
$
|
1,460
|
|
|
$
|
1,370
|
|
Accrued salaries
|
|
|
849
|
|
|
|
854
|
|
Other accrued expenses
|
|
|
1,158
|
|
|
|
1,282
|
|
Long-term debt due within one year
|
|
|
846
|
|
|
|
404
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,313
|
|
|
|
3,910
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Long-term debt
|
|
|
24,824
|
|
|
|
26,585
|
|
Professional liability risks
|
|
|
1,057
|
|
|
|
1,108
|
|
Income taxes and other liabilities
|
|
|
1,768
|
|
|
|
1,782
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity securities with contingent redemption rights
|
|
|
147
|
|
|
|
155
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stockholders deficit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Common stock $0.01 par; authorized
125,000,000 shares 2009 and 2008; outstanding
94,637,400 shares 2009 and
94,367,500 shares 2008
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
Capital in excess of par value
|
|
|
226
|
|
|
|
165
|
|
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
|
|
|
(450
|
)
|
|
|
(604
|
)
|
Retained deficit
|
|
|
(8,763
|
)
|
|
|
(9,817
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stockholders deficit attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
|
(8,986
|
)
|
|
|
(10,255
|
)
|
Noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
1,008
|
|
|
|
995
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(7,978
|
)
|
|
|
(9,260
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
$
|
24,280
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated
financial statements.
F-6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity (Deficit) Attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Common Stock
|
|
|
Capital in
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
Attributable to
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shares
|
|
|
Par
|
|
|
Excess of
|
|
|
Comprehensive
|
|
|
Retained
|
|
|
Noncontrolling
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(000)
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Par Value
|
|
|
Income (Loss)
|
|
|
Deficit
|
|
|
Interests
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
Balances, December 31, 2006
|
|
|
92,218
|
|
|
$
|
1
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
16
|
|
|
$
|
(11,391
|
)
|
|
$
|
907
|
|
|
$
|
(10,467
|
)
|
Comprehensive income:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
874
|
|
|
|
208
|
|
|
|
1,082
|
|
Other comprehensive income:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in fair value of investment securities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
Foreign currency translation adjustments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(15
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(15
|
)
|
Defined benefit plans
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23
|
|
Change in fair value of derivative instruments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(194
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(194
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(188
|
)
|
|
|
874
|
|
|
|
208
|
|
|
|
894
|
|
Equity contributions
|
|
|
1,961
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
60
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
60
|
|
Share-based benefit plans
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
Distributions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(152
|
)
|
|
|
(152
|
)
|
Other
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
28
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
38
|
|
|
|
(25
|
)
|
|
|
41
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balances, December 31, 2007
|
|
|
94,182
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
112
|
|
|
|
(172
|
)
|
|
|
(10,479
|
)
|
|
|
938
|
|
|
|
(9,600
|
)
|
Comprehensive income:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
673
|
|
|
|
229
|
|
|
|
902
|
|
Other comprehensive income:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in fair value of investment securities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(44
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(44
|
)
|
Foreign currency translation adjustments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(62
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(62
|
)
|
Defined benefit plans
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(62
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(62
|
)
|
Change in fair value of derivative instruments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(264
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(264
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(432
|
)
|
|
|
673
|
|
|
|
229
|
|
|
|
470
|
|
Share-based benefit plans
|
|
|
185
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
40
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
40
|
|
Distributions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(178
|
)
|
|
|
(178
|
)
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
13
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(11
|
)
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balances, December 31, 2008
|
|
|
94,367
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
165
|
|
|
|
(604
|
)
|
|
|
(9,817
|
)
|
|
|
995
|
|
|
|
(9,260
|
)
|
Comprehensive income:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,054
|
|
|
|
321
|
|
|
|
1,375
|
|
Other comprehensive income:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in fair value of investment securities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
44
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
44
|
|
Foreign currency translation adjustments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
25
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
25
|
|
Change in fair value of derivative instruments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
85
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
85
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total comprehensive income
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
154
|
|
|
|
1,054
|
|
|
|
321
|
|
|
|
1,529
|
|
Share-based benefit plans
|
|
|
270
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
47
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
47
|
|
Distributions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(330
|
)
|
|
|
(330
|
)
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
14
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
22
|
|
|
|
36
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balances, December 31, 2009
|
|
|
94,637
|
|
|
$
|
1
|
|
|
$
|
226
|
|
|
$
|
(450
|
)
|
|
$
|
(8,763
|
)
|
|
$
|
1,008
|
|
|
$
|
(7,978
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated
financial statements.
F-7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Cash flows from operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
$
|
1,375
|
|
|
$
|
902
|
|
|
$
|
1,082
|
|
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by
operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Increase (decrease) in cash from operating assets and
liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts receivable
|
|
|
(3,180
|
)
|
|
|
(3,328
|
)
|
|
|
(3,345
|
)
|
Inventories and other assets
|
|
|
(191
|
)
|
|
|
159
|
|
|
|
(241
|
)
|
Accounts payable and accrued expenses
|
|
|
280
|
|
|
|
(198
|
)
|
|
|
(29
|
)
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
3,276
|
|
|
|
3,409
|
|
|
|
3,130
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
1,425
|
|
|
|
1,416
|
|
|
|
1,426
|
|
Income taxes
|
|
|
(520
|
)
|
|
|
(448
|
)
|
|
|
(105
|
)
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
(97
|
)
|
|
|
(471
|
)
|
Impairment of long-lived assets
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
Amortization of deferred loan costs
|
|
|
80
|
|
|
|
79
|
|
|
|
78
|
|
Share-based compensation
|
|
|
40
|
|
|
|
32
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
Pay-in-kind
interest
|
|
|
58
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
46
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(9
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by operating activities
|
|
|
2,747
|
|
|
|
1,990
|
|
|
|
1,564
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from investing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Purchase of property and equipment
|
|
|
(1,317
|
)
|
|
|
(1,600
|
)
|
|
|
(1,444
|
)
|
Acquisition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
(61
|
)
|
|
|
(85
|
)
|
|
|
(32
|
)
|
Disposal of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
41
|
|
|
|
193
|
|
|
|
767
|
|
Change in investments
|
|
|
303
|
|
|
|
21
|
|
|
|
207
|
|
Other
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
23
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in investing activities
|
|
|
(1,035
|
)
|
|
|
(1,467
|
)
|
|
|
(479
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from financing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Issuances of long-term debt
|
|
|
2,979
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net change in revolving bank credit facilities
|
|
|
(1,335
|
)
|
|
|
700
|
|
|
|
(520
|
)
|
Repayment of long-term debt
|
|
|
(3,103
|
)
|
|
|
(960
|
)
|
|
|
(750
|
)
|
Distributions to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
(330
|
)
|
|
|
(178
|
)
|
|
|
(152
|
)
|
Payment of debt issuance costs
|
|
|
(70
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Issuances of common stock
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
100
|
|
Other
|
|
|
(6
|
)
|
|
|
(13
|
)
|
|
|
(4
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in financing activities
|
|
|
(1,865
|
)
|
|
|
(451
|
)
|
|
|
(1,326
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in cash and cash equivalents
|
|
|
(153
|
)
|
|
|
72
|
|
|
|
(241
|
)
|
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
|
|
|
465
|
|
|
|
393
|
|
|
|
634
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
|
|
$
|
312
|
|
|
$
|
465
|
|
|
$
|
393
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest payments
|
|
$
|
1,751
|
|
|
$
|
1,979
|
|
|
$
|
2,163
|
|
Income tax payments, net of refunds
|
|
$
|
1,147
|
|
|
$
|
716
|
|
|
$
|
421
|
|
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated
financial statements.
F-8
HCA
INC.
|
|
NOTE 1
|
ACCOUNTING
POLICIES
|
Merger,
Recapitalization and Reporting Entity
On November 17, 2006, HCA Inc. completed its merger (the
Merger) with Hercules Acquisition Corporation,
pursuant to which the Company was acquired by Hercules Holding
II, LLC (Hercules Holding), a Delaware limited
liability company owned by a private investor group comprised of
affiliates of or funds sponsored by Bain Capital Partners, LLC,
Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., Merrill Lynch Global
Private Equity (now BAML Capital Partners) (each a
Sponsor), affiliates of Citigroup Inc. and Bank of
America Corporation (the Sponsor Assignees) and
affiliates of HCA founder, Dr. Thomas F. Frist, Jr., (the
Frist Entities, and together with the Sponsors and
the Sponsor Assignees, the Investors), and by
members of management and certain other investors. The Merger,
the financing transactions related to the Merger and other
related transactions are collectively referred to in this
prospectus as the Recapitalization. The Merger was
accounted for as a recapitalization in our financial statements,
with no adjustments to the historical basis of our assets and
liabilities. As a result of the Recapitalization, our
outstanding capital stock is owned by the Investors, certain
members of management and key employees. On April 29, 2008,
we registered our common stock pursuant to Section 12(g) of
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, thus subjecting
us to the reporting requirements of Section 13(a) of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. Our common stock is
not traded on a national securities exchange.
HCA Inc. is a holding company whose affiliates own and operate
hospitals and related health care entities. The term
affiliates includes direct and indirect subsidiaries
of HCA Inc. and partnerships and joint ventures in which such
subsidiaries are partners. At December 31, 2009, these
affiliates owned and operated 155 hospitals, 97 freestanding
surgery centers and provided extensive outpatient and ancillary
services. Affiliates of HCA are also partners in joint ventures
that own and operate eight hospitals and eight freestanding
surgery centers, which are accounted for using the equity
method. The Companys facilities are located in
20 states and England. The terms HCA,
Company, we, our or
us, as used in these notes to consolidated financial
statements, refer to HCA Inc. and its affiliates unless
otherwise stated or indicated by context.
Basis
of Presentation
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with
generally accepted accounting principles requires management to
make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported
in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes.
Actual results could differ from those estimates.
The consolidated financial statements include all subsidiaries
and entities controlled by HCA. We generally define
control as ownership of a majority of the voting
interest of an entity. The consolidated financial statements
include entities in which we absorb a majority of the
entitys expected losses, receive a majority of the
entitys expected residual returns, or both, as a result of
ownership, contractual or other financial interests in the
entity. Significant intercompany transactions have been
eliminated. Investments in entities we do not control, but in
which we have a substantial ownership interest and can exercise
significant influence, are accounted for using the equity method.
We have completed various acquisitions and joint venture
transactions. The accounts of these entities have been included
in our consolidated financial statements for periods subsequent
to our acquisition of controlling interests. The majority of our
expenses are cost of revenue items. Costs that could
be classified as general and administrative include our
corporate office costs, which were $164 million,
$174 million and $169 million for the years ended
December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
Revenues
Revenues consist primarily of net patient service revenues that
are recorded based upon established billing rates less
allowances for contractual adjustments. Revenues are recorded
during the period the health care
F-9
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 1
|
ACCOUNTING
POLICIES (Continued)
|
services are provided, based upon the estimated amounts due from
the patients and third-party payers. Third-party payers include
federal and state agencies (under the Medicare and Medicaid
programs), managed care health plans, commercial insurance
companies and employers. Estimates of contractual allowances
under managed care health plans are based upon the payment terms
specified in the related contractual agreements. Contractual
payment terms in managed care agreements are generally based
upon predetermined rates per diagnosis, per diem rates or
discounted
fee-for-service
rates.
Laws and regulations governing the Medicare and Medicaid
programs are complex and subject to interpretation. As a result,
there is at least a reasonable possibility recorded estimates
will change by a material amount. Estimated reimbursement
amounts are adjusted in subsequent periods as cost reports are
prepared and filed and as final settlements are determined (in
relation to certain government programs, primarily Medicare,
this is generally referred to as the cost report
filing and settlement process). The adjustments to estimated
Medicare and Medicaid reimbursement amounts and
disproportionate-share funds, which resulted in net increases to
revenues, related primarily to cost reports filed during the
respective year were $40 million, $32 million and
$47 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. The
adjustments to estimated reimbursement amounts, which resulted
in net increases to revenues, related primarily to cost reports
filed during previous years were $60 million,
$35 million and $83 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007,
respectively.
The Emergency Medical Treatment and Active Labor Act
(EMTALA) requires any hospital participating in the
Medicare program to conduct an appropriate medical screening
examination of every person who presents to the hospitals
emergency room for treatment and, if the individual is suffering
from an emergency medical condition, to either stabilize the
condition or make an appropriate transfer of the individual to a
facility able to handle the condition. The obligation to screen
and stabilize emergency medical conditions exists regardless of
an individuals ability to pay for treatment. Federal and
state laws and regulations, including but not limited to EMTALA,
require, and our commitment to providing quality patient care
encourages, us to provide services to patients who are
financially unable to pay for the health care services they
receive. Because we do not pursue collection of amounts
determined to qualify as charity care, they are not reported in
revenues. Patients treated at hospitals for nonelective care,
who have income at or below 200% of the federal poverty level,
are eligible for charity care. Charity care (amounts are based
on our gross charges) totaled $2.151 billion,
$1.747 billion and $1.530 billion in 2009, 2008 and
2007, respectively. The federal poverty level is established by
the federal government and is based on income and family size.
We provide discounts to uninsured patients who do not qualify
for Medicaid or charity care. These discounts are similar to
those provided to many local managed care plans and totaled
$2.935 billion, $1.853 billion and $1.474 billion
in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively. In implementing the
discount policy, we first attempt to qualify uninsured patients
for Medicaid, other federal or state assistance or charity care.
If an uninsured patient does not qualify for these programs, the
uninsured discount is applied.
Cash
and Cash Equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents include highly liquid investments with
a maturity of three months or less when purchased. Our insurance
subsidiarys cash equivalent investments in excess of the
amounts required to pay estimated professional liability claims
during the next twelve months are not included in cash and cash
equivalents as these funds are not available for general
corporate purposes. Carrying values of cash and cash equivalents
approximate fair value due to the short-term nature of these
instruments.
Our cash management system provides for daily investment of
available balances and the funding of outstanding checks when
presented for payment. Outstanding, but unpresented, checks
totaling $392 million and $382 million at
December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, have been
included in accounts payable in
F-10
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 1
|
ACCOUNTING
POLICIES (Continued)
|
the consolidated balance sheets. Upon presentation for payment,
these checks are funded through available cash balances or our
credit facility.
Accounts
Receivable
We receive payments for services rendered from federal and state
agencies (under the Medicare and Medicaid programs), managed
care health plans, commercial insurance companies, employers and
patients. During the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008
and 2007, 23%, 23% and 24%, respectively, of our revenues
related to patients participating in the
fee-for-service
Medicare program and 7%, 6% and 5%, respectively, of our
revenues related to patients participating in managed Medicare
programs. We recognize that revenues and receivables from
government agencies are significant to our operations, but do
not believe there are significant credit risks associated with
these government agencies. We do not believe there are any other
significant concentrations of revenues from any particular payer
that would subject us to any significant credit risks in the
collection of our accounts receivable.
Additions to the allowance for doubtful accounts are made by
means of the provision for doubtful accounts. Accounts written
off as uncollectible are deducted from the allowance for
doubtful accounts and subsequent recoveries are added. The
amount of the provision for doubtful accounts is based upon
managements assessment of historical and expected net
collections, business and economic conditions, trends in
federal, state and private employer health care coverage and
other collection indicators. The provision for doubtful accounts
and the allowance for doubtful accounts relate primarily to
uninsured amounts (including copayment and
deductible amounts from patients who have health care coverage)
due directly from patients. Accounts are written off when all
reasonable internal and external collection efforts have been
performed. We consider the return of an account from the
secondary external collection agency to be the culmination of
our reasonable collection efforts and the timing basis for
writing off the account balance. Writeoffs are based upon
specific identification and the writeoff process requires a
writeoff adjustment entry to the patient accounting system.
Management relies on the results of detailed reviews of
historical writeoffs and recoveries at facilities that represent
a majority of our revenues and accounts receivable (the
hindsight analysis) as a primary source of
information to utilize in estimating the collectibility of our
accounts receivable. We perform the hindsight analysis
quarterly, utilizing rolling twelve-months accounts receivable
collection and writeoff data. At December 31, 2009 and
2008, the allowance for doubtful accounts represented
approximately 94% and 92%, respectively, of the
$5.176 billion and $5.148 billion, respectively,
patient due accounts receivable balance. The patient due
accounts receivable balance represents the estimated uninsured
portion of our accounts receivable. The estimated uninsured
portion of Medicaid pending and uninsured discount pending
accounts is included in our patient due accounts receivable
balance. Days revenues in accounts receivable were 45 days,
49 days and 53 days at December 31, 2009, 2008
and 2007, respectively. Adverse changes in general economic
conditions, patient accounting service center operations, payer
mix or trends in federal or state governmental health care
coverage could affect our collection of accounts receivable,
cash flows and results of operations.
Inventories
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost
(first-in,
first-out) or market.
Property
and Equipment and Amortizable Intangibles
Depreciation expense, computed using the straight-line method,
was $1.419 billion in 2009, $1.412 billion in 2008 and
$1.421 billion in 2007. Buildings and improvements are
depreciated over estimated useful lives ranging generally from
10 to 40 years. Estimated useful lives of equipment vary
generally from four to 10 years.
F-11
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 1
|
ACCOUNTING
POLICIES (Continued)
|
Debt issuance costs are amortized based upon the terms of the
respective debt obligations. The gross carrying amount of
deferred loan costs at December 31, 2009 and 2008 was
$689 million and $650 million, respectively, and
accumulated amortization was $271 million and
$192 million, respectively. Amortization of deferred loan
costs is included in interest expense and was $80 million,
$79 million and $78 million for 2009, 2008 and 2007,
respectively.
When events, circumstances or operating results indicate the
carrying values of certain long-lived assets and related
identifiable intangible assets (excluding goodwill) expected to
be held and used, might be impaired, we prepare projections of
the undiscounted future cash flows expected to result from the
use of the assets and their eventual disposition. If the
projections indicate the recorded amounts are not expected to be
recoverable, such amounts are reduced to estimated fair value.
Fair value may be estimated based upon internal evaluations that
include quantitative analyses of revenues and cash flows,
reviews of recent sales of similar facilities and independent
appraisals.
Long-lived assets to be disposed of are reported at the lower of
their carrying amounts or fair value less costs to sell or
close. The estimates of fair value are usually based upon recent
sales of similar assets and market responses based upon
discussions with and offers received from potential buyers.
Investments
of Insurance Subsidiary
At December 31, 2009 and 2008, the investments of our
wholly-owned insurance subsidiary were classified as
available-for-sale
as defined in Accounting Standards Codification No. 320,
Investments Debt and Equity Securities and
are recorded at fair value. The investment securities are held
for the purpose of providing the funding source to pay
professional liability claims covered by the insurance
subsidiary. We perform a quarterly assessment of individual
investment securities to determine whether declines in market
value are temporary or
other-than-temporary.
Our investment securities evaluation process involves multiple
subjective judgments, often involves estimating the outcome of
future events, and requires a significant level of professional
judgment in determining whether an impairment has occurred. We
evaluate, among other things, the financial position and near
term prospects of the issuer, conditions in the issuers
industry, liquidity of the investment, changes in the amount or
timing of expected future cash flows from the investment, and
recent downgrades of the issuer by a rating agency, to determine
if, and when, a decline in the fair value of an investment below
amortized cost is considered
other-than-temporary.
The length of time and extent to which the fair value of the
investment is less than amortized cost and our ability and
intent to retain the investment, to allow for any anticipated
recovery of the investments fair value, are important
components of our investment securities evaluation process.
Goodwill
Goodwill is not amortized, but is subject to annual impairment
tests. In addition to the annual impairment review, impairment
reviews are performed whenever circumstances indicate a possible
impairment may exist. Impairment testing for goodwill is done at
the reporting unit level. Reporting units are one level below
the business segment level, and our impairment testing is
performed at the operating division or market level. We compare
the fair value of the reporting unit assets to the carrying
amount, on at least an annual basis, to determine if there is
potential impairment. If the fair value of the reporting unit
assets is less than their carrying value, we compare the fair
value of the goodwill to its carrying value. If the fair value
of the goodwill is less than its carrying value, an impairment
loss is recognized. Fair value of goodwill is estimated based
upon internal evaluations of the related long-lived assets for
each reporting unit that include quantitative analyses of
revenues and cash flows and reviews of recent sales of similar
facilities. We recognized goodwill impairments of
$19 million and $48 million during 2009 and 2008,
respectively. No goodwill impairments were recognized during
2007.
F-12
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 1
|
ACCOUNTING
POLICIES (Continued)
|
During 2009, goodwill increased by $5 million related to
acquisitions, decreased by $19 million related to
impairments and increased by $11 million related to foreign
currency translation and other adjustments. During 2008,
goodwill increased by $43 million related to acquisitions,
decreased by $14 million related to facility sales,
decreased by $48 million related to impairments and
decreased by $30 million related to foreign currency
translation and other adjustments.
Since January 1, 2000, we have recognized total goodwill
impairments of $88 million in the aggregate. None of the
goodwill impairments related to evaluations of goodwill at the
reporting unit level, as all recognized goodwill impairments
during this period related to goodwill allocated to asset
disposal groups.
Physician
Recruiting Agreements
In order to recruit physicians to meet the needs of our
hospitals and the communities they serve, we enter into minimum
revenue guarantee arrangements to assist the recruited
physicians during the period they are relocating and
establishing their practices. A guarantor is required to
recognize, at the inception of a guarantee, a liability for the
fair value of the stand-ready obligation undertaken in issuing
the guarantee. We expense the total estimated guarantee
liability amount at the time the physician recruiting agreement
becomes effective as we are not able to justify recording a
contract-based asset based upon our analysis of the related
control, regulatory and legal considerations.
The physician recruiting liability amounts of $24 million
and $27 million at December 31, 2009 and 2008,
respectively, represent the amount of expense recognized in
excess of payments made through December 31, 2009 and 2008,
respectively. At December 31, 2009 the maximum amount we
could have to pay under all effective minimum revenue guarantees
was $64 million.
Professional
Liability Claims
Reserves for professional liability risks were
$1.322 billion and $1.387 billion at December 31,
2009 and 2008, respectively. The current portion of the
reserves, $265 million and $279 million at
December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, is included in
other accrued expenses in the consolidated balance
sheets. Provisions for losses related to professional liability
risks were $211 million, $175 million and
$163 million for 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively, and are
included in other operating expenses in our
consolidated income statements. Provisions for losses related to
professional liability risks are based upon actuarially
determined estimates. Loss and loss expense reserves represent
the estimated ultimate net cost of all reported and unreported
losses incurred through the respective consolidated balance
sheet dates. The reserves for unpaid losses and loss expenses
are estimated using individual case-basis valuations and
actuarial analyses. Those estimates are subject to the effects
of trends in loss severity and frequency. The estimates are
continually reviewed and adjustments are recorded as experience
develops or new information becomes known. Adjustments to the
estimated reserve amounts are included in current operating
results. The reserves for professional liability risks cover
approximately 2,600 and 2,800 individual claims at
December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and estimates for
unreported potential claims. The time period required to resolve
these claims can vary depending upon the jurisdiction and
whether the claim is settled or litigated. During 2009 and 2008,
$272 million and $314 million, respectively, of net
payments were made for professional and general liability
claims. The estimation of the timing of payments beyond a year
can vary significantly. Although considerable variability is
inherent in professional liability reserve estimates, we believe
the reserves for losses and loss expenses are adequate; however,
there can be no assurance the ultimate liability will not exceed
our estimates.
A portion of our professional liability risks is insured through
a wholly-owned insurance subsidiary. Subject to a
$5 million per occurrence self-insured retention, our
facilities are insured by our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary
for losses up to $50 million per occurrence. The insurance
subsidiary has obtained
F-13
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 1
|
ACCOUNTING
POLICIES (Continued)
|
reinsurance for professional liability risks generally above a
retention level of $15 million per occurrence. We also
maintain professional liability insurance with unrelated
commercial carriers for losses in excess of amounts insured by
our insurance subsidiary.
The obligations covered by reinsurance contracts are included in
the reserves for professional liability risks, as the insurance
subsidiary remains liable to the extent the reinsurers do not
meet their obligations under the reinsurance contracts. The
amounts receivable under the reinsurance contracts include
$28 million at December 31, 2009 and 2008 recorded in
other assets and $25 million and
$29 million at December 31, 2009 and 2008,
respectively, recorded in other current assets.
Financial
Instruments
Derivative financial instruments are employed to manage risks,
including interest rate and foreign currency exposures, and are
not used for trading or speculative purposes. We recognize
derivative instruments, such as interest rate swap agreements
and foreign exchange contracts, in the consolidated balance
sheets at fair value. Changes in the fair value of derivatives
are recognized periodically either in earnings or in
stockholders equity, as a component of other comprehensive
income (loss), depending on whether the derivative financial
instrument qualifies for hedge accounting, and if so, whether it
qualifies as a fair value hedge or a cash flow hedge. Generally,
changes in fair values of derivatives accounted for as fair
value hedges are recorded in earnings, along with the changes in
the fair value of the hedged items related to the hedged risk.
Gains and losses on derivatives designated as cash flow hedges,
to the extent they are effective, are recorded in other
comprehensive income (loss), and subsequently reclassified to
earnings to offset the impact of the forecasted transactions
when they occur. In the event the forecasted transaction to
which a cash flow hedge relates is no longer likely, the amount
in other comprehensive income (loss) is recognized in earnings
and generally the derivative is terminated. Changes in the fair
value of derivatives not qualifying as hedges, and for any
portion of a hedge that is ineffective, are reported in earnings.
The net interest paid or received on interest rate swaps is
recognized as interest expense. Gains and losses resulting from
the early termination of interest rate swap agreements are
deferred and amortized as adjustments to interest expense over
the remaining term of the debt originally covered by the
terminated swap.
Noncontrolling
Interests in Consolidated Entities
The consolidated financial statements include all assets,
liabilities, revenues and expenses of less than 100% owned
entities that we control. Accordingly, we have recorded
noncontrolling interests in the earnings and equity of such
entities.
Related
Party Transactions Management
Agreement
Affiliates of the Investors entered into a management agreement
with us pursuant to which such affiliates will provide us with
management services. Under the management agreement, the
affiliates of the Investors are entitled to receive an aggregate
annual management fee of $15 million, which amount
increases annually, beginning in 2008, at a rate equal to the
percentage increase in Adjusted EBITDA (as defined in the
Management Agreement) in the applicable year compared to the
preceding year, and reimbursement of
out-of-pocket
expenses incurred in connection with the provision of services
pursuant to the agreement. The annual management fee was
$15 million for each of 2009, 2008 and 2007. The management
agreement has an initial term expiring on December 31,
2016, provided that the term will be extended annually for one
additional year unless we or the Investors provide notice to the
other of their desire not to automatically extend the term. In
addition, the management agreement provides that the affiliates
of the Investors are entitled to receive a fee equal to 1% of
the gross transaction value in connection with certain
financing, acquisition,
F-14
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 1
|
ACCOUNTING
POLICIES (Continued)
|
disposition, and change of control transactions, as well as a
termination fee based on the net present value of future payment
obligations under the management agreement in the event of an
initial public offering or under certain other circumstances.
The agreement also contains customary exculpation and
indemnification provisions in favor of the Investors and their
affiliates.
Reclassifications
Certain prior year amounts have been reclassified to conform to
the 2009 presentation.
|
|
NOTE 2
|
SHARE-BASED
COMPENSATION
|
Certain management holders of outstanding HCA stock options
retained certain of their stock options (the Rollover
Options) in lieu of receiving the Merger consideration.
The Rollover Options remain outstanding in accordance with the
terms of the governing stock incentive plans and grant
agreements pursuant to which the holder originally received the
stock option grants, except the exercise price and number of
shares subject to the rollover option agreement were adjusted so
that the aggregate intrinsic value for each applicable option
holder was maintained and the exercise price for substantially
all the options was adjusted to $12.75 per option. Pursuant to
the rollover option agreement, 10,967,500 prerecapitalization
HCA stock options were converted into 2,285,200 Rollover
Options, of which 1,349,800 are outstanding and exercisable at
December 31, 2009.
2006
Stock Incentive Plan
The 2006 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees of HCA Inc. and
its Affiliates (the 2006 Plan) is designed to
promote the long term financial interests and growth of the
Company and its subsidiaries by attracting and retaining
management and other personnel and key service providers and to
motivate management personnel by means of incentives to achieve
long range goals and further the alignment of interests of
participants with those of our stockholders through
opportunities for increased stock, or stock-based, ownership in
the Company. A portion of the options under the 2006 Plan vests
solely based upon continued employment over a specific period of
time, and a portion of the options vests based both upon
continued employment over a specific period of time and upon the
achievement of predetermined financial and Investor return
targets over time. We granted 1,785,900 and 357,500 options
under the 2006 Plan during 2009 and 2008, respectively. As of
December 31, 2009, 3,010,000 options granted under the 2006
Plan have vested, and there were 392,400 shares available
for future grants under the 2006 Plan.
Stock
Option Activity
The fair value of each stock option award is estimated on the
grant date, using option valuation models and the weighted
average assumptions indicated in the following table. Awards
under the 2006 Plan generally vest based on continued employment
and based upon achievement of certain financial and Investor
return targets. Each grant is valued as a single award with an
expected term equal to the average expected term of the
component vesting tranches. We use historical option exercise
behavior data and other factors to estimate the expected term of
the options. The expected term of the option is limited by the
contractual term, and employee post-vesting termination behavior
is incorporated in the historical option exercise behavior data.
Compensation cost is recognized on the straight-line attribution
method. The straight-line attribution method requires that total
compensation expense recognized must at least equal the vested
portion of the grant-date fair value. The expected volatility is
derived using historical stock price information of certain peer
group companies for a period of time equal to the expected
option term. The risk-free interest rate is the approximate
F-15
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 2
|
SHARE-BASED
COMPENSATION (Continued)
|
yield on United States Treasury Strips having a life equal to
the expected option life on the date of grant. The expected life
is an estimate of the number of years an option will be held
before it is exercised.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
2008
|
|
2007
|
|
Risk-free interest rate
|
|
|
1.45
|
%
|
|
|
2.50
|
%
|
|
|
4.86
|
%
|
Expected volatility
|
|
|
35
|
%
|
|
|
30
|
%
|
|
|
30
|
%
|
Expected life, in years
|
|
|
5
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Expected dividend yield
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Information regarding stock option activity during 2009, 2008
and 2007 is summarized below (share amounts in thousands):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Weighted
|
|
|
Weighted
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Average
|
|
|
Average
|
|
|
Aggregate
|
|
|
|
Stock
|
|
|
Exercise
|
|
|
Remaining
|
|
|
Intrinsic Value
|
|
|
|
Options
|
|
|
Price
|
|
|
Contractual Term
|
|
|
(dollars in millions)
|
|
|
Options outstanding, December 31, 2006
|
|
|
2,285
|
|
|
$
|
12.50
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Granted
|
|
|
9,328
|
|
|
|
51.34
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exercised
|
|
|
(36
|
)
|
|
|
12.75
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cancelled
|
|
|
(405
|
)
|
|
|
51.00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Options outstanding, December 31, 2007
|
|
|
11,172
|
|
|
|
43.54
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Granted
|
|
|
357
|
|
|
|
58.21
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exercised
|
|
|
(480
|
)
|
|
|
15.01
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cancelled
|
|
|
(412
|
)
|
|
|
51.14
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Options outstanding, December 31, 2008
|
|
|
10,637
|
|
|
|
45.02
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Granted
|
|
|
1,786
|
|
|
|
88.74
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Exercised
|
|
|
(506
|
)
|
|
|
17.16
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cancelled
|
|
|
(390
|
)
|
|
|
52.08
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Options outstanding, December 31, 2009
|
|
|
11,527
|
|
|
|
52.78
|
|
|
|
7.1 years
|
|
|
$
|
406
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Options exercisable, December 31, 2009
|
|
|
4,208
|
|
|
$
|
46.63
|
|
|
|
6.3 years
|
|
|
$
|
174
|
|
The weighted average fair values of stock options granted during
2009, 2008 and 2007 were $15.96, $14.01 and $16.01 per share,
respectively. The total intrinsic value of stock options
exercised in the year ended December 31, 2009 was
$26 million.
|
|
NOTE 3
|
ACQUISITIONS
AND DISPOSITIONS
|
During 2009, we paid $61 million to acquire nonhospital
health care entities. During 2008, we paid $18 million to
acquire one hospital and $67 million to acquire other
health care entities. During 2007, we paid $32 million to
acquire nonhospital health care entities. Purchase price amounts
have been allocated to the related assets acquired and
liabilities assumed based upon their respective fair values. The
purchase price paid in excess of the fair value of identifiable
net assets of acquired entities aggregated $5 million,
$43 million and $44 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007,
respectively. The consolidated financial statements include the
accounts and operations of the acquired entities subsequent to
the respective acquisition dates. The pro forma effects of the
acquired entities on our results of operations for periods prior
to the respective acquisition dates were not significant.
F-16
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 3
|
ACQUISITIONS
AND DISPOSITIONS (Continued)
|
During 2009, we received proceeds of $3 million and
recognized a net pretax loss of $8 million ($5 million
after tax) on the sales of three hospitals. We also received
proceeds of $38 million and recognized a net pretax loss of
$7 million ($4 million after tax) from sales of other
health care entities and real estate investments. During 2008,
we received proceeds of $143 million and recognized a net
pretax gain of $81 million ($48 million after tax)
from the sales of two hospitals. We also received proceeds of
$50 million and recognized a net pretax gain of
$16 million ($10 million after tax) from sales of
other health care entities and real estate investments. During
2007, we received proceeds of $661 million and recognized a
net pretax gain of $443 million ($272 million after
tax) from sales of three hospitals. We also received proceeds of
$106 million and recognized a net pretax gain of
$28 million ($18 million after tax) from sales of real
estate investments.
|
|
NOTE 4
|
IMPAIRMENTS
OF LONG-LIVED ASSETS
|
During 2009, we recorded pretax charges of $43 million to
reduce the carrying value of identified assets to estimated fair
value. The $43 million asset impairment includes
$15 million related to certain hospital facilities and
other health care entity investments in our Central Group,
$14 million related to other health care entity investments
in our Eastern Group and $14 million related to certain
hospital facilities in our Western Group. During 2008, we
recorded pretax charges of $64 million to reduce the
carrying value of identified assets to estimated fair value. The
$64 million asset impairment includes $55 million
related to other health care entity investments in our Eastern
Group and $9 million related to certain hospital facilities
in our Central Group. During 2007, we recorded a pretax charge
of $24 million to adjust the value of a building in our
Central Group to estimated fair value.
The asset impairment charges did not have a significant impact
on our operations or cash flows and are not expected to
significantly impact cash flows for future periods. The
impairment charges affected our property and equipment asset
category by $24 million, $16 million and
$24 million in 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.
The provision for income taxes consists of the following
(dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Current:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Federal
|
|
$
|
809
|
|
|
$
|
699
|
|
|
$
|
566
|
|
State
|
|
|
75
|
|
|
|
56
|
|
|
|
37
|
|
Foreign
|
|
|
21
|
|
|
|
25
|
|
|
|
32
|
|
Deferred:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Federal
|
|
|
(274
|
)
|
|
|
(505
|
)
|
|
|
(391
|
)
|
State
|
|
|
(37
|
)
|
|
|
(29
|
)
|
|
|
(62
|
)
|
Foreign
|
|
|
33
|
|
|
|
22
|
|
|
|
134
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
627
|
|
|
$
|
268
|
|
|
$
|
316
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The provision for income taxes reflects $18 million and
$20 million ($12 million net of tax for each)
reductions in interest related to taxing authority examinations
for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008,
respectively, and interest expense of $17 million
($11 million net of tax) for the year ended
December 31, 2007.
F-17
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 5
|
INCOME
TAXES (Continued)
|
A reconciliation of the federal statutory rate to the effective
income tax rate follows:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Federal statutory rate
|
|
|
35.0
|
%
|
|
|
35.0
|
%
|
|
|
35.0
|
%
|
State income taxes, net of federal tax benefit
|
|
|
3.2
|
|
|
|
3.7
|
|
|
|
0.2
|
|
Change in liability for uncertain tax positions
|
|
|
(0.2
|
)
|
|
|
(7.4
|
)
|
|
|
(7.2
|
)
|
Nondeductible intangible assets
|
|
|
0.4
|
|
|
|
0.4
|
|
|
|
|
|
Tax exempt interest income
|
|
|
(0.8
|
)
|
|
|
(2.5
|
)
|
|
|
(2.1
|
)
|
Income attributable to noncontrolling interests from
consolidated partnerships
|
|
|
(6.0
|
)
|
|
|
(5.6
|
)
|
|
|
(4.0
|
)
|
Other items, net
|
|
|
(0.3
|
)
|
|
|
(0.7
|
)
|
|
|
0.7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Effective income tax rate
|
|
|
31.3
|
%
|
|
|
22.9
|
%
|
|
|
22.6
|
%
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As a result of a settlement reached with the Appeals Division of
the Internal Revenue Service (the IRS) and the
revision of a proposed IRS adjustment related to prior taxable
years, we reduced our provision for income taxes by
$69 million in 2008. Our 2007 provision for income taxes
was reduced by $85 million, principally based on new
information received related to tax positions taken in a prior
taxable year, and by an additional $39 million to adjust
2006 state tax accruals to the amounts reported on
completed tax returns and based upon an analysis of the
Recapitalization costs.
A summary of the items comprising the deferred tax assets and
liabilities at December 31 follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
|
Assets
|
|
|
Liabilities
|
|
|
Assets
|
|
|
Liabilities
|
|
|
Depreciation and fixed asset basis differences
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
258
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
324
|
|
Allowances for professional liability and other risks
|
|
|
288
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
244
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts receivable
|
|
|
1,453
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,263
|
|
|
|
|
|
Compensation
|
|
|
190
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
201
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
740
|
|
|
|
336
|
|
|
|
786
|
|
|
|
287
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
2,671
|
|
|
$
|
594
|
|
|
$
|
2,494
|
|
|
$
|
611
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At December 31, 2009, state net operating loss
carryforwards (expiring in years 2010 through
2029) available to offset future taxable income
approximated $116 million. Utilization of net operating
loss carryforwards in any one year may be limited and, in
certain cases, result in an adjustment to intangible assets. Net
deferred tax assets related to such carryforwards are not
significant.
At December 31, 2009, we are contesting before the Appeals
Division of the IRS certain claimed deficiencies and adjustments
proposed by the IRS in connection with its examination of the
2003 and 2004 federal income tax returns for HCA and eight
affiliates that are treated as partnerships for federal income
tax purposes (affiliated partnerships). The disputed
items include the timing of recognition of certain patient
service revenues and our method for calculating the tax
allowance for doubtful accounts.
Six taxable periods of HCA and its predecessors ended in 1997
through 2002 and the 2002 taxable year of four affiliated
partnerships, for which the primary remaining issue is the
computation of the tax allowance for doubtful accounts, were
pending before the IRS Examination Division as of
December 31, 2009.
F-18
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 5
|
INCOME
TAXES (Continued)
|
The IRS began an audit of the 2005 and 2006 federal income tax
returns for HCA and seven affiliated partnerships during 2008.
We anticipate the IRS Examination Division will conclude its
audit in 2010. During 2009, the seven affiliated partnership
audits were resolved with no material impact on our operations
or financial position. We anticipate the IRS will begin an audit
of the 2007 and 2008 federal income tax returns for HCA during
2010.
The following table summarizes the activity related to our
unrecognized tax benefits (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
Balance at January 1
|
|
$
|
482
|
|
|
$
|
622
|
|
Additions based on tax positions related to the current year
|
|
|
44
|
|
|
|
32
|
|
Additions for tax positions of prior years
|
|
|
11
|
|
|
|
55
|
|
Reductions for tax positions of prior years
|
|
|
(33
|
)
|
|
|
(57
|
)
|
Settlements
|
|
|
(8
|
)
|
|
|
(162
|
)
|
Lapse of applicable statutes of limitations
|
|
|
(11
|
)
|
|
|
(8
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance at December 31
|
|
$
|
485
|
|
|
$
|
482
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
During 2008, we reached a settlement with the IRS Appeals
Division relating to the deductibility of the 2001 government
settlement payment, the timing of recognition of certain patient
service revenues for 2001 and 2002, and the amount of insurance
expense deducted in 2001 and 2002. As a result of the
settlement, $111 million of the $215 million
refundable deposit made in 2006 has been applied to tax and
interest due for the 2001 and 2002 taxable years.
Our liability for unrecognized tax benefits was
$628 million, including accrued interest of
$156 million and excluding $13 million that was
recorded as reductions of the related deferred tax assets, as of
December 31, 2009 ($625 million, $156 million and
$13 million, respectively, as of December 31, 2008).
Unrecognized tax benefits of $236 million
($264 million as of December 31, 2008) would
affect the effective rate, if recognized. The liability for
unrecognized tax benefits does not reflect deferred tax assets
of $77 million ($81 million as of December 31,
2008) related to deductible interest and state income taxes
or a refundable deposit of $104 million, which is recorded
in noncurrent assets.
Depending on the resolution of the IRS disputes, the completion
of examinations by federal, state or international taxing
authorities, or the expiration of statutes of limitation for
specific taxing jurisdictions, we believe it is reasonably
possible that our liability for unrecognized tax benefits may
significantly increase or decrease within the next
12 months. However, we are currently unable to estimate the
range of any possible change.
F-19
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 6
|
INVESTMENTS
OF INSURANCE SUBSIDIARY
|
A summary of the insurance subsidiarys investments at
December 31 follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unrealized
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amortized
|
|
|
Amounts
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
|
Cost
|
|
|
Gains
|
|
|
Losses
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Debt securities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
States and municipalities
|
|
$
|
668
|
|
|
$
|
30
|
|
|
$
|
(3
|
)
|
|
$
|
695
|
|
Auction rate securities
|
|
|
401
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(5
|
)
|
|
|
396
|
|
Asset-backed securities
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
42
|
|
Money market funds
|
|
|
176
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
176
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,288
|
|
|
|
30
|
|
|
|
(9
|
)
|
|
|
1,309
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity securities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Preferred stocks
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
4
|
|
Common stocks
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,296
|
|
|
$
|
31
|
|
|
$
|
(11
|
)
|
|
|
1,316
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amounts classified as current assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(150
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investment carrying value
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,166
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unrealized
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amortized
|
|
|
Amounts
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
|
Cost
|
|
|
Gains
|
|
|
Losses
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Debt securities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
States and municipalities
|
|
$
|
808
|
|
|
$
|
20
|
|
|
$
|
(23
|
)
|
|
$
|
805
|
|
Auction rate securities
|
|
|
576
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(40
|
)
|
|
|
536
|
|
Asset-backed securities
|
|
|
51
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
(5
|
)
|
|
|
47
|
|
Money market funds
|
|
|
226
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
226
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,661
|
|
|
|
21
|
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
|
|
1,614
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity securities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Preferred stocks
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
5
|
|
Common stocks
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,670
|
|
|
$
|
21
|
|
|
$
|
(69
|
)
|
|
|
1,622
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amounts classified as current assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(200
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investment carrying value
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,422
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At December 31, 2009 and 2008 the investments of our
insurance subsidiary were classified as
available-for-sale.
Changes in temporary unrealized gains and losses are recorded as
adjustments to other comprehensive income (loss). At
December 31, 2009 and 2008, $100 million and
$119 million, respectively,
F-20
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 6
|
INVESTMENTS
OF INSURANCE SUBSIDIARY (Continued)
|
of our investments were subject to the restrictions included in
insurance bond collateralization and assumed reinsurance
contracts.
Scheduled maturities of investments in debt securities at
December 31, 2009 were as follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amortized
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
|
Cost
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Due in one year or less
|
|
$
|
216
|
|
|
$
|
216
|
|
Due after one year through five years
|
|
|
310
|
|
|
|
325
|
|
Due after five years through ten years
|
|
|
193
|
|
|
|
204
|
|
Due after ten years
|
|
|
125
|
|
|
|
126
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
844
|
|
|
|
871
|
|
Auction rate securities
|
|
|
401
|
|
|
|
396
|
|
Asset-backed securities
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
42
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,288
|
|
|
$
|
1,309
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The average expected maturity of the investments in debt
securities at December 31, 2009 was 3.5 years,
compared to the average scheduled maturity of 12.3 years.
Expected and scheduled maturities may differ because the issuers
of certain securities have the right to call, prepay or
otherwise redeem such obligations prior to their scheduled
maturity date. The average expected maturities for our auction
rate and asset-backed securities were derived from valuation
models of expected cash flows and involved managements
judgment. The average expected maturities for our auction rate
and asset-backed securities at December 31, 2009 were
4.7 years and 6.3 years, respectively, compared to
average scheduled maturities of 25.4 years and
26.0 years, respectively.
The cost of securities sold is based on the specific
identification method. Sales of securities for the years ended
December 31 are summarized below (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Debt securities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash proceeds
|
|
$
|
141
|
|
|
$
|
23
|
|
|
$
|
272
|
|
Gross realized gains
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
Gross realized losses
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
Equity securities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash proceeds
|
|
$
|
3
|
|
|
$
|
4
|
|
|
$
|
87
|
|
Gross realized gains
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
Gross realized losses
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
NOTE 7
|
FINANCIAL
INSTRUMENTS
|
Interest
Rate Swap Agreements
We have entered into interest rate swap agreements to manage our
exposure to fluctuations in interest rates. These swap
agreements involve the exchange of fixed and variable rate
interest payments between two parties based on common notional
principal amounts and maturity dates. Pay-fixed interest rate
swaps effectively convert LIBOR indexed variable rate
instruments to fixed interest rate obligations. The net interest
payments, based on the notional amounts in these agreements,
generally match the timing of the related
F-21
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 7
|
FINANCIAL
INSTRUMENTS (Continued)
|
liabilities. The notional amounts of the swap agreements
represent amounts used to calculate the exchange of cash flows
and are not our assets or liabilities. Our credit risk related
to these agreements is considered low because the swap
agreements are with creditworthy financial institutions. The
interest payments under these agreements are settled on a net
basis.
The following table sets forth our interest rate swap
agreements, which have been designated as cash flow hedges, at
December 31, 2009 (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notional
|
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
Termination Date
|
|
Value
|
|
Pay-fixed interest rate swap
|
|
$
|
500
|
|
|
|
March 2011
|
|
|
$
|
(13
|
)
|
Pay-fixed interest rate swaps
|
|
|
8,000
|
|
|
|
November 2011
|
|
|
|
(523
|
)
|
Pay-fixed interest rate swaps (starting November 2011)
|
|
|
2,000
|
|
|
|
December 2016
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
During the next 12 months, we estimate $364 million
will be reclassified from other comprehensive income
(OCI) to interest expense.
Cross
Currency Swaps
The Company and certain subsidiaries have incurred obligations
and entered into various intercompany transactions where such
obligations are denominated in currencies other than the
functional currencies of the parties executing the trade. In
order to better match the cash flows of our obligations and
intercompany transactions with cash flows from operations, we
entered into various cross currency swaps. Our credit risk
related to these agreements is considered low because the swap
agreements are with creditworthy financial institutions.
Certain of our cross currency swaps were not designated as
hedges, and changes in fair value are recognized in results of
operations. The following table sets forth our cross currency
swap agreement, which has not been designated as a hedge, at
December 31, 2009 (amounts in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notional
|
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
Termination Date
|
|
Value
|
|
Euro United States Dollar Currency Swap
|
|
|
411 Euro
|
|
|
|
December 2011
|
|
|
$
|
79
|
|
The following table sets forth our cross currency swap
agreements, which have been designated as cash flow hedges, at
December 31, 2009 (amounts in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notional
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Termination Date
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
GBP United States Dollar Currency Swaps
|
|
|
100 GBP
|
|
|
|
November 2010
|
|
|
$
|
(13
|
)
|
Derivatives Results
of Operations
The following tables present the effect of our interest rate and
cross currency swaps on our results of operations for the year
ended December 31, 2009 (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Location of Loss
|
|
|
Amount of Loss
|
|
|
|
Amount of Loss (Gain)
|
|
|
Reclassified from
|
|
|
Reclassified from
|
|
|
|
Recognized in OCI on
|
|
|
Accumulated OCI
|
|
|
Accumulated OCI
|
|
Derivatives in Cash Flow Hedging Relationships
|
|
Derivatives, Net of Tax
|
|
|
into Operations
|
|
|
into Operations
|
|
|
Interest rate swaps
|
|
$
|
141
|
|
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
$
|
345
|
|
Cross currency swaps
|
|
|
(8
|
)
|
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
133
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
345
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-22
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 7
|
FINANCIAL
INSTRUMENTS (Continued)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Location of Loss
|
|
Amount of Loss
|
|
|
|
Recognized in
|
|
Recognized in
|
|
|
|
Operations on
|
|
Operations on
|
|
Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
|
|
Derivatives
|
|
Derivatives
|
|
|
Cross currency swaps
|
|
Other operating expense
|
|
$
|
5
|
|
Credit-risk-related
Contingent Features
We have agreements with each of our derivative counterparties
that contain a provision where we could be declared in default
on our derivative obligations if repayment of the underlying
indebtedness is accelerated by the lender due to our default on
the indebtedness. As of December 31, 2009, we have not been
required to post any collateral related to these agreements. If
we had breached these provisions at December 31, 2009, we
would have been required to settle our obligations under the
agreements at their aggregate, estimated termination value of
$488 million.
|
|
NOTE 8
|
ASSETS
AND LIABILITIES MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE
|
ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures
(ASC 820) defines fair value, establishes a
framework for measuring fair value, and expands disclosures
about fair value measurements. ASC 820 applies to reported
balances that are required or permitted to be measured at fair
value under existing accounting pronouncements.
ASC 820 emphasizes fair value is a market-based measurement, not
an entity-specific measurement. Therefore, a fair value
measurement should be determined based on the assumptions market
participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. As a
basis for considering market participant assumptions in fair
value measurements, ASC 820 establishes a fair value hierarchy
that distinguishes between market participant assumptions based
on market data obtained from sources independent of the
reporting entity (observable inputs classified within
Levels 1 and 2 of the hierarchy) and the reporting
entitys own assumptions about market participant
assumptions (unobservable inputs classified within Level 3
of the hierarchy).
Level 1 inputs utilize quoted prices (unadjusted) in active
markets for identical assets or liabilities. Level 2 inputs
are inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are
observable for the asset or liability, either directly or
indirectly. Level 2 inputs may include quoted prices for
similar assets and liabilities in active markets, as well as
inputs observable for the asset or liability (other than quoted
prices), such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, and
yield curves observable at commonly quoted intervals.
Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or
liability, which are typically based on an entitys own
assumptions, as there is little, if any, related market
activity. In instances where the determination of the fair value
measurement is based on inputs from different levels of the fair
value hierarchy, the level in the fair value hierarchy within
which the entire fair value measurement falls is based on the
lowest level input significant to the fair value measurement in
its entirety. Our assessment of the significance of a particular
input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires
judgment, and considers factors specific to the asset or
liability.
Cash
Traded Investments
Our cash traded investments are generally classified within
Level 1 or Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy because
they are valued using quoted market prices, broker or dealer
quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable
levels of price transparency. Certain types of cash traded
instruments are classified within Level 3 of the fair value
hierarchy because they trade infrequently and therefore have
little or no price transparency. Such instruments include
auction rate securities (ARS) and limited
partnership investments. The transaction price is initially used
as the best estimate of fair value.
F-23
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 8
|
ASSETS
AND LIABILITIES MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE (Continued)
|
Our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary had investments in
municipal, tax-exempt ARS, that are backed by student loans
substantially guaranteed by the federal government, of
$396 million ($401 million par value) at
December 31, 2009. We do not currently intend to attempt to
sell the ARS as the liquidity needs of our insurance subsidiary
are expected to be met by other investments in its investment
portfolio. These securities continue to accrue and pay interest
semi-annually based on the failed auction maximum rate formulas
stated in their respective Official Statements. During 2009 and
2008, certain issuers and their broker/dealers redeemed or
repurchased $172 million and $93 million,
respectively, of our ARS at par value. The valuation of these
securities involved managements judgment, after
consideration of market factors and the absence of market
transparency, market liquidity and observable inputs. Our
valuation models derived a fair market value compared to
tax-equivalent yields of other student loan backed variable rate
securities of similar credit worthiness.
Derivative
Financial Instruments
We have entered into interest rate and cross currency swap
agreements to manage our exposure to fluctuations in interest
rates and foreign currency risks. The valuation of these
instruments is determined using widely accepted valuation
techniques, including discounted cash flow analysis on the
expected cash flows of each derivative. This analysis reflects
the contractual terms of the derivatives, including the period
to maturity, and uses observable market-based inputs, including
interest rate curves, foreign exchange rates and implied
volatilities. To comply with the provisions of ASC 820, we
incorporate credit valuation adjustments to reflect both our own
nonperformance risk and the respective counterpartys
nonperformance risk in the fair value measurements.
Although we determined the majority of the inputs used to value
our derivatives fall within Level 2 of the fair value
hierarchy, the credit valuation adjustments associated with our
derivatives utilize Level 3 inputs, such as estimates of
current credit spreads to evaluate the likelihood of default by
us and our counterparties. We assessed the significance of the
impact of the credit valuation adjustments on the overall
valuation of our derivative positions and at December 31,
2008, we determined the credit valuation adjustments were
significant to the overall valuation of our derivatives;
however, we determined the credit valuation adjustments were not
significant to the overall valuation of our derivatives at
December 31, 2009. As a result, we have reclassified our
derivative valuations in their entirety from Level 3 to
Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy at December 31,
2009.
F-24
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 8
|
ASSETS
AND LIABILITIES MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE (Continued)
|
The following table summarizes our assets and liabilities
measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of
December 31, 2009, aggregated by the level in the fair
value hierarchy within which those measurements fall (dollars in
millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fair Value Measurements Using
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Quoted Prices in
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Active Markets for
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Identical Assets
|
|
|
Significant Other
|
|
|
Significant
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
and Liabilities
|
|
|
Observable Inputs
|
|
|
Unobservable Inputs
|
|
|
|
Fair Value
|
|
|
(Level 1)
|
|
|
(Level 2)
|
|
|
(Level 3)
|
|
|
Assets:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investments of insurance subsidiary
|
|
$
|
1,316
|
|
|
$
|
178
|
|
|
$
|
741
|
|
|
$
|
397
|
|
Less amounts classified as current assets
|
|
|
(150
|
)
|
|
|
(150
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,166
|
|
|
|
28
|
|
|
|
741
|
|
|
|
397
|
|
Cross currency swap (Other assets)
|
|
|
79
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
79
|
|
|
|
|
|
Liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest rate swaps (Income taxes and other liabilities)
|
|
|
528
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
528
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cross currency swaps (Income taxes and other liabilities)
|
|
|
13
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
13
|
|
|
|
|
|
The following table summarizes the activity related to the
investments of our insurance subsidiary and our cross currency
and interest rate swaps which have fair value measurements based
on significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) during
the year ended December 31, 2009 (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investments
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest
|
|
|
|
of Insurance
|
|
|
Cross Currency
|
|
|
Rate
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Swaps
|
|
|
Swaps
|
|
|
Asset (liability) balances at December 31, 2008
|
|
$
|
538
|
|
|
$
|
97
|
|
|
$
|
(26
|
)
|
|
$
|
(657
|
)
|
Realized losses included in earnings
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(5
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
341
|
|
Unrealized gains (losses) included in other comprehensive income
|
|
|
35
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
13
|
|
|
|
(222
|
)
|
Purchases, issuances and settlements
|
|
|
(176
|
)
|
|
|
(13
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10
|
|
Transfers out of Level 3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(79
|
)
|
|
|
13
|
|
|
|
528
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Asset (liability) balances at December 31, 2009
|
|
$
|
397
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The estimated fair value of our long-term debt was
$25.659 billion and $20.225 billion at
December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, compared to
carrying amounts aggregating $25.670 billion and
$26.989 billion, respectively. The estimates of fair value
are generally based upon the quoted market prices or quoted
market prices for similar issues of long-term debt with the same
maturities.
F-25
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
NOTE 9
LONG-TERM DEBT
A summary of long-term debt at December 31, including
related interest rates at December 31, 2009, follows
(dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
Senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility (effective
interest rate of 1.7%)
|
|
$
|
715
|
|
|
$
|
2,000
|
|
Senior secured revolving credit facility
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
50
|
|
Senior secured term loan facilities (effective interest rate of
6.5%)
|
|
|
8,987
|
|
|
|
12,002
|
|
Senior secured first lien notes (effective interest rate of 8.9%)
|
|
|
2,682
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other senior secured debt (effective interest rate of 6.8%)
|
|
|
362
|
|
|
|
406
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
First lien debt
|
|
|
12,746
|
|
|
|
14,458
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Senior secured cash-pay notes (effective interest rate of 9.7%)
|
|
|
4,500
|
|
|
|
4,200
|
|
Senior secured toggle notes (effective interest rate of 10.0%)
|
|
|
1,578
|
|
|
|
1,500
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Second lien debt
|
|
|
6,078
|
|
|
|
5,700
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Senior unsecured notes (effective interest rate of 7.2%)
|
|
|
6,846
|
|
|
|
6,831
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total debt (average life of six years, rates averaging 7.6%)
|
|
|
25,670
|
|
|
|
26,989
|
|
Less amounts due within one year
|
|
|
846
|
|
|
|
404
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,824
|
|
|
$
|
26,585
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Senior
Secured Credit Facilities And Other First Lien
Debt
In connection with the Recapitalization, we entered into
(i) a $2.000 billion senior secured asset-based
revolving credit facility with a borrowing base of 85% of
eligible accounts receivable, subject to customary reserves and
eligibility criteria ($1.280 billion available at
December 31, 2009) (the ABL credit facility)
and (ii) a senior secured credit agreement (the cash
flow credit facility and, together with the ABL credit
facility, the senior secured credit facilities),
consisting of a $2.000 billion revolving credit facility
($1.901 billion available at December 31, 2009 after
giving effect to certain outstanding letters of credit), a
$2.750 billion term loan A ($1.908 billion outstanding
at December 31, 2009), a $8.800 billion term loan B
($6.515 billion outstanding at December 31,
2009) and a 1.000 billion European term loan
(394 million, or $564 million, outstanding at
December 31, 2009) under which one of our European
subsidiaries is the borrower.
Borrowings under the senior secured credit facilities bear
interest at a rate equal to, as determined by the type of
borrowing, either an applicable margin plus, at our option,
either (a) a base rate determined by reference to the
higher of (1) the federal funds rate plus 0.50% or
(2) the prime rate of Bank of America or (b) a LIBOR
rate for the currency of such borrowing for the relevant
interest period, plus, in each case, an applicable margin. The
applicable margin for borrowings under the senior secured credit
facilities, with the exception of term loan B where the margin
is static, may be reduced subject to attaining certain leverage
ratios.
The ABL credit facility and the $2.000 billion revolving
credit facility portion of the cash flow credit facility expire
November 2012. The term loan facilities require quarterly
installment payments. The final payment under term loan A is in
November 2012. The final payments under term loan B and the
European term loan are in November 2013. The senior secured
credit facilities contain a number of covenants that restrict,
subject to certain exceptions, our (and some or all of our
subsidiaries) ability to incur additional indebtedness,
repay subordinated indebtedness, create liens on assets, sell
assets, make investments, loans or advances, engage in certain
transactions with affiliates, pay dividends and distributions,
and enter into sale and
F-26
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
NOTE 9
LONG-TERM DEBT (Continued)
leaseback transactions. In addition, we are required to satisfy
and maintain a maximum total leverage ratio covenant under the
cash flow credit facility and, in certain situations under the
ABL credit facility, a minimum interest coverage ratio covenant.
During April 2009, we issued $1.500 billion aggregate
principal amount of
81/2% senior
secured first lien notes due 2019 at a price of 96.755% of their
face value, resulting in $1.451 billion of gross proceeds.
During August 2009, we issued $1.250 billion aggregate
principal amount of
77/8% senior
secured first lien notes due 2020 at a price of 98.254% of their
face value, resulting in $1.228 billion of gross proceeds.
After the payment of related fees and expenses, we used the
proceeds from these debt issuances to repay outstanding
indebtedness under our senior secured term loan facilities.
We use interest rate swap agreements to manage the variable rate
exposure of our debt portfolio. At December 31, 2009, we
had entered into effective interest rate swap agreements, in a
total notional amount of $8.5 billion, in order to hedge a
portion of our exposure to variable rate interest payments
associated with the senior secured credit facility. The effect
of the interest rate swaps is reflected in the effective
interest rates for the senior secured credit facilities.
Senior
Secured Notes And Other Second Lien Debt
In November 2006, we issued $4.200 billion of senior
secured notes (comprised of $1.000 billion of
91/8% notes
due 2014 and $3.200 billion of
91/4% notes
due 2016), and $1.500 billion of
95/8%
cash/103/8%
in-kind senior secured toggle notes (which allow us, at our
option, to pay interest in-kind during the first five years) due
2016, which are subject to certain standard covenants. We made
the interest payment for the interest period ended in May 2009
by paying in-kind ($78 million) instead of paying interest
in cash.
During February 2009, we issued $310 million aggregate
principal amount of
97/8% senior
secured second lien notes due 2017 at a price of 96.673% of
their face value, resulting in $300 million of gross
proceeds. After the payment of related fees and expenses, we
used the proceeds to repay outstanding indebtedness under our
senior secured term loan facilities.
General
Debt Information
The senior secured credit facilities and senior secured notes
are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by substantially all
existing and future, direct and indirect, wholly-owned material
domestic subsidiaries that are Unrestricted
Subsidiaries under our Indenture (the 1993
Indenture) dated December 16, 1993 (except for
certain special purpose subsidiaries that only guarantee and
pledge their assets under our ABL credit facility). In addition,
borrowings under the European term loan are guaranteed by all
material, wholly-owned European subsidiaries.
All obligations under the ABL credit facility, and the
guarantees of those obligations, are secured, subject to
permitted liens and other exceptions, by a first-priority lien
on substantially all of the receivables of the borrowers and
each guarantor under such ABL credit facility (the
Receivables Collateral).
All obligations under the cash flow credit facility and the
guarantees of such obligations are secured, subject to permitted
liens and other exceptions, by:
|
|
|
|
|
a first-priority lien on the capital stock owned by HCA Inc., or
by any U.S. guarantor, in each of their respective
first-tier subsidiaries;
|
|
|
|
a first-priority lien on substantially all present and future
assets of HCA Inc. and of each U.S. guarantor other than
(i) Principal Properties (as defined in the
1993 Indenture), (ii) certain other real properties
|
F-27
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
NOTE 9
LONG-TERM DEBT (Continued)
|
|
|
|
|
and (iii) deposit accounts, other bank or securities
accounts, cash, leaseholds, motor-vehicles and certain other
exceptions; and
|
|
|
|
|
|
a second-priority lien on certain of the Receivables Collateral.
|
Our senior secured first lien notes and the related guarantees
are secured by first-priority liens, subject to permitted liens,
on our and our subsidiary guarantors assets, subject to
certain exceptions, that secure our cash flow credit facility on
a first-priority basis and are secured by second-priority liens,
subject to permitted liens, on our and our subsidiary
guarantors assets that secure our ABL credit facility on a
first-priority basis and our other cash flow credit facility on
a second-priority basis.
Our second lien debt and the related guarantees are secured by
second-priority liens, subject to permitted liens, on our and
our subsidiary guarantors assets, subject to certain
exceptions, that secure our cash flow credit facility on a
first-priority basis and are secured by third-priority liens,
subject to permitted liens, on our and our subsidiary
guarantors assets that secure our asset-based revolving
credit facility on a first priority basis and our other cash
flow credit facility on a second-priority basis.
Maturities of long-term debt in years 2011 through 2014 are
$629 million, $3.273 billion, $8.108 billion and
$1.646 billion, respectively.
NOTE 10
CONTINGENCIES
We operate in a highly regulated and litigious industry. As a
result, various lawsuits, claims and legal and regulatory
proceedings have been and can be expected to be instituted or
asserted against us. The resolution of any such lawsuits, claims
or legal and regulatory proceedings could have a material,
adverse effect on our results of operations or financial
position in a given period.
We are subject to claims and suits arising in the ordinary
course of business, including claims for personal injuries or
wrongful restriction of, or interference with, physicians
staff privileges. In certain of these actions the claimants may
seek punitive damages against us which may not be covered by
insurance. It is managements opinion that the ultimate
resolution of these pending claims and legal proceedings will
not have a material, adverse effect on our results of operations
or financial position.
NOTE 11
CAPITAL STOCK
The Companys certificate of incorporation and by-laws were
amended and restated, effective March 27, 2008 and
March 26, 2008, respectively. The amended and restated
certificate of incorporation authorizes the Company to issue up
to 125,000,000 shares of common stock, and the amended and
restated by-laws set the number of directors constituting the
board of directors of the Company at not less than one nor more
than 15.
Stockholder
Agreements and Equity Securities with Contingent
Redemption Rights
The stockholder agreements, among other things, contain
agreements among the parties with respect to restrictions on the
transfer of shares, including tag along rights and drag along
rights, registration rights (including customary indemnification
provisions) and other rights. Pursuant to the management
stockholder agreements, the applicable employees can elect to
have the Company redeem their common stock and vested stock
options in the events of death or permanent disability, prior to
the consummation of the initial public offering of common stock
by the Company. At December 31, 2009, 1,968,400 common
shares and 4,207,800 vested stock options were subject to these
contingent redemption terms.
F-28
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
NOTE 12
EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
We maintain contributory, defined contribution benefit plans
that are available to employees who meet certain minimum
requirements. Certain of the plans require that we match
specified percentages of participant contributions up to certain
maximum levels (generally, 100% of the first 3% to 9%, depending
upon years of vesting service, of compensation deferred by
participants for periods subsequent to March 31, 2008, and
50% of the first 3% of compensation deferred by participants for
periods prior to April 1, 2008). The cost of these plans
totaled $283 million for 2009, $233 million for 2008
and $86 million for 2007. Our contributions are funded
periodically during each year.
We maintained a noncontributory, defined contribution retirement
plan which covered substantially all employees. Benefits were
determined as a percentage of a participants salary and
vest over specified periods of employee service. Benefits
expense was $46 million for 2008 and $203 million for
2007. There was no expense for 2009 as the noncontributory plan
and the related participant account balances were merged into
the contributory HCA 401(k) Plan effective April 1, 2008.
We maintain the noncontributory, nonqualified Restoration Plan
to provide certain retirement benefits for eligible employees.
Eligibility for the Restoration Plan is based upon earning
eligible compensation in excess of the Social Security Wage Base
and attaining 1,000 or more hours of service during the plan
year. Company credits to participants account balances
(the Restoration Plan is not funded) depend upon
participants compensation, years of vesting service and
certain IRS limitations related to the HCA 401(k) plan. Benefits
expense under this plan was $26 million for 2009,
$2 million for 2008 and $20 million for 2007. Accrued
benefits liabilities under this plan totaled $73 million at
December 31, 2009 and $48 million at December 31,
2008.
We maintain a Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan
(SERP) for certain executives. The plan is designed
to ensure that upon retirement the participant receives the
value of a prescribed life annuity from the combination of the
SERP and our other benefit plans. Benefits expense under the
plan was $24 million for 2009, $20 million for 2008
and $20 million for 2007. Accrued benefits liabilities
under this plan totaled $152 million at December 31,
2009 and $133 million at December 31, 2008.
We maintain defined benefit pension plans which resulted from
certain hospital acquisitions in prior years. Benefits expense
under these plans was $39 million for 2009,
$24 million for 2008, and $27 million for 2007.
Accrued benefits liabilities under these plans totaled
$115 million at December 31, 2009 and
$142 million at December 31, 2008.
NOTE 13
SEGMENT AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION
We operate in one line of business, which is operating hospitals
and related health care entities. During the years ended
December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007, approximately 23%, 23%
and 24%, respectively, of our revenues related to patients
participating in the
fee-for-service
Medicare program.
Our operations are structured into three geographically
organized groups: the Eastern Group includes 48 consolidating
hospitals located in the Eastern United States, the Central
Group includes 46 consolidating hospitals located in the Central
United States and the Western Group includes 55 consolidating
hospitals located in the Western United States. We also operate
six consolidating hospitals in England, and these facilities are
included in the Corporate and other group.
Adjusted segment EBITDA is defined as income before depreciation
and amortization, interest expense, losses (gains) on sales of
facilities, impairments of long-lived assets, income taxes and
net income attributable to noncontrolling interests. We use
adjusted segment EBITDA as an analytical indicator for purposes
of allocating resources to geographic areas and assessing
performance. Adjusted segment EBITDA is commonly used as an
analytical indicator within the health care industry, and also
serves as a measure of leverage
F-29
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
NOTE 13
SEGMENT AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION (Continued)
capacity and debt service ability. Adjusted segment EBITDA
should not be considered as a measure of financial performance
under generally accepted accounting principles, and the items
excluded from adjusted segment EBITDA are significant components
in understanding and assessing financial performance. Because
adjusted segment EBITDA is not a measurement determined in
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and is
thus susceptible to varying calculations, adjusted segment
EBITDA, as presented, may not be comparable to other similarly
titled measures of other companies.
The geographic distributions of our revenues, equity in earnings
of affiliates, adjusted segment EBITDA, depreciation and
amortization, assets and goodwill are summarized in the
following table (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For the Years Ended December 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Revenues:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Eastern Group
|
|
$
|
8,807
|
|
|
$
|
8,570
|
|
|
$
|
8,204
|
|
Central Group
|
|
|
7,225
|
|
|
|
6,740
|
|
|
|
6,302
|
|
Western Group
|
|
|
13,140
|
|
|
|
12,118
|
|
|
|
11,378
|
|
Corporate and other
|
|
|
880
|
|
|
|
946
|
|
|
|
974
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
30,052
|
|
|
$
|
28,374
|
|
|
$
|
26,858
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Eastern Group
|
|
$
|
(3
|
)
|
|
$
|
(2
|
)
|
|
$
|
(2
|
)
|
Central Group
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
8
|
|
Western Group
|
|
|
(241
|
)
|
|
|
(219
|
)
|
|
|
(212
|
)
|
Corporate and other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
(246
|
)
|
|
$
|
(223
|
)
|
|
$
|
(206
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Adjusted segment EBITDA:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Eastern Group
|
|
$
|
1,469
|
|
|
$
|
1,288
|
|
|
$
|
1,268
|
|
Central Group
|
|
|
1,325
|
|
|
|
1,061
|
|
|
|
1,082
|
|
Western Group
|
|
|
2,867
|
|
|
|
2,270
|
|
|
|
2,196
|
|
Corporate and other
|
|
|
(189
|
)
|
|
|
(45
|
)
|
|
|
46
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
5,472
|
|
|
$
|
4,574
|
|
|
$
|
4,592
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Depreciation and amortization:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Eastern Group
|
|
$
|
364
|
|
|
$
|
358
|
|
|
$
|
369
|
|
Central Group
|
|
|
352
|
|
|
|
359
|
|
|
|
364
|
|
Western Group
|
|
|
578
|
|
|
|
552
|
|
|
|
529
|
|
Corporate and other
|
|
|
131
|
|
|
|
147
|
|
|
|
164
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,425
|
|
|
$
|
1,416
|
|
|
$
|
1,426
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Adjusted segment EBITDA
|
|
$
|
5,472
|
|
|
$
|
4,574
|
|
|
$
|
4,592
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
1,425
|
|
|
|
1,416
|
|
|
|
1,426
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
1,987
|
|
|
|
2,021
|
|
|
|
2,215
|
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
(97
|
)
|
|
|
(471
|
)
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
$
|
2,002
|
|
|
$
|
1,170
|
|
|
$
|
1,398
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-30
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
NOTE 13
SEGMENT AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION (Continued)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
As of December 31,
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
Assets:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Eastern Group
|
|
$
|
5,018
|
|
|
$
|
4,906
|
|
Central Group
|
|
|
5,173
|
|
|
|
5,251
|
|
Western Group
|
|
|
8,847
|
|
|
|
8,597
|
|
Corporate and other
|
|
|
5,093
|
|
|
|
5,526
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
$
|
24,280
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Eastern
|
|
|
Central
|
|
|
Western
|
|
|
Corporate
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Group
|
|
|
Group
|
|
|
Group
|
|
|
and Other
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
Goodwill:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance at December 31, 2008
|
|
$
|
602
|
|
|
$
|
1,013
|
|
|
$
|
754
|
|
|
$
|
211
|
|
|
$
|
2,580
|
|
Acquisitions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Impairments
|
|
|
(7
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(12
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(19
|
)
|
Foreign currency translation and other
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10
|
|
|
|
11
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balance at December 31, 2009
|
|
$
|
596
|
|
|
$
|
1,018
|
|
|
$
|
742
|
|
|
$
|
221
|
|
|
$
|
2,577
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-31
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
NOTE 14
OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
The components of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
are as follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unrealized
|
|
|
Foreign
|
|
|
|
|
|
in Fair
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Gains (Losses) on
|
|
|
Currency
|
|
|
Defined
|
|
|
Value of
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Available-for-Sale
|
|
|
Translation
|
|
|
Benefit
|
|
|
Derivative
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Securities
|
|
|
Adjustments
|
|
|
Plans
|
|
|
Instruments
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
Balances at December 31, 2006
|
|
$
|
16
|
|
|
$
|
49
|
|
|
$
|
(67
|
)
|
|
$
|
18
|
|
|
$
|
16
|
|
Unrealized gains on
available-for-sale
securities, net of $1 of income taxes
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3
|
|
Foreign currency translation adjustments, net of $3 income tax
benefit
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(7
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(7
|
)
|
Defined benefit plans, net of $10 of income taxes
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
16
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
16
|
|
Change in fair value of derivative instruments, net of $100
income tax benefit
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(172
|
)
|
|
|
(172
|
)
|
(Income) expense reclassified into operations from other
comprehensive income, net of $3, $5, $(4) and $12, respectively,
of income taxes (benefit)
|
|
|
(5
|
)
|
|
|
(8
|
)
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
(22
|
)
|
|
|
(28
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balances at December 31, 2007
|
|
|
14
|
|
|
|
34
|
|
|
|
(44
|
)
|
|
|
(176
|
)
|
|
|
(172
|
)
|
Unrealized losses on
available-for-sale
securities, net of $25 income tax benefit
|
|
|
(44
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(44
|
)
|
Foreign currency translation adjustments, net of $33 income tax
benefit
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(62
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(62
|
)
|
Defined benefit plans, net of $40 income tax benefit
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
Change in fair value of derivative instruments, net of $194
income tax benefit
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(334
|
)
|
|
|
(334
|
)
|
Expense reclassified into operations from other comprehensive
income, net of $4 and $42, respectively, income tax benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
70
|
|
|
|
76
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balances at December 31, 2008
|
|
|
(30
|
)
|
|
|
(28
|
)
|
|
|
(106
|
)
|
|
|
(440
|
)
|
|
|
(604
|
)
|
Unrealized gains on
available-for-sale
securities, net of $25 of income taxes
|
|
|
44
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
44
|
|
Foreign currency translation adjustments, net of $14 of income
taxes
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
25
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
25
|
|
Defined benefit plans, net of $8 income tax benefit
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(10
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(10
|
)
|
Change in fair value of derivative instruments, net of $76
income tax benefit
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(133
|
)
|
|
|
(133
|
)
|
Expense reclassified into operations from other comprehensive
income, net of $6 and $127, respectively, income tax benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10
|
|
|
|
218
|
|
|
|
228
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balances at December 31, 2009
|
|
$
|
14
|
|
|
$
|
(3
|
)
|
|
$
|
(106
|
)
|
|
$
|
(355
|
)
|
|
$
|
(450
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-32
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 15
|
ACCRUED
EXPENSES AND ALLOWANCE FOR DOUBTFUL ACCOUNTS
|
A summary of other accrued expenses at December 31 follows
(dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
Professional liability risks
|
|
$
|
265
|
|
|
$
|
279
|
|
Interest
|
|
|
283
|
|
|
|
212
|
|
Income taxes
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
224
|
|
Taxes other than income
|
|
|
190
|
|
|
|
189
|
|
Other
|
|
|
420
|
|
|
|
378
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,158
|
|
|
$
|
1,282
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
A summary of activity for the allowance of doubtful accounts
follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Provision
|
|
Accounts
|
|
|
|
|
Balance at
|
|
for
|
|
Written off,
|
|
Balance
|
|
|
Beginning
|
|
Doubtful
|
|
Net of
|
|
at End
|
|
|
of Year
|
|
Accounts
|
|
Recoveries
|
|
of Year
|
|
Allowance for doubtful accounts:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Year ended December 31, 2007
|
|
$
|
2,889
|
|
|
$
|
3,130
|
|
|
$
|
(2,308
|
)
|
|
$
|
3,711
|
|
Year ended December 31, 2008
|
|
|
3,711
|
|
|
|
3,409
|
|
|
|
(2,379
|
)
|
|
|
4,741
|
|
Year ended December 31, 2009
|
|
|
4,741
|
|
|
|
3,276
|
|
|
|
(3,157
|
)
|
|
|
4,860
|
|
During 2009, we refined our allowance for doubtful accounts
estimation process to include separate estimates of pending
charity and pending uninsured discount amounts. These amounts
were previously included in the allowance for doubtful accounts,
but at December 31, 2009, we recorded these estimated
amounts as reductions to accounts receivable. This
reclassification has no effect on net accounts receivable and
the prior year amounts have been reclassified to conform with
the 2009 presentation. The incremental, annual amounts
reclassified were $135 million, $116 million and
$39 million for the years ended December 31, 2009,
2008 and 2007, respectively.
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION
|
The senior secured credit facilities and senior secured notes
described in Note 9 are fully and unconditionally
guaranteed by substantially all existing and future, direct and
indirect, wholly-owned material domestic subsidiaries that are
Unrestricted Subsidiaries under our Indenture dated
December 16, 1993 (except for certain special purpose
subsidiaries that only guarantee and pledge their assets under
our ABL credit facility).
Our condensed consolidating balance sheets at December 31,
2009 and 2008 and condensed consolidating statements of income
and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended
December 31, 2009, segregating the parent company issuer,
the subsidiary guarantors, the subsidiary non-guarantors and
eliminations, follow.
F-33
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION (Continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING INCOME STATEMENT
For The Year Ended December 31, 2009
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
17,584
|
|
|
$
|
12,468
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
30,052
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,149
|
|
|
|
4,809
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,958
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,846
|
|
|
|
2,022
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,868
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
14
|
|
|
|
2,497
|
|
|
|
2,213
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,724
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,043
|
|
|
|
1,233
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,276
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(2,540
|
)
|
|
|
(95
|
)
|
|
|
(151
|
)
|
|
|
2,540
|
|
|
|
(246
|
)
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
787
|
|
|
|
638
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,425
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
2,356
|
|
|
|
(500
|
)
|
|
|
131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,987
|
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
17
|
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
15
|
|
Impairment of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
34
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
43
|
|
Management fees
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(443
|
)
|
|
|
443
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(170
|
)
|
|
|
14,335
|
|
|
|
11,345
|
|
|
|
2,540
|
|
|
|
28,050
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
170
|
|
|
|
3,249
|
|
|
|
1,123
|
|
|
|
(2,540
|
)
|
|
|
2,002
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
(884
|
)
|
|
|
1,189
|
|
|
|
322
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
627
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
1,054
|
|
|
|
2,060
|
|
|
|
801
|
|
|
|
(2,540
|
)
|
|
|
1,375
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
61
|
|
|
|
260
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
321
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
1,054
|
|
|
$
|
1,999
|
|
|
$
|
541
|
|
|
$
|
(2,540
|
)
|
|
$
|
1,054
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-34
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION (Continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING INCOME STATEMENT
For The Year Ended December 31, 2008
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
16,507
|
|
|
$
|
11,867
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
28,374
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,846
|
|
|
|
4,594
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,440
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,671
|
|
|
|
1,949
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,620
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
(6
|
)
|
|
|
2,445
|
|
|
|
2,115
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,554
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,073
|
|
|
|
1,336
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,409
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(2,100
|
)
|
|
|
(82
|
)
|
|
|
(141
|
)
|
|
|
2,100
|
|
|
|
(223
|
)
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
776
|
|
|
|
640
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,416
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
2,190
|
|
|
|
(328
|
)
|
|
|
159
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,021
|
|
Gains on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(5
|
)
|
|
|
(92
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(97
|
)
|
Impairment of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
Management fees
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(426
|
)
|
|
|
426
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
84
|
|
|
|
13,970
|
|
|
|
11,050
|
|
|
|
2,100
|
|
|
|
27,204
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income (loss) before income taxes
|
|
|
(84
|
)
|
|
|
2,537
|
|
|
|
817
|
|
|
|
(2,100
|
)
|
|
|
1,170
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
(757
|
)
|
|
|
803
|
|
|
|
222
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
268
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
673
|
|
|
|
1,734
|
|
|
|
595
|
|
|
|
(2,100
|
)
|
|
|
902
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
53
|
|
|
|
176
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
229
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
673
|
|
|
$
|
1,681
|
|
|
$
|
419
|
|
|
$
|
(2,100
|
)
|
|
$
|
673
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-35
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION (Continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING INCOME STATEMENT
For The Year Ended December 31, 2007
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
15,598
|
|
|
$
|
11,260
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
26,858
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,441
|
|
|
|
4,273
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
10,714
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,549
|
|
|
|
1,846
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,395
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
2,279
|
|
|
|
1,956
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,233
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,942
|
|
|
|
1,188
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,130
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(2,245
|
)
|
|
|
(90
|
)
|
|
|
(116
|
)
|
|
|
2,245
|
|
|
|
(206
|
)
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
779
|
|
|
|
647
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,426
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
2,161
|
|
|
|
(95
|
)
|
|
|
149
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,215
|
|
Gains on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3
|
)
|
|
|
(468
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(471
|
)
|
Impairment of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
Management fees
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(392
|
)
|
|
|
392
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(86
|
)
|
|
|
13,410
|
|
|
|
9,891
|
|
|
|
2,245
|
|
|
|
25,460
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
86
|
|
|
|
2,188
|
|
|
|
1,369
|
|
|
|
(2,245
|
)
|
|
|
1,398
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
(788
|
)
|
|
|
712
|
|
|
|
392
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
316
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
874
|
|
|
|
1,476
|
|
|
|
977
|
|
|
|
(2,245
|
)
|
|
|
1,082
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
28
|
|
|
|
180
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
208
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
874
|
|
|
$
|
1,448
|
|
|
$
|
797
|
|
|
$
|
(2,245
|
)
|
|
$
|
874
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-36
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION (Continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING BALANCE SHEET
DECEMBER 31, 2009
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current assets:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
95
|
|
|
$
|
217
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
312
|
|
Accounts receivable, net
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,135
|
|
|
|
1,557
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,692
|
|
Inventories
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
489
|
|
|
|
313
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
802
|
|
Deferred income taxes
|
|
|
1,192
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,192
|
|
Other
|
|
|
81
|
|
|
|
148
|
|
|
|
350
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
579
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,273
|
|
|
|
2,867
|
|
|
|
2,437
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,577
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Property and equipment, net
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,034
|
|
|
|
4,393
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,427
|
|
Investments of insurance subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,166
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,166
|
|
Investments in and advances to affiliates
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
244
|
|
|
|
609
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
853
|
|
Goodwill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,641
|
|
|
|
936
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,577
|
|
Deferred loan costs
|
|
|
418
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
418
|
|
Investments in and advances to subsidiaries
|
|
|
21,830
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
963
|
|
|
|
19
|
|
|
|
131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,113
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,484
|
|
|
$
|
11,805
|
|
|
$
|
9,672
|
|
|
$
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS
(DEFICIT) EQUITY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts payable
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
908
|
|
|
$
|
552
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,460
|
|
Accrued salaries
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
542
|
|
|
|
307
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
849
|
|
Other accrued expenses
|
|
|
282
|
|
|
|
293
|
|
|
|
583
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,158
|
|
Long-term debt due within one year
|
|
|
802
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
35
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
846
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,084
|
|
|
|
1,752
|
|
|
|
1,477
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,313
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Long-term debt
|
|
|
24,427
|
|
|
|
103
|
|
|
|
294
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24,824
|
|
Intercompany balances
|
|
|
6,636
|
|
|
|
(10,387
|
)
|
|
|
3,751
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Professional liability risks
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,057
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,057
|
|
Income taxes and other liabilities
|
|
|
1,176
|
|
|
|
421
|
|
|
|
171
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,768
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
33,323
|
|
|
|
(8,111
|
)
|
|
|
6,750
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
31,962
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity securities with contingent redemption rights
|
|
|
147
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
147
|
|
Stockholders (deficit) equity attributable to HCA
Inc.
|
|
|
(8,986
|
)
|
|
|
19,787
|
|
|
|
2,043
|
|
|
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
|
(8,986
|
)
|
Noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
129
|
|
|
|
879
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,008
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(8,986
|
)
|
|
|
19,916
|
|
|
|
2,922
|
|
|
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
|
(7,978
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,484
|
|
|
$
|
11,805
|
|
|
$
|
9,672
|
|
|
$
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-37
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION (Continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING BALANCE SHEET
DECEMBER 31, 2008
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current assets:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
134
|
|
|
$
|
331
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
465
|
|
Accounts receivable, net
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,214
|
|
|
|
1,566
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,780
|
|
Inventories
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
455
|
|
|
|
282
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
737
|
|
Deferred income taxes
|
|
|
914
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
914
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
140
|
|
|
|
265
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
405
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
914
|
|
|
|
2,943
|
|
|
|
2,444
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,301
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Property and equipment, net
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,122
|
|
|
|
4,407
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,529
|
|
Investments of insurance subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,422
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,422
|
|
Investments in and advances to affiliates
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
243
|
|
|
|
599
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
842
|
|
Goodwill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,643
|
|
|
|
937
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,580
|
|
Deferred loan costs
|
|
|
458
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
458
|
|
Investments in and advances to subsidiaries
|
|
|
19,290
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(19,290
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
1,050
|
|
|
|
31
|
|
|
|
67
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,148
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
21,712
|
|
|
$
|
11,982
|
|
|
$
|
9,876
|
|
|
$
|
(19,290
|
)
|
|
$
|
24,280
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS (DEFICIT) EQUITY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts payable
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
881
|
|
|
$
|
489
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,370
|
|
Accrued salaries
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
549
|
|
|
|
305
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
854
|
|
Other accrued expenses
|
|
|
435
|
|
|
|
284
|
|
|
|
563
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,282
|
|
Long-term debt due within one year
|
|
|
355
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
49
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
404
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
790
|
|
|
|
1,714
|
|
|
|
1,406
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,910
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Long-term debt
|
|
|
26,089
|
|
|
|
99
|
|
|
|
397
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
26,585
|
|
Intercompany balances
|
|
|
3,663
|
|
|
|
(8,136
|
)
|
|
|
4,473
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Professional liability risks
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,108
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,108
|
|
Income taxes and other liabilities
|
|
|
1,270
|
|
|
|
379
|
|
|
|
133
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,782
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
31,812
|
|
|
|
(5,944
|
)
|
|
|
7,517
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
33,385
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity securities with contingent redemption rights
|
|
|
155
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
155
|
|
Stockholders (deficit) equity attributable to HCA
Inc.
|
|
|
(10,255
|
)
|
|
|
17,788
|
|
|
|
1,502
|
|
|
|
(19,290
|
)
|
|
|
(10,255
|
)
|
Noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
138
|
|
|
|
857
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
995
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(10,255
|
)
|
|
|
17,926
|
|
|
|
2,359
|
|
|
|
(19,290
|
)
|
|
|
(9,260
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
21,712
|
|
|
$
|
11,982
|
|
|
$
|
9,876
|
|
|
$
|
(19,290
|
)
|
|
$
|
24,280
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-38
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION (Continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
For The Year Ended December 31, 2009
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Cash flows from operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
$
|
1,054
|
|
|
$
|
2,060
|
|
|
$
|
801
|
|
|
$
|
(2,540
|
)
|
|
$
|
1,375
|
|
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by
(used in) operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in operating assets and liabilities
|
|
|
90
|
|
|
|
(1,882
|
)
|
|
|
(1,299
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3,091
|
)
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,043
|
|
|
|
1,233
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,276
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
787
|
|
|
|
638
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,425
|
|
Income taxes
|
|
|
(520
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(520
|
)
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
17
|
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
15
|
|
Impairment of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
34
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
43
|
|
Amortization of deferred loan costs
|
|
|
80
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
80
|
|
Share-based compensation
|
|
|
40
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
40
|
|
Pay-in-kind
interest
|
|
|
58
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
58
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(2,540
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,540
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
50
|
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
46
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
|
|
|
(1,688
|
)
|
|
|
3,057
|
|
|
|
1,378
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,747
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from investing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Purchase of property and equipment
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(720
|
)
|
|
|
(597
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,317
|
)
|
Acquisition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(38
|
)
|
|
|
(23
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(61
|
)
|
Disposal of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
21
|
|
|
|
20
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
41
|
|
Change in investments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(7
|
)
|
|
|
310
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
303
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in investing activities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(744
|
)
|
|
|
(291
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,035
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from financing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Issuances of long-term debt
|
|
|
2,979
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,979
|
|
Net change in revolving bank credit facilities
|
|
|
(1,335
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,335
|
)
|
Repayment of long-term debt
|
|
|
(2,972
|
)
|
|
|
(7
|
)
|
|
|
(124
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3,103
|
)
|
Distributions to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(70
|
)
|
|
|
(260
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(330
|
)
|
Payment of debt issuance costs
|
|
|
(70
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(70
|
)
|
Changes in intercompany balances with affiliates, net
|
|
|
3,107
|
|
|
|
(2,275
|
)
|
|
|
(832
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
(21
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(6
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
|
|
|
1,688
|
|
|
|
(2,352
|
)
|
|
|
(1,201
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,865
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in cash and cash equivalents
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(39
|
)
|
|
|
(114
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(153
|
)
|
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
134
|
|
|
|
331
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
465
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
95
|
|
|
$
|
217
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
312
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-39
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION (Continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
For The Year Ended December 31, 2008
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Cash flows from operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
$
|
673
|
|
|
$
|
1,734
|
|
|
$
|
595
|
|
|
$
|
(2,100
|
)
|
|
$
|
902
|
|
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by
(used in) operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in operating assets and liabilities
|
|
|
(11
|
)
|
|
|
(2,085
|
)
|
|
|
(1,271
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3,367
|
)
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,073
|
|
|
|
1,336
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,409
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
776
|
|
|
|
640
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,416
|
|
Income taxes
|
|
|
(448
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(448
|
)
|
Gains on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(5
|
)
|
|
|
(92
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(97
|
)
|
Impairment of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
64
|
|
Amortization of deferred loan costs
|
|
|
79
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
79
|
|
Share-based compensation
|
|
|
32
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
32
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(2,100
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,100
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(19
|
)
|
|
|
19
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
|
|
|
(1,775
|
)
|
|
|
2,474
|
|
|
|
1,291
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,990
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from investing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Purchase of property and equipment
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(927
|
)
|
|
|
(673
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,600
|
)
|
Acquisition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(34
|
)
|
|
|
(51
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(85
|
)
|
Disposal of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
27
|
|
|
|
166
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
193
|
|
Change in investments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(26
|
)
|
|
|
47
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
21
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(4
|
)
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in investing activities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(964
|
)
|
|
|
(503
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,467
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from financing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net change in revolving bank credit facilities
|
|
|
700
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
700
|
|
Repayment of long-term debt
|
|
|
(851
|
)
|
|
|
(4
|
)
|
|
|
(105
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(960
|
)
|
Distributions to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(32
|
)
|
|
|
(146
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(178
|
)
|
Changes in intercompany balances with affiliates, net
|
|
|
1,935
|
|
|
|
(1,505
|
)
|
|
|
(430
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
(9
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(4
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(13
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
|
|
|
1,775
|
|
|
|
(1,541
|
)
|
|
|
(685
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(451
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in cash and cash equivalents
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(31
|
)
|
|
|
103
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
72
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
165
|
|
|
|
228
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
393
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
134
|
|
|
$
|
331
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
465
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-40
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION (Continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
For The Year Ended December 31, 2007
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Cash flows from operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
$
|
874
|
|
|
$
|
1,476
|
|
|
$
|
977
|
|
|
$
|
(2,245
|
)
|
|
$
|
1,082
|
|
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by
(used in) operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in operating assets and liabilities
|
|
|
(6
|
)
|
|
|
(2,127
|
)
|
|
|
(1,482
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3,615
|
)
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,942
|
|
|
|
1,188
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,130
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
779
|
|
|
|
647
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,426
|
|
Income taxes
|
|
|
(105
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(105
|
)
|
Gains on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3
|
)
|
|
|
(468
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(471
|
)
|
Impairment of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
Amortization of deferred loan costs
|
|
|
78
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
78
|
|
Share-based compensation
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(2,245
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,245
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
(34
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(9
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
|
|
|
(1,373
|
)
|
|
|
2,085
|
|
|
|
852
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,564
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from investing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Purchase of property and equipment
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(640
|
)
|
|
|
(804
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,444
|
)
|
Acquisition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(11
|
)
|
|
|
(21
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(32
|
)
|
Disposal of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
743
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
767
|
|
Change in investments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
204
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
207
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(8
|
)
|
|
|
31
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(632
|
)
|
|
|
153
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(479
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from financing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net change in revolving bank credit facilities
|
|
|
(520
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(520
|
)
|
Repayment of long-term debt
|
|
|
(255
|
)
|
|
|
(4
|
)
|
|
|
(491
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(750
|
)
|
Distributions to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(12
|
)
|
|
|
(140
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(152
|
)
|
Issuances of common stock
|
|
|
100
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
100
|
|
Changes in intercompany balances with affiliates, net
|
|
|
2,059
|
|
|
|
(1,554
|
)
|
|
|
(505
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
(11
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(4
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
|
|
|
1,373
|
|
|
|
(1,570
|
)
|
|
|
(1,129
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,326
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in cash and cash equivalents
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(117
|
)
|
|
|
(124
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(241
|
)
|
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
282
|
|
|
|
352
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
634
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
165
|
|
|
$
|
228
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
393
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-41
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 16
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND OTHER
COLLATERAL-RELATED INFORMATION (Continued)
|
Healthtrust, Inc. The Hospital Company
(Healthtrust) is the first-tier subsidiary of HCA
Inc. The common stock of Healthtrust has been pledged as
collateral for the senior secured credit facilities and senior
secured notes described in Note 9. Rule 3-16 of
Regulation S-X
under the Securities Act requires the filing of separate
financial statements for any affiliate of the registrant whose
securities constitute a substantial portion of the collateral
for any class of securities registered or being registered. We
believe the separate financial statements requirement applies to
Healthtrust due to the pledge of its common stock as collateral
for the senior secured notes. Due to the corporate structure
relationship of HCA and Healthtrust, HCAs operating
subsidiaries are also the operating subsidiaries of Healthtrust.
The corporate structure relationship, combined with the
application of push-down accounting in Healthtrusts
consolidated financial statements related to HCAs debt and
financial instruments, results in the consolidated financial
statements of Healthtrust being substantially identical to the
consolidated financial statements of HCA. The consolidated
financial statements of HCA and Healthtrust present the
identical amounts for revenues, expenses, net income, assets,
liabilities, total stockholders deficit, net cash provided
by operating activities, net cash used in investing activities
and net cash used in financing activities. Certain individual
line items in the HCA consolidated statements of
stockholders deficit and cash flows are combined into one
line item in the Healthtrust consolidated statements of
stockholders deficit and cash flows.
Reconciliations of the HCA Inc. Consolidated Statements of
Stockholders Deficit and Consolidated Statements of Cash
Flows presentations to the Healthtrust, Inc. The
Hospital Company Consolidated Statements of Stockholders
Deficit and Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows presentations
for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 are as
follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
2007
|
|
|
Presentation in HCA Inc. Consolidated Statements of
Stockholders Deficit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity contributions
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
60
|
|
Share-based benefit plans
|
|
|
47
|
|
|
|
40
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
Other
|
|
|
14
|
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
28
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Presentation in Healthtrust, Inc. The Hospital
Company Consolidated Statements of Stockholders Deficit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Distributions from HCA Inc., net of contributions to HCA
Inc.
|
|
$
|
61
|
|
|
$
|
42
|
|
|
$
|
112
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Presentation in HCA Inc. Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
(cash flows from financing activities):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Issuances of common stock
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
100
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(9
|
)
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Presentation in Healthtrust Inc. The Hospital
Company Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (cash flows from
financing activities):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash distributions (to) from HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
(9
|
)
|
|
$
|
98
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Due to the consolidated financial statements of Healthtrust
being substantially identical to the consolidated financial
statements of HCA, except for the items presented in the tables
above, the separate consolidated financial statements of
Healthtrust are not presented.
F-42
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
NOTE 17
SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
January
2010 Distribution Declaration
On January 27, 2010, our Board of Directors declared a
distribution to the Companys stockholders and holders of
vested stock options. The distribution was $17.50 per share and
vested stock option, or approximately $1.750 billion in the
aggregate. The distribution was paid on February 5, 2010 to
holders of record on February 1, 2010. The distribution was
funded using funds available under our existing senior secured
credit facilities and approximately $100 million of cash on
hand. Pursuant to the terms of our stock option plans, the
holders of nonvested stock options received a $17.50 per share
reduction to the exercise price of their share-based awards.
May
2010 Distribution Declaration and Registration Statement Filing
(Unaudited)
On May 5, 2010, our Board of Directors declared a
distribution to the Companys existing stockholders and
holders of vested stock options. The distribution will be $5.00
per share and vested stock option, or approximately
$500 million in the aggregate. The distribution is expected
to be paid on May 14, 2010 to holders of record on
May 6, 2010. The distribution is expected to be funded
using funds available under our existing senior secured credit
facilities. Pursuant to the terms of our stock option plans, the
holders of nonvested stock options will receive a $5.00 per
share reduction to the exercise price of their share-based
awards.
On May 5, 2010, our Board of Directors granted approval for
the Company to file with the Securities and Exchange Commission
a registration statement on
Form S-1
relating to a proposed initial public offering of its common
stock. We expect to file the
Form S-1
on or about May 7, 2010. We intend to use the anticipated
net proceeds to repay certain of our existing indebtedness, as
will be determined prior to our offering, and for general
corporate purposes. Upon completion of the offering and in
connection with our termination of the management agreement we
have with affiliates of the Investors, we will be required to
pay a termination fee based upon the net present value of our
future obligations under the management agreement.
,
2010 Stock Split and Increase in Authorized Shares
(Unaudited)
On ,
2010, our Board of Directors approved
a
to
split of the Companys common stock, effective as
of ,
2010, and an increase in the number of authorized shares
to shares.
All common share and per share amounts in the consolidated
financial statements and notes to consolidated financial
statements have been restated to reflect the stock split.
F-43
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
First
|
|
Second
|
|
Third
|
|
Fourth
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
7,431
|
|
|
$
|
7,483
|
|
|
$
|
7,533
|
|
|
$
|
7,605
|
|
Net income
|
|
$
|
432
|
(a)
|
|
$
|
365
|
(b)
|
|
$
|
274
|
(c)
|
|
$
|
304
|
(d)
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
360
|
(a)
|
|
$
|
282
|
(b)
|
|
$
|
196
|
(c)
|
|
$
|
216
|
(d)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2008
|
|
|
First
|
|
Second
|
|
Third
|
|
Fourth
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
7,127
|
|
|
$
|
6,980
|
|
|
$
|
7,002
|
|
|
$
|
7,265
|
|
Net income
|
|
$
|
225
|
(e)
|
|
$
|
197
|
(f)
|
|
$
|
136
|
(g)
|
|
$
|
344
|
(h)
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
170
|
(e)
|
|
$
|
141
|
(f)
|
|
$
|
86
|
(g)
|
|
$
|
276
|
(h)
|
|
|
|
(a) |
|
First quarter results include $3 million of losses on sales
of facilities (See NOTE 3 of the notes to consolidated
financial statements) and $6 million of costs related to
the impairment of long-lived assets (See NOTE 4 of the
notes to consolidated financial statements). |
|
(b) |
|
Second quarter results include $2 million of losses on
sales of facilities (See NOTE 3 of the notes to
consolidated financial statements) and $2 million of costs
related to the impairment of long-lived assets (See NOTE 4
of the notes to consolidated financial statements). |
|
(c) |
|
Third quarter results include $2 million of costs related
to the impairment of long-lived assets (See NOTE 4 of the
notes to consolidated financial statements). |
|
(d) |
|
Fourth quarter results include $4 million of losses on
sales of facilities (See NOTE 3 of the notes to
consolidated financial statements) and $24 million of costs
related to the impairment of long-lived assets (See NOTE 4
of the notes to consolidated financial statements). |
|
(e) |
|
First quarter results include $30 million of gains on sales
of facilities (See NOTE 3 of the notes to consolidated
financial statements). |
|
(f) |
|
Second quarter results include $6 million of losses on
sales of facilities (See NOTE 3 of the notes to
consolidated financial statements) and $6 million of costs
related to the impairment of long-lived assets (See NOTE 4
of the notes to consolidated financial statements). |
|
(g) |
|
Third quarter results include $29 million of gains on sales
of facilities (See NOTE 3 of the notes to consolidated
financial statements) and $28 million of costs related to
the impairment of long-lived assets (See NOTE 4 of the
notes to consolidated financial statements). |
|
(h) |
|
Fourth quarter results include $5 million of gains on sales
of facilities (See NOTE 3 of the notes to consolidated
financial statements) and $6 million of costs related to
the impairment of long-lived assets (See NOTE 4 of the
notes to consolidated financial statements). |
F-44
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
7,544
|
|
|
$
|
7,431
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
3,072
|
|
|
|
2,923
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
1,200
|
|
|
|
1,210
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
1,202
|
|
|
|
1,102
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
564
|
|
|
|
807
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
355
|
|
|
|
353
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
516
|
|
|
|
471
|
|
Losses on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,859
|
|
|
|
6,812
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
685
|
|
|
|
619
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
209
|
|
|
|
187
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
476
|
|
|
|
432
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
88
|
|
|
|
72
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
360
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See accompanying notes.
F-45
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
December 31,
|
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
ASSETS
|
Current assets:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
312
|
|
Accounts receivable, less allowance for doubtful accounts of
$4,519 and $4,860
|
|
|
3,878
|
|
|
|
3,692
|
|
Inventories
|
|
|
794
|
|
|
|
802
|
|
Deferred income taxes
|
|
|
1,181
|
|
|
|
1,192
|
|
Other
|
|
|
497
|
|
|
|
579
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,738
|
|
|
|
6,577
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Property and equipment, at cost
|
|
|
24,766
|
|
|
|
24,669
|
|
Accumulated depreciation
|
|
|
(13,514
|
)
|
|
|
(13,242
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,252
|
|
|
|
11,427
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investments of insurance subsidiary
|
|
|
1,146
|
|
|
|
1,166
|
|
Investments in and advances to affiliates
|
|
|
851
|
|
|
|
853
|
|
Goodwill
|
|
|
2,561
|
|
|
|
2,577
|
|
Deferred loan costs
|
|
|
411
|
|
|
|
418
|
|
Other
|
|
|
1,132
|
|
|
|
1,113
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,091
|
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS DEFICIT
|
Current liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts payable
|
|
$
|
1,199
|
|
|
$
|
1,460
|
|
Accrued salaries
|
|
|
893
|
|
|
|
849
|
|
Other accrued expenses
|
|
|
1,498
|
|
|
|
1,158
|
|
Long-term debt due within one year
|
|
|
981
|
|
|
|
846
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,571
|
|
|
|
4,313
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Long-term debt
|
|
|
25,874
|
|
|
|
24,824
|
|
Professional liability risks
|
|
|
1,058
|
|
|
|
1,057
|
|
Income taxes and other liabilities
|
|
|
1,742
|
|
|
|
1,768
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity securities with contingent redemption rights
|
|
|
144
|
|
|
|
147
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stockholders deficit:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Common stock $0.01 par; authorized 125,000,000 shares;
outstanding 94,626,100 shares in 2010 and
94,637,400 shares in 2009
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
Capital in excess of par value
|
|
|
291
|
|
|
|
226
|
|
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
|
|
|
(479
|
)
|
|
|
(450
|
)
|
Retained deficit
|
|
|
(10,126
|
)
|
|
|
(8,763
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stockholders deficit attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
|
(10,313
|
)
|
|
|
(8,986
|
)
|
Noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
1,015
|
|
|
|
1,008
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(9,298
|
)
|
|
|
(7,978
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,091
|
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
See accompanying notes.
F-46
Unaudited
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Cash flows from operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
$
|
476
|
|
|
$
|
432
|
|
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by
operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
|
|
|
(838
|
)
|
|
|
(1,111
|
)
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
564
|
|
|
|
807
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
355
|
|
|
|
353
|
|
Income taxes
|
|
|
280
|
|
|
|
41
|
|
Losses on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
Amortization of deferred loan costs
|
|
|
20
|
|
|
|
21
|
|
Share-based compensation
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
Pay-in-kind
interest
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
39
|
|
Other
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
12
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by operating activities
|
|
|
901
|
|
|
|
615
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from investing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Purchase of property and equipment
|
|
|
(214
|
)
|
|
|
(337
|
)
|
Acquisition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
(21
|
)
|
|
|
(38
|
)
|
Disposition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Change in investments
|
|
|
29
|
|
|
|
76
|
|
Other
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in investing activities
|
|
|
(181
|
)
|
|
|
(288
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from financing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Issuance of long-term debt
|
|
|
1,387
|
|
|
|
300
|
|
Net change in revolving credit facilities
|
|
|
1,339
|
|
|
|
(335
|
)
|
Repayment of long-term debt
|
|
|
(1,510
|
)
|
|
|
(339
|
)
|
Distributions to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
(83
|
)
|
|
|
(55
|
)
|
Payment of debt issuance costs
|
|
|
(25
|
)
|
|
|
(14
|
)
|
Payment of cash distribution to stockholders
|
|
|
(1,751
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in financing activities
|
|
|
(644
|
)
|
|
|
(436
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in cash and cash equivalents
|
|
|
76
|
|
|
|
(109
|
)
|
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
|
|
|
312
|
|
|
|
465
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
356
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest payments
|
|
$
|
374
|
|
|
$
|
344
|
|
Income tax (refunds) payments, net
|
|
$
|
(71
|
)
|
|
$
|
146
|
|
See accompanying notes.
F-47
HCA
INC.
Unaudited
|
|
NOTE 1
|
INTERIM
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
|
Merger,
Recapitalization and Reporting Entity
On November 17, 2006, HCA Inc. completed its merger (the
Merger) with Hercules Acquisition Corporation,
pursuant to which the Company was acquired by Hercules Holding
II, LLC (Hercules Holding), a Delaware limited
liability company owned by a private investor group comprised of
affiliates of or funds sponsored by Bain Capital Partners, LLC,
Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., Merrill Lynch Global
Private Equity (now BAML Capital Partners) (each a
Sponsor), affiliates of Citigroup Inc. and Bank of
America Corporation (the Sponsor Assignees) and
affiliates of HCA founder, Dr. Thomas F. Frist, Jr., (the
Frist Entities, and together with the Sponsors and
the Sponsor Assignees, the Investors) and by members
of management and certain other investors. The Merger, the
financing transactions related to the Merger and other related
transactions are collectively referred to in this quarterly
report as the Recapitalization. The Merger was
accounted for as a recapitalization in our financial statements,
with no adjustments to the historical basis of our assets and
liabilities. As a result of the Recapitalization, our
outstanding capital stock is owned by the Investors, certain
members of management and key employees. On April 29, 2008,
we registered our common stock pursuant to Section 12(g) of
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, thus subjecting
us to the reporting requirements of Section 13(a) of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. Our common stock is
not traded on a national securities exchange.
HCA Inc. is a holding company whose affiliates own and operate
hospitals and related health care entities. The term
affiliates includes direct and indirect subsidiaries
of HCA Inc. and partnerships and joint ventures in which such
subsidiaries are partners. At March 31, 2010, these
affiliates owned and operated 154 hospitals, 98 freestanding
surgery centers and facilities which provided extensive
outpatient and ancillary services. Affiliates of HCA are also
partners in joint ventures that own and operate eight hospitals
and eight freestanding surgery centers which are accounted for
using the equity method. The Companys facilities are
located in 20 states and England. The terms
HCA, Company, we,
our or us, as used in this quarterly
report on
Form 10-Q,
refer to HCA Inc. and its affiliates unless otherwise stated or
indicated by context.
Basis of
Presentation
The accompanying unaudited condensed consolidated financial
statements have been prepared in accordance with generally
accepted accounting principles for interim financial information
and with the instructions to
Form 10-Q
and Article 10 of
Regulation S-X.
Accordingly, they do not include all the information and
footnotes required by generally accepted accounting principles
for complete consolidated financial statements. In the opinion
of management, all adjustments considered necessary for a fair
presentation have been included and are of a normal and
recurring nature. In accordance with Accounting Standards
Codification (ASC) 810, Consolidation
(ASC 810), references in this report to
net income attributable to HCA Inc. and stockholders
deficit attributable to HCA Inc. do not include noncontrolling
interests (previously reported as minority
interests), which we now report separately. The
implementation of ASC 810 also results in the cash flow
impact of distributions to and certain other transactions with
noncontrolling interests that were previously classified within
operating activities, being classified within financing
activities. Such treatment is consistent with the view that,
under ASC 810, transactions between HCA Inc. and
noncontrolling interests are considered to be equity
transactions.
The majority of our expenses are cost of revenue
items. Costs that could be classified as general and
administrative would include our corporate office costs, which
were $38 million and $37 million for the quarters
ended March 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Operating
results for the quarter ended March 31, 2010 are not
necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for
the year ending December 31, 2010. For further information,
refer to the consolidated financial statements and footnotes
thereto included in our annual report on
Form 10-K
for the year ended December 31, 2009.
F-48
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 1
|
INTERIM
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (continued)
|
Basis of
Presentation (continued)
Certain prior year amounts have been reclassified to conform to
the current year presentation.
At March 31, 2010, we were contesting before the Appeals
Division of the Internal Revenue Service (IRS),
certain claimed deficiencies and adjustments proposed by the IRS
in connection with its examination of the 2003 and 2004 federal
income tax returns for HCA and eight affiliates that are treated
as partnerships for federal income tax purposes
(affiliated partnerships). The disputed items
include the timing of recognition of certain patient service
revenues and our method for calculating the tax allowance for
doubtful accounts.
Six taxable periods of HCA and its predecessors ended in 1997
through 2002 and the 2002 taxable year of four affiliated
partnerships, for which the primary remaining issue is the
computation of the tax allowance for doubtful accounts, were
pending before the IRS Examination Division as of March 31,
2010.
We expect the IRS Examination Division will complete its audit
of HCAs 2005 and 2006 federal income tax returns and will
begin an audit of the 2007, 2008 and 2009 federal income tax
returns for HCA and one or more affiliated partnerships during
2010.
Our liability for unrecognized tax benefits was
$550 million, including accrued interest of
$137 million as of March 31, 2010 ($628 million
and $156 million, respectively, as of December 31,
2009). The reduction in our liability for unrecognized tax
benefits was principally based on new information received
related to tax positions taken in prior years. Unrecognized tax
benefits of $201 million ($236 million as of
December 31, 2009) would affect the effective rate, if
recognized. The liability for unrecognized tax benefits does not
reflect deferred tax assets of $71 million
($77 million as of December 31, 2009) related to
deductible interest and state income taxes or a refundable
deposit of $104 million, which is recorded in noncurrent
assets. The provision for income taxes reflects reductions of
$15 million and $20 million in interest expense
related to taxing authority examinations for the quarters ended
March 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
Depending on the resolution of the IRS disputes, the completion
of examinations by federal, state or international taxing
authorities, or the expiration of statutes of limitation for
specific taxing jurisdictions, we believe it is reasonably
possible our liability for unrecognized tax benefits may
significantly increase or decrease within the next
12 months. However, we are currently unable to estimate the
range of any possible change.
F-49
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 3
|
INVESTMENTS
OF INSURANCE SUBSIDIARY
|
A summary of our insurance subsidiarys investments at
March 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009 follows (dollars
in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 31, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unrealized
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amortized
|
|
|
Amounts
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
|
Cost
|
|
|
Gains
|
|
|
Losses
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Debt securities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
States and municipalities
|
|
$
|
648
|
|
|
$
|
29
|
|
|
$
|
(2
|
)
|
|
$
|
675
|
|
Auction rate securities
|
|
|
336
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3
|
)
|
|
|
333
|
|
Asset-backed securities
|
|
|
40
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
39
|
|
Money market funds
|
|
|
249
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
249
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,273
|
|
|
|
29
|
|
|
|
(6
|
)
|
|
|
1,296
|
|
Equity securities
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,281
|
|
|
$
|
29
|
|
|
$
|
(7
|
)
|
|
|
1,303
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amounts classified as current assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(157
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investment carrying value
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,146
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
December 31, 2009
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unrealized
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amortized
|
|
|
Amounts
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
|
Cost
|
|
|
Gains
|
|
|
Losses
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Debt securities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
States and municipalities
|
|
$
|
668
|
|
|
$
|
30
|
|
|
$
|
(3
|
)
|
|
$
|
695
|
|
Auction rate securities
|
|
|
401
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(5
|
)
|
|
|
396
|
|
Asset-backed securities
|
|
|
43
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
42
|
|
Money market funds
|
|
|
176
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
176
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,288
|
|
|
|
30
|
|
|
|
(9
|
)
|
|
|
1,309
|
|
Equity securities
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,296
|
|
|
$
|
31
|
|
|
$
|
(11
|
)
|
|
|
1,316
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amounts classified as current assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(150
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investment carrying value
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,166
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
At March 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009, the
investments of our insurance subsidiary were classified as
available-for-sale.
Changes in temporary unrealized gains and losses are recorded as
adjustments to other comprehensive income. At March 31,
2010 and December 31, 2009, $92 million and
$100 million, respectively, of our investments were subject
to restrictions included in insurance bond collateralization and
assumed reinsurance contracts.
F-50
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 3
|
INVESTMENTS
OF INSURANCE SUBSIDIARY (continued)
|
Scheduled maturities of investments in debt securities at
March 31, 2010 were as follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Amortized
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
|
Cost
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Due in one year or less
|
|
$
|
295
|
|
|
$
|
296
|
|
Due after one year through five years
|
|
|
298
|
|
|
|
312
|
|
Due after five years through ten years
|
|
|
186
|
|
|
|
197
|
|
Due after ten years
|
|
|
118
|
|
|
|
119
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
897
|
|
|
|
924
|
|
Auction rate securities
|
|
|
336
|
|
|
|
333
|
|
Asset-backed securities
|
|
|
40
|
|
|
|
39
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,273
|
|
|
$
|
1,296
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The average expected maturity of the investments in debt
securities at March 31, 2010 was 3.1 years, compared
to the average scheduled maturity of 10.8 years. Expected
and scheduled maturities may differ because the issuers of
certain securities have the right to call, prepay or otherwise
redeem such obligations prior to the scheduled maturity date.
The average expected maturities for our auction rate and
asset-backed securities were derived from valuation models of
expected cash flows and involved managements judgment. The
average expected maturities for our auction rate and
asset-backed securities at March 31, 2010 were
4.3 years and 5.9 years, respectively, compared to
average scheduled maturities of 25.1 years and
25.7 years, respectively.
A summary of long-term debt at March 31, 2010 and
December 31, 2009, including related interest rates at
March 31, 2010, follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
December 31,
|
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility (effective
interest rate of 1.7%)
|
|
$
|
1,825
|
|
|
$
|
715
|
|
Senior secured revolving credit facility (effective interest
rate of 2.0%)
|
|
|
229
|
|
|
|
|
|
Senior secured term loan facilities (effective interest rate of
6.7%)
|
|
|
7,594
|
|
|
|
8,987
|
|
Senior secured first lien notes (effective interest rate of 8.4%)
|
|
|
4,071
|
|
|
|
2,682
|
|
Other senior secured debt (effective interest rate of 7.0%)
|
|
|
345
|
|
|
|
362
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
First lien debt
|
|
|
14,064
|
|
|
|
12,746
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Senior secured cash-pay notes (effective interest rate of 9.7%)
|
|
|
4,501
|
|
|
|
4,500
|
|
Senior secured toggle notes (effective interest rate of 10.0%)
|
|
|
1,578
|
|
|
|
1,578
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Second lien debt
|
|
|
6,079
|
|
|
|
6,078
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Senior unsecured notes (effective interest rate of 7.1%)
|
|
|
6,712
|
|
|
|
6,846
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total debt (average life of six years, rates averaging 7.4%)
|
|
|
26,855
|
|
|
|
25,670
|
|
Less amounts due within one year
|
|
|
981
|
|
|
|
846
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
25,874
|
|
|
$
|
24,824
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-51
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 4
|
LONG-TERM
DEBT (continued)
|
During February 2009, we issued $310 million aggregate
principal amount of
97/8% senior
secured second lien notes due 2017 at a price of 96.673% of
their face value, resulting in $300 million of gross
proceeds. During April 2009, we issued $1.500 billion
aggregate principal amount of
81/2% senior
secured first lien notes due 2019 at a price of 96.755% of their
face value, resulting in $1.451 billion of gross proceeds.
During August 2009, we issued $1.250 billion aggregate
principal amount of
77/8% senior
secured first lien notes due 2020 at a price of 98.254% of their
face value, resulting in $1.228 billion of gross proceeds.
During March 2010, we issued $1.400 billion aggregate
principal amount of
71/4% senior
secured first lien notes due 2020 at a price of 99.095% of their
face value, resulting in $1.387 billion of gross proceeds.
After the payment of related fees and expenses, we used the
proceeds from these 2009 and 2010 debt issuances to repay
outstanding indebtedness under our senior secured term loan
facilities.
|
|
NOTE 5
|
FINANCIAL
INSTRUMENTS
|
Interest
Rate Swap Agreements
We have entered into interest rate swap agreements to manage our
exposure to fluctuations in interest rates. These swap
agreements involve the exchange of fixed and variable rate
interest payments between two parties based on common notional
principal amounts and maturity dates. Pay-fixed interest rate
swaps effectively convert LIBOR indexed variable rate
obligations to fixed interest rate obligations. Pay-variable
interest rate swaps effectively convert fixed interest rate
obligations to LIBOR indexed variable rate obligations. The net
interest payments, based on the notional amounts in these
agreements, generally match the timing of the related
liabilities, for the interest rate swap agreements which have
been designated as cash flow hedges. The notional amounts of the
swap agreements represent amounts used to calculate the exchange
of cash flows and are not our assets or liabilities. Our credit
risk related to these agreements is considered low because the
swap agreements are with creditworthy financial institutions.
The interest payments under these agreements are settled on a
net basis.
During March 2010, the application of the net proceeds from
our issuance of $1.400 billion aggregate principal amount
of
71/4% senior
secured first lien notes to repay variable rate debt resulted in
our remaining outstanding variable rate indebtedness being less
than the notional amounts of the related pay-fixed interest rate
swaps, which had been designated as cash flow hedges. Therefore,
we dedesignated $1.400 billion notional amount of our
pay-fixed interest rate swaps and entered into
$1.400 billion notional amount of pay-variable interest
rate swaps, which we expect to produce approximately offsetting
changes in fair value through the swap maturity dates.
The following table sets forth our interest rate swap
agreements, which have been designated as cash flow hedges, at
March 31, 2010 (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notional
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
|
Maturity Date
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Pay-fixed interest rate swaps
|
|
$
|
7,100
|
|
|
|
November 2011
|
|
|
$
|
(448
|
)
|
Pay-fixed interest rate swaps (starting November 2011)
|
|
|
2,000
|
|
|
|
December 2016
|
|
|
|
(24
|
)
|
F-52
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 5
|
FINANCIAL
INSTRUMENTS (continued)
|
Interest
Rate Swap Agreements (continued)
Certain of our interest rate swaps are not designated as hedges,
and changes in fair value are recognized in results of
operations. The following table sets forth our interest rate
swap agreements, which were not designated as hedges, at
March 31, 2010 (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notional
|
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
Maturity Date
|
|
Value
|
|
Pay-fixed interest rate swap
|
|
$
|
500
|
|
|
|
March 2011
|
|
|
$
|
(12
|
)
|
Pay-variable interest rate swap
|
|
|
500
|
|
|
|
March 2011
|
|
|
|
|
|
Pay-fixed interest rate swap
|
|
|
900
|
|
|
|
November 2011
|
|
|
|
(56
|
)
|
Pay-variable interest rate swap
|
|
|
900
|
|
|
|
November 2011
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
During the next 12 months, we estimate $368 million
will be reclassified from other comprehensive income
(OCI) to interest expense.
Cross
Currency Swaps
The Company and certain subsidiaries have incurred obligations
and entered into various intercompany transactions where such
obligations are denominated in currencies, other than the
functional currencies of the parties executing the trade. In
order to mitigate the currency exposure risks and better match
the cash flows of our obligations and intercompany transactions
with cash flows from operations, we entered into various cross
currency swaps. Our credit risk related to these agreements is
considered low because the swap agreements are with creditworthy
financial institutions.
Certain of our cross currency swaps are not designated as
hedges, and changes in fair value are recognized in results of
operations. The following table sets forth our cross currency
swap agreement which was not designated as a hedge at
March 31, 2010 (amounts in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notional
|
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
Maturity Date
|
|
Value
|
|
Euro United States Dollar currency swap
|
|
|
351 Euro
|
|
|
|
December 2011
|
|
|
$
|
45
|
|
The following table sets forth our cross currency swap
agreements, which have been designated as cash flow hedges, at
March 31, 2010 (amounts in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Notional
|
|
|
|
Fair
|
|
|
Amount
|
|
Maturity Date
|
|
Value
|
|
GBP United States Dollar currency swaps
|
|
|
100 GBP
|
|
|
|
November 2010
|
|
|
$
|
(24
|
)
|
Derivatives Results
of Operations
The following tables present the effect on our results of
operations of our interest rate and cross currency swaps for the
quarter ended March 31, 2010 (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Location of Loss
|
|
|
Amount of Loss
|
|
|
|
Amount of Loss
|
|
|
Reclassified from
|
|
|
Reclassified from
|
|
|
|
Recognized in OCI on
|
|
|
Accumulated OCI
|
|
|
Accumulated OCI
|
|
Derivatives in Cash Flow Hedging Relationships
|
|
Derivatives, Net of Tax
|
|
|
into Operations
|
|
|
into Operations
|
|
|
Interest rate swaps
|
|
$
|
67
|
|
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
$
|
95
|
|
Cross currency swaps
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
74
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
95
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-53
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 5
|
FINANCIAL
INSTRUMENTS (continued)
|
Derivatives Results
of Operations (continued)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Location of Loss
|
|
Amount of Loss
|
|
|
Recognized in
|
|
Recognized in
|
|
|
Operations on
|
|
Operations on
|
Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
|
|
Derivatives
|
|
Derivatives
|
|
Interest rate swaps
|
|
|
Other operating expense
|
|
|
$
|
1
|
|
Cross currency swap
|
|
|
Other operating expense
|
|
|
|
34
|
|
Credit-risk-related
Contingent Features
We have agreements with each of our derivative counterparties
that contain a provision where we could be declared in default
on our derivative obligations if repayment of the underlying
indebtedness is accelerated by the lender due to our default on
the indebtedness. As of March 31, 2010, we have not been
required to post any collateral related to these agreements. If
we had breached these provisions at March 31, 2010, we
would have been required to settle our obligations under the
agreements at their aggregate, estimated termination value of
$586 million.
|
|
NOTE 6
|
ASSETS
AND LIABILITIES MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE
|
ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures
(ASC 820) defines fair value, establishes a
framework for measuring fair value, and expands disclosures
about fair value measurements. ASC 820 applies to reported
balances that are required or permitted to be measured at fair
value under existing accounting pronouncements.
ASC 820 emphasizes fair value is a market-based measurement, not
an entity-specific measurement. Therefore, a fair value
measurement should be determined based on the assumptions market
participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. As a
basis for considering market participant assumptions in fair
value measurements, ASC 820 establishes a fair value
hierarchy that distinguishes between market participant
assumptions based on market data obtained from sources
independent of the reporting entity (observable inputs
classified within Levels 1 and 2 of the hierarchy) and the
reporting entitys own assumptions about market participant
assumptions (unobservable inputs classified within Level 3
of the hierarchy).
Level 1 inputs utilize quoted prices (unadjusted) in active
markets for identical assets or liabilities. Level 2 inputs
are inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1
that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly
or indirectly. Level 2 inputs may include quoted prices for
similar assets and liabilities in active markets, as well as
inputs observable for the asset or liability (other than quoted
prices), such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, and
yield curves observable at commonly quoted intervals.
Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or
liability, which are typically based on an entitys own
assumptions, as there is little, if any, related market
activity. In instances where the determination of the fair value
measurement is based on inputs from different levels of the fair
value hierarchy, the level in the fair value hierarchy within
which the entire fair value measurement falls is based on the
lowest level input significant to the fair value measurement in
its entirety. Our assessment of the significance of a particular
input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires
judgment, and considers factors specific to the asset or
liability.
Cash
Traded Investments
Our cash traded investments are generally classified within
Level 1 or Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy because
they are valued using quoted market prices, broker or dealer
quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable
levels of price transparency. Certain types of cash traded
instruments are classified within Level 3 of the fair value
hierarchy because they trade infrequently and therefore have
little or no price
F-54
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 6
|
ASSETS
AND LIABILITIES MEASURED AT FAIR
VALUE (continued)
|
Cash
Traded Investments (continued)
transparency. Such instruments include auction rate securities
(ARS) and limited partnership investments. The
transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair
value.
Our wholly-owned insurance subsidiary had investments in
municipal, tax-exempt ARS, which are backed by student loans
substantially guaranteed by the federal government, of
$333 million ($336 million par value) at
March 31, 2010. We do not currently intend to attempt to
sell the ARS as the liquidity needs of our insurance subsidiary
are expected to be met by other investments in its investment
portfolio. These securities continue to accrue and pay interest
semi-annually based on the failed auction maximum rate formulas
stated in their respective Official Statements. During 2009 and
the first quarter of 2010, certain issuers and their
broker/dealers redeemed or repurchased $172 million and
$65 million, respectively, of our ARS at par value. The
valuation of these securities involved managements
judgment, after consideration of market factors and the absence
of market transparency, market liquidity and observable inputs.
Our valuation models derived a fair market value compared to
tax-equivalent yields of other student loan backed variable rate
securities of similar credit worthiness and similar effective
maturities.
Derivative
Financial Instruments
We have entered into interest rate and cross currency swap
agreements to manage our exposure to fluctuations in interest
rates and foreign currency risks. The valuation of these
instruments is determined using widely accepted valuation
techniques, including discounted cash flow analysis on the
expected cash flows of each derivative. This analysis reflects
the contractual terms of the derivatives, including the period
to maturity, and uses observable market-based inputs, including
interest rate curves, foreign exchange rates and implied
volatilities. To comply with the provisions of ASC 820, we
incorporate credit valuation adjustments to reflect both our own
nonperformance risk and the respective counterpartys
nonperformance risk in the fair value measurements.
Although we have determined the majority of the inputs used to
value our derivatives fall within Level 2 of the fair value
hierarchy, the credit valuation adjustments associated with our
derivatives utilize Level 3 inputs, such as estimates of
current credit spreads to evaluate the likelihood of default by
us and our counterparties. However, we have assessed the
significance of the impact of the credit valuation adjustments
on the overall valuation of our derivative positions and have
determined that the credit valuation adjustments were not
significant to the overall valuation of our derivatives at
March 31, 2010. As a result, we have determined that our
derivative valuations in their entirety are classified in
Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy at March 31, 2010.
F-55
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 6
|
ASSETS
AND LIABILITIES MEASURED AT FAIR
VALUE (continued)
|
Fair
Value Summary
The following table summarizes our assets and liabilities
measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of March 31,
2010, aggregated by the level in the fair value hierarchy within
which those measurements fall (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Fair Value Measurements Using
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Quoted Prices in
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Active Markets for
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Identical Assets
|
|
|
Significant Other
|
|
|
Significant
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
and Liabilities
|
|
|
Observable Inputs
|
|
|
Unobservable Inputs
|
|
|
|
Fair Value
|
|
|
(Level 1)
|
|
|
(Level 2)
|
|
|
(Level 3)
|
|
|
Assets:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investments of insurance subsidiary:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Debt securities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
States and municipalities
|
|
$
|
675
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
675
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Auction rate securities
|
|
|
333
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
333
|
|
Asset-backed securities
|
|
|
39
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
39
|
|
|
|
|
|
Money market funds
|
|
|
249
|
|
|
|
249
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,296
|
|
|
|
249
|
|
|
|
714
|
|
|
|
333
|
|
Equity securities
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Investments of insurance subsidiary
|
|
|
1,303
|
|
|
|
251
|
|
|
|
718
|
|
|
|
334
|
|
Less amounts classified as current assets
|
|
|
(157
|
)
|
|
|
(157
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,146
|
|
|
$
|
94
|
|
|
$
|
718
|
|
|
$
|
334
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cross currency swap (Other assets)
|
|
$
|
45
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
45
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
Liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Interest rate swaps (Income taxes and other liabilities)
|
|
|
541
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
541
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cross currency swaps (Income taxes and other liabilities)
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
The following table summarizes the activity related to the
auction rate and equity securities investments of our insurance
subsidiary, which have fair value measurements based on
significant unobservable inputs (Level 3), during the
quarter ended March 31, 2010 (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
Asset balances at December 31, 2009
|
|
$
|
397
|
|
Unrealized gains included in other comprehensive income
|
|
|
2
|
|
Settlements
|
|
|
(65
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
Asset balances at March 31, 2010
|
|
$
|
334
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The estimated fair value of our long-term debt was
$27.007 billion and $25.659 billion at March 31,
2010 and December 31, 2009, respectively, compared to
carrying amounts aggregating $26.855 billion and
$25.670 billion, respectively. The estimates of fair value
are generally based upon the quoted market prices or quoted
market prices for similar issues of long-term debt with the same
maturities.
We operate in a highly regulated and litigious industry. As a
result, various lawsuits, claims and legal and regulatory
proceedings have been and can be expected to be instituted or
asserted against us. The resolution of
F-56
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 7
|
CONTINGENCIES (continued)
|
any such lawsuits, claims or legal and regulatory proceedings
could have a material, adverse effect on our results of
operations or financial position in a given period.
We are subject to claims and suits arising in the ordinary
course of business, including claims for personal injuries or
wrongful restriction of, or interference with, physicians
staff privileges. In certain of these actions the claimants may
seek punitive damages against us which may not be covered by
insurance. It is managements opinion that the ultimate
resolution of these pending claims and legal proceedings will
not have a material, adverse effect on our results of operations
or financial position.
|
|
NOTE 8
|
COMPREHENSIVE
INCOME AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE
|
The components of comprehensive income, net of related taxes,
for the quarters ended March 31, 2010 and 2009 are only
attributable to HCA Inc. and are as follows (dollars in
millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
360
|
|
Change in fair value of derivative instruments
|
|
|
(12
|
)
|
|
|
(8
|
)
|
Change in fair value of
available-for-sale
securities
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
Foreign currency translation adjustments
|
|
|
(21
|
)
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
Defined benefit plans
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Comprehensive income
|
|
$
|
359
|
|
|
$
|
356
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The components of accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of
related taxes, are as follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
March 31,
|
|
|
December 31,
|
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Change in fair value of derivative instruments
|
|
$
|
(367
|
)
|
|
$
|
(355
|
)
|
Change in fair value of
available-for-sale
securities
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
14
|
|
Foreign currency translation adjustments
|
|
|
(24
|
)
|
|
|
(3
|
)
|
Defined benefit plans
|
|
|
(103
|
)
|
|
|
(106
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
|
|
$
|
(479
|
)
|
|
$
|
(450
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The changes in stockholders deficit, including changes in
stockholders deficit attributable to HCA Inc. and changes
in equity attributable to noncontrolling interests are as
follows (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity (Deficit) Attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Capital in
|
|
|
Accumulated
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Common Stock
|
|
|
Excess of
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
Attributable to
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Shares
|
|
|
Par
|
|
|
Par
|
|
|
Comprehensive
|
|
|
Retained
|
|
|
Noncontrolling
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(000)
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Value
|
|
|
Loss
|
|
|
Deficit
|
|
|
Interests
|
|
|
Total
|
|
|
Balances, December 31, 2009
|
|
|
94,637
|
|
|
$
|
1
|
|
|
$
|
226
|
|
|
$
|
(450
|
)
|
|
$
|
(8,763
|
)
|
|
$
|
1,008
|
|
|
$
|
(7,978
|
)
|
Net income
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
388
|
|
|
|
88
|
|
|
|
476
|
|
Other comprehensive loss
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(29
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(29
|
)
|
Distributions
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,751
|
)
|
|
|
(83
|
)
|
|
|
(1,834
|
)
|
Share-based benefit plans
|
|
|
(11
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
41
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
41
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
26
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Balances, March 31, 2010
|
|
|
94,626
|
|
|
$
|
1
|
|
|
$
|
291
|
|
|
$
|
(479
|
)
|
|
$
|
(10,126
|
)
|
|
$
|
1,015
|
|
|
$
|
(9,298
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-57
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 8
|
COMPREHENSIVE
INCOME AND CAPITAL STRUCTURE (continued)
|
On January 27, 2010, our Board of Directors declared a
distribution to the Companys stockholders and holders of
vested stock options. The distribution was $17.50 per share and
vested stock option, or $1.751 billion in the aggregate.
The distribution was paid on February 5, 2010 to holders of
record on February 1, 2010. The distribution was funded
using funds available under our existing senior secured credit
facilities and approximately $100 million of cash on hand.
Pursuant to the terms of our stock option plans, the holders of
nonvested stock options received a $17.50 per share reduction to
the exercise price of their share-based awards.
|
|
NOTE 9
|
SEGMENT
AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION
|
We operate in one line of business, which is operating hospitals
and related health care entities. During the quarters ended
March 31, 2010 and 2009, approximately 25% and 24%,
respectively, of our patient revenues related to patients
participating in the
fee-for-service
Medicare program.
Our operations are structured into three geographically
organized groups: the Eastern Group includes 48 consolidating
hospitals located in the Eastern United States, the Central
Group includes 45 consolidating hospitals located in the Central
United States and the Western Group includes 55 consolidating
hospitals located in the Western United States. We also operate
six consolidating hospitals in England, and these facilities are
included in the Corporate and other group.
Adjusted segment EBITDA is defined as income before depreciation
and amortization, interest expense, losses on sales of
facilities, impairments of long-lived assets, income taxes and
noncontrolling interests. We use adjusted segment EBITDA as an
analytical indicator for purposes of allocating resources to
geographic areas and assessing their performance. Adjusted
segment EBITDA is commonly used as an analytical indicator
within the health care industry, and also serves as a measure of
leverage capacity and debt service ability. Adjusted segment
EBITDA should not be considered as a measure of financial
performance under generally accepted accounting principles, and
the items excluded from adjusted segment EBITDA are significant
components in understanding and assessing financial performance.
Because adjusted segment EBITDA is not a measurement determined
in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and
is thus susceptible to varying calculations, adjusted segment
EBITDA, as presented, may not be comparable to other similarly
titled measures of other companies. The geographic distributions
of our revenues, equity in earnings of
F-58
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 9
|
SEGMENT
AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION (continued)
|
affiliates, adjusted segment EBITDA and depreciation and
amortization for the quarters ended March 31, 2010 and 2009
are summarized in the following table (dollars in millions):
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2010
|
|
|
2009
|
|
|
Revenues:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Central Group
|
|
$
|
1,764
|
|
|
$
|
1,803
|
|
Eastern Group
|
|
|
2,233
|
|
|
|
2,275
|
|
Western Group
|
|
|
3,308
|
|
|
|
3,151
|
|
Corporate and other
|
|
|
239
|
|
|
|
202
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
7,544
|
|
|
$
|
7,431
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Central Group
|
|
$
|
(1
|
)
|
|
$
|
(1
|
)
|
Eastern Group
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Western Group
|
|
|
(67
|
)
|
|
|
(67
|
)
|
Corporate and other
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
(68
|
)
|
|
$
|
(68
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Adjusted segment EBITDA:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Central Group
|
|
$
|
342
|
|
|
$
|
351
|
|
Eastern Group
|
|
|
440
|
|
|
|
433
|
|
Western Group
|
|
|
791
|
|
|
|
733
|
|
Corporate and other
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
(60
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,574
|
|
|
$
|
1,457
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Depreciation and amortization:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Central Group
|
|
$
|
87
|
|
|
$
|
88
|
|
Eastern Group
|
|
|
91
|
|
|
|
90
|
|
Western Group
|
|
|
144
|
|
|
|
144
|
|
Corporate and other
|
|
|
33
|
|
|
|
31
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
355
|
|
|
$
|
353
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Adjusted segment EBITDA
|
|
$
|
1,574
|
|
|
$
|
1,457
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
355
|
|
|
|
353
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
516
|
|
|
|
471
|
|
Losses on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
$
|
685
|
|
|
$
|
619
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-59
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 10
|
ACQUISITIONS,
DISPOSITIONS AND IMPAIRMENT OF LONG-LIVED ASSETS
|
During the quarters ended March 31, 2010 and 2009, we paid
$21 million and $38 million, respectively, to acquire
nonhospital health care entities.
During the quarter ended March 31, 2010, we received
proceeds of $24 million related to sales of real estate
investments and the proceeds were equal to the carrying amounts.
During the quarter ended March 31, 2009, we received
proceeds of $5 million and recognized a net pretax loss of
$5 million related to sales of hospital facilities and
other investments.
During the quarter ended March 31, 2010, we recorded
charges of $18 million to adjust the values of real estate
and other investments in our Eastern, Western and Corporate and
Other Groups to estimated fair value. During the quarter ended
March 31, 2009, we recorded a charge of $9 million to
adjust the value of real estate investments in our Central Group
to estimated fair value.
F-60
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 11
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL INFORMATION
|
Our senior secured credit facilities and senior secured notes
are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by substantially all
existing and future, direct and indirect, wholly-owned material
domestic subsidiaries that are Unrestricted
Subsidiaries under our Indenture dated December 16,
1993 (except for certain special purpose subsidiaries that only
guarantee and pledge their assets under our senior secured
asset-based revolving credit facility).
Our summarized condensed consolidating balance sheets at
March 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009 and condensed
consolidating statements of income and cash flows for the
quarters ended March 31, 2010 and 2009, segregating the
parent company issuer, the subsidiary guarantors, the subsidiary
non-guarantors and eliminations, follow:
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING INCOME STATEMENT
FOR THE QUARTER ENDED MARCH 31, 2010
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
4,374
|
|
|
$
|
3,170
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
7,544
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,826
|
|
|
|
1,246
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,072
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
690
|
|
|
|
510
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,200
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
2
|
|
|
|
638
|
|
|
|
562
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,202
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
358
|
|
|
|
206
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
564
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(811
|
)
|
|
|
(27
|
)
|
|
|
(41
|
)
|
|
|
811
|
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
195
|
|
|
|
160
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
355
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
648
|
|
|
|
(115
|
)
|
|
|
(17
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
516
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
18
|
|
Management fees
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(118
|
)
|
|
|
118
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(161
|
)
|
|
|
3,462
|
|
|
|
2,747
|
|
|
|
811
|
|
|
|
6,859
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
161
|
|
|
|
912
|
|
|
|
423
|
|
|
|
(811
|
)
|
|
|
685
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
(227
|
)
|
|
|
313
|
|
|
|
123
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
209
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
388
|
|
|
|
599
|
|
|
|
300
|
|
|
|
(811
|
)
|
|
|
476
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
73
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
88
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
584
|
|
|
$
|
227
|
|
|
$
|
(811
|
)
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-61
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 11
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL
INFORMATION (continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING INCOME STATEMENT
FOR THE QUARTER ENDED MARCH 31, 2009
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Revenues
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
4,393
|
|
|
$
|
3,038
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
7,431
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Salaries and benefits
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,755
|
|
|
|
1,168
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,923
|
|
Supplies
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
721
|
|
|
|
489
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,210
|
|
Other operating expenses
|
|
|
5
|
|
|
|
617
|
|
|
|
480
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,102
|
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
508
|
|
|
|
299
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
807
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(705
|
)
|
|
|
(24
|
)
|
|
|
(44
|
)
|
|
|
705
|
|
|
|
(68
|
)
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
196
|
|
|
|
157
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
353
|
|
Interest expense
|
|
|
542
|
|
|
|
(66
|
)
|
|
|
(5
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
471
|
|
Losses (gains) on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
(2
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
Management fees
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(116
|
)
|
|
|
116
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(158
|
)
|
|
|
3,607
|
|
|
|
2,658
|
|
|
|
705
|
|
|
|
6,812
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Income before income taxes
|
|
|
158
|
|
|
|
786
|
|
|
|
380
|
|
|
|
(705
|
)
|
|
|
619
|
|
Provision for income taxes
|
|
|
(202
|
)
|
|
|
270
|
|
|
|
119
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
187
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
|
360
|
|
|
|
516
|
|
|
|
261
|
|
|
|
(705
|
)
|
|
|
432
|
|
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
14
|
|
|
|
58
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
72
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income attributable to HCA Inc.
|
|
$
|
360
|
|
|
$
|
502
|
|
|
$
|
203
|
|
|
$
|
(705
|
)
|
|
$
|
360
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-62
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 11
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL
INFORMATION (continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING BALANCE SHEET
MARCH 31, 2010
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current assets:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
80
|
|
|
$
|
308
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
Accounts receivable, net
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,253
|
|
|
|
1,625
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,878
|
|
Inventories
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
481
|
|
|
|
313
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
794
|
|
Deferred income taxes
|
|
|
1,181
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,181
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
182
|
|
|
|
315
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
497
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,181
|
|
|
|
2,996
|
|
|
|
2,561
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,738
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Property and equipment, net
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,880
|
|
|
|
4,372
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,252
|
|
Investments of insurance subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,146
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,146
|
|
Investments in and advances to affiliates
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
247
|
|
|
|
604
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
851
|
|
Goodwill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,635
|
|
|
|
926
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,561
|
|
Deferred loan costs
|
|
|
411
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
411
|
|
Investments in and advances to subsidiaries
|
|
|
22,641
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(22,641
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
988
|
|
|
|
16
|
|
|
|
128
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,132
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
25,221
|
|
|
$
|
11,774
|
|
|
$
|
9,737
|
|
|
$
|
(22,641
|
)
|
|
$
|
24,091
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS (DEFICIT) EQUITY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts payable
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
727
|
|
|
$
|
472
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,199
|
|
Accrued salaries
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
559
|
|
|
|
334
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
893
|
|
Other accrued expenses
|
|
|
622
|
|
|
|
274
|
|
|
|
602
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,498
|
|
Long-term debt due within one year
|
|
|
942
|
|
|
|
10
|
|
|
|
29
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
981
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,564
|
|
|
|
1,570
|
|
|
|
1,437
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,571
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Long-term debt
|
|
|
25,476
|
|
|
|
96
|
|
|
|
302
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
25,874
|
|
Intercompany balances
|
|
|
7,205
|
|
|
|
(10,805
|
)
|
|
|
3,600
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Professional liability risks
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,058
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,058
|
|
Income taxes and other liabilities
|
|
|
1,145
|
|
|
|
431
|
|
|
|
166
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,742
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
35,390
|
|
|
|
(8,708
|
)
|
|
|
6,563
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
33,245
|
|
Equity securities with contingent redemption rights
|
|
|
144
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
144
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stockholders (deficit) equity attributable to HCA
Inc.
|
|
|
(10,313
|
)
|
|
|
20,371
|
|
|
|
2,270
|
|
|
|
(22,641
|
)
|
|
|
(10,313
|
)
|
Noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
111
|
|
|
|
904
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,015
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(10,313
|
)
|
|
|
20,482
|
|
|
|
3,174
|
|
|
|
(22,641
|
)
|
|
|
(9,298
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
25,221
|
|
|
$
|
11,774
|
|
|
$
|
9,737
|
|
|
$
|
(22,641
|
)
|
|
$
|
24,091
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-63
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 11
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL
INFORMATION (continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING BALANCE SHEET
DECEMBER 31, 2009
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
ASSETS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current assets:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
95
|
|
|
$
|
217
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
312
|
|
Accounts receivable, net
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,135
|
|
|
|
1,557
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
3,692
|
|
Inventories
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
489
|
|
|
|
313
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
802
|
|
Deferred income taxes
|
|
|
1,192
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,192
|
|
Other
|
|
|
81
|
|
|
|
148
|
|
|
|
350
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
579
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,273
|
|
|
|
2,867
|
|
|
|
2,437
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6,577
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Property and equipment, net
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7,034
|
|
|
|
4,393
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
11,427
|
|
Investments of insurance subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,166
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,166
|
|
Investments in and advances to affiliates
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
244
|
|
|
|
609
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
853
|
|
Goodwill
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,641
|
|
|
|
936
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
2,577
|
|
Deferred loan costs
|
|
|
418
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
418
|
|
Investments in and advances to subsidiaries
|
|
|
21,830
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
963
|
|
|
|
19
|
|
|
|
131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,113
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,484
|
|
|
$
|
11,805
|
|
|
$
|
9,672
|
|
|
$
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS (DEFICIT) EQUITY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Current liabilities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Accounts payable
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
908
|
|
|
$
|
552
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
1,460
|
|
Accrued salaries
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
542
|
|
|
|
307
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
849
|
|
Other accrued expenses
|
|
|
282
|
|
|
|
293
|
|
|
|
583
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,158
|
|
Long-term debt due within one year
|
|
|
802
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
35
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
846
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,084
|
|
|
|
1,752
|
|
|
|
1,477
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4,313
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Long-term debt
|
|
|
24,427
|
|
|
|
103
|
|
|
|
294
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24,824
|
|
Intercompany balances
|
|
|
6,636
|
|
|
|
(10,387
|
)
|
|
|
3,751
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Professional liability risks
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,057
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,057
|
|
Income taxes and other liabilities
|
|
|
1,176
|
|
|
|
421
|
|
|
|
171
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,768
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
33,323
|
|
|
|
(8,111
|
)
|
|
|
6,750
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
31,962
|
|
Equity securities with contingent redemption rights
|
|
|
147
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
147
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Stockholders (deficit) equity attributable to HCA
Inc.
|
|
|
(8,986
|
)
|
|
|
19,787
|
|
|
|
2,043
|
|
|
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
|
(8,986
|
)
|
Noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
129
|
|
|
|
879
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,008
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(8,986
|
)
|
|
|
19,916
|
|
|
|
2,922
|
|
|
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
|
(7,978
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
$
|
24,484
|
|
|
$
|
11,805
|
|
|
$
|
9,672
|
|
|
$
|
(21,830
|
)
|
|
$
|
24,131
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-64
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 11
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL
INFORMATION (continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE QUARTER ENDED MARCH 31, 2010
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Cash flows from operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
$
|
599
|
|
|
$
|
300
|
|
|
$
|
(811
|
)
|
|
$
|
476
|
|
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by
operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
|
|
|
116
|
|
|
|
(670
|
)
|
|
|
(284
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(838
|
)
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
358
|
|
|
|
206
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
564
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
195
|
|
|
|
160
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
355
|
|
Income taxes
|
|
|
280
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
280
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
15
|
|
|
|
3
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
18
|
|
Amortization of deferred loan costs
|
|
|
20
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
20
|
|
Share-based compensation
|
|
|
8
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
8
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(811
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
811
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
18
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by operating activities
|
|
|
19
|
|
|
|
497
|
|
|
|
385
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
901
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from investing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Purchase of property and equipment
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(53
|
)
|
|
|
(161
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(214
|
)
|
Acquisition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(21
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(21
|
)
|
Disposition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
23
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
24
|
|
Change in investments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
22
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
29
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(3
|
)
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in investing activities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(47
|
)
|
|
|
(134
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(181
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from financing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Issuance of long-term debt
|
|
|
1,387
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,387
|
|
Net change in revolving credit facilities
|
|
|
1,339
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1,339
|
|
Repayment of long-term debt
|
|
|
(1,496
|
)
|
|
|
(11
|
)
|
|
|
(3
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,510
|
)
|
Distributions to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(33
|
)
|
|
|
(50
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(83
|
)
|
Changes in intercompany balances with affiliates, net
|
|
|
532
|
|
|
|
(421
|
)
|
|
|
(111
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Payment of debt issuance costs
|
|
|
(25
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(25
|
)
|
Payment of cash distribution to stockholders
|
|
|
(1,751
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,751
|
)
|
Other
|
|
|
(5
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in financing activities
|
|
|
(19
|
)
|
|
|
(465
|
)
|
|
|
(160
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(644
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in cash and cash equivalents
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(15
|
)
|
|
|
91
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
76
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
95
|
|
|
|
217
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
312
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
80
|
|
|
$
|
308
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
388
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-65
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 11
|
SUPPLEMENTAL
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL
INFORMATION (continued)
|
HCA
INC.
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE QUARTER ENDED MARCH 31, 2009
(Dollars in millions)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Parent
|
|
|
Subsidiary
|
|
|
Non-
|
|
|
|
|
|
Condensed
|
|
|
|
Issuer
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Guarantors
|
|
|
Eliminations
|
|
|
Consolidated
|
|
|
Cash flows from operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net income
|
|
$
|
360
|
|
|
$
|
516
|
|
|
$
|
261
|
|
|
$
|
(705
|
)
|
|
$
|
432
|
|
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by
(used in) operating activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
|
|
|
75
|
|
|
|
(706
|
)
|
|
|
(480
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(1,111
|
)
|
Provision for doubtful accounts
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
508
|
|
|
|
299
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
807
|
|
Depreciation and amortization
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
196
|
|
|
|
157
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
353
|
|
Income taxes
|
|
|
41
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
41
|
|
Losses on sales of facilities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Impairments of long-lived assets
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
9
|
|
Amortization of deferred loan costs
|
|
|
21
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
21
|
|
Share-based compensation
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
Pay-in-kind
interest
|
|
|
39
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
39
|
|
Equity in earnings of affiliates
|
|
|
(705
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
705
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
12
|
|
|
|
(4
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
12
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
|
|
|
(158
|
)
|
|
|
536
|
|
|
|
237
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
615
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from investing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Purchase of property and equipment
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(177
|
)
|
|
|
(160
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(337
|
)
|
Acquisition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(38
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(38
|
)
|
Disposition of hospitals and health care entities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
1
|
|
|
|
4
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
5
|
|
Change in investments
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(4
|
)
|
|
|
80
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
76
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
6
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash used in investing activities
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(218
|
)
|
|
|
(70
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(288
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash flows from financing activities:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Issuance of long-term debt
|
|
|
300
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
300
|
|
Net change in revolving credit facilities
|
|
|
(335
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(335
|
)
|
Repayment of long-term debt
|
|
|
(285
|
)
|
|
|
(1
|
)
|
|
|
(53
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(339
|
)
|
Distributions to noncontrolling interests
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(21
|
)
|
|
|
(34
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(55
|
)
|
Payment of debt issuance costs
|
|
|
(14
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(14
|
)
|
Changes in intercompany balances with affiliates, net
|
|
|
492
|
|
|
|
(304
|
)
|
|
|
(188
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Other
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
7
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
|
|
|
158
|
|
|
|
(326
|
)
|
|
|
(268
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(436
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Change in cash and cash equivalents
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(8
|
)
|
|
|
(101
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(109
|
)
|
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
134
|
|
|
|
331
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
465
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
126
|
|
|
$
|
230
|
|
|
$
|
|
|
|
$
|
356
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
F-66
HCA
INC.
NOTES TO
CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
|
|
NOTE 12
|
SUBSEQUENT
EVENTS
|
On May 5, 2010, our Board of Directors declared a distribution
to the Companys existing stockholders and holders of
vested stock options. The distribution will be $5.00 per share
and vested stock option, or approximately $500 million in the
aggregate. The distribution is expected to be paid on May 14,
2010 to holders of record on May 6, 2010. The distribution
is expected to be funded using funds available under our
existing senior secured credit facilities. Pursuant to the terms
of our stock option plans, the holders of nonvested stock
options will receive a $5.00 per share reduction to the exercise
price of their share-based awards.
On May 5, 2010, our Board of Directors granted approval for
the Company to file with the Securities and Exchange Commission
a registration statement on
Form S-1
relating to a proposed initial public offering of its common
stock. We expect to file the
Form S-1
on or about May 7, 2010. We intend to use the anticipated
net proceeds to repay certain of our existing indebtedness, as
will be determined prior to our offering, and for general
corporate purposes. Upon completion of the offering and in
connection with our termination of the management agreement we
have with affiliates of the Investors, we will be required to
pay a termination fee based upon the net present value of our
future obligations under the management agreement.
F-67
Shares
Common Stock
Prospectus
BofA Merrill Lynch
Citi
J.P. Morgan
Barclays Capital
Credit Suisse
Deutsche Bank
Securities
Goldman, Sachs &
Co.
Morgan Stanley
Wells Fargo
Securities
PART II
INFORMATION
NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
|
|
Item 13.
|
Other
Expenses of Issuance and Distribution.
|
The following table sets forth the costs and expenses, other
than underwriting discounts and commissions, payable solely by
the Registrant in connection with the offer and sale of the
securities being registered. All amounts are estimates except
the registration fee.
|
|
|
|
|
SEC registration fee
|
|
$
|
327,980
|
|
FINRA filing fee
|
|
|
*
|
|
New York Stock Exchange listing fee
|
|
|
*
|
|
Blue Sky fees and expenses
|
|
|
*
|
|
Transfer agents fee
|
|
|
*
|
|
Printing and engraving expenses
|
|
|
*
|
|
Legal fees and expenses
|
|
|
*
|
|
Accounting fees and expenses
|
|
|
*
|
|
Liability insurance for directors and officers
|
|
|
*
|
|
Miscellaneous
|
|
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Total
|
|
$
|
*
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
* |
|
To be completed by amendment. |
|
|
Item 14.
|
Indemnification
of Directors and Officers.
|
Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the
DGCL) grants each corporation organized thereunder
the power to indemnify any person who is or was a director,
officer, employee or agent of a corporation or enterprise,
against expenses, including attorneys fees, judgments,
fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably
incurred by him in connection with any threatened, pending or
completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal,
administrative or investigative, other than an action by or in
the right of the corporation, by reason of being or having been
in any such capacity, if he acted in good faith in a manner
reasonably believed to be in, or not opposed to, the best
interests of the corporation, and, with respect to any criminal
action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe his
conduct was unlawful.
Section 102(b)(7) of the DGCL enables a corporation in its
certificate of incorporation or an amendment thereto to
eliminate or limit the personal liability of a director to the
corporation or its stockholders of monetary damages for
violations of the directors fiduciary duty of care, except
(i) for any breach of the directors duty of loyalty
to the corporation or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or
omissions not in good faith or that involve intentional
misconduct or a knowing violation of law, (iii) pursuant to
Section 174 of the DGCL (providing for liability of
directors for unlawful payment of dividends or unlawful stock
purchases or redemptions) or (iv) for any transaction from
which a director derived an improper personal benefit.
HCA Inc.s bylaws indemnify the directors and officers to
the full extent of the DGCL and also allow the Board of
Directors to indemnify all other employees. Such indemnification
extends to the payment of judgments against such officers and
directors and to reimbursement of amounts paid in settlement of
such claims or actions and may apply to judgments in favor of
the corporation or amounts paid in settlement to the
corporation. Such indemnification also extends to the payment of
counsel fees and expenses of such officers and directors in
suits against them where successfully defended by them or where
unsuccessfully defended, if there is no finding or judgment that
the claim or action arose from the gross negligence or willful
misconduct of such officers or directors. Such right of
indemnification is not exclusive of any right to which such
officer or director may be entitled as a matter of law and shall
extend and apply to the estates of deceased officers and
directors.
II-1
HCA Inc. maintains a directors and officers
liability insurance policy that covers its directors and
officers in amounts that HCA Inc. believes are customary in its
industry, including for liabilities in connection with the
registration, offering and sale of the notes.
On November 1, 2009, we entered into an indemnification
priority and information sharing agreement with the Sponsors and
certain of its affiliated funds to clarify the priority of
advancement and indemnification obligations among us and any of
our directors appointed by the Sponsors and other related
matters.
The Company also agreed to indemnify certain officers of the
Company for adverse tax consequences they may suffer pursuant to
their employment agreements.
Pursuant to the registration rights agreement entered into with
the Investors in connection with the Recapitalization, the
Company agreed to indemnify the Investors from certain
liabilities incurred in connection with this registration
statement.
In addition, pursuant to the Management Agreement entered into
with the Sponsors and their affiliates and the Frists, the
Company has agreed to customary exculpation and indemnification
provisions for the benefit of the Sponsors, the Frists, their
affiliates, directors, officers and certain other persons. See
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions.
|
|
Item 15.
|
Recent
Sales of Unregistered Securities.
|
Equity
Securities
During the year ended December 31, 2007, HCA issued and
sold 781,960 shares of common stock for an aggregate
purchase price of $40 million to certain of our employees,
and HCA issued and sold 1,178,822 shares of common stock
for an aggregate purchase price of approximately
$60 million to Hercules Holding II, LLC. HCA issued and
sold 35,669 shares of common stock in connection with the
cashless exercise of stock options for aggregate consideration
of $454,780 resulting in 19,088 net settled shares. HCA
also issued and sold 519 shares of common stock in
connection with the cash exercise of stock options for aggregate
consideration of $6,617. These shares were issued without
registration in reliance on the exemptions afforded by
Section 4(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the
Securities Act), and Rule 701 promulgated
thereunder.
During the year ended December 31, 2008, HCA issued and
sold 445,506 shares of common stock in connection with the
cashless exercise of stock options for aggregate consideration
of $5,741,746 resulting in 224,627 net settled shares. HCA
also issued and sold 7,981 of common stock in connection with
the cash exercise of stock options for aggregate consideration
of $101,758. The shares were issued without registration in
reliance on the exemptions afforded by Section 4(2) of the
Securities Act, and Rule 701 promulgated thereunder.
During the year ended December 31, 2009, HCA issued and
sold 394,783 shares of common stock in connection with the
cashless exercise of stock options for aggregate consideration
of $5,033,483 resulting in 206,986 net settled shares. HCA
also issued and sold 52,598 of common stock in connection with
the cash exercise of stock options for aggregate consideration
of $670,625. HCA issued and sold 36,928 shares of common
stock for aggregate consideration of $1,889,606 to certain
employees. The shares were issued without registration in
reliance on the exemptions afforded by Section 4(2) of the
Securities Act, and Rule 701 promulgated thereunder.
During the quarter ended March 31, 2010, HCA issued and
sold 38,504 shares of common stock in connection with the
cashless exercise of stock options for aggregate consideration
of $490,926 resulting in 20,514 net settled shares. HCA
also issued and sold 12,156 shares of common stock in
connection with the cash exercise of stock options for aggregate
consideration of $154,989. These shares were issued without
registration in reliance on the exemptions afforded by
Section 4(2) of the Securities Act and Rule 701
promulgated thereunder.
Debt
Securities
On February 19, 2009, we issued $310 million aggregate
principal amount of
97/8%
senior secured notes due 2017 at a price of 96.673% of their
face value resulting in approximately $300 million of gross
proceeds, which
II-2
were used to repay outstanding indebtedness under our cash flow
credit facility. The initial purchasers for the senior secured
notes issued on February 19, 2009 were Banc of America
Securities LLC, Citigroup Global Markets Inc., J.P. Morgan
Securities Inc., Wachovia Capital Markets, LLC, Deutsche Bank
Securities Inc., Goldman, Sachs & Co., Barclays
Capital Inc., Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC and KKR Capital
Markets LLC.
On April 22, 2009, we issued $1.500 billion aggregate
principal amount of
81/2%
senior secured notes due 2019 at a price of 96.755% of their
face value resulting in approximately $1.451 billion of
gross proceeds, which were used to repay outstanding
indebtedness under our cash flow credit facility. The initial
purchasers for the senior secured notes issued on April 22,
2009 were Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Banc of America
Securities LLC, J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., Deutsche Bank
Securities Inc., Goldman, Sachs & Co., Wachovia
Capital Markets, LLC, Barclays Capital Inc., Credit Suisse
Securities (USA) LLC and Mizuho Securities USA Inc.
On August 11, 2009, we issued $1.250 billion aggregate
principal amount of
77/8% senior
secured notes due 2020 at a price of 98.254% of their face
value, resulting in approximately $1.228 billion of gross
proceeds, which were used to repay outstanding indebtedness
under our cash flow credit facility. The initial purchasers for
the senior secured notes issued on August 11, 2009 were
J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., Banc of America Securities
LLC, Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Goldman, Sachs &
Co., Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, Deutsche Bank Securities Inc.,
Barclays Capital Inc., Calyon Securities (USA) Inc., Credit
Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, GE Capital Markets, Inc., Mizuho
Securities USA Inc., Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated
and RBS Securities Inc.
On March 10, 2010, we issued $1.400 billion aggregate principal
amount of
71/4%
senior secured notes due 2020 at a price of 99.095% of their
face value resulting in approximately $1.387 billion of gross
proceeds, which were used to repay outstanding indebtedness
under our cash flow credit facility. The initial purchasers for
the senior secured notes issued on March 10, 2010 were Banc
of America Securities LLC, Citigroup Global Markets Inc.,
J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., Barclays Capital Inc.,
Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., Goldman, Sachs & Co.,
Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, Credit Agricole Securities (USA)
Inc., Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, Daiwa Securities
America Inc., Mizuho Securities USA Inc., Morgan
Stanley & Co. Incorporated, RBC Capital Markets
Corporation and RBS Securities Inc.
Each of the above offerings of debt securities was offered and
sold to qualified institutional buyers pursuant to
Rule 144A under the Securities Act or to
non-U.S. investors
outside the United States in compliance with Regulation S
of the Securities Act.
|
|
Item 16.
|
Exhibits
and Financial Statement Schedules.
|
(a) Exhibits
|
|
|
|
|
|
1
|
.1
|
|
Form of Underwriting Agreement.
|
|
2
|
.1
|
|
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated July 24, 2006, by and
among HCA Inc., Hercules Holding II, LLC and Hercules
Acquisition Corporation (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to the
Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed July 25, 2006, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
3
|
.1
|
|
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company.
|
|
3
|
.2
|
|
Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Company.
|
|
4
|
.1
|
|
Specimen Certificate for shares of Common Stock, par value $0.01
per share, of the Company (filed as Exhibit 3 to the
Companys
Form 8-A,
Amendment No. 2, filed March 11, 2004 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.2
|
|
Indenture, dated November 17, 2006, among HCA Inc., the
guarantors party thereto and The Bank of New York, as trustee
(filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
filed November 24, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.3
|
|
Security Agreement, dated as of November 17, 2006, among
HCA Inc., the subsidiary grantors party thereto and The Bank of
New York, as collateral agent (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the
Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed November 24, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
II-3
|
|
|
|
|
|
4
|
.4
|
|
Pledge Agreement, dated as of November 17, 2006, among HCA
Inc., the subsidiary pledgors party thereto and The Bank of New
York, as collateral agent (filed as Exhibit 4.3 to the
Companys Current Report of
Form 8-K
filed November 24, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.5(a)
|
|
Form of
91/8% Senior
Secured Notes due 2014 (included in Exhibit 4.2).
|
|
4
|
.5(b)
|
|
Form of
91/4% Senior
Secured Notes due 2016 (included in Exhibit 4.2).
|
|
4
|
.5(c)
|
|
Form of
95/8%/103/8% Senior
Secured Toggle Notes due 2016 (included in Exhibit 4.2).
|
|
4
|
.6
|
|
Indenture, dated February 19, 2009, among HCA Inc, the
guarantors party thereto, The Bank of New York Mellon, as
collateral agent and The Bank of New York Mellon
Trust Company, N.A., as trustee (filed as Exhibit 4.1
to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed February 25, 2009, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.7
|
|
Form of
97/8% Senior
Secured Notes due 2017 (included in Exhibit 4.6).
|
|
4
|
.8(a)
|
|
$13,550,000,000 1,000,000,000 Credit
Agreement, dated as of November 17, 2006, among HCA Inc.,
HCA UK Capital Limited, the lending institutions from time to
time parties thereto, Banc of America Securities LLC,
J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated, as joint lead arrangers and joint bookrunners,
Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent, JPMorgan Chase
Bank, N.A. and Citicorp North America, Inc., as co-syndication
agents and Merrill Lynch Capital Corporation, as documentation
agent (filed as Exhibit 4.8 to the Companys Current
Report on
Form 8-K
filed November 24, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.8(b)
|
|
Amendment No. 1 to the Credit Agreement, dated as of
February 16, 2007, among HCA Inc., HCA UK Capital Limited,
the lending institutions from time to time parties thereto, Bank
of America, N.A., as administrative agent, JPMorgan Chase Bank,
N.A., and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Co-Syndication
Agents, Banc of America Securities, LLC, J.P. Morgan
Securities Inc., Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and Merrill
Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, as joint
lead arrangers and bookrunners, Deutsche Bank Securities and
Wachovia Capital Markets LLC, as joint bookrunners and Merrill
Lynch Capital Corporation, as documentation agent (filed as
Exhibit 4.7(b) to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.8(c)
|
|
Amendment No. 2 to the Credit Agreement, dated as of
March 2, 2009, among HCA Inc., HCA UK Capital Limited, the
lending institutions from time to time parties thereto, Bank of
America, N.A., as administrative agent, JPMorgan Chase Bank,
N.A., and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Co-Syndication
Agents, Banc of America Securities, LLC, J.P. Morgan
Securities Inc., Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and Merrill
Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, as joint
lead arrangers and bookrunners, Deutsche Bank Securities and
Wachovia Capital Markets LLC, as joint bookrunners and Merrill
Lynch Capital Corporation, as documentation agent (filed as
exhibit 4.8(c) to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.8(d)
|
|
Amendment No. 3 to the Credit Agreement, dated as of
June 18, 2009, among HCA Inc., HCA UK Capital Limited, the
lending institutions from time to time parties thereto, Bank of
America, N.A., as administrative agent, JPMorgan Chase Bank,
N.A., and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Co-Syndication
Agents, Banc of America Securities, LLC, J.P. Morgan
Securities Inc., Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and Merrill
Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, as joint
lead arrangers and bookrunners, Deutsche Bank Securities and
Wachovia Capital Markets LLC, as joint bookrunners and Merrill
Lynch Capital Corporation, as documentation agent (filed as
Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed June 22, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.8(e)
|
|
Extension Amendment No. 1 to the Credit Agreement, dated as
of April 6, 2010, among HCA Inc., HCA UK Capital Limited,
the lending institutions from time to time parties thereto, Bank
of America, N.A., as administrative agent and collateral agent
(filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
filed April 8, 2010, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.9
|
|
U.S. Guarantee, dated November 17, 2006, among HCA Inc.,
the subsidiary guarantors party thereto and Bank of America,
N.A., as administrative agent (filed as Exhibit 4.9 to the
Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed November 24, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
II-4
|
|
|
|
|
|
4
|
.10
|
|
Indenture, dated as of April 22, 2009, among HCA Inc., the
guarantors party thereto, Deutsche Bank Trust Company
Americas, as paying agent, registrar and transfer agent, and Law
Debenture Trust Company of New York, as trustee (filed as
Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed April 28, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.11
|
|
Security Agreement, dated as November 17, 2006, and amended
and restated as of March 2, 2009, among the Company, the
Subsidiary Grantors named therein and Bank of America, N.A., as
Collateral Agent (filed as exhibit 4.10 to the
Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.12
|
|
Pledge Agreement, dated as of November 17, 2006, and
amended and restated as of March 2, 2009, among the
Company, the Subsidiary Pledgors named therein and Bank of
America, N.A., as Collateral Agent (filed as exhibit 4.11
to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.13
|
|
Form of
81/2% Senior
Secured Notes due 2019 (included in Exhibit 4.10).
|
|
4
|
.14
|
|
Indenture, dated as of August 11, 2009, among HCA Inc., the
guarantors party thereto, Deutsche Bank Trust Company
Americas, as paying agent, registrar and transfer agent, and Law
Debenture Trust Company of New York, as trustee (filed as
Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed August 17, 2009, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.15
|
|
Form of
77/8% Senior
Secured Notes due 2020 (included in Exhibit 4.14).
|
|
4
|
.16
|
|
Indenture, dated as of March 10, 2010, among HCA Inc., the
guarantors party thereto, Deutsche Bank Trust Company
Americas, as paying agent, registrar and transfer agent, and Law
Debenture Trust Company of New York, as trustee (filed as
Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed March 12, 2010, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.17
|
|
Form of
71/4% Senior
Secured Notes due 2020 (included in Exhibit 4.16).
|
|
4
|
.18(a)
|
|
$2,000,000,000 Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as
of June 20, 2007, among HCA Inc., the subsidiary borrowers
parties thereto, the lending institutions from time to time
parties thereto, Banc of America Securities LLC,
J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated, as joint lead arrangers and joint bookrunners,
Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent, JPMorgan Chase
Bank, N.A. and Citicorp North America, Inc., as co-syndication
agents, and Merrill Lynch Capital Corporation, as documentation
agent (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current
Report on
Form 8-K
filed June 26, 2007, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.18(b)
|
|
Amendment No. 1 to the $2,000,000,000 Amended and Restated
Credit Agreement, dated as of March 2, 2009, among HCA
Inc., the subsidiary borrowers parties thereto, the lending
institutions from time to time parties thereto, Banc of America
Securities LLC, J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., Citigroup
Global Markets Inc. and Merrill Lynch, Pierce,
Fenner & Smith Incorporated, as joint lead arrangers
and joint bookrunners, Bank of America, N.A., as administrative
agent, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Citicorp North America,
Inc., as co-syndication agents, and Merrill Lynch Capital
Corporation, as documentation agent (filed as
exhibit 4.12(b) to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.19
|
|
Security Agreement, dated as of November 17, 2006, among
HCA Inc., the subsidiary borrowers party thereto and Bank of
America, N.A., as collateral agent (filed as Exhibit 4.13
to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed November 24, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.20(a)
|
|
General Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of November 17,
2006, between Bank of America, N.A., as First Lien Collateral
Agent, and The Bank of New York, as Junior Lien Collateral Agent
(filed as Exhibit 4.13(a) to the Companys
Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.20(b)
|
|
Additional General Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of
April 22, 2009, by and among Bank of America, N.A., in its
capacity as First Lien Collateral Agent, The Bank of New York
Mellon, in its capacity as Junior Lien Collateral Agent and in
its capacity as 2006 Second Lien Trustee and The Bank of New
York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., in its capacity as 2009
Second Lien Trustee (filed as Exhibit 4.6 to the
Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed April 28, 2009, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
II-5
|
|
|
|
|
|
4
|
.20(c)
|
|
Additional General Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of
August 11, 2009, by and among Bank of America, N.A., in its
capacity as First Lien Collateral Agent, The Bank of New York
Mellon, in its capacity as Junior Lien Collateral Agent and in
its capacity as trustee for the Second Lien Notes issued on
November 17, 2006, and The Bank of New York Mellon
Trust Company, N.A., in its capacity as trustee for the
Second Lien Notes issued on February 19, 2009 (filed as
Exhibit 4.6 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed August 17, 2009, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.20(d)
|
|
Receivables Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of
November 17, 2006, among Bank of America, N.A., as ABL
Collateral Agent, Bank of America, N.A., as CF Collateral Agent
and The Bank of New York, as Bonds Collateral Agent (filed as
Exhibit 4.13(b) to the Companys Registration
Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.20(e)
|
|
Additional Receivables Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of
April 22, 2009, by and between Bank of America, N.A. as ABL
Collateral Agent, and Bank of America, N.A. as New First Lien
Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 4.7 to the
Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed April 28, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.20(f)
|
|
Additional Receivables Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of
August 11, 2009, by and between Bank of America, N.A., as
ABL Collateral Agent, and Bank of America, N.A., as New First
Lien Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 4.7 to the
Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed August 17, 2009, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.20(g)
|
|
First Lien Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of April 22,
2009, among Bank of America, N.A. as Collateral Agent, Bank of
America, N.A. as Authorized Representative under the Credit
Agreement and Law Debenture Trust Company of New York as
the Initial Additional Authorized Representative (filed as
Exhibit 4.5 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed April 28, 2009, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.21
|
|
Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of November 17,
2006, among HCA Inc., Hercules Holding II, LLC and certain other
parties thereto (filed as Exhibit 4.4 to the Companys
Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed November 24, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.22
|
|
Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of March 16, 1989,
by and among HCA-Hospital Corporation of America and the persons
listed on the signature pages thereto (filed as
Exhibit 4.14 to the Companys Registration Statement
on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.23
|
|
Assignment and Assumption Agreement, dated as of
February 10, 1994, between HCA-Hospital Corporation of
America and the Company relating to the Registration Rights
Agreement, as amended (filed as Exhibit 4.15 to the
Companys Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.24(a)
|
|
Indenture, dated as of December 16, 1993 between the
Company and The First National Bank of Chicago, as Trustee
(filed as Exhibit 4.16(a) to the Companys
Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.24(b)
|
|
First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of May 25, 2000
between the Company and Bank One Trust Company, N.A., as
Trustee (filed as Exhibit 4.16(b) to the Companys
Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.24(c)
|
|
Second Supplemental Indenture, dated as of July 1, 2001
between the Company and Bank One Trust Company, N.A., as
Trustee (filed as Exhibit 4.16(c) to the Companys
Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.24(d)
|
|
Third Supplemental Indenture, dated as of December 5, 2001
between the Company and The Bank of New York, as Trustee (filed
as Exhibit 4.16(d) to the Companys Registration
Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.24(e)
|
|
Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of November 14,
2006, between the Company and The Bank of New York, as Trustee
(filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
filed November 16, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.25
|
|
Form of 7.5% Debentures due 2023 (filed as
Exhibit 4.17 to the Companys Registration Statement
on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
II-6
|
|
|
|
|
|
4
|
.26
|
|
Form of 8.36% Debenture due 2024 (filed as
Exhibit 4.18 to the Companys Registration Statement
on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.27
|
|
Form of Fixed Rate Global Medium-Term Note (filed as
Exhibit 4.19 to the Companys Registration Statement
on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.28
|
|
Form of Floating Rate Global Medium-Term Note (filed as
Exhibit 4.20 to the Companys Registration Statement
on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.29
|
|
Form of 7.69% Note due 2025 (filed as Exhibit 4.10 to
the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2004 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.30
|
|
Form of 7.19% Debenture due 2015 (filed as
Exhibit 4.22 to the Companys Registration Statement
on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.31
|
|
Form of 7.50% Debenture due 2095 (filed as
Exhibit 4.23 to the Companys Registration Statement
on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.32
|
|
Form of 7.05% Debenture due 2027 (filed as
Exhibit 4.24 to the Companys Registration Statement
on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.33(a)
|
|
8.750% Note in the principal amount of $400,000,000 due
2010 (filed as Exhibit 4.26(a) to the Companys
Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.33(b)
|
|
8.750% Note in the principal amount of $350,000,000 due
2010 (filed as Exhibit 4.26(b) to the Companys
Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.34
|
|
8.75% Note due 2010 in the principal amount of
£150,000,000 (filed as Exhibit 4.27 to the
Companys Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.35(a)
|
|
77/8% Note
in the principal amount of $100,000,000 due 2011 (filed as
Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed January 31, 2001 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.35(b)
|
|
77/8% Note
in the principal amount of $400,000,000 due 2011 (filed as
Exhibit 4.2 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed January 31, 2001 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.36(a)
|
|
6.95% Note due 2012 in the principal amount of $400,000,000
(filed as Exhibit 4.29(a) to the Companys
Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.36(b)
|
|
6.95% Note due 2012 in the principal amount of $100,000,000
(filed as Exhibit 4.29(b) to the Companys
Registration Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.37(a)
|
|
6.30% Note due 2012 in the principal amount of $400,000,000
(filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
dated September 18, 2002 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.37(b)
|
|
6.30% Note due 2012 in the principal amount of $100,000,000
(filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
dated September 18, 2002 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.38(a)
|
|
6.25% Note due 2013 in the principal amount of $400,000,000
(filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
dated February 5, 2003 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.38(b)
|
|
63/4% Note
due 2013 in the principal amount of $100,000,000 (filed as
Exhibit 4.2 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
dated February 5, 2003 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.39(a)
|
|
63/4% Note
due 2013 in the principal amount of $400,000,000 (filed as
Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
dated July 23, 2003 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
II-7
|
|
|
|
|
|
4
|
.39(b)
|
|
63/4% Note
due 2013 in the principal amount of $100,000,000 (filed as
Exhibit 4.2 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
dated July 23, 2003 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.40
|
|
7.50% Note due 2033 in the principal amount of $250,000,000
(filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
dated November 6, 2003 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.41
|
|
5.75% Note due 2014 in the principal amount of $500,000,000
(filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
dated March 8, 2004 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.42(a)
|
|
6.375% Note due 2015 in the principal amount of
$500,000,000 (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Companys
Current Report on
Form 8-K
dated November 16, 2004 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.42(b)
|
|
6.375% Note due 2015 in the principal amount of
$250,000,000 (filed as Exhibit 4.3 to the Companys
Current Report on
Form 8-K
dated November 16, 2004 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
4
|
.43(a)
|
|
6.500% Note due 2016 in the principal amount of
$500,000,000 (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Companys
Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed on February 8, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
4
|
.43(b)
|
|
6.500% Note due 2016 in the principal amount of
$500,000,000 (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Companys
Current Report on
Form 8-K
filed on February 8, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
5
|
.1
|
|
Opinion of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP.
|
|
10
|
.1(a)
|
|
Amended and Restated Columbia/HCA Healthcare Corporation 1992
Stock and Incentive Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.7(b) to the
Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1998 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.1(b)
|
|
First Amendment to Amended and Restated Columbia/HCA Healthcare
Corporation 1992 Stock and Incentive Plan (filed as
Exhibit 10.2 to the Companys Quarterly Report on
Form 10-Q
for the quarter ended September 30, 1999 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.2
|
|
HCA-Hospital Corporation of America Nonqualified Initial Option
Plan (filed as Exhibit 4.6 to the Companys
Registration Statement on
Form S-3
(File
No. 33-52379),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.3
|
|
Form of Indemnity Agreement with certain officers and directors
(filed as Exhibit 10.3 to the Companys Registration
Statement on
Form S-4
(File
No. 333-145054)
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.4
|
|
Form of Galen Health Care, Inc. 1993 Adjustment Plan (filed as
Exhibit 4.15 to the Companys Registration Statement
on
Form S-8
(File
No. 33-50147)
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.5
|
|
Form of HCA-Hospital Corporation of America 1992 Stock
Compensation Plan (filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the
Companys Registration Statement on
Form S-8
(File
No. 33-52253),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.6
|
|
Columbia/HCA Healthcare Corporation 2000 Equity Incentive Plan
(filed as Exhibit A to the Companys Proxy Statement
for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders on May 25, 2000, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.7
|
|
Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Award Agreement (Officers)
(filed as Exhibit 99.2 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
dated February 2, 2005 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.8
|
|
HCA 2005 Equity Incentive Plan (filed as Exhibit B to the
Companys Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of
Shareholders on May 26, 2005, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
10
|
.9
|
|
Form of 2005 Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (Officers)
(filed as Exhibit 99.2 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
dated October 6, 2005, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
II-8
|
|
|
|
|
|
10
|
.10
|
|
Form of 2006 Non-Qualified Stock Option Award Agreement
(Officers) (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Companys
Current Report on
Form 8-K
dated February 1, 2006, and incorporated herein by
reference).
|
|
10
|
.11
|
|
2006 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees of HCA Inc. and its
Affiliates (filed as Exhibit 10.11 to the Companys
Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.12
|
|
Management Stockholders Agreement dated November 17,
2006 (filed as Exhibit 10.12 to the Companys Annual
Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.13
|
|
Sale Participation Agreement dated November 17, 2006 (filed
as Exhibit 10.13 to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.14
|
|
Form of Option Rollover Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.14
to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.15
|
|
Form of Stock Option Agreement (2007) (filed as
Exhibit 10.15 to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.16
|
|
Form of Stock Option Agreement (2008) (filed as
Exhibit 10.16 to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2007, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.17
|
|
Form of Stock Option Agreement (2009) (filed as
Exhibit 10.17 to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.18
|
|
Form of Stock Option Agreement (2010) (filed as
Exhibit 10.20 to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.19
|
|
Form of 2x Time Stock Option Agreement (filed as
Exhibit 10.2 to the Companys Quarterly Report on
Form 10-Q
for the quarterly period ended September 30, 2009, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.20
|
|
Exchange and Purchase Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.16 to
the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.21
|
|
Civil and Administrative Settlement Agreement, dated
December 14, 2000 between the Company, the United States
Department of Justice and others (filed as Exhibit 99.2 to
the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
dated December 20, 2000 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.22
|
|
Plea Agreement, dated December 14, 2000 between the
Company, Columbia Homecare Group, Inc., Columbia Management
Companies, Inc. and the United States Department of Justice
(filed as Exhibit 99.3 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
dated December 20, 2000 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.23
|
|
Corporate Integrity Agreement, dated December 14, 2000
between the Company and the Office of Inspector General of the
United States Department of Health and Human Services (filed as
Exhibit 99.4 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
dated December 20, 2000 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.24
|
|
Management Agreement, dated November 17, 2006, among HCA
Inc., Bain Capital Partners, LLC, Kohlberg Kravis
Roberts & Co. L.P., Dr. Thomas F. Frist, Jr.,
Patricia F. Elcan, William R. Frist and Thomas F.
Frist III, and Merrill Lynch Global Partners, Inc. (filed
as Exhibit 10.20 to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.25
|
|
Retirement Agreement between the Company and Thomas F. Frist,
Jr., M.D. dated as of January 1, 2002 (filed as
Exhibit 10.30 to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2001 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.26
|
|
Amended and Restated HCA Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan,
effective January 1, 2007, except as provided therein
(filed as Exhibit 10.24 to the Companys Annual Report
on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.27(a)
|
|
Amended and Restated HCA Restoration Plan, effective
January 1, 2008 (filed as Exhibit 10.25 to the
Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
II-9
|
|
|
|
|
|
10
|
.27(b)
|
|
First Amendment to the January 1, 2008 Restatement of the
HCA Restoration Plan, dated December 17, 2008 (filed as
Exhibit 10.28(b) to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.27(c)
|
|
Second Amendment to the January 1, 2008 Restatement of the
HCA Restoration Plan, dated December 23, 2009 (filed as
Exhibit 10.28(c) to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.28
|
|
HCA Inc. 2007 Senior Officer Performance Excellence Program
(filed as Exhibit 10.26 to the Companys Annual Report
on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.29(a)
|
|
HCA Inc.
2008-2009
Senior Officer Performance Excellence Program (filed as
Exhibit 10.27 to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2007, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.29(b)
|
|
HCA Inc. Amendment No. 1 to the
2008-2009
Senior Officer Performance Excellence Program (filed as
Exhibit 10.28(b) to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.30(a)
|
|
Employment Agreement dated November 16, 2006 (Richard M.
Bracken) (filed as Exhibit 10.27(b) to the Companys
Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.30(b)
|
|
Employment Agreement dated November 16, 2006 (R. Milton
Johnson) (filed as Exhibit 10.27(c) to the Companys
Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.30(c)
|
|
Employment Agreement dated November 16, 2006 (Samuel N.
Hazen) (filed as Exhibit 10.27(d) to the Companys
Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.30(d)
|
|
Employment Agreement dated November 16, 2006 (William P.
Rutledge) (filed as Exhibit 10.27(e) to the Companys
Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.30(e)
|
|
Employment Agreement dated November 16, 2006 (Beverly B.
Wallace) (filed as Exhibit 10.28(e) to the Companys
Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2007, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.30(f)
|
|
Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated October 27,
2008 (Jack O. Bovender, Jr.) (filed as
Exhibit 10.29(f) to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.30(g)
|
|
Amendment to Employment Agreement effective January 1, 2009
(Richard M. Bracken) (filed as Exhibit 10.29(g) to the
Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008, and
incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.31
|
|
Administrative Settlement Agreement dated June 25, 2003 by
and between the United States Department of Health and Human
Services, acting through the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid
Services, and the Company (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the
Companys Quarterly Report on
Form 10-Q
for the quarter ended June 30, 2003 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.32
|
|
Civil Settlement Agreement by and among the United States of
America, acting through the United States Department of
Justice and on behalf of the Office of Inspector General of the
Department of Health and Human Services, the TRICARE Management
Activity (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Companys
Quarterly Report of
Form 10-Q
for the quarter ended June 30, 2003 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.33
|
|
Form of Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement
of Hercules Holding II, LLC dated as of November 17, 2006,
among Hercules Holding II, LLC and certain other parties thereto
(filed as Exhibit 10.3 to the Companys Registration
Statement on
Form 8-A,
filed April 29, 2008 (File
No. 000-18406)
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.34
|
|
Indemnification Priority and Information Sharing Agreement,
dated as of November 1, 2009, between HCA Inc. and certain
other parties thereto (filed as Exhibit 10.35 to the
Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009 (File
No. 001-11239),
and incorporated herein by reference).
|
II-10
|
|
|
|
|
|
10
|
.35
|
|
HCA Inc. 2010 Senior Officer Performance Excellence Program
(filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Companys Current Report
on
Form 8-K
dated April 6, 2010, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
10
|
.36
|
|
Form of Restricted Share Unit Agreement (Officers) (filed as
Exhibit 10.2 to the Companys Current Report on
Form 8-K
dated April 6, 2010, and incorporated herein by reference).
|
|
21
|
.1
|
|
List of Subsidiaries.
|
|
23
|
.1
|
|
Consent of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP (included as
part of its opinion filed as Exhibit 5.1 hereto).
|
|
23
|
.2*
|
|
Consent of Ernst & Young LLP.
|
|
24
|
.1
|
|
Powers of Attorney (included in signature pages of this
prospectus).
|
|
|
|
* |
|
Filed herewith. |
|
|
|
To be filed by amendment. |
(b) Financial Statement Schedules
All schedules are omitted because the required information is
either not present, not present in material amounts or presented
within the consolidated financial statements included in the
prospectus and are incorporated herein by reference.
The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:
(1) For purposes of determining any liability under the
Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of
prospectus filed as part of this Registration Statement in
reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of
prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to
Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities
Act shall be deemed to be part of this Registration Statement as
of the time it was declared effective.
(2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the
Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that
contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new
registration statement relating to the securities offered
therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall
be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.
(3) Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising
under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to
directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant
pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the
registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the
Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is
against public policy as expressed in the Act and is, therefore,
unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification
against such liabilities (other than the payment by the
registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer
or controlling person of the registrant in the successful
defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the
securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the
opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by
controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate
jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is
against public policy as expressed in the Act and will be
governed by the final adjudication of such issue.
II-11
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the
registrant has duly caused this registration statement to be
signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly
authorized, in the City of Nashville, State of Tennessee, on
May 7, 2010.
HCA INC.
|
|
|
|
By:
|
/s/ R.
Milton Johnson
|
Name: R. Milton Johnson
|
|
|
|
Title:
|
Executive Vice President and Chief
|
Financial Officer
POWER OF
ATTORNEY
KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature
appears below hereby constitutes and appoints Richard M.
Bracken, R. Milton Johnson, David G. Anderson and John M. Franck
II, and each of them, the true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and
agents of the undersigned, with full power of substitution and
resubstitution, for and in the name, place and stead of the
undersigned, to sign in any and all capacities (including,
without limitation, the capacities listed below), the
registration statement, any and all amendments (including
post-effective amendments) to the registration statement and any
and all successor registration statements of HCA Inc., including
any filings pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities
Act of 1933, as amended, and to file the same, with all exhibits
thereto, and all other documents in connection therewith, with
the Securities and Exchange Commission, and hereby grants to
such attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power
and authority to do and perform each and every act and anything
necessary to be done to enable HCA Inc. to comply with the
provisions of the Securities Act and all the requirements of the
Securities and Exchange Commission, as fully to all intents and
purposes as the undersigned might or could do in person, hereby
ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and
agents, or any of them, or their or his or her substitute, or
substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue
hereof.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this
registration statement has been signed by the following persons
in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Signature
|
|
Title
|
|
Date
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Richard
M. Bracken
Richard
M. Bracken
|
|
Chairman of the Board and
Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ R.
Milton Johnson
R.
Milton Johnson
|
|
Executive Vice President,
Chief Financial Officer and Director
(Principal Financial Officer and Principal
Accounting Officer)
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Christopher
J. Birosak
Christopher
J. Birosak
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ John
P. Connaughton
John
P. Connaughton
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
II-12
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Signature
|
|
Title
|
|
Date
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ James
D. Forbes
James
D. Forbes
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Kenneth
W. Freeman
Kenneth
W. Freeman
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Thomas
F. Frist III
Thomas
F. Frist III
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ William
R. Frist
William
R. Frist
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Christopher
R. Gordon
Christopher
R. Gordon
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Michael
W. Michelson
Michael
W. Michelson
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ James
C. Momtazee
James
C. Momtazee
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Stephen
G. Pagliuca
Stephen
G. Pagliuca
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
|
|
|
|
|
/s/ Nathan
C. Thorne
Nathan
C. Thorne
|
|
Director
|
|
May 7, 2010
|
II-13